HISTORY of the
87th MOUNTAIN INFANTRY
in ITALY
George F. Earle
Captain, 87th Mountain Infantry
1945
3 JANUARY 1945 — 14 AUGUST 1945
Digitized and edited by Barbara Imbrie, 2004
CONTENTS
PREFACE: THE 87TH REGIMENT FROM DECEMBER 1941 TO JANUARY 1945................. i - iii
INTRODUCTION TO ITALY .................................................................................................. 1
(4 Jan — 16 Feb)
BELVEDERE OFFENSIVE..................................................................................................... 10
(16 Feb — 28 Feb)
MARCH OFFENSIVE AND CONSOLIDATION..................................................................... 24
(3 Mar — 31 Mar)
SPRING OFFENSIVE TO PO VALLEY................................................................................... 43
(1 Apr — 20 Apr)
Preparation: 1 Apr—13 Apr 43
First day: 14 April 48
Second day: 15 April 61
Third day: 16 April 75
Fourth day: 17 April 86
Fifth day: 18 April 96
Sixth day: 19 April 99
Seventh day: 20 April 113
PO VALLEY TO LAKE GARDA...........................................................................................120
(21 Apr — 2 May)
Eighth day: 21 April 120
Ninth day: 22 April 130
Tenth day: 23 April 132
Eleventh and Twelfth days: 24-25 April 149
Thirteenth day: 26 April 150
Fourteenth day: 27 April 152
Fifteenth day: 28 April 155
Sixteenth day: 29 April 157
End of the Campaign: 30 April-2 May 161
OCCUPATION DUTY AND RETURN TO THE STATES........................................................165
(8 May — 14 August)
COMBAT ORGANIZATION OF THE 87TH REGIMENT.......................................................172
CASUALTIES OF THE 87TH REGIMENT.............................................................................173
ROLL OF HONOR OF THE 87TH REGIMENT......................................................................174
MAPS OF THE CAMPAIGN*
MAP 1. RIVA RIDGE ........................................................................................180
MAP 2. MT. BELVEDERE RIDGE ......................................................................181
MAP 3. MARCH OFFENSIVE............................................................................182
MAP 4. SPRING OFFENSIVE ............................................................................183
MAP 5. BREAKOUT .........................................................................................184
MAP 6. PO VALLEY SOUTH.............................................................................185
MAP 7. PO RIVER CROSSING ..........................................................................186
MAP 8. ADVANCE TO LAKE GARDA..............................................................187
MAP 9. LAKE GARDA: THE FINAL BATTLES..................................................188
BATTLE ROUTE OF THE
10th MOUNTAIN DIVISION CAMPAIGN IN ITALY
December 1944 – May 1945
*Modified by Barbara Imbrie from original battle diagrams published by Armand
Casini in 1945.
PREFACE
THE 87TH REGIMENT
FROM DECEMBER 1941 TO JANUARY 1945
The first element of the 87th Mountain Infantry, now part of the 10th Mountain Division, was
officially formed at Fort Lewis, Washington on 8 December 1941, the day after Pearl Harbor
was attacked. Four days previously, twelve officers and one enlisted man had met and were designated
as the “87th Infantry, Mountain, 1st Battalion, Reinforced.” Lieutenant Colonel ONSLOW
S. ROLFE was in command. Most of the original officers are now within the 10th Mountain
Division, but the identity of the enlisted man is unknown. He was drafted in to stoke the
fires, and was the only non-volunteer in the early days of the outfit.
During the next few days a large number of volunteer cadre arrived from regular army
units—many from the 15th Cavalry, so that by December 8th, there were approximately 75 officers
and enlisted men, all attached to A Company, but forming the nucleus of A, B, C, D, Headquarters,
and Service Companies. This first United States mountain organization was the result
of efforts of army and civilian groups, which prevailed upon the War Department after more
than a year of effort. Most active among civilian groups was the National Ski Patrol Association,
headed by MINOT DOLE, who had been in correspondence with General MARSHALL for several
months. This organization, through a special arrangement with the War Department, supplied
a large proportion of the volunteers. During the previous winter, a ski patrol from the 15th
Infantry Regiment had trained on Mount Rainier, and other army skiing had been done at Lake
Placid and in Wisconsin.
Almost at once, the present communications officer, Captain (then Private) JOSEPH A.
HEARST, caught a communicable disease, quarantining A Company for 21 days over Christmas
and New Year’s Day, thereby becoming the most unpopular private in the new outfit. This
seemed to establish a precedent, for on the following Christmas the outfit was confined because
of maneuvers in California; the one after that found most of them on ships returning from the
Aleutians; and the Christmas of 1944 was spent in the Staging Area getting ready to ship to Italy.
In January of 1942 all manner of ski and winter equipment was issued, and ski calisthenics
were given in the mud of Fort Lewis, Washington. Late in the month, Companies A, B, and C
moved up to Tatoosh and Paradise Lodges on Mount Rainier for ski training. Tests were devised
and a ski school set up. The testing of equipment and mountain techniques were handled by a
section of the unit called the Mountain and Winter Warfare Board. Master Sergeant WILLIAM P.
JONES, then First Sergeant of Company A, and now regimental Sergeant Major, at this time
proved to the satisfaction of Colonel ROLFE and the Board that all soldiers could not be made
into skiers. As advised, Sergeant JONES permanently put away his skis.
Meanwhile, Company D and the Service Company under Captain GEORGE FLETCHER,
now Colonel, G-3 of the 91st Division in Italy, remained down at Fort Lewis, building a corral for
the mules. In the spring, Company D moved up for a brief ski period. The Battalion returned to
Fort Lewis in May, and by this time, the all-volunteer outfit had grown large enough to form a
Second Battalion under the command of Major RICHARD F. READY. Major FLETCHER was
given command of the First.
At this time, the unit was made up of world-famous skiers, mountaineers, forest rangers and
trappers, lumbermen and guides, and a group of cowboys, muleskinners and horsemen, in addition
to the regular army cadre. A riding school was begun at Fort Lewis in July. A detachment
T
spent two summer months in the Columbian Ice Fields in Canada to develop an over-snow vehicle,
the great-granddaddy of the present M-29 “Weasel.” Incredible as it may seem to the Infantry,
another detachment made a movie short in Hollywood, the first of several films featuring ski
troops of the 87th. At a later date, both Warner Brothers and Paramount made pictures on the
Army ski slopes.
Intensive military training began in September at the Main Camp in Fort Lewis with rigorous
conditioning and range work. Colonel JEFFERSON B. WILLIS took command of the regiment
under the over-all command of Colonel ROLFE. On 18 November 1942, the 1st and 2nd Battalions
entrained for maneuvers at Jolon, California, accompanied by the horses and mules. For six
weeks the two battalions maneuvered against a battalion of the First Filipino Regiment. Meanwhile,
a site had been chosen for a brand new camp to house the 87th, on the Continental Divide
in Colorado, at 9,480 feet above sea level. Camp Hale was to be complete with a mile-long ski
tow, several rope tows, stables, and even ski waxing rooms in the barracks. The camp was nearing
completion while the 1st and 2nd Battalions maneuvered, and a skeleton 3rd Battalion,
formed in September, moved and waited at Camp Hale until rejoined by the rest of the regiment
just before the new year.
Many new problems in winter-military training were presented by the extreme high altitude
and weather. Over a hundred types of equipment and vehicles were tested. Units and detachments,
to the size of battalions, bivouacked in the surrounding mountains at 12,000 feet, and ran
problems and tests in the snow and extreme cold. Unusual schools were set up with experienced
men in charge to teach—not only skiing, but snow-shoeing, snow freighting, and trail breaking
on toboggan. Dog teams were attached, and men were trained in their handling. Men were
trained to build snow caves; taught to cook the mountain ration individually; trained in the prevention
of avalanches; and instructed in rescue work. Detachments were sent to teach skiing and
mountaineering at Camp McCoy, Wisconsin, and to a mountain-training center at Seneca Falls,
Virginia. Techniques slowly evolved both from winter military operations, and from living successfully
under the extreme conditions.
Various manuals were written. A ”Manual of Skis” for drilling and marching in the snow
was taught. The Mountain Soldier carried his rifle on his back, and his skis at “right shoulder”
while marching. He also gave the “Ski salute,” and learned to stack skis and to mount and dismount
them “by the numbers.” Also, early in the winter, a nucleus of officers and enlisted men
from the 87th formed the cadre for the new 86th Infantry Regiment. Later, in the spring, schools
were set up for rock-climbing, mule packing, and forest fire fighting. Scout and Attack Dog Detachment
joined; and even pigeons, reputedly helpless at the camp altitude, not only flew missions,
but presented the regiment with its first egg late in May. The development of the snow
vehicle was progressing with revisions of the old model, and also rejections of several abortive
experimental contraptions. Civilian Arctic explorers and renowned mountaineers lent technical
advice. Yet the severe conditions caused a high casualty and reclassification rate. The old Regular
Army cadre at times despaired of ever doing any soldiering, considering the experts on detached
service, the many schools, and the reclassifications. Meanwhile, the regular infantry training
struggled on, men often firing on the range at twenty below zero in swirling snow.
On 11 June 1943, the outfit left for amphibious training, conducted by the Marines at Fort
Ord, California. After a two-week training cruise to San Diego, the regiment entrained at Fort
Ord on the night of 27 July, boarded four ships in San Francisco the same night, and sailed for
Adak in the Aleutians on the 29th of July as part of Amphibian Training Force Nine, preparatory
to the occupation of Kiska. The regiment landed on the beach at Adak and bivouacked there
from 9 to 12 August under their new commander, Colonel ROY V. RICKARD.
ii
In the lee of volcanic Great Sitkin, in Adak’s outer harbor, a great convoy including forty
thousand troops and a large portion of the Pacific Fleet formed up in a rare Aleutian sunset on 13
August. Land-based planes were still returning from Kiska, and paratroopers waited on Amchitka
to support the occupation. Each battalion was to assault a separate landing point, each the
spearhead to one of the three major landings. Through the fog, on the mornings of the 15th and
16th, the regiment hit the beaches, quickly climbed the precipitous cliffs of the north shore, and
obtained their initial objectives. There was no opposition encountered beyond the severe winds,
fog, and occasional mines. On the landing, the 1st Battalion was commanded by one of the organization’s
earliest arrivals, Lieutenant Colonel ROSS J. WILSON, the 2nd by Major EMMETT L.
NATIONS, and the 3rd by Lieutenant Colonel ARTHUR H. HENDERSON.
During the operation and occupation, much of the special equipment proved itself. Especially
notable was the early model of the present M-29, then called the T-15, which gave promise
of its future combat value. At the conclusion of the successful occupation, Colonel RICKARD
and the regiment received commendation from observers of the War and Navy Departments.
Colonel RICKARD moved on to another assignment, leaving the regimental executive officer,
Lieutenant Colonel JOHN F. SCHMELZER, in temporary command. On 5 October, Colonel
JESSE E. GRAHAM assumed command of the regiment, now reassembled as a unit. During November
and December, battalions were withdrawn individually to the States, and by 1 January
1944, the entire regiment was back at Camp Carson, Colorado.
In the middle of February, the 87th replaced the 90th in the 10th Light Division and was
moved up again to Camp Hale, Colorado, coming under the command of Colonel PAUL F.
“Pop” GOODE. The 87th Mountain Infantry Regiment shortly became the 87th Infantry Regiment,
Light. In the Division were the 86th and 85th Regiments, the latter activated at Camp Hale
after the 87th left for Kiska. With the 85th and 86th Regiments, the 87th went into the “D-Series,”
a six-week maneuver in sub-zero weather, down to thirty-eight degrees below zero, conducted in
the mountainous terrain near Camp Hale. In one night alone, over one hundred cases of frostbite
were evacuated, and all men who completed the maneuver were commended.
Colonel DAVID M. FOWLER assumed command of the regiment in early June. In late June,
the regiment moved with the Division to Camp Swift, Texas, into a broiling summer of small-unit
problems, and 25-mile speed marches. A final reorganization took place in the fall. The 10th became
the only Mountain Division in the U.S. Army, and the 87th, at one time the only Mountain
Regiment, now shared that distinction with the 85th and the 86th.
The 87th Mountain Infantry entrained from Camp Swift, Texas on 20 December, for Camp
Patrick Henry, Virginia, and embarked at Newport News on the USS West Point on 3 January
1945. Sailing time: 1100, 4 January 1945; destination: Naples, Italy.
iii
INTRODUCTION TO ITALY
PATROL ACTION
(4 JAN — 16 FEB)
nique in being the first infantry regiment to sail to both the Pacific and European Theaters,
the 87th Mountain Infantry embarked at Newport News, Virginia, on the morning of 3
January 1945, shortly after the start of our country’s fourth year of World War II. Less than onehalf
of the heavily burdened men who struggled up the steep gangplanks of the USS West Point,
and filed down to their compartments, had made the amphibious landing on Kiska Island a year
and a half before. A large percentage had joined the regiment since the conclusion of mountain
training six months previously, when the move from Camp Hale, Colorado, to Camp Swift,
Texas, was accomplished. But a strong nucleus of officers and enlisted men remained who had
followed the Regimental Colors most, or all of the way, from Fort Lewis and Mount Rainier, to
Jolon, to Camp Hale, to Fort Ord on the west coast, to San Francisco, to Adak, and to Kiska; then
back to Camp Carson, to Camp Hale, and finally to Camp Swift and the East Coast Staging Area,
Camp Patrick Henry.
Under the command of Colonel DAVID M. FOWLER, old and new had shaken down into a
well-integrated force. On New Year’s Day, a brief ceremony had been held at Camp Patrick
Henry in which the history of the organization was reviewed, and some of its traditional songs
were sung to pass on to the new men some of the spirit of the regiment.
On the gray morning of 4 January, the West Point slid from the pier, and moved down the
calm harbor past Old Point Comfort, and out into the long Atlantic swells. The 87th Mountain
Infantry had completed one of the longest wartime training periods of any U.S. Army combat
unit, and certainly the most unusual and varied. The morale was of the kind known only to a
unit old enough and rich enough in its own traditions, possessing a colorful individuality, a unit
with songs and stories.
The West Point, formerly the peacetime liner SS America, largest ship ever built in the United
States, made the Atlantic crossing in nine days. Landfall was made in the forenoon of the seventh
day, and the Straits of Gibraltar were passed through that afternoon in a rare spell of sunshine.
Two days later the great ship slipped close by the towering Isle of Capri and docked at Naples on
13 January in a series of cold rainsqualls that all but blotted out snow-spotted Mount Vesuvius.
At an end were the seasickness, and the normal friction of crowded troops on a rough crossing.
The 87th and its sister regiment, the 85th Mountain Infantry, had crossed on the West Point without
convoy escort. Nothing important occurred, except for those men in the compartments beneath
the troop dispensary where, just after daybreak on the sixth day out, heavy seas tore life
rafts loose from the decks above, and smashed them through the port side of the ship, staving in
three plates and pouring tons of sea water into just-vacated bunks. The icy seawater washed duffel
bags and gear against the alarmed men as they waded out of bed. The hold compartment below
had to be evacuated as it filled with several feet of water before the damage could be shored
up.
The arrival of the 87th in Naples brought them some fifteen and one-half degrees beyond
halfway around the world since their departure from Kiska Harbor a little more than a year before.
No sharper contrast could be drawn than between that stark, rain-washed, uninhabited island
jutting out of the North Pacific, and this ancient Italian port, cluttered and teeming with
people, ships, and crowded buildings.
U
Jan 13
2
The 2nd and 3rd Battalions, and Company D, immediately debarked and boarded Italian
four-wheel freight cars for the long overland trip north, through Rome, to Leghorn. The men
slept on the boxcar floors, and cooked C-rations on small open fires kindled on the floors. They
left Naples on the night of 13 January and rode all day and night of the 14th, through scenes of
the previous year’s devastation. Especially marked was the area near Cisterno and Anzio. They
passed through Rome on the second night, and on 15 January, changed to trucks at Leghorn—
reaching the staging area north of Pisa late in the evening.
The 1st Battalion, less Company D, Headquarters Company of the regiment, and Service
Company, were to make the trip north by ship. They remained in Naples Harbor almost three
days until the Italian stevedores could, in the greatest confusion, complete the loading of organizational
equipment on the Italian freighter Sestriere. Short exercise marches within the harbor
area displayed the terrible war damage to the local buildings and to human beings alike. The
stunted, malnourished Neapolitans of the docks appeared degenerate and loathsome to the
American soldier as they clambered around in their rags, and picked little morsels of garbage
from the cracks of the docks. However, the soldiers were very willing to swap American cigarettes
for rings and trinkets.
The dirty little Sestriere seemed dwarfed and was a poor sequel to the West Point; but the trip
up the Tyrrhenian Coast, threading through the historic islands on a calm sea turned out to be
more pleasant than anticipated. On the following day, the 17th, in the afternoon, the ship passed
through Leghorn’s ancient seawall and her recent wall of German-scuttled ships, and the troops
entrucked to join the remainder of the regiment beyond Pisa.
The Peninsular Base Section, Staging Area No. 3, was a conveniently arranged bivouac of pyramidal
and pup tents located on property formerly part of King Victor Emanuel’s Hunting
Grounds; and the rows of stately trees and vistas of distant snowy mountain masses remained fit
for a king.
On 21 January, the regiment moved into a bivouac east of Camaiore, as IV Corps reserve,
with the possible mission of supporting the 92nd Division either in the narrow coastal plain or in
the Serchio Valley. The 3rd Battalion bivouacked and billeted in and around Villa Colli; the 2nd
Battalion bivouacked on a hillside nearby, while the 1st Battalion bivouacked down the road toward
Valpromaro. Except for battalion headquarters, and some other elements of the 3rd Battalion,
the regiment passed up the many possible farmhouse billets in the neighborhood for the
Spartan life in the open; and the tents were surrounded with mud and snow. The bivouac area
near Villa Colli was a good seven airline miles to the rear of the 92nd Division, and the unit’s position
was strategic rather than tactical. From that point, they could be rapidly shifted to either
the coastal plain or to the Serchio Valley—avenues of approach where the Germans had made
alarming penetrations in the past. Directly to the front, however, was a series of jagged mountain
peaks and ridges, and deep roadless valleys that had never seen any action, and were only
scouted by occasional patrols of both sides.
So the statement that there was nothing between the 87th and the enemy, which flashed
around the regiment, was the truth—but not the whole truth. The system of setting up tactically,
with guards, outposts, and gun emplacements further supported the belief that this was more
than a training area. Consequently, the area developed into a hotbed of flashing lights, green and
blue flares, skulking figures on ridges, and assorted rifle, pistol, and machine gun shots. Patrols
discovered houses with candles set by the window so that the shade might be drawn and raised
for the enemy, and finally, a poor suspicious-looking character (a local Italian) was held until ordered
released to the CIC (Counter Intelligence). The nights were exciting, and the only reason
Jan 21
3
the promiscuous shooting by guards didn’t bring more positive results is that some Providence
looked after the drunken American soldier as he staggered back to his tent.
Winter equipment was issued in this area, and various firing ranges were established for
training. Training hikes and patrols were made. Field Order No. 1, dealing with the defense of
the Serchio Valley and the Coastal Sectors was completed and sent to IV Corps headquarters at
Lucca, on 25 January 1945.
Introduction to Battle
Meanwhile, on the narrow coastal plain dotted with resort towns and laced with canals, a
memorable “First” occurred. It was the morning of 27 January that the first shot was fired
against the enemy by the 87th Mountain Infantry. After hundreds of thousands of expended
rounds of ammunition, one round was finally fired against the enemy—in the fourth year of the
unit’s existence. Not the first shot fired in anger—thousands of angry shots had peppered the
Kiska fog—but the first shot against a living and present enemy.
The first bang was a resounding one, fired from one of nine pack howitzers brought up and
dug into position on the coast, in the sector held by the 371st Infantry, supported by the 599th
Field Artillery. Pfc. RAYMOND IWANKOWSKI pulled the lanyard of Gun No. 1, 1st Platoon, 1st
Battalion, under command of Second Lieutenant ROCCO C. SICILIANO. This use of the 92nd
Division front line for the howitzers was the first of several arrangements whereby the 87th
Mountain Infantry “borrowed” a few of the enemy opposing the 92nd Division, to use as targets
for a last-minute “warm-up” before moving up into our own sector of the front. The 92nd Division
was very willing and cooperative in arranging for the mountaineers’ “practice” on their enemy.
The next day, 28 January, eighteen mortars from the weapons companies were emplaced and
fired behind Company E, 371st Infantry. Meanwhile, on the 29th and 30th, sixty riflemen from
the 1st and 3rd Battalions, 87th, went out on sniping missions in the mountainous terrain just inland
from the coast near Seravezza, twenty miles northwest of Lucca, in front of Companies K
and L and the Intelligence and Reconnaissance (I & R) Platoon of the 371st Infantry. Initially, in
these missions, the front line was approached with some misgivings. The observation posts were
selected for the 75s with great caution, but quickly the awe of the front line disappeared and by
nightfall, the situation around the guns seemed almost festive, with the crews bunking in the
houses of the congenial Italian families. Life seemed to prove more comfortable at the front than
it had been at the rear. As they ate breakfast after the second day’s firing, German 88s zeroed in,
bracketing Second Lieutenant EDWIN A. SMITH’s 2nd Battalion gun positions, breaking up
breakfast, and finally striking within two feet of a gun, damaging it slightly. Quick counterbattery
fire from the 599th allowed the guns to be pulled out and saved. The crew, although
without casualty, had one man knocked down by shrapnel and his wind knocked out. Everyone
was shaken up and sobered down. Jerry had taken notice of the first shots of the 87th.
Later, the mortar crews fired their mission without event, and some of the sniper groups, under
Second Lieutenant CHARLES L. PFEIFFER and First Lieutenant MORLAN W. NELSON,
found targets and drew fire, from both automatic weapons and 88-mm artillery which drove a
group of them from a house at noon and struck one man with a flying rock.
On short notice, this training activity and the range firing, marches, and practice patrols in
progress near the bivouac area ended. The regiment reverted back to 10th Mountain Division
control on 29 January, and prepared to relieve the 86th Mountain Infantry in the old Task Force
45 sector, now controlled by 10th Mountain Division. A movement order was received on 1 February.
The 87th was to relieve the 86th, which had been on the line for a month. On the left, the
Jan 28
4
85th would continue as they had for the past two weeks. The 2nd Battalion moved forward on
the early afternoon of 2 February, riding by truck 47 miles, detrucking and then marching eight
miles over a most difficult mud and ice trail, closing at 2245 in Vidiciatico, after five hours of
stumbling and falling in the foggy blackness under full field equipment. Colonel FOWLER called
it a feat of war which only the Infantry is called upon to perform. Every man, he believed, fell
down on the mud-coated ice at least once, and he felt that the march alone, within range of German
artillery, entitled all who made it to the Combat Infantryman’s Badge.
The 3rd Battalion went into regimental reserve, in and around San Marcello, with Battalion
Headquarters at the sanatorium at Colonia Montana. Replacing the 1st Battalion, 86th, the 3rd
Battalion made the fifty-eight mile trip by truck. The regimental command post (CP) opened in a
villa in San Marcello. The 1st Battalion stayed on a few days longer at the rear. Although an advance
CP was opened at Cutigliano on 1 February, the troops did not move up until the 5th.
Patrol Action and Minor Skirmishes
Seventeen days elapsed between the arrival of the regiment at the front and D-Day. The action
was largely of a patrol nature. The firefights divided themselves into, first, our patrols attacking
enemy positions in the Vidiciatico-Belvedere area, and, second, our 1st and 3rd Battalions
successively defending the Cutigliano-la Lima sector against German patrols. The Vidiciatico-
Belvedere area, occupied continuously by the 2nd Battalion through D-Day, was the more important,
since the eventual battle was fought there. The series of active patrols that felt their way
forward, and eventually confirmed accurately the enemy line on the slopes of Mt. Belvedere,
were important. The patrol work of the whole regiment, while overshadowed by the battle that
followed, and looked back upon as comparatively easy, should be evaluated against several factors.
The men were new to the front, and had never entered no-man’s-land before; not to mention
that probing beyond, into the unknown land of the enemy, can be more nerve-racking to the
individual than the mass movements of battle. There is the long strain of silent movement, the
breathless waits, the inexorable searching out of him who lies in wait to kill. There is the physical
punishment and even torture of alternately sweating up the rough terrain and lying motionless
for hours on the snow—freezing in your own icy sweat. Finally, there is the fast withdrawal,
possibly under fire, with no litter bearers for the casualty, and only the desperate loyalty of a
comrade to drag the wounded in. The 2nd Battalion scheduled a total of 33 patrols prior to DDay.
Its patrols were the most numerous, and some performed brilliantly in their encounters
with the enemy.
VIDICIATICO FRONT
The 2nd Battalion had reached the snow-covered mountain town of Vidiciatico on the night
of 2 February. Outposts were manned around the town, and out on either side of the Mt. Belvedere
road, beyond Querciola. The road through Querciola runs along a ridge top, connecting two
mountain masses and forming sharp watersheds on either side. It is like two domes connected
by a ridgepole and roof. On the lower slopes of Monte Grande (1,531 meters), the larger dome, is
Vidiciatico. Reaching more than halfway along the ridgepole, and on either side of it, to Querciola,
was the 2nd Battalion. Beyond loomed German-held Mt. Belvedere (1,139 meters), the
other dome. Running down on either side of the ridge road are deeply eroded draws, containing
swift and deep streams and with many sheer rock faces and waterfalls. The “ridgepole” runs
more or less to the north from Vidiciatico. At right angles to it, running west from the summit of
Belvedere, is another ridge, appearing on the skyline from along the Vidiciatico-Querciola road.
This ridge was the German front line, starting up on Belvedere and running down to cross the
Querciola road at a little town called Corona, and then on down the slope between deep ravines
to Rocca Corneta, a spectacular rock escarpment with a church atop its walls. Further to the left,
5
the “rock” drops to the river. Across the river the sheer walls of Pizzo di Campiano rise abruptly,
a steep mountain ridge, higher than Belvedere. In the lower valley areas, and in the areas above
the deep draws, irregularly terraced fields are spotted here and there. At this time, from six
inches to four feet or more of snow, depending upon the exposure and height of the slopes, made
patrolling arduous. The science of tracking was added to normal patrol work.
The first shot fired directly at the 87th Mountain Infantry came in the little town of Farne,
down the “ridgepole” to the left, on the bright morning of 5 February. It was fired at the seventh
patrol sent out by the battalion, one officer and ten enlisted men. They were fired at by an undiscovered
sniper, and since T/Sgt. FRED R. FRICK was not seriously wounded in the buttock, it
might be said that our first casualty was a shot in the pants. The shot came at 1100 and was followed
by mortar fire in town, forcing the patrol to withdraw. They were followed by more mortar
fire on this trail. FRICK was able to walk, and all were in by 1330.
Another man, S/Sgt. JOSEPH Z. LA LIBERTY, was wounded southwest of Corona when he
activated a mine on the early morning of the 7th, but he was able to walk back.
The thirteenth patrol from the 2nd Battalion was the first true “Ski Patrol” of the 87th Mountain
Infantry at the front. The one officer and ten enlisted men were on skis and snowshoes when
they left at 1130 for the high ground above Vidiciatico. The patrol was uneventful, but confirmed
the old 87th argument that on steep terrain, snowshoes slide sideways and are no good, while
skis edge in and work well. This fact was noted even at noon when the crust had melted.
On the night of 7 February, a Company G patrol of one officer and fifteen enlisted men left
Roncoravecchia early in the evening. Just after 2300, a machine gun, thirty yards distant, opened
up with two bursts. Pvt. BEN S. JACKSON threw a grenade, and forty rounds of artillery were
adjusted on the position, silencing the gun. From southeast of Pianello, the patrol withdrew under
German flares, without casualty. As they withdrew, a shout in German challenged them
with, “What is going on down there? Who’s there?”
Another patrol from Companies F and G, three officers and six forward observers on skis,
went as far as Corona and discovered mines laid bare by melted snow, under which, buried deep
in the ground, were those other mines which were to give us so much trouble later on.
Probably the most successful patrol of the period left the Company G outpost at Roncoravecchia
the next night, with Lieutenant OSCAR E. DUTTWEILER and fourteen enlisted men. They
climbed the escarpment southeast of Pianello near where they had been fired on by the machine
gun the night before. Here they waited until after 0200, watching three of the enemy move into a
machine gun position. Following two scouts, Sgt. HERBERT E. STECKMAN and Pvt. BEN S.
JACKSON, the patrol leader and the bazooka man, Sgt. LESLIE E. BROWN, had worked along
the edge of the cliff. The first scout was able to inch up to within five feet of the emplacement.
He slowly raised his Tommy gun into position as a Nazi stood up. He squeezed the trigger. One
shot only rang out. The gun jammed. The enemy quickly opened up with four rounds, wounding
the bazooka man, BROWN, in the leg. Sgt. BROWN, in spite of his wound, fired his bazooka
and got a direct hit. The machine gun fire ceased. Sgt. STECKMAN called for the enemy in the
emplacement to surrender. No one appeared from the ruined emplacement. STECKMAN then
dumped two hand grenades into the position, silencing those within. A second machine gun
opened up from beyond and below the first, and was grenaded and silenced. The patrol then
withdrew along the ridge to pick up the wounded bazooka man, and was engaged with machine
pistol fire from the north. A grenade was thrown and the firing ceased. The patrol picked up
their wounded man, lowered him down the cliff and then, on an improvised stretcher, carried
him back to Company G lines—a difficult feat.
Feb 5
6
On the night of 10 February, a patrol near Polla received automatic weapons fire and, at a distance
of fifteen yards, exchanged grenades with the enemy—three each. The enemy grenades
landed within ten feet. The patrol suffered one minor casualty: a fragment entered the calf of Pfc.
ROBERT H. PFOHL. The enemy then withdrew across a draw and set up their light machine
gun against the 87th patrol. After some shots, artillery was adjusted on the machine gun and the
position was hit. Enemy casualties were not determined.
A snowshoe ascent of Mt. Grande was made during the day of 12 February for observation.
The snow was waist deep; the trip was uneventful.
After several days of routine patrolling, Company G patrols again tackled “DUTTWEILER’s
Escarpment” on the 14th. This time it had the strength of a raid, with one officer, thirty-two enlisted
men and one artillery observer, plus twenty enlisted men and two officers with .50-caliber
machine gun support from Company H. An enemy patrol got behind the raiding party, causing
them to lay low until nearly daybreak. Consequently, when at 0550 of the 14th, they met enemy
rifle and machine gun fire at fifteen yards from the scouts, and were concentrated upon by four
machine guns from atop the escarpment, they were in an unfavorable position. They were unable
to score effectively with eight grenades and a bazooka. The enemy positions were wellprotected
emplacements. German grenades began to come down. Artillery fire was called for
and the party withdrew to a creek bed where they were pinned down again by mortar fire.
Counter mortar and machine gun fire were called for, and, with daylight already upon them, the
party withdrew. Thus ended for the time being the series of patrol actions on the escarpment.
Lieutenant DUTTWEILER himself and S/Sgt. ROBERT C. CLUKAY were slightly wounded, but
returned to duty within twenty-four hours.
Not all of the patrols have been mentioned, some of them important for the negative information
they brought back. The I & R Platoon’s patrols should be mentioned here, if only for their
importance in covering the area so that their men could lead the 1st Battalion to their objectives
on D-Day.
The 2nd Battalion had been repeatedly shelled in Vidiciatico. For a long time their luck held.
Finally, on 17 February at 1600, a direct hit on a Company G outpost caused the first deaths of the
regiment in the European Theater. Killed in action were Pvt. BILLY J. THAXTON and Pvt.
WARREN F. MAIN. One officer and four enlisted men had been wounded by artillery up to this
time.
Meanwhile, the 1st Battalion, while suffering no casualties, had drawn first blood from the
enemy. By just a few hours, the 2nd Platoon of Company B had beaten DUTTWEILER’s patrol in
hitting their first German.
CUTIGLIANO AREA
As has been noted, the 1st Battalion was delayed in their movement forward. The 3rd Battalion
of the 85th, whom they were to relieve at Cutigliano, had scheduled a raid for the night of 3-4
February that Division was anxious to have them stage. Therefore the 1st Battalion did not complete
their relief until just before midnight on the 5th, after opening an advance CP at Cutigliano
on the 1st. The companies marched at night three or four miles from the detrucking point at la
Lima. The relief was without incident.
The raid of the 85th on Mt. La Serra had been unsuccessful, for the flanking forces found
themselves under flanking fire from still higher mutually supporting and well-dug bunkers. The
85th had suffered casualties. But the enemy seemed to have been stung into action. Two hours
after Company B had occupied the half-dozen stone houses and the outposts of Sestaione, an
eight-man patrol was detected entering the position. Outpost No. 1 of the 2nd Platoon chal-
Feb 10
7
lenged, and when unanswered, opened up with a BAR. At daybreak, a wounded German, hit
three times, still lay in the snow in front of the position and became the first Prisoner of War, and
the first known enemy shot by the regiment. At the PW cage, he quickly revealed to the integrator
his unit: the 2nd Company of the 4th Mountain Battalion. He was part of a thirty-man platoon
at Boscolungo.
Two 1st Battalion daylight patrols made no enemy contact, although one of them traced the
footprints of a wounded man for a half-mile toward Pianosinatico. Partisans were used on these
patrols and proved so valuable that they went with all 1st Battalion patrols from then on.
Company B had at Sestaione a system of four log-and-earth-covered dugouts for the outpost
positions. These could be supported by machine gun and rifle fire from the upper windows of
the defended houses. The lower windows were sandbagged; the upper one screened over with
chicken wire to keep grenades out. The positions were constantly improved with barbed wire,
alarms, and trip flares during the daytime. Jerry tested it regularly at night. All four outposts
were interconnected with sound-powered telephones, controlled from the company CP. Captain
CLARENCE H. SWEDBERG, commanding the company, designed this defense plan to overcome
the difficulty presented by the problem of defending the bottom of a mountain canyon.
On the evening of the 6th and 7th, the night following the capture of the prisoner of war, an
outguard reported movement on the right flank at 2140. A few moments later, Platoon Sergeant
RAY WILSON started small arms fire at a group of enemy in some woods. At the same point as
the attack of the night before, the enemy had infiltrated into town and assaulted the buildings
with machine pistol fire and grenades. When a flare went up, fifteen enemy could be seen on the
ridge to the north. Others were between the buildings, an estimated thirty in all. At 2350, mortar
and artillery fire was brought down upon the front. The enemy retreated at 0045. There were no
American wounded; but the following morning, traces of blood on the road and in the snow indicated
several German casualties.
Positions in the defense were mutually supporting. All outguards were manned before dark.
No man moved from his location once the fight had begun. On their second day of combat, these
men effectively repulsed an attack, inflicting casualties on the enemy at no cost to themselves.
While this action was going on, Company K was closing on Mt. Caligi, just to the south, to relieve
elements of the 85th Infantry. At 0200 Company K had moved up from la Lima to Company
C at Piano d’Ontani whose mortars had assisted in the fight. Company K struggled up the
icy mountain until 0630.
The tenseness of the front line was sometimes rudely shocked by the Italian natives living as
normally as possible right at the elbow of the front-line soldier, and furnishing a comic opera
touch. During the day, after Company B’s defense and Company K’s march, while fighting fervor
was at high pitch, the 1st Battalion got into a difficulty with an Italian woman who was in the
habit of passing through our lines to milk her cow. The excitement can be imagined—the cow
had to be milked—the Italian language had to be coped with—a decision had to be reached. Finally,
Major JOHN B. WOODWARD phoned to Regiment and the message came back, “Woman
going through our lines to milk cow will have to bring cow back to our side.”—end of message.
Darkness came and at 2130, the silence was broken again by the 2nd Platoon of Company B
as they exchanged fire of automatic weapons and rifles with an eight- or ten-man enemy patrol,
driving them off after a half-hour. After midnight, the enemy was back, harassing the company
with fire of burp guns and rifles. Company B remained alert but held their fire. The following
night, on the 8th, a four-man patrol was driven off from the same area just before 1900; and the
platoon was fired upon by a machine gun. Several rounds of artillery were dropped on the en8
emy; but at one time the patrol had been able to get within 60 yards of the outpost. The patrol
came back again just before dawn on the 9th. Late that day, Company C picked up an enemy
Italian deserter at its lines, and moved him down to the PW cage for interrogation. He was a willing
talker, but knew little except that he was a medic in the San Marco Marine Division. He revealed
that he had treated German casualties on 7 February, confirming the belief that casualties
had been inflicted by the 2nd Platoon, Company B, on one of the persistent raiding parties.
Meanwhile, the 1st Battalion was planning a daring raid of battalion strength on Mt. la Serra.
The 3rd Battalion was to occupy the 1st Battalion positions. With this in view, Company K pulled
back from Mt. Caligi, on being relieved by the 85th Infantry, and moved up with the rest of the
battalion during the night of 11-12 February into the Cutigliano-la Lima area, ready to support
the 1st when they took off on the night following. Company K was to relieve B, and L was to relieve
C. Company I would relieve A in Cutigliano.
During the day, before the move, ten shells dropped in Cutigliano and a patrol had three
rounds lobbed at it in the afternoon. The 3rd Battalion CP closed in Cutigliano at 0230, and the
regiment thought of itself as being in its last night of peace and quiet before plunging into its first
battle. So far, brushes with the enemy had been brief and sketchy, but the planned raid up on to
the enemy’s tightly held La Serra would initially commit the entire 1st Battalion and a band of
Partisans, and might well blood a majority of the battalion. The raiding party, in honor of Lieutenant
Colonel WILSON’s hometown in Montana, was called “Task Force Kalispell.” The raid
was to be introduced by a loudspeaker system beaming out an appeal for the enemy to surrender.
Good hot food was promised to be awaiting their arrival in the American lines. Wines and
other pleasures and comforts were touched on lightly.
At 1205 on 12 February, Brigadier General ROBINSON E. DUFF of Division tapped off all the
pressure by informing Regiment that the “Red Plan” was off, by order of Corps. The 1st Battalion
was withdrawn at once to San Marcello; the 3rd remaining in their positions. Then, after a few
nights absence, as though to test the new company, a six- or eight-man German patrol appeared
in the old area of the 2nd Platoon, Company B, now defended by the 2nd Platoon of Company K.
The mortar section lit the area with flares, and Company M and the 616th laid down mortar and
artillery fire. Two enemy were hit, but none captured. The enemy returned at 0315, possibly to
remove their casualties, and another firefight opened. The 3rd Battalion went ahead with the
public address plan and the broadcast bore fruit. The next day three Italian deserters came in
from Pianosinatico and the San Marco Division.
Patrolling continued around Cutigliano until 1 February. On the 13th, a patrol on La Serra
discovered the body of an American soldier, apparently from the last raid of the 85th. On the
14th, a patrol found and led in an RAF sergeant, pilot of a Spitfire shot down behind the lines two
weeks previously. He had bailed out successfully, thereby owing his parachute packer 200 lire.
The Partisan OSS organization had quickly hidden him and arranged for his passage through our
lines. The sergeant was physically exhausted from his three-day trek over the mountainous terrain,
and had great admiration for the tireless Partisan guide who climbed so easily and passed
between lines at will. He told of a well-organized system at work behind the lines, not only for
rescuing Allies, but also for harassing the Germans, and even holding towns for a time. Before a
real German attack, the town would fall and no one would be there. The flyer was not only well
fed and hidden, but was even entertained at a small dance. With typical British restraint, he
spoke disparagingly of his own efforts and escapes, and made it sound rather easy, except for the
walking.
On the 14th, five more Italian deserters passed through Company I, with three OSS agents,
early in the morning. On the 15th, a rescued American flyer, First Lieutenant WILLIAM C.
9
TENCH, Thunderbolt pilot, 57th Fighter Group, was followed shortly through the lines by a
German deserter, four Free French and about fifty-six Italians. This broke down into thirty-two
in civilian clothes, five OSS men, one German prisoner of war and nineteen Italian prisoners of
war. Lieutenant TENCH, who spent the night with the regiment, was, like the British pilot, exhausted.
He had been shot down in November, and hurt his leg in landing with a damaged
parachute. Since then, he had had all kinds of hair-raising close calls under the care of the Partisans.
Much of the time he hid in the attic of a house in which German soldiers were quartered.
At another time he had ridden a bicycle to town to get pictures taken for his faked Italian passport
before the long trip via the “underground railroad” to the American lines. He was overwhelmed
with being back safe.
On the night of the 16th, the 3rd Battalion was relieved in the Cutigliano-la Lima area by the
473rd Infantry, Reinforced, and withdrew to Popiglio and Momigno near San Marcello. The curtain
rang down on the series of minor skirmishes and major enemy encounters in the snowcovered
mountains about Cutigliano.
Feb 15
10
BELVEDERE OFFENSIVE
(16 FEB — 28 FEB)
PREPARATION FOR BATTLE
he focus of attention now shifts from the Cutigliano area to San Marcello where the regimental
staff, in Villa Biche, the former home of an Italian admiral, had been working up their part
in the Divisional Attack Plan. Lieutenant General LUCIAN K. TRUSCOTT, commanding Fifth
Army, accompanied by Major General WILLIS D. CRITTENBERGER, commanding IV Corps,
and Major General GEORGE P. HAYS, commanding the 10th Mountain Division, gave a brief
address to many of the 1st and 3rd Battalion and staff officers on the 9th of February. He spoke
of the coming battle and of his high hopes and confidence in our future.
All kinds of aerial photos and maps of the Mt. Belvedere region were studied and distributed
to the battalions. A wax relief map was built up from the map contours of the vital region, modeled,
and cast in plaster for battalion distribution. The 37th Quartermaster War Dog Platoon,
First Lieutenant ARCHER D. AKERS commanding, arrived one morning and was attached to the
regiment, the platoon closing on the night of 16 February, with both scout and messenger dogs.
The dogs, largely untried in Italy, had been very successful in the China-Burma-India Theater.
The scout dogs worked with patrols at night and “alerted” toward strange patrols or gun positions
while a safe distance away. The dog’s handler could intelligently interpret the “alert” as to
direction and distance. The messenger dogs functioned by carrying messages forward from Battalion
Headquarters to the forward companies during an operation. Unfortunately, the late date
of their attachment caused the misuse of the dogs by one battalion during the coming battle.
Operations Memorandum No. 2, detailing the move of the 1st and 3rd Battalions to Vidiciatico
for the operation, was delivered on 16 February. First Lieutenant WILLIAM C.
MCGUCKIN, liaison officer, was meanwhile making a house-to-house canvass, preparatory for
billeting the two battalions upon their arrival at crowded Vidiciatico. Assisted by an Italianspeaking
sergeant, he went into all the rooms of each building in town, under the pretense of
searching for an escaped soldier. Although the mountain village already overflowed with Italian
families who had fled from the demolished front-line houses, billets were found to include every
last soldier and the dogs. Copies of Field Order No. 5 were distributed on the night and early
morning of 17-18 February, as the 1st Battalion was moving up to Vidiciatico.
The troops of the regiment were to jump off on the night of the 19th, at 2300, from the line of
departure below Querciola. The battalions were to “seize, occupy, and defend” initial objectives
prior to daylight. They were to drive generally north toward the town of Corona and then split
off—the 2nd Battalion turning left toward Rocca Corneta and securing the little towns of Polla
and C. Florio, and the 1st Battalion passing through Corona, turning right, moving up toward the
summit of Mt. Belvedere and being prepared to relieve 3rd Battalion, 85th, after it had seized that
position. The 3rd Battalion, 87th, was to remain in Corps reserve in Vidiciatico.
On the 18th, the night previous to our jump-off, the 1st Battalion, 86th, was to seize the long
steep line of mountains starting west of, and running southwest from Rocca Corneta—the nearest
of which is Pizzo di Campiano, overlooking the whole prospective battlefield.
On our right, the 85th Regiment would attack coincident with and parallel to us, moving to
objectives along the Belvedere ridge to include the highest point, and the summit of Mt. Gorgolesco
to the east.
T
11
The attack was to be supported by the 10th Mountain Division artillery plus some Corps artillery
of 155 howitzers and guns. Tank and Tank Destroyer units would support; and the Air
Corps would fly missions in close support, as close as 600 yards, as directed by “Rover Joe.”
“The ground occupied will be held at all costs.” This direct quote from the field order recalled
the capture of Mt. Belvedere in November 1944 when after three days, an enemy counterattack
drove the Americans back disastrously. Three tanks still remained in Corona’s ruins from
this rout.
Every detail was checked and rechecked for the important movements on succeeding nights
of the two battalions to Vidiciatico. The good road into Vidiciatico came from the east, up the
Silla River valley, from the Reno River and Highway 64. This route ran parallel to the ridgeline
of mountains—all held by the Germans from Mt. Castello to Mt. Belvedere. The whole road
could be watched by the enemy from Silla to Vidiciatico, except when screened by the artificial
smoke machine sending fog drifting up on the wind. Sometimes, by afternoon, the fog would
reach all the way to Vidiciatico. Because of this exposure, troops could not be moved along this
road. While jeeps might draw an occasional round or two from Jerry, a 2 1/2 - ton truck would
bring a concentration. A convoy or a column of troops would have brought his full fury. So the
troops must, of necessity, move in on foot over eight miles of back roads that were impassable for
2 1/2 - ton trucks.
The staff officers made the trip by jeep, up from the artificially smoked end of the valley for
the final time, and opened the forward regimental CP at Vidiciatico at 1645 on 18 February. During
the many jeep trips necessary for planning the operation, occasional shell bursts had been
observed, but much more alarming were the seemingly stark-mad Brazilian drivers, careening
through their fog-shrouded Brazilian Expeditionary Force area around Porretta Terme. The fog
seemed more of a menace than the German artillery.
The night of 17-18 February, the 1st Battalion made the grueling march in heavy, natural fog
from the truckhead to Vidiciatico, over the mud and ice of the back trail, closing five hours after
detrucking, and well before daylight of the 18th. That day, artillery fell in Vidiciatico and in
Querciola. The 1st Battalion had its initial casualties in each company, with one death: S/Sgt,
WILLIAM C. MERRILL, Company D; and one wounded from Company B, four from Headquarters,
the Company C commander, Captain ALFRED C. EDWARDS, and Second Lieutenant
GEORGE J. HAYS, son of the division commander, from Company B. Both of the officers returned
to duty the same day.
Before daylight on the morning of the 19th, the 3rd Battalion made the long march over the
rough trail into Vidiciatico. Pfc. JOE I. RAMIREZ became the first casualty of the 3rd Battalion as
more shellfire greeted the battalion.
On the night of the 18th, just north of Querciola, Company C had relieved Company C of the
85th, who had temporarily manned our right outposts to become familiar with the ground over
which they must attack. Company E was in position on the left, just south of Case Buio.
Forward reconnaissance was made. In the evening, a party of 2nd Battalion scouts and officers
were led by Cpl. BENNETT L. BOGGESS of the I & R Platoon, to a point just below Corona.
BOGGESS returned and led a party forward to lay wire. T/5 ROBERT W. PARKER led similar
parties out from the 1st Battalion to a point above Corona. The scout dogs, too, had made brief
reconnaissance patrols of both sectors.
The 86th Mountain Infantry had begun its advance about 2000 on the 18th, and before dawn
had accomplished the remarkable feat of climbing, storming, and occupying the precipitous
mountain wall on the left of the 87th with only one man wounded. Ropes and rock climbers had
Feb 18
12
been used in places, so steep was the ascent. The surprise was complete, and a number of prisoners
of war were taken before they had time to offer resistance. This capture, by the 86th, 18
hours prior to the attack by the remainder of the Division, denied vital observation to the Germans,
and raised the hopes of the regiment tremendously.
All during the 19th of February, Querciola and Vidiciatico were bursting with troops of the
87th and supporting units, and both towns were shelled lightly. Attached or in support, in addition
to the War Dog Platoon, were the 1st Platoon, Company B, 84th Chemical Battalion; the
616th Field Artillery Battalion; Company C, 126th Engineers; the 751st Tank Battalion; the Interrogators
of Prisoners of War Team; the Air Corps Rover Joe outfit to give direct air support; and
several parties of Partisans.
BATTLE BAPTISM (19 FEB – 20 FEB)
The night of D-Day was clear and cold with both friendly and enemy artillery sounding off at
a slightly increased tempo. Company C was already in the assembly area. Company B left Vidiciatico
at 2000, marching the three miles to Querciola in column of twos. Company A followed,
remaining in reserve in Querciola. By this time, Companies F and G were already in their assembly
areas before Case Buio, where Company E was to remain in reserve. The weapons companies,
D and H, had attached their machine gun platoons to the two leading rifle companies of respective
battalions, and kept the mortars and .50-caliber machine guns under battalion control.
All companies crossed the line of departure on time, 2300, and moved off into the cold, clear
night, flashing with frequent artillery bursts. The moon was about to rise, and the long bands of
blue light overhead reached sharper and sharper back to the searchlights far to the southeast
across the Silla Valley.
1st Battalion
By midnight, the 1st Battalion had moved out into some places as far as 700 yards from the
line of departure, while the 2nd was 300 yards out. As yet there had been no enemy contact.
Five minutes later, Company B was fired upon, 800 yards out. Two burp guns opened up.
Hand grenades were thrown in response, but the company was pinned down by machine gun
fire and artillery bursts until after 0300. T/5 ROBERT W. PARKER of the I & R Platoon, who was
to guide Company B through the minefields, moved back and forth between the leading scouts
while the company was stopped, exposing himself to the fire. Excited bazooka men were neglecting
to pull firing pins, and sent back the message through 1st Battalion at 0038 that the ammunition
was no good. One of the two scout dogs, which were unadvisedly being used in the actual
attack, became too excited while the company was stopped, and whined and barked. Both dogs
had to be withdrawn at 0030 while under fire. Meanwhile, Company C, at 0030, was being fired
upon while moving slowly through minefields. They were led by Cpl. BENNETT L. BOGGESS,
of the I & R Platoon, and Pfc. EDWARD D. STACKWICK, Company C scout. The terrain had
been patrolled previously by the I & R Platoon, and also by another pair of scout dogs and their
handlers. One dog, Tarzan, handled by T/5 CLIFFORD W. MORTENSEN, had definitely located
two gun positions the night before. Both dogs worked successfully with the company on the
night of the attack until the first contact with the enemy.
At about 0045, while still in the minefield, BOGGESS and STACKWICK crawled forward,
under fire from six burp guns on the company, from the right flank near Corona, and cut the
barbed wire entanglements. At 0114, they were still cutting through the barbed wire and could
hear company G on their left. The enemy flares from Corona and Belvedere made the progress
slow. At about 0200, the 1st Platoon and part of the 2nd, following BOGGESS and STACKWICK,
became separated from the rest of the company, and moving over a ridge, spotted four men. A
Feb 19
13
flare lit up the area, and two Germans could be seen running toward them. Each of the scouts,
BOGGESS and STACKWICK, nailed a Nazi before he could get far enough away to reveal the
American position. They then threw grenades over the ridge and moved forward. From the
brush, a German surrendered to this advance element and told one of the men, who spoke German,
of a dugout with five other Germans who wanted to surrender. STACKWICK made over to
the bunker, jammed his gun through the port, and three men and a lieutenant came out—hands
in the air. The lieutenant requested permission to retrieve his helmet, and the foursome was
herded to the rear. BOGGESS moved with his group back 75 yards below the crest of the ridge,
from where they held off a small counterattack from the right flank. They fired steadily at a machine
pistol until the rest of the company could work up to the ridge and drive the Germans back.
Captain ALRED C. EDWARDS, the company commander, had led Company C into the attack
although wounded in the hand earlier in the day while making a reconnaissance. Near Corona,
he was struck in the leg by small arms fire, and had to be evacuated from the fight. First
Lieutenant JAMES H. PENROSE had also been wounded and evacuated earlier.
At 0300, Company C had reached Corona, but B was still taking casualties from grazing fire
from Mt. Belvedere. Artillery fire was planned for the area between Corona and Belvedere. This
was called off, for at 0320, Company C was past Corona, and going on up, and B was finally able
to move forward. A few minutes later, B and C had gained contact beyond Corona, moving up
the slope. Word came in at this point that 3rd Battalion, 85th, on the right, were also advancing
and were only 300 yards short of the summit of Belvedere.
By 0430, Companies B and C were on their objectives on Belvedere. Company A was given
the task of mopping up Corona, bypassed by C. They reached Corona at 0615 and, engaging at
once in a firefight, overcame the resistance—killing seven (counted) Germans and capturing
twenty, while suffering one dead and four wounded. Pfc. LEE H. CHEW, of Chinese descent,
was shot and killed while leading forward an element of the 2nd Platoon. By dawn, the 1st Battalion
estimated thirty-five prisoners of war and twelve or fifteen casualties. Both figures had to
be revised upward. Company B, up to the following nightfall, had suffered eleven wounded.
Company C—three killed, Pfc. MARVIN E. HINER, Pvt. HERBERT W. DILKES, and Pvt. CHARLES
YUPA, and ten wounded. Company D—two dead, Sgt. WILLIAM F. MURPHY and Pfc.
FRED FLOYD, and two wounded. Company A—one dead and five wounded.
After daybreak, Company C, up on Belvedere, still had a fight on its hands to secure the
ridge above Valpiana. The 2nd Platoon was repelled on its first attempt by heavy fire with some
casualties. A small patrol from the 1st Platoon assaulted and neutralized the positions. Several
prisoners emerged, hands in the air, and Sgt. WILLIAM F. MURPHY and some others went forward
to make them prisoners of war. Then the Nazis pulled their common trick—they suddenly
hit the ground and other Nazis behind them began firing. Sgt. MURPHY of Company D was
shot and killed—others were wounded. The enemy soldiers were eliminated to a man. Company
C took no further prisoners of war.
Company B was counterattacked after daybreak at 0730, and at 0930. They took two prisoners,
one wounded, and the attack was over. The 1st Battalion started to receive considerable artillery
fire on Belvedere the first morning, but it was neutralized effectively by Rover Joe. Company
A stopped some sniping near Corona.
2nd Battalion
On the left, shortly after midnight, the 1st Platoon of Company G veered right to attack enemy
positions. East of their objective, the area to the right of Polla, they struck a minefield
shortly after midnight. Ten men were wounded from the 1st and 2nd Squads. The platoon con-
Feb 19
14
tinued forward, overrunning a mortar position between Polla and Corona. By this time, the
whole of Company G was under automatic weapons fire from Polla. Here the platoon dug in.
Communication with the company had been lost at 0100. At dawn they knocked out a machine
gun and four snipers. They remained all day in dug-in positions north of the line Polla-Corona.
On their left, the 2nd and 3rd Platoons were also held up by minefields. Four of the company’s
Partisans were killed by mines. The company was unable to secure Polla until after daybreak.
Two squads reached the 2nd Platoon objective, but had to withdraw until dawn because
of exposure to friendly fire. At 0330, the 126th Engineers started up to help the company clear a
path through minefields before dawn. After daylight, Company G’s left elements were hit by
enemy reinforcements, but dispersed them and took two prisoners. It wasn’t until 1035 that
Company G’s position, 200 yards west of Polla, was finally confirmed and reported to Regiment.
Company F, on G’s left, had had rough going, too. Their first enemy contact came at twenty
minutes after midnight, and at 0220, they were pinned down before C. Florio, while Company G
floundered in the minefields. At 0324, Company F was still pinned down by mortar fire, but the
right platoon was flanking around on C. Florio from which heavy fire was coming. C. Florio was
under friendly artillery fire by this time. It was during this flanking movement that First Lieutenant
JOHN P. BENSON, JR., directing his platoon under sustained fire across a field to support
the flanking unit, was shot and killed.
By 0400, Company F was in position for assault. At daybreak, C. Florio and all objectives
were stormed and taken. Company F killed three (counted) Germans and captured fifty-five,
losing three killed and nineteen wounded. Those killed were: Pvt. CLARENCE E. CAMPBELL,
Sgt. WALTER R. STRUBEL, and Lieutenant BENSON. At 0615, the company was reorganized.
Mopping up went on throughout the morning.
For some time after 0400, 2nd Battalion was out of communication with both forward companies.
The dog team of Cpl. WILLIAM D. DAVIS and T/5 HERBERT SPENCER, with Rex and
Mack, reestablished communications to Company F.
The 2nd Battalion, running into very stiff resistance, had to call on artillery support from the
rear, and from the 86th positions up on Pizzo di Campiano to the left, as well as air support, after
daylight, on Valle and Marne, just behind their objectives. One diving Thunderbolt dropped its
bomb squarely on one of the buildings in Polla, apparently mistaking the village for Marne, about
one kilometer to the north. Some Company G men were occupying the very building and were
badly battered. Prisoners came in after daybreak in batches of twelve, sixteen, and thirtyfive—
and finally, the battalion reported fifty-seven prisoners of war coming up from near Rocca
Corneta. These prisoners arrived at the regimental CP just as Generals TRUSCOTT, CRITTENBERGER,
and HAYS arrived to get first-hand information of the attack. The impression on them
was very favorable. Late in the morning Company E, supported by artillery and air, took Pianello
and finally captured well-patrolled “DUTTWEILER’s Escarpment,” swarming all over it without
casualty.
Company G had suffered the heaviest of any company in the regiment. By nightfall, seven
had been killed: Pfc. LEONARD C. CRISP, Pfc. CAMILLE J. DESCHAINE, Pfc. FRANCIS E.
LOWERY, Pfc. FORREST M. MUELLER, Pfc. BURTON E. PIERCE, Pfc. WILBUR D. REDDING,
and Pfc. EDWIN G. VAN AUKEN. Twenty-nine had been wounded. Company H had one man
killed, Cpl. JOHN HOLLINGSWORTH, and one wounded.
THE BATTLE’S GAIN
From the morning of the 20th until the unit was relieved a week later, there were no major
developments. The positions were steadily improved tactically. The balance of the casualties
15
occurred during the attack and the day of the 20th. By midnight of the 20th, there had been
eighteen deaths and ninety-one wounded in the regiment during the 24-hour period. Shellfire
took its toll during the following eight days, killing sixteen and wounding forty-four. Only when
our planes were in the air were the men sure of a respite from artillery or mortar fire. Counterattacks
occurred with decreasing frequency. All were easily beaten back with heavy losses to the
enemy and at little cost to ourselves.
Shortly after daybreak, the success of the 87th Mountain Infantry’s first battle was becoming
as clear as the close-at-hand outline of Mt. Belvedere. All companies had attained their objectives.
Over one hundred enemy dead lay among our positions. During the day, 115 prisoners of
war moved through our cage. These prisoners, talking freely, revealed the enemy’s side of the
story to S/Sgt. LEO A. HANDEL of the Interrogators of Prisoners of War Team.
The first prisoners, shaking with cold and shock, came from the 1st Battalion zone, and had
no idea what had hit them—so swiftly had the battle swept over them. The enemy main line of
resistance, running from Mt. Belvedere to Rocca Corneta, had been manned from east to west by
the 6th Company, the 8th Company, the 5th Company, and the 7th Company—all part of the
1044th Regiment, 232nd Division, and reinforced by elements of the 14th Anti-tank Company,
also of the 1044th, which had constructed strong points and had set up specially-trained antitank
squads equipped with antitank close combat weapons. The companies averaged eighty to a
hundred men on 19 February.
The 5th and 6th Companies were virtually wiped out by the first impact of our attack. Most
of the men not killed were regrouped—at the Prisoner of War cage. Forty men of the 5th Company
and 43 men of the 6th Company were all present and accounted for less than twelve hours
after the 87th Mountain Infantry made first battle with the supermen.
The enemy, it was revealed, had committed its first tactical reserves at 0400 of the 20th. One
platoon of the 1st Company, 232nd Reconnaissance Battalion, was ordered to counterattack west
of Mt. Belvedere. The counterattack was broken up before it got started, and 14 prisoners of war
were taken by the 2nd Battalion.
The capture of the company commander of the 6th Company, Lieutenant Kaeser, facilitated
the compilation of intelligence. This was the lieutenant captured by the Company C scouts. The
lieutenant at first was one of the few captives reluctant to talk, but he talked willingly and gladly
when his Red Cross card was about to be marked “deserted.” By such a method is the Nazi’s
own inhuman cruelty turned against itself. Lest the Gestapo punish his family at home for his
being declared a deserter, the lieutenant talked eagerly.
It was noticed that all prisoners of war talked freely when questioned. They often asked
when first questioned, “Do I have to tell you?” When answered in the affirmative, their qualms
vanished. They obeyed blindly as they had been taught to obey. A few general conclusions were
gathered from these prisoners of war, captured in February 1945, five and a half years after Germany’s
sweep into Poland. First, they didn’t expect mistreatment as prisoners of war. Most of
them did expect Germany to be sterilized or enslaved at the war’s end. Some of them, therefore,
believed it best to die, for the conviction was general that the war was lost. Still, seventy per cent
of the enemy troops are said to be potential deserters who can’t desert lest they be either shot by
us, shot by a German officer or NCO (all of whom are authorized to shoot on mere suspicion), or
finally lest their families be punished. They are all concerned about the danger of recapture and
anxious to get safely to America. Many ask at once about citizenship. All prisoners of war seem
to be well informed about current war developments, and to have read avidly our propaganda
sheet, “Front Post.”
Feb 20
16
However, in spite of this, the German was still an excellent soldier; his equipment and gear
was of the best, and while he ate but once a day, his food kept him going. It made no difference
to him that his resistance was senseless. When asked what he thought about the war, he answered
dully, “I am not supposed to think. I am a soldier.” Most of his responses were dull.
About the only conviction frequently expressed was that Americans don’t take war seriously—
that for the American, “war is a sport.”
Unfortunately, it was quite evident that a hopeless German remains just as deadly behind a
weapon as one looking forward to victory, for nothing dismays him as he doggedly kills and
waits with resignation to be killed or given a chance to surrender.
HOLDING THE GAIN
Rover Joe started operating on the morning of 20 February. At about 0730, the first mission
was run against Ca Valle, a village northwest of Polla. He bombed, strafed, and dropped rockets,
but the results could not be seen. At 0920, he hit artillery positions at Marne and returned to finish
up fifteen minutes later when his bombs dropped too far north. During this first day, two or
three bombs were dropped by mistake on Polla.
The front line troops came to love Rover Joe, who operated under the direction of the aerial
observation plane called “Horsefly.” Jerry was forced to keep his weapons silent while planes
were in the air. Typical Rover Joe reports were like this one at 1100: “One bomb near
hit—building demolished, remainder of bombs within target area; five or six Germans fleeing
from buildings; three or four killed; observed flashes from mortar in another area; will bomb at
once.” The sight of the diving plane, the falling bombs, or flash of rockets, and the following
sound of strafing or the tremendous bomb blast, was a heartening one to the soldier lying in his
hole, harassed by artillery. Many a mountain trooper, in a poignant instant, forgave the Air
Corps for years of feuding in Denver.
TANKS AND MINES
All during the first morning on Belvedere, the men dug in, consolidated their positions and
made readjustments. Occasionally, there was sniper fire, and a few rounds of artillery. Usually it
was quiet. At noon, one platoon of medium tanks and one platoon of tank destroyers were on our
right flank at Calcinara, ready to move forward to the close defense of front lines against the expected
counterattacks. Later, the tank platoon tried to move up the trail on to the high shoulder
of Belvedere. The lead tank hit a mine and blew up. The assistant driver was blown clear, and
the tank commander was heroically rescued from the burning tank by First Lieutenant MELVIN
S. BARRETT of the 126th Engineers (A Company) just before its 75-mm ammunition began exploding.
Three crewmembers were killed inside the tank.
At one o’clock in the afternoon, a platoon of medium tanks was supporting our left flank
with fire from Cse. Buio. A platoon of light tanks was in Querciola. A platoon of mediums was
in reserve.
The engineer company had been sweeping the road for mines up to Corona since early morning,
and had ordered up a Brockway truck with a treadway bridge to a blown-out section of road
just below Corona.
The 3rd Battalion, placed in IV Corps reserve one hour after H-Hour, was released to regiment
at 1230, and moved out of Vidiciatico shortly after 1400 to go into position between Valpiana
(north of Corona) and Polla. As they moved up on either side of the road, the Brockway
truck blew up, 300 yards below the bridge site, killing a passing soldier, but not injuring the
driver. The road was to have been cleared here, but at this point large charges had been buried
17
four feet deep, and the area was covered with buried shrapnel, which threw the mine detectors
off. Meanwhile, the 3rd Battalion was being shelled as it moved slowly up the road, and suffered
casualties. An American rocket plane, apparently assuming that these were German troops, dove
down and fired his rockets, which just missed the road, but fortunately exploded harmlessly.
Rover Joe quickly called him off.
The tanks were anxious to get to Corona where they could silence the German artillery coming
in from the west. At about 1730, a bulldozer proved that the road was still not free of mines.
As the bulldozer moved past the wrecked Brockway, a terrific blast hurled him into the air and
over to the side, in front of the truck. The driver, thrown thirty feet into the air, was uninjured,
but the dozer was a twisted mass of steel. A deep crater was left in the road. The engineers went
back to their probing.
In the evening the road was pronounced cleared, and a daring tank commander was willing
to risk running his tank through to Corona. The Tank Platoon commander forbade it. IV Corps
then stepped in and ordered two platoons of tanks to Valpiana—beyond Corona—at once. They
were sure of a heavy counterattack in the morning, and wanted tanks there to stop it. It was 2300
when the order went through.
The first tank rumbled up to the ruined truck and dozer. In a few tense moments it was past
them, on up to the bridge site from which scores of mines had been removed, down into the dry
draw and up on to the road again. From there it moved up the road beyond Corona without
mishap. A second tank confidently followed, reached the truck and dozer, and blew up. This
was after midnight. Less than an hour later, a three-quarter ton weapons carrier of the 3rd Battalion
drew up behind the wreckage, found another mine and went up in smoke, injuring its two
occupants. The pile of wreckage at this point in the road was tremendous.
Just before three in the morning, the first tank was reported in position at Valpiana with two
75-mm pack howitzers of the Anti-tank Platoon, and two .50-calibers and three bazookas on the
left flank. Before dawn, however, these tanks too had to be abandoned after striking a mine between
Corona and Valpiana.
The engineers, during the following two days, blasted the road with Bangalore torpedoes,
detonating the remaining mines. Ultimately, one section of tanks took up positions along the Corona
road, south of Valpiana, and another section moved near Cse. Buio where their fire was
most effective. Meanwhile, there were no tanks at Valpiana for the counterattack against Company
I the morning of the 21st. But as will be seen, Company I could scarcely have dealt more
effectively with the counterattack had it been supported by a 45,000-ton battleship.
COUNTERATTACKS
The 3rd Battalion closed in Corona before dark of the 20th. The battalion CP was established
there. Pfc. PIERRE B. ERHARD had been killed and several wounded. Company I moved forward
to positions beyond Corona, near Valpiana, relieving Company A, who in turn moved up
to the right of Company B on Belvedere, plugging the gap between the right flank and the 85th.
Company K moved down to Polla between Corona and Company G, allowing G to form in more
depth. Company F remained out on the left beyond C. Florio.
At 1845, Colonel DAVID M. FOWLER ordered commanding officers of the 1st and 3rd Battalions
to “walk your positions—check final protective lines, select normal barrages of artillery and
primary target areas for mortars, to insure that the fire plan is coordinated and that the defense is
tightly buttoned up.” The line companies settled down in their dark foxholes to await the certain
enemy counterattacks at first light or sooner.
18
On the morning of 21 February, the enemy launched counterattacks against almost every
front-line company. The 1st Battalion, atop Belvedere, was hit first. At about 0610, Company B
was attacked after six enemy had infiltrated into old positions. The enemy hit with a sporadic
barrage of fire from machine pistols, snipers, mortars, and 88s. Company fire pinned them
down, and five came out—hands up. The sixth opened up with an automatic weapon, causing
casualties. By 0730, the action had terminated. Six enemy were killed. Two of our men were
wounded.
Meanwhile, Company C had been hit more decisively. After a few rounds of early morning
artillery, at about 0630, seventy or eighty Germans moved up on to the nose of Belvedere—four
hundred yards above Valpiana. Company C was bitter and determined after being tricked by the
German ruse the morning before. They waited silently in their positions until the enemy was
within a hundred yards. Not a shot was fired as the enemy moved up. They made targets as big
as houses. Suddenly the waiting men opened fire. Eighteen enemy were killed and four
wounded. Some of the bodies were hit by more than one man. The final count reported twentyfive
enemy dead. There were no prisoners taken by Company C.
The 2nd Battalion put artillery on the German advances coming from Polla towards Companies
G and F, and the advances never developed. Later in the day, two prisoners of war, taken by
Company F, confirmed that the attacks had been broken up completely by the artillery. However,
while T/Sgt. NORMAND W. CONNOLLY of Company G was holding back the fire of his
platoon to collect two prisoners of war, a sniper shot and killed him, indoctrinating Company G
in Nazi tactics.
The 3rd Battalion had the most hectic time. First, there was considerable shelling before daybreak,
with casualties. Some of it was friendly, and at least one death resulted from friendly fire.
Then, after dawn, enemy mortar concentrations started falling in—raising difficulty with the
communications. Artillery and mortar support was limited due to the lack of communication.
Meanwhile, Company K was hit in two places. The company OP (observation post) had
been manned all night by S/Sgt. RAYMOND T. SECORD, and S/Sgt. EDMUND D. BENNETT.
They spotted a 12-man patrol working up the hill with a machine gun. Artillery was called for
but the lines were out. The enemy was within 500 yards of the 3rd Platoon positions. Sgt.
BENNETT broke up the spearhead at 0730 by hitting the lead man with a BAR, and the German
patrol took cover in a draw below the open slope. Two more of the enemy were killed by the 3rd
Platoon while trying to escape down the draw back to the German lines. Pfc. VIRGIL CORNETT
patiently waited for the remainder to run the gauntlet—finally getting a shot at two and bringing
one down wounded as they dashed for safety. The other was brought down by other fire, and
the wounded man was captured, totaling four killed and one wounded and captured, plus a machine
gun for the platoon. The 2nd Platoon, too, had gotten into the firefight and added another
prisoner of war.
THE HEIMER INCIDENT
I Company’s counterattack was the strangest and the most brilliant too. Pfc. MALFORD C.
HEIMER, in his foxhole before dawn, heard noises in the pink stucco house behind his position at
Valpiana. Keeping the two blankets wrapped around him, but leaving helmet and rifle on the
parapet, he jumped up to tell the fellows in the house to quiet down. The “fellows” were German,
and meeting him outside his foxhole, they shoved weapons in HEIMER’s face and took him
prisoner back to the house. HEIMER’s buddy, Pvt. JOHN A. O’ROURKE, saw HEIMER being
led away, and reached for his rifle, just as four more enemy opened up on him. The squad
leader, S/Sgt. THEODORE B. REINERO, also made out the captured HEIMER being led away in
the dark. He quickly had the whole squad open fire at a distance of fifty yards, letting HEIMER
Feb 21
19
take his chances. HEIMER made a run for it with the Germans. They barricaded themselves,
HEIMER included, in the stone house, HEIMER on the floor in a little hallway. His captors were
good to him, offering him cigarettes and making him comfortable, so he went to sleep there on
the floor. A sharp firefight soon began. Company and supporting units opened up with M-1s,
.50-caliber machine guns, mortars, and 75-mm pack howitzers, pouring everything into the demolished
house. Dawn came. There was a good deal of enemy firing from all sides, especially
down from the ridge to the east in front of Company C. Burp guns, machine pistols, and German
bazookas were coming from several directions. The forward 75-mm was knocked out, injuring
Second Lieutenant ROBERT S. KELLAR.
For a while, HEIMER had slept. The Germans had covered him with a raincoat, but the
house smashing up around him settled that. Waking, he found his captors had had enough.
Two wounded were shouting that they wanted to surrender. Sgt. REINERO killed one enemy
making a break for the house as the light increased. He worked his way forward with S/Sgt.
CHARLES E. ERNST to the pink house. ERNST took three prisoners, and three more surrendered
to him from positions near a haystack. By this time, REINERO had reached the house,
ready to blast the inside. HEIMER was yelling for him to hold his fire, and one Kraut appeared
disarmed at the doorway, followed by seven or eight others.
Down the road, Pfc. ROBERT DUDLEY and Pfc. JOSEPH POLUNCI had worked their way
down to some other houses. With POLUNCI covering, DUDLEY had flushed out somewhere
around a dozen more prisoners from the ruined houses. Altogether, 31 prisoners of war were
taken, three of them wounded. Seven of the enemy were found killed. Three machine guns were
taken, several burp guns, rocket launchers, piles of grenades and ammunition.
All of the 31 prisoners were from the 741st Mountain Infantry. They had marched for seven
continuous days from the Po Valley, and had immediately been sent by truck up into the line.
TANK SCARE
In the late afternoon of the 21st, Company I moved small elements into Valpiana and on to
the ridge above. A troop column had been observed at various times throughout the afternoon
moving south toward Valpiana. This was a column of foot troops with equipment, followed by
vehicles, and accompanied by one armored vehicle. The words “armored vehicle” soon became
“tanks,” and the 3rd Battalion, before long, expected to be hit by a column of tanks. What actually
happened was somewhat different.
The column was first sighted shortly before 1300 and again at 1350. It was mistakenly called
an armored column instead of a column with armor. Rover Joe’s reconnaissance couldn’t spot
any armored column. At 1600, though, he could find, and did take care of, a column of foot
troops, bombing and strafing them. Also at 1605 he destroyed the one armored vehicle in the
column. That was all the armor there was. Reports kept coming in from delayed sources, and at
1700, Rover Joe went back to make sure. At 1710, the battalions were receiving the original alert,
no final result of Rover Joe’s work having come in. By 1725, Rover Joe’s mission was complete.
Fifteen minutes before that, the 85th declared the road clear of living troops and the vehicles destroyed.
The companies, however, had received a final report that the armored column was only 500
yards away at 1700. However, friendly artillery searching out this column was falling on Companies
C and I. The 616th Field Artillery Battalion was notified. The fire was lifted and finally
registered in front of Company I at Valpiana, and the threat was dissipated in excess.
20
ROVER JOE
On the 21st, Rover Joe had been all set to go, but received no target until early afternoon. The
87th targets, numbers 1 and 2, were troop activities and gun positions which were taken care of.
Then at 1600, target number 3 appeared. It was the column of foot troops marching south from
Castelluccio toward Valpiana. Rover Joe dived in. The first report tersely stated: “(1) Area covered.
(2) All bombs on target. (3) Building afire—believe ammunition dump. (4) Strafed enemy
vehicles three times, armored vehicle destroyed. (5) Strafed fleeing personnel five times. (6) Also
strafed gun positions east—no ack-ack.”
Altogether, Rover Joe reported on nine targets during the afternoon of the 21st, all in the area
just forward of our positions. All but one target was well covered by the fighter-bombers with
bombs, rockets, and strafing. Many direct hits were scored on enemy-occupied buildings.
Night settled with the 85th carrying forward the attack on the right. The 3rd Battalion 86th
was passing through 2nd Battalion 85th to attack Mt. della Torraccia at dawn. Torraccia was the
last of the initial objectives. On the left, the 10th Anti-tank Battalion and 10th Reconnaissance
Troop up on the Mt. Serrasiccia-Pizzo di Campiano ridge had relieved the 86th, who in turn had
displaced to the right.
FURTHER CASUALTIES
AT 2200, Major GEORGE A. FELCH was accidentally shot and killed. Major FELCH, commanding
officer of the 3rd Battalion, was checking on outposts, and was fired at by a rifleman
ordered to “shoot at anything moving.” The death of Major FELCH was a shock to all the officers
and enlisted men of the regiment. Major JOHN C. MCKAY, executive officer, assumed temporary
command.
During the twenty-four-hour period, there were a good many casualties largely from artillery.
Those killed were: Sgt. CHARLES W. LEVITT of Company I; S/Sgt. JOSEPH A POIRIER,
JR. of Company K; Sgt. PAUL N. FRYE, JR., Pfc. ROBERT M. POST, and Sgt. GEORGE DAY, JR.
of Company M.
Artillery was active all night, and during the next morning. No counterattacks occurred, although
the 2nd Battalion did allow a two-man, and later, a twelve-man patrol, to advance within
a hundred yards and go away, while holding their fire. The 3rd Battalion killed a single enemy.
At 1220 of the 22nd, the regimental commander, Colonel DAVID M. FOWLER, was wounded
by a shell fragment in the left knee, just in rear of Company B. Colonel FOWLER had been forward
frequently. His orderly, Pvt. NORMAN W. DORSEY, had been wounded on the 20th, and
his driver’s helmet nicked on the 21st. All members of the regiment were greatly relieved to
learn that the colonel’s wound was not serious, and his early return expected. By his order, Lieutenant
Colonel JOHN F. SCHMELZER took command of the 87th Mountain Infantry.
There were other casualties that day from artillery fire; among them Pvt. THEODORE
FRITCHIE of Company G, was killed.
Lieutenant Colonel ROBERT C. WORKS, G-2 of the 10th Mountain Division, took command
of the 3rd Battalion, 87th Mountain Infantry, returning to the regiment after more than a year’s
absence.
BATTLE ACTION CONCLUDED
By February 22, when Colonel FOWLER was wounded, the operation had been concluded in
every sense. The objectives were long since consolidated, and excellent defensive positions built.
Feb 22
21
The strongest and most coordinated counterattack the enemy seemed able to put on—against our
air power and superior observation—was withstood on the morning of the 21st and a great percentage
of the enemy troops that were involved were killed or captured. The enemy was proven
even more unable to counterattack with tanks, for he couldn’t move his armor up into position
under the watchful eye of Rover Joe. The only effective force the enemy seemed able to bring on
our troops was his artillery and mortar fire, and this remained heavy throughout the week.
WIRE MEN
Some mention should be made of the Communications Section for their part in the operation.
The wiremen were the kingpins of the communications phase of the action, since most orders,
reports, and messages went over the phone. Initially, wire was laid to all companies from battalions,
and regiment had two wires to each attacking battalion. Communication between regiment
and battalion was usually very good. There were periods on the morning after the attack when
communication with the 1st Battalion was not continuous between 0400 and 0800. The combined
factors of artillery barrages and a platoon of our tanks kept taking out the lines quicker than the
linemen could repair them. Later, after the 3rd Battalion was put into the line, their wire was
blown out several times by artillery concentrations, shells twice landing within 25 yards of the
switchboard. Sgt. GEORGE DAY, JR. was killed laying wire during this period. Minefield explosions
occasionally blew out one of the double lines laid to the 1st or 3rd Battalion. The work of all
the linemen was exemplary. Particularly outstanding, under heavy fire, were S/Sgt. KARL K.
KIELHOFER and T/5 HERBERT W. STEINGRABER, who were largely responsible for the success
of the wire communication.
The radio section was on “stand by” except for the brief times the lines were out. Message
Center functioned smoothly, delivering overlays and written messages by jeep and foot under
heavy shellfire.
The Intelligence and Reconnaissance Platoon, in addition to the guide work and patrols mentioned,
manned an OP throughout the operation, searched German dead, and guarded the prisoners
of war.
MEDICS
Heroic work was done by the Medical Detachment during the weeklong operation. They
suffered more than their share of casualties while aiding wounded men. First Lieutenant WILLIAM
H. MILLMAN, while his 3rd Battalion aid station was under heavy shellfire, repeatedly
left his shelter to give medical attention, finally being mortally wounded as he rose to give aid
during a barrage. Many others could be mentioned, but Pfc. JOSEPH P. PRYCE demonstrated
the common spirit of the medics when he insisted on attempting to get to a wounded man even
though two other attempts had failed. After being wounded twice, he kept others from making
any attempt to reach him for two hours, and when he was finally evacuated to the aid station he
demanded that other cases by attended to first.
SITUATION 22 FEBRUARY
During the morning of 22 February, Major General CRITTENBERGER, commanding IV
Corps, and Brigadier General CRANE, artillery officer, visited the front and expressed great admiration
for the mountain troops. Supplies were, by then, going up the mountain by mule rather
than pack board. The enemy dead were being evacuated. That afternoon, Rover Joe had a busy
time knocking out tanks and self-propelled guns in front of Companies C and I. Enemy artillery
had been very quiet all afternoon. The road up to Corona had been declared open for jeeps and
tanks for the final time by the engineers, who had used large quantities of explosives and Bangalore
torpedoes to detonate the remaining mines. Several old demolition men, veterans in the Ital22
ian campaign, declared that the mine condition of the Corona road was the equal of anything
seen in Italy. One of the few problems remaining was the “rock,” as Rocca Corneta was called,
sticking up against the left flank. This had been shelled steadily.
Before 2100 that night, Rocca Corneta was occupied by a party of 27 Partisans and Pfc. EDWARD
PALEY, an intelligence scout. He was the only American soldier in the party. The “rock”
had been abandoned by the enemy, leaving only trip wires and much equipment, including some
American weapons. The church and other buildings atop the fortress-like pile of rock were
empty, battered shells from the constant barrage and bombardment.
The German artillery was very heavy through the 23rd and 24th. Those killed were: Pfc.
MARVIN H. HOFFMAN of Company F, Pfc. HERBERT G. YARNELL of Company C, Pfc. WILLIAM
CAMPBELL, JR. and LOUIE A. ORDAZ of Company I. It wasn’t until the 25th that no artillery
casualties were suffered. There was, from time to time, some friendly artillery dropping
into our area, especially on the 24th, but as far as could be determined, no further casualties were
from friendly fire.
PATROL ACTION
Some patrolling was done at night by both sides and on the afternoon of the 23rd, each battalion
was ordered by Division to send out daylight patrols to gather information on enemy frontline
positions. The patrol from 1st Battalion, led by Second Lieutenant JAMES ANDERSON III,
was an interesting one. One thousand yards forward with the lead scout on the ridge of the nose,
above and north of Valpiana, burp guns opened up from enemy bunkers both east and west of
the nose. One soldier was hit in the shoulder and wounded lightly. The patrol was badly caught
in crossfire, but fire was returned and the German in the left bunker was hit and killed. German
mortar fire was apparently being directed by telephone by an enemy observer, seen off to the
right of an American OP. The patrol was directed by radio to withdraw with the wounded man.
The withdrawal was accomplished by covering fire and movement while under rifle, grenade,
and mortar fire. Rifle grenades were fired back, but friendly mortar fire was not brought on to
the enemy. As the patrol cleared the ridge top, artillery time-fire was called for on the nose. The
enemy automatic weapons on the ridge were thereby silenced. A sniper in support at the OP
picked off the German on the telephone, silencing their mortars. The patrol, while coming down
off the ridge, killed two Germans, and Lieutenant ANDERSON nailed another while he covered
the withdrawal. The patrol had finished its withdrawal down the hill and through a draw into
the area, when machine gun fire cut down three more members of the patrol. No wounds were
serious. All members of the patrol returned. Eight rounds of time-fire brought up the Red Cross
flag which the Germans use when they are evacuating their wounded.
At night on 26 February, Second Lieutenant DONALD DWYER led a patrol from the 1st Platoon
of Company F from Rocca Corneta, going underneath Pizzo di Campiano to the north, to a
point near C. Vigoni. Here, just after a mortar muzzle blast was heard, the second scout, Pvt.
WILLIAM E. CHRISTENSEN, saw a German from behind a tree, ten yards away. The German
had our first scout, Pfc. PETER NASSAU, in his sights. CHRISTENSEN watched him allow the
scout to pass him and then he saw him step out and challenge NASSAU from the rear. The rest
of the patrol had not yet reached the road the two scouts were on. The guard moved around and
pointed his rifle at NASSAU’s chest. CHRISTENSEN circled around behind the German and,
holding his own rifle in his right hand, knocked the German’s rifle out of his hands with his left.
NASSAU, who speaks German, ordered him to raise his hands and keep quiet. In answer to
questions, the German revealed that there were 55 or 60 enemy in the rear. The men were on the
edge of a lawn, sloping down from town to the road—a poor place, tactically. Just as the lieuten-
Feb 23
Feb 26
23
ant was coming up to see what the matter was, two more enemy appeared from above and behind
the German, and called out in German, “What’s up below?”
NASSAU called them over and halted them in German. He told them they were surrounded,
to throw away their weapons and come down. Doubtful, they asked, “Who’s there, Americans?”
NASSAU answered in German in the affirmative and for them to drop their weapons and come
down on the double. One dropped his rifle, but the other dropped back behind his companion
and fired point-blank at NASSAU with an automatic weapon, stunning the scout and bruising his
shoulder. NASSAU fired back with his Tommy gun—the disarmed man was only four or five
feet away and was probably hit. A German grenade landed from behind a hedge giving the two
scouts time to hit the roadside ditch before it exploded, scratching NASSAU’s chin and blowing
off both their helmets.
The scouts covered the withdrawal of the patrol with their Tommy guns. More grenades
were thrown and heavy fire was directed on the retreating patrol. After they forded the deep,
boulder-strewn stream below the “rock,” two machine guns opened on them from a ridge. The
Germans had rushed the guns cross-country to cut them off; but the patrol, after returning part
way for semi-stunned NASSAU, was able to withdraw to friendly lines.
On the night of 26-27 February, the 2nd and 3rd Battalions were relieved by elements of the
Brazilian Expeditionary Force, and withdrew to the town of Vidiciatico for a brief rest and showers.
On 27 February Company C suffered more casualties in position near Valpiana and Pfc.
JUAN BARRIENTOS was killed by shellfire. The 1st Battalion was relieved and moved to Lizzano
that night. Meanwhile, the regimental staff was in Lizzano, preparing the second attack in
the region north of Gaggio Montano on the slopes of Mt. Terminale. The whole unit was making
ready to move forward beyond Abetaia.
On the 27th, with brief rest, the 3rd Battalion entrucked at 1600 for Malandrone. Here it dug
in. Over 1200 rounds of artillery fell during the night, causing some casualties. The men impatiently
awaited the rest of the regiment and the jump-off in the second battle of the 87th Mountain
Infantry.
Feb 27
24
MARCH OFFENSIVE AND CONSOLIDATION
(1 MAR — 31 MAR)
PREPARATION FOR BATTLE
uring early March, the 87th Mountain Infantry engaged in its first full-scale daylight battle.
With the other elements of the 10th Mountain Division, it jumped off on a three-day offensive
on March 3. The smashing success achieved is indicated by the unprecedented bag of prisoners
of war. On the first day alone, more prisoners were taken than had ever been taken before
on a single day by any unit in the Italian Theater. All objectives were taken far ahead of schedule,
and the unit acquitted itself brilliantly.
The Battle of Belvedere in February had been a night attack. All objectives of the 87th were
taken before dawn of the 20th of February. From then until the relief at the end of the month, the
fighting had been defensive. In contrast, the Battle of Castel d’Aiano was a deadly struggle in the
sunlight, from bunker to bunker, hill to hill, objective to objective, for three bloody days. It was
accomplished against prepared positions and heavily mined areas, in the roughest kind of terrain
and under heavy enemy artillery fire. However, this brilliant, full-scale action should not completely
overshadow the unusual accomplishments of Belvedere. Night battle is among the most
difficult of battle maneuvers. Night assaults have always presented the most complex problems
of warfare. That these problems of confusion, of difficult control, and of units losing themselves,
were overcome in February’s action deserves the highest tribute.
The March operation to Castel d’Aiano, although of quite a different caliber, depended on the
earlier effort in an interesting way. The original enemy line ran along high ground from Riva
Ridge, Rocca Corneta, up over Belvedere, and along Gorgolesco Ridge, and continued far back to
the northeast along Mt. della Torraccia and Mt. Terminale. Then it swung to the east again over
Cimon della Piella and along the ridge to Pietra Colora, Mt. della Croce, and beyond to Highway
64. To oversimplify the strategy, and reduce it to football terms, “Belvedere” had resembled a
“quarterback sneak.” The 86th Mountain Infantry had first taken the high ridge on the left out of
the play, and then the 87th and 85th had, under cover of darkness, plunged through and seized
Belvedere. It was planned as a short “line plunge,” not as a “touchdown play.” And as it developed,
successfully penetrating the highly important central position of Belvedere, the enemy expected
further thrusts here and pulled back to get set. However, after the 85th and 86th had hit
“off tackle” on the right, and had taken Mt. della Torraccia, the old “end around” play was called.
The 10th Mountain Division was pulled from the line and swung around the “right end,” the
Brazilian Expeditionary Force (BEF) holding their former positions at Belvedere. It was not a
“power play,” but one of speedy movement and deception. It caught the enemy completely off
balance; and here the football analogy breaks down, for the enemy was hit in the midst of making
a relief.
So large was the hole opened in the enemy line that the proverbial “truck” could have driven
through. But again the “thrust” hadn’t been planned as a touchdown play. It hadn’t been realized
that such rapid movement was possible in mountain terrain. The line had been opened
wide, the ball was in the clear, but there was no one to go through for down-field “blocking.”
The fast play was unexpectedly successful. The effort had been to try merely to gain some
ground; but it looked as though it could have been a touchdown play itself. Instead, the Division
had to be content with the four-mile sweep around the right end to Castel d’Aiano. It was a short
gain, but it was recognized and commended as a brilliant one, and the ground was laid for a long
sweep into enemy territory at a later date.
D
25
Pre-Battle Punishment
The 3rd Battalion bore the brunt of the battle. They led the column of battalions from the line
of departure on the first day. Furthermore, they took three days of pounding from enemy artillery
before the other battalions arrived. The 3rd Battalion had been relieved from Belvedere on
27 February and had rushed up to the new area. Here they took up defensive positions on the
north side of Malandrone Gulch on the southern slopes of the shell-scarred hill, La Serra, after
only a few hours for clean-up in Vidiciatico.
The battalion had hardly closed before S/Sgt. ROBERT SMITH of Company I was wounded
while making a reconnaissance. A few minutes later, Pfc. WARNER F. LAKEWAY of Company
K was killed by artillery in the company area. The attack, originally planned for 1 March, was
postponed until the 2nd, and then to the 3rd. Meanwhile, the battalion remained in position absorbing
the worst shellfire so far experienced by the regiment. During the three days from the
night of the 27th until D-Day, the 3rd Battalion area suffered 25 casualties, nine of whom were
deaths.
Even these casualties do not indicate the severity of the shelling. During the night of 28 February-
1 March, for instance, over a thousand rounds of artillery and mortar fire fell in the small
battalion area. This increased with one-half hour barrages all day of the 1st of March. During
some barrages, fifty rounds were counted around one position in two minutes, over 350 rounds
in fifteen minutes. During the afternoon hours of 1 March, 1500 rounds pounded onto the battered,
stumpy, brown slopes of the 3rd Battalion area. The men could only dig and dig deeper,
and their six-foot deep holes did cut down the casualty rate.
Unfortunately, there is no defense against a direct hit. For some, time seems to run out. The
highly valued regimental intelligence sergeant, LOREN M. FRANK, was blown up in his foxhole
at the regimental OP, along with another man, Pfc. JOHN F. VAN DE PUTTE, at 1600 on the 1st
of March. Duties kept others from the safety of foxholes. Sgt. ELMER A. BERLIN, of Headquarters
Company, 3rd Battalion, was mortally wounded while leading the Italian mule train to the
forward ammunition dump on 28 February. The dead in addition to those mentioned above
were: Sgt. JOHN B. BLANCHARD, Pfc. DALE W. DUNHAM, Pfc. THEODORE E. WALL, and
Pvt. JAMES H. ROGERS, JR. of Company L; and Pfc. THEODORE W. WENDERS of Company I.
Some mention should be made here of the job done by the Corps Engineers in erecting the
Bailey Bridge at Malandrone. The Malandrone River ran just south of the 3rd Battalion position
through a deep, narrow gulch between Mt. Castello and La Serra. Crossing here had been a high
stone bridge. Its remains lay in the stream. The road running north from Gaggio Montano to
Castel d’Aiano was the springboard of attack. It cut through this narrow valley and crossed the
river at the rubble heap called Malandrone. Where this old masonry bridge had been blown out,
a steep bypass dipped down from the old approach to stream’s edge, and crossed on the rubble
of ruined buildings scraped down as a roadbed fill. Before the 3rd Battalion arrived, work had
started on the Bailey Bridge to eliminate the difficult descent and ascent from the high approaches
to the water’s edge and back. On 28 February, stringers were across, but five or six
shells were thundering into the gulch every two or three minutes. They smashed onto the bridge,
bending the stringers and threatening the unfinished bridge. It later developed that the enemy
had observation on one of the approaches, and almost on the bridge itself, from the heights above
Pietra Colora to the east. Al vehicles approaching from Gaggio Montano, seemingly under cover
from the north, were pounded unmercifully. In spite of heavy casualties in the construction, the
bridge was completed on 2 March, and the long gauntlet down into the gulch and up was thus
shortened. The “shorts” of the continual shelling of this bridge were landing in the laps of the
3rd Battalion.
Feb 27
Mar 1
26
Pre-Battle Situation
Across the stream, the road climbed a series of switchbacks and ran along the valley to the
north and northeast into enemy terrain. The narrow ridge of hills running along parallel to the
road on its right was the initial objective. The hills started at Cimon della Piella and ended at the
side road over to Pietra Colora. These hills, except for one, were in reality one long sharp ridge,
for the hills ran into each other in a string of five peaks with narrow saddles separating them.
They were labeled “Charlie 1, 2, and 3” and “Easy 1 and 2.” The whole ridge was referred to as
Mt. della Vedetta, or “Charlie-Easy Ridge.” To the west of Charlie 1 was a separate hill, Cimon
della Piella, connected by a saddle, but not in line with the ridge. This was called Hill 997. Ideal
defensively, the crest of the steep ridge was wooded and irregular with rock escarpments, stone
walls, and boulder heaps for defensive positions. The approaches to the crest up the steep sides
were open fields broken up with rock outcroppings and walls. Rocky lanes cut into the hillsides
offered some cover. Most of the trees bordering the lanes and fields lay shattered and shredded.
Many of them were large ones, three feet in girth, chewed off at the stump by the heavy German
artillery fire.
The 3rd Battalion 87th, starting northeast, then east, raced right along the German front line
as it faced the Brazilian front, rolling it up from Malandrone to Mt. della Croce. The other two
battalions penetrated northward behind this rolled-up east-west line, and found a little less resistance
as they occupied key hills beyond the side road to Pietra Colora. The 86th on the left side of
the road had to break through only a narrow segment of the front line, and they too were in the
rear moving along beside our 2nd Battalion with the road between them. When the action was
finished, a sizable segment of front line was swept up and a salient was occupied leading north to
Castel d’Aiano.
Originally, the column of battalions was to be the 2nd, 1st, and 3rd, with the 2nd moving to
the attack through the 3rd, but this was changed and the 3rd Battalion was picked to jump off
from the positions they had been occupying for three days. They were to take Hill 997 as the first
objective, and then “Charlie 1, 2, and 3” and “Easy 1 and 2.” They were then to prepare to set a
roadblock north of Pietra Colora on regimental order; and they were also to be prepared to continue
the attack northeast or east.
On the right was the 1st Infantry BEF; on the left, the 86th Mountain Infantry. Company H
relieved Company M on D-1 prepared to support the attack from M’s old positions.
The regiment was supported by the 616th Field Artillery, reinforced by the 175th Field Artillery,
and also by the 84th Chemical Battalion, the 76th Medium Tank Destroyers and Medium
Tank Battalion. Company C of the 126th Engineers cleared mines from roads and checked assembly
areas.
During the night before the attack, the 2nd and 1st Battalions moved up into the assembly areas
south of the gulch on the slopes of Mt. Castello. By 0615 the morning of 3 March, the 87th
was ready to go. Company L was in position on the left of the narrow sector. Company I, the
right flank company of the Division, would follow Company L out at 400 yards. Company K in
the area, rear, would lead the attack, passing through L and jumping off across the line of departure.
To the south across the river were the 2nd and 1st Battalions waiting in the assembly areas.
On the north banks of the stream was the regimental CP, with the OP up on la Serra further to the
north, commanding a direct view of the length of ridge “Charlie-Easy,” and of the town of Pietra
Colora.
Mar 3
27
FIRST DAY—3 MARCH
3rd Battalion—Mt. della Vedetta
COMPANY K ATTACK
Company K moved forward to within a hundred yards of a group of houses on the hillside
south of Stancadora. Supporting artillery worked over these houses and the hills beyond for 15
minutes. At 0700, H-Hour, Company K crossed the line of departure and attacked. Seventeen
minutes later, they were followed by Company L. Heavy enemy artillery fire greeted both companies
as they moved forward. Company I waited to follow Company L. In accordance with the
order, Company K moved straight ahead to the steep hill of Cimon della Piella. The 2nd Platoon
was on the left, 3rd on the right. Following them in support was the 1st Platoon of Company M.
Tanks started moving up the road on the left as they crossed the line of departure. The company
met scattered small arms fire seven minutes later, but by 0730 they were approaching the base of
the hill and requested an artillery concentration on it.
Back in the assembly area waited the 3rd Platoon of Company M, ready to move forward
with mules to Hill 997 when it should be taken. They would support the battalion’s progress
along the ridge “Charlie-Easy.” Also back there was a “Special Force” of the 2nd Platoon, Company
M, plus three .50-caliber machine guns and three 37-mm guns with their crews and mules.
This force, under First Lieutenant WILLIAM D. FLOYD, was to move up in support when Hill
997 was taken. The all-important key to the whole attack for the 87th was the initial taking of Hill
997, which all but blocked the narrow regimental zone of attack.
While the 2nd Platoon of Company K moved up along the steep hill along to the road, the
3rd Platoon under Lieutenant CHARLES L. PFEIFFER swung around to the right to flank the hill.
They received rifle fire from the farm in the saddle, but were able to pass to the left between it
and the hill and up onto the upper slopes. Here, they sent word back prematurely that they were
on top. As Captain ROGER EDDY, company commander, reached the open field the platoon was
in, it became pinned down by heavy machine gun fire from this farm below.
Lieutenant PFEIFFER, out in front of his men reconnoitering for his platoon position, was hit
by small arms fire. He lay unable to move in front of his platoon in an exposed position under
machine gun and small arms fire. Pfc. WILLIAM C. MAAS III, and S/Sgt. HARRY SOUTHARD
volunteered to make their way out to the wounded platoon leader. The two men succeeded in
bringing in Lieutenant PFEIFFER, but MAAS was shot and killed by a sniper just as he had apparently
reached safety. Lieutenant PFEIFFER later died of his wounds.
Meanwhile, the 2nd Platoon had gone on up and had nearly reached the summit from the
left, led by T/Sgt. TOIVO RANTA. (Sergeant RANTA received his battlefield commission a few
days later as a result of his actions on Belvedere in February.) The platoon had been halted,
though, on top of the hill just short of the summit. A strongly defended area with open fields of
fire forced the men to take cover. S/Sgt. EDMUND D. BENNETT, a squad leader in the 2nd Platoon,
seeing that flanking action was impossible, crawled along the side of a stone wall to within
thirty yards of the enemy under a barrage of machine gun fire. Three of the enemy, seeing him
closing in on their position, surrendered; the others abandoned their machine gun and ran back
over the hill. BENNETT, a famous cross-country skier, ran, grabbed up the weapon and chased
them. On the crest of the hill, he set up the gun and opened fire, hitting several of the fleeing enemy
and forcing eight more to surrender. Although lightly wounded, BENNETT’s actions were
outstanding throughout the entire attack.
Mar 3
28
The upper slopes, by 0830, were well spotted with dead Germans, and at least thirty prisoners
of war were moving down without escort. In the saddle between Hill 997 and “Charlie 1”
more fire from the cluster of farm buildings was holding up elements of Company L following on
Company K right. Tracer bullets were shot into a haystack from under which Germans were firing.
The haystack flared up, cremating some of the enemy beneath.
Company L was held up at this farmhouse for a considerable time while Company K consolidated
on the top of Hill 997. They finally moved past it to the right after knocking out much
of its resistance and taking some prisoners. Later in the morning, however, Company K discovered
enemy still in the farm buildings, and two squads from the 1st Platoon under First Lieutenant
WILLIAM PHILP moved down into the saddle. They killed two and captured three more,
then continued up the other side of the saddle onto the west slope of “Charlie 1” from where machine
gun and rifle fire was coming across on that part of the company remaining on Hill 997.
Companies L and I had moved fast past the action of Company K, and moved up a lane running
along the east side of “Charlie-Easy Ridge,” bypassing considerable resistance behind the crest on
the west side.
The two squads under Lieutenant PHILP were supported by one platoon of Company M and
their own weapons from Hill 997 as they moved up “Charlie 1” and took nearly fifty prisoners of
war on the hillside. Their casualties were heavy, though. S/Sgt. MAURICE E. AUCOIN, leading
one of the squads, was cut down and killed by machine gun fire as they assaulted. Also S/Sgt.
GEORGE A. WEMPLE and S/Sgt. RALPH TOWNSEND, another outstanding skier, were seriously
wounded during this action. Pfc. RAYMOND E. HATCHMAN distinguished himself in
this encounter. When his platoon was fired on, he continued to advance until he personally was
fired on. Then, from a covered position, he fired into a building and hurled a grenade, killing
three and driving off the rest of the enemy.
T/5 WILLIAM R. CONNER, aid man, supporting these squads, did heroic work. Under the
heavy fire, he moved openly about to get aid quickly to the wounded men. He spotted one man
lying wounded out in front less than fifty yards from an enemy position. The men with him
yelled for him not to go out, but he moved out regardless. Part way out, intense fire drove him to
cover momentarily. Then putting his Red Cross flag on a stick, he dashed to the wounded man’s
side. He stuck the flag in the ground and in full view was giving aid, when he was shot and
killed by a German sniper in cold blood and in utter disregard for the Red Cross flag, which the
German himself depends on so often.
Sgt. HARRY THOMAS, light machine gun squad leader, was killed while directing his
squad’s fire from an exposed position during the attack. Also, Pfc. DAN M. WILSON, Pfc. FRED
M. PALMER, and Pfc. HAROLD J. PERDUE had been hit fatally as they moved up the rocky
slopes. Lieutenant PHILP, moving forward under heavy mortar and small arms fire to reconnoiter,
rescued a wounded man under difficult circumstances. Later, Lieutenant PHILP was killed
by artillery fire.
Company K finally established contact late in the day with Company L over the ridge. The
command post that night was established in the farmhouse between Hill 997 and “Charlie 1.”
COMPANY L ATTACK
To go back to the line of departure: the elements of Company L had moved out after Company
K under heavy artillery fire. They hit resistance before they reached the slopes of “Charlie,”
and two men were hit by a burp gun near Stancadora just below the farmhouse in the saddle.
They were held up here for nearly an hour, from some time after 0800. It was here they set fire to
the haystack with tracers. T/5 JOSEPH W. CARTER displayed great courage when he moved
29
through mortar and machine gun fire to aid a wounded man lying close to the flaming haystack
in front of the platoon. Shortly after 0900, the German Red Cross flag appeared to protect their
aid men, but the company still was pinned down by machine gun fire from around the farm
buildings. Two machine guns seemed to be firing from the farm buildings. The mortars brought
fire and silenced one. Then Pfc. RALPH MATTSON personally took the attack into his own
hands. Leaving his covered position, he moved forward alone through the heavy fire, firing his
BAR from the hip as he went right up to the machine gun nest. He rushed, silencing it and killing
all three Germans behind the gun. This done, he kept right on going, and the inspired platoon
took off after him.
Sgt. WILLIAM M. KENNEDY, back at the mortar OP, who had been directing fire on the enemy
artillery weapons, was instantly killed by artillery fire. KENNEDY was an invaluable mortar
man, having developed a new type of mortar sight. His loss was great.
Pfc. ROBERT L. MACWILLIAMS was killed during the reorganization following this early
stage of the attack when a small counterattack developed. MACWILLIAMS had been the 2nd
Scout of the 2nd Platoon. He had crawled up and dragged back wounded Pvt. PERRY W.
PROUGH under intense fire. He volunteered to get another wounded man, but was ordered not
to. Instead, with the squad still pinned down from fire from a building, he threw in a grenade
and captured fourteen Germans coming out. A short time later, he was shot in the head with machine
gun fire, and killed.
The 1st Platoon of Company L had moved from their position to the east slope in an attempt
to flank the machine gun positions. They continued on along the lane traversing the steep eastern
slopes. By 0920, they were just north of Merlano on the right flank of “Charlie 1,” having bypassed
considerable resistance on the west slopes.
By 1000, Company I was following Company L, and groups of prisoners were streaming
through them. The 2nd Battalion had moved into the old 3rd Battalion positions, near the line of
departure. The 1st Platoon of Company L was on “Charlie 2” by 1030, followed by 2nd Platoon
and weapons platoon. They had flanked completely around “Charlie 1” by the lane, and climbed
up from the east onto “Charlie 2.” Eighteen minutes later, they were on “Charlie 3” looking forward
to “Easy.” Twenty-three more PWs moved down the road to the battalion area.
No sooner had they gone than firing flared up again from over the ridge and the mortar men
had to set up a firing line. T/Sgt. WALTER P. STILLWELL, at the mortar outpost, crawled forward
to the ridge on hearing the firing, and watched an enemy lieutenant organizing the counterattack.
With S/Sgt. JOHN W. TRIPP, he set up the mortar section defense. STILLWELL himself
killed one enemy and shot down three. Then, seeing no help coming for his hard-pressed
section, he ran back to bring up elements of Company K and Company E. With the help of men
from Company K, the enemy threat was beaten off.
Sergeant JOHN W. TRIPP was wounded early in the action. Although struck in both knees,
he continued to coordinate his mortars with the fire of others until the attack was repulsed. He
finally had to be evacuated.
Sergeant ARTHUR H. BURGESS, JR. at the outbreak of the attack, rushed forward to aid the
exposed outpost. He was crawling along a stone wall to get into position to throw a grenade
when he was struck in the head and killed.
Several of the mortar men deserve mention for heroic action during this attack. Pvt. ROY
JOHNS exposed himself fearlessly in beating off the attack. Pvt. NEAL C. YORKER left his mortar
position as he saw the enemy maneuvering toward his section and helped disperse the attack
with his pistol and grenades.
30
After the counterattack had been repulsed, Lieutenant Colonel ROBERT C. WORKS, battalion
commander, reported that the battalion would take “Easy” by noon. Having learned that the
86th Mountain Infantry had secured his left rear, he ordered Company K to move forward, relieve
Company L, defend “Charlie,” and mop up the area between Hill 997 and “Charlie.” He
ordered Company L to seize and organize “Easy,” and directed that Company I pass through L
prepared to continue the attack. By 1100, Captain JOSEPH J. DUNCAN, reported that he had
seized “Easy 1 and 2.” The prisoners of war were flooding down the road. The entire ridgeline
to the Pietra Colora road had been taken. The PWs coming out from their overrun positions were
confused and surprised by the attack.
It was forward on objective “Easy” that Pfc. ALLEN F. SCHAUFFLER, runner of the leading
platoon, distinguished himself. He went to the aid of a helpless wounded squad leader, S/Sgt.
ARTHUR C. DELANEY, who lay in a dangerously exposed area. In the face of intense small
arms fire, he treated the wounded man and brought him to safety. Later, he aided another
wounded man and refused to leave him during a heavy barrage, remaining until the litter bearers
arrived. Throughout the action, he assisted in the treatment and evacuation of the wounded, as
well as doing his own duties.
Pfc. WILLIAM WILLIAMSON, JR. deserves recognition. Although painfully wounded, he
refused to leave his unit and continued firing at the enemy until he had to be evacuated.
Although running into positions all the way along the ridge top, positions that momentarily
held them up, the progress of the company along the crest to its termination above the Pietra
Colora road was rapid. By 1130 they were there. All of the initial objectives of the 3rd Battalion
had been taken. But the swift progress was built on the many brave deeds of the men who
climbed up and moved along that ridge.
The enemy who lived won’t forget men like S/Sgt. JOHN R. BERGSTROM, a forward squad
leader. He spotted an enemy machine gun in a haystack. Ordering his squad to take positions
and prepare to cover him, he crawled carefully up toward the German gun, then with a wild war
whoop, he rushed the haystack, killing one and capturing another. Neither will they forget
S/Sgt. JAMES C. MOREHOUSE higher up on the ridge. His squad was fired on from a stone
wall 700 yards to his front. He led off across the field in a reckless charge, cleared the wall in a
leap, and killed the enemy.
Other stratagems were used. Pfc. WILBUR D. GIESE captured three PWs single-handedly by
moving far forward above, commanding them in German to surrender. As he moved back with
his booty, he was seriously wounded. Pfc. ELMO J. MILLER, although lying helplessly wounded
before a house, repeatedly tried to direct fire on an enemy machine gun he had spotted, until finally
he was evacuated.
Pfc. SIMON A. PROPPER was fired on and his companion wounded as he advanced toward
a building. He refused to leave his companion. Small arms fire was ineffective against the enemy
machine gun, so he threw a grenade. The gun was knocked out, and he returned to the
squad as the wounded man was being taken care of. He himself was wounded later in the day.
Another rescue of a wounded man was effected during an intense barrage by Sgt. JOSEPH A.
CAMPBELL, who had taken over his squad when its leader had been wounded.
Communications became a problem for Company L as it moved rapidly forward on the attack.
The wiremen worked under the utmost danger until hit. S/Sgt. HERBERT C. SPAULDING,
communications sergeant of Company L, was killed, as was Pvt. GERARD E. O’HARA of
Company I, while laying wire. Pfc. JOHN F. JAMES of Company L was seriously wounded
while working on wire lines.
31
T/5 ROBERT H. SUNDELL, a mail clerk, took over and laid wire in the heaviest fire, after the
others were gone. In addition, he brought aid to wounded men and assisted the medics. All of
these had worked in the open under the heaviest fire, sure of the importance of their jobs, and
heedless of their own safety.
Another squad leader, S/Sgt. LAWRENCE J. LA BONTE, was killed during the advance by
an artillery tree burst up on the ridge.
SUMMARY
Only a few deeds are recorded; many were unseen. But the few that are recorded establish
the temper of the whole action. S/Sgt. JOHN R. BERGSTROM rushing a machine gun in a haystack
with a wild war whoop is an unorthodox way to fight. How can you be a “superman”
against such a man, or against men who can race 300 yards across a field and jump the stone wall
on top of you? Many of the PWs were almost resentful. They didn’t like our tactics. One captured
sergeant in the PW cage asked indignantly, “You came from the wrong side. How can I be
expected to hold my sector if my machine gun is pointing the wrong way?”
Up on that narrow, almost knife-edged ridge, along the tumbled boulders and rock faces,
among the battered trees, some fine men fell. Those who fell left a story of accomplishment.
Those who remain can be proud to have served with such men.
Company K lost six men in death, and L lost five; each company had twenty men wounded.
They had killed many times that number of Germans, and the 87th’s PW count by dark that night
was 442, most of whom came from the ridge; and there were still more drifting in.
The bridge at Malandrone was blown out again about an hour and a half after H-Hour. Only
five tanks had gone over it before it went, but the bypass was still passable down to the water’s
edge and up. The bridge and the bypass were shelled all day and levied more casualties on the
engineers, including the death of the platoon leader, Lt. CHARLES MCKELVEY. A tank was hit
and disabled in the bypass, but tanks continued to move up in support. One attempted to climb
up to the ridge from the main road on the west, but struck a minefield on the lower slopes. By
afternoon one platoon of tanks was able to get up to a supporting position on the east side of the
ridge. The bridge was repaired for the final time by 1450.
Remaining Action of the First Day
Before noon of 3 March, the 2nd Battalion was moving forward to the Pietra Colora road at a
point to the left of Company L, to attack objective “Item,” a low hill northeast of the crossroads.
Before they started, S/Sgt. LEO E. MILLER and Pfc. LEWIS S. TRAUTWEIN of Battalion Headquarters
and Sgt. HARVEY F. CORN, JR. of Company F were killed by artillery fire. The 1st Battalion
had left the assembly area to follow the 2nd. However, at 1145, General HAYS, division
commander, ordered the 2nd Battalion to establish a roadblock at the crossroads, later called
“Shrapnel Junction,” before advancing on “Item.” Meanwhile, Company I was ordered to establish
a roadblock north of Pietra Colora, on the right, to seal off the other end of this road across
the regimental front.
COMPANY I
Company I jumped off at 1315 for the town of Pietra Colora, passing through Company L.
The leading platoon, moving south and east of the road across open slopes, was stopped by an
Italian civilian who pointed out a minefield in their path. The town, a German command post,
was defended by about thirty enemy. The 2nd Platoon in the lead advanced against sniper fire,
taking the town and the thirty Germans by 1500. Only one casualty was suffered during the attack—
a sergeant was hit in the hand. However, although the company quickly reorganized and
32
dug in, heavy artillery and mortar fire killed Pfc. ANTHONY S. SCUTO and Pfc. FREDERICK B.
STRAUSS, and wounded six. This town, on a high knob, was rapidly taken as a result of an accurate
and intense artillery preparation that was closely followed by an assault on the enemy’s rear.
By 1400, the 2nd Battalion was ready to jump off from the north end of the ridge “Charlie-
Easy” at Mt. della Vedetta. Here, they were later pinned down and suffered casualties as they
tried to move forward. Heavy fire was coming from self-propelled guns to the west, and artillery
from Crocette di Sotto, a town to the east of Pietra Colora. Both artillery and air support were
requested on this town at a little after 1500.
Also at this time a Brazilian patrol was seeking to come up the road to Pietra Colora from
Santa Maria Villiana, to the east. They had taken this town just after Company I took Pietra Colora,
and were trying to make contact with Company I. However, communications had been cut
with Company I since its jump-off. The progress of the company was reported to the Brazilians
by First Lieutenant LEON C. WILMOT, the 87th liaison officer, from the OP across the valley.
From this position, he had been able to follow the action all day, even to counting the number of
prisoners taken. Since Company I couldn’t be warned, the Brazilian patrol was not allowed to
make contact. Their green uniforms might easily be mistaken for the enemy.
At 1505, General HAYS ordered the 86th to move up promptly on Objectives “George” and
“Fox,” since the 2nd Battalion couldn’t occupy “Item” until the other two were taken. The attack
on “Item” was to be coordinated with the advance of the 86th on “Howe.” Colonel EARL
THOMSON, chief of staff, also ordered tank destroyers to fire on Crocette di Sotto. Three guns
were each to lay in 15 rounds.
The 86th had had a difficult time in Iola, and were still cleaning it out at 1530, thus preventing
any action at “Fox” and “George.” Elements of the 85th, originally scheduled to relieve the
3rd Battalion, all shifted into the 86th sector to hasten them along.
COMPANY E
At 1700, the 2nd Battalion, with Company E leading, moved out to attack “Item.” Division
ordered at 1730 to “button up” for the night whenever a defensive position was reached. However,
Company E had moved out and their wire was cut. The 1st Platoon had stopped southwest
of the crossroad near Flizzone, and the 2nd and 3rd Platoons had gone through them, the 2nd
leading across the road and into the town of Canevaccia. They entered the town as it grew dark
under shellfire from German self-propelled guns.
Communication had been blown out soon after the company had crossed the road. So, after
occupation was completed, Captain LE GRAND PENDREY and three men went back and found
the breaks. Communication reestablished, the company was able to receive word to withdraw
across the road. Their position in Canevaccia was exposed and liable to encirclement during the
night, since the units on the left had not moved abreast.
Company E withdrew to Flizzone. They had suffered five casualties, two of them killed,
from the self-propelled guns. These two were Pfc. EDMON E. HATHAWAY and Pfc. ALBERT L.
SAYER who died firing.
Before they could get down off the ridge in the afternoon, Company F had been plastered
with artillery and self-propelled gun fire and had suffered twelve casualties. Two were fatalities:
Pvt. WESLEY E. LAHTI, and Pfc. EUGENE C. NORTON. Company F spent the night with Companies
E and G near Flizzone.
33
Situation at the End of the First Day
The situation at the end of the first day of attack was excellent. The 87th had taken all of the
ground in its sector up to the Pietra Colora road, including the town itself, and it had established
roadblocks on that road. The plans for the second day included the 2nd and 1st Battalions jumping
off simultaneously at 0800 and moving parallel to each other out to the north, each taking two
of the rolling hills lying before them. The 3rd Battalion meanwhile was to push further to the
right (east) and occupy a mountain above Pietra Colora. The 3rd Battalion requested and received
permission to move their H-Hour from 0800 to 1000.
The total casualties for the first day of fighting had been 25 killed in action and 80 wounded.
The 3rd Battalion, leading, had suffered more than half of these, with 16 killed and 50 wounded.
Word came that night that back at Abetaia, the aid station had been booby-trapped, and had
blown up with its occupants. In it, in addition to its staff and patients, were all three of the chaplains
of the 87th. Few survived the tremendous blast that hollowed the stone building and
knocked out one of its stone walls. Chaplain EDWIN C. GOMKE was one of the few seriously
wounded who were gotten out alive. But the universally liked Chaplains HARRY MONTGOMERY
and WILLIAM S. CONTINO were both killed. Two of their drivers were wounded, and the
87th medic Pfc. FRANK J. PIAZZA was killed in the same explosion.
SECOND DAY—4 MARCH
1st Battalion—Bacucco
Early in the morning of the 2nd day of the attack, the 1st Battalion started moving forward
from near Stancadora. They left at 0530, passed through the 3rd Battalion, Mt. della Vedetta
ridge area, and jumped off across the Pietra Colora road at 0800, after a fifteen-minute artillery
barrage, just as the 2nd Battalion was crossing to their left.
COMPANY A
Company A was leading with the 1st and 2nd Platoons abreast as they moved toward Mt.
Acidola. In the draw south of Acidola, they were hit by heavy mortar and artillery fire. Sgt.
EUGENE C. LOUMAN and Pfc. WAVEL P. ELAM were badly hurt here, and soon afterward two
scouts from the battalion headquarters company advancing in front of Company A were hit. Pfc.
HANS JUNGSTER was only lightly wounded, but Pfc. JOE C. MILLER was killed. MILLER,
since the early days of the regiment, had been applauded as the Regimental Cartoonist. With
him went a good many—but not all—of those happy “slope dopes” he carried around in his
mind and put on paper. Many still remain with friends, and in old copies of the Blizzard, and in
the back of other people’s minds. No one who ever saw the cartoon could forget poor old
“Slopey” in D-Series, hunched over a briskly burning stack of broken skis, cooking a C-ration,
resigned to his place in the snowy waste, but making the best of it.
By 0930, Company A had taken Mt. Acidola, and an hour later, the Battalion CP prepared to
displace forward to it. A prisoner of war with a secret document was sent back to the regiment at
this time.
COMPANY B
Meanwhile Company B, followed by C and D, went through A, and the 2nd Battalion moved
by on the left. Company B headed for Bacucco, the objective code-named “Love.” They moved
across a wide valley with 2nd Platoon on the left, 1st on the right. From a group of houses half-
Mar 4
34
way up the hill still 400 yards away, six or seven helmeted Germans emerged holding Italian
women before them as shields. They seemed to be looking the situation over, and as the Americans
continued to advance, they ran back into the houses, waving white flags. One, however,
started to run up the hill. Pfc. GERALD E. MULVANEY at a 400-yard range, raised his M-1,
squeezed, and as the single shot sounded, the running figure collapsed. A “bulls-eye” at 400
yards!
Company B moved up and deployed on a ridge. Next, six Germans came out of the houses
with cloth caps instead of helmets and moved down to surrender to the 2nd Platoon. They apparently
were a mortar squad, but they hadn’t fired a shot.
Later, hearing information about some enemy over on the back of the hill, Pfc. PAUL F.
SCHILLER and one other man composed a voluntary patrol to creep forward and locate the enemy.
SCHILLER came up a gully to the left of the German position, and seeing the German
leader just as the German saw SCHILLER, he beat him to the draw and shot him. Four other
Germans surrendered quickly. In the strong point were one 81-mm mortar, two machine guns,
and some AT grenades. Shortly after noon, all was occupied on Bacucco. Pfc. LUCIEN T.
DEETER was killed by artillery.
During the afternoon, the company dug in along the draw northeast of Bacucco. At this time,
the 2nd Battalion had not reached their final objective on Hill 926 (Objective “King”) nor Madna
di Brasa. These objectives were all taken, however, before 1700, and the 1st Battalion tied in with
the 2nd and shifted over to their left near Madna di Brasa.
Lieutenant Colonel ROSS J. WILSON, commanding the 1st Battalion, when requested by Division
to move on to Castel d’Aiano, explained that he was unable to do so, due to lack of supplies
and the fatigue of his men. So the attack was postponed until morning.
2nd Battalion—Madna di Brasa
COMPANY E
As the 1st Battalion advanced, the 2nd Battalion had jumped off on the left, closely following
a fifteen-minute barrage. Company E, with the 2nd Platoon leading, crossed the road at 0800, 4
March, the second day of the attack. The battalion received heavy artillery and mortar fire as it
advanced, and had one killed and four wounded before going 600 yards. The leading company
moved to the right of yesterday’s route to Canevaccia, but to the left of the 1st Battalion jumping
off for Acidola.
They held up at a farmhouse on “Item” 500 yards beyond the road. Mortar fire was coming
in at this point, but no small arms fire as yet. Pvt. JAMES P. KENNEY was killed by mortar fire
while covering the building for the assault squad. After the house was taken, Lieutenant Colonel
EMMETT L. NATIONS, battalion commander, came up to survey the situation.
From the farmhouse on “Item,” the 2nd Platoon advanced directly toward Hill 926 (“King”).
The 3rd Platoon flanked around to the right. They were so far to the right that they lost contact
across the valley from Hill 926 on Madna di Brasa.
At about 1500, when the 2nd Platoon was pinned down on the slopes of Hill 926, the 1st Platoon
was used as a flanking element through the gap between the 2nd and 3rd. The rifle squads
of the 1st Platoon moved up the valley followed by a machine gun section. The enemy in position
at the head of the valley allowed the rifle squads to go by, and then opened up on the machine
gun crew, cutting down S/Sgt. DONALD P. DUNCAN, Pfc. HOWARD WINTER, Pvt.
GEORGE E. MITCHELL, and Sgt. CECIL E. NIRIDER. No one was killed. This fusillade of resis35
tance ended the skirmish, for the two squads went up on the hill, captured a mortar crew in position,
and drove back the remainder of the defenders.
COMPANY G
Company G, following E, swung over and occupied Madna di Brasa and Road Junction (RJ)
K 20 just north, about 1600. They received mortar fire during occupation, and S/Sgt. GEORGE J.
BLAKER was killed while digging. Also killed in Company G were: Pfc. HENRY F. ROSE, JR.
and Pvt. BRAINERD E. LYNCH.
The 1st Battalion had meanwhile moved out abreast of the 2nd, and passed over Acidola and
Bacucco by noon. By the time Company G reached Madna di Brasa, Company B had dug positions
that continued a line to the southeast of Madna di Brasa.
COMPANY F
The 1st Platoon of Company F, which had followed E and G in the advance, moved out an
hour and a half after the hill was taken to establish outposts on the ridge running out of Natale,
while E and G established defensive positions on Hill 926 and K 20 beyond Madna di Brasa. At
0430 on 5 March, one squad of Company F established a roadblock at RJ 813 near Casone. During
the morning of the 5th, Lieutenant DONALD DWYER, with half a squad, captured 13 Germans
to the left of his roadblock. He had reinforced his roadblock with a machine gun squad
from Natale, and then with half a squad, he had walked over to Gualandi on the regimental left
boundary. As this patrol approached Gualandi, the men were fired on by snipers. They all took
cover, all except Pfc. PAUL STETTNER who braved the fire to continue moving forward, shouting
in German to surrender for they were outnumbered. This action drew fire, confused the enemy,
and allowed the remainder of the patrol to enter the town and capture 13 Germans.
3rd Battalion—Mt. della Croce
COMPANY I
To return to the morning of 4 March, the second day of the attack, the 3rd Battalion was to
jump off for Mt. della Croce at 1000, after a fifteen-minute barrage. The barrage was delayed due
to clearance uncertainty with the Brazilians, whose front lines were just below Mt. della Croce.
The jump-off was held up until 1100 when they led off, 2nd, 1st, and 3rd Platoons, Company I, in
that order. As they moved up, they were fired on at long range by automatic weapons from two
houses. The houses were bypassed and mopped up from the rear, all the inmates surrendering.
From long range, heavy machine guns supporting the advance from Pietra Colora fired a haystack,
and more Germans were driven out and captured. Leading elements climbed a ridge running
up to the summit from the left side, and exchanged grenades with the enemy in position on
top. After a fifteen-minute firefight, three men surrendered and the resistance was crushed. The
company then moved rapidly along the open top of the hill, meeting only sporadic resistance
here and there. This initial objective of Mt. della Croce was occupied by 1200.
The final objective, Hill 882, was a knob off to the east on a shoulder of the mountain. The 1st
Platoon went through the 2nd to continue the attack supported by heavy weapons on Mt. della
Croce. They moved through a minefield, followed by the weapons platoon. Although the entire
1st Platoon passed through the field uneventfully, Sgt. G. C. MANIS, mortar squad leader of the
weapons platoon, touched off a mine that blew his foot off, crumpling him up on the ground.
Pfc. KENNETH D. PERKINS fearlessly moved out into the minefield and administered to the
wounded man. As he turned to leave, he blew off two more mines and was killed. Then another
aid man Pfc. ROY K. COMBS, moved into the minefield to try to evacuate MANIS to safety.
COMBS suddenly crumpled in another explosion, his leg gone. Pvt. JACK PITTMAN from the
36
litter team of Company K picked up a length of W-130 wire, and probing his way, moved in to
the three forms on the ground. He tied wire around each of the two living men, and they were
hauled to safety and evacuated.
The Brazilians made contact from the right flank, and took over and secured positions, allowing
Company I to withdraw to Pietra Colora. Company I had suffered no casualties from actual
contact with the enemy, except for the mine casualties. Only one man, Pfc. JOSEPH G. HANCE,
had been hit; he was killed by our own artillery at 1000 that morning. Company M, in support
from Mt. della Vedetta ridge, was hit by artillery. Pfc. FRANCIS A. LA FOUNTAIN was killed.
Company I took ten prisoners of war.
The action for the 3rd Battalion was completed, and they moved their CP into the ruined
buildings of Pietra Colora.
THIRD DAY—5 MARCH
1st Battalion—Castel d’Aiano
During the afternoon of 5 March, the 87th made its final effort of the offensive, when the 1st
Battalion pushed on to Castel d’Aiano and Hill 813. The attack was to begin at 0630, but was delayed
to allow the 85th time to move up Mt. della Spe on the right.
By noon, friendly tanks had moved into Castel d’Aiano, were being fired on, and had called
for infantry support. The 1st Battalion jumped off across northeast of Madna di Brasa (K 20) at
1400. Company C led off, and as they crossed the ridge and moved down the long open slope
into the draw, everything the enemy had opened up on them. Company C headed for Hill 813, a
thousand yards north. Company A, following across the road, swung to the right toward Castel
d’Aiano.
COMPANY C ATTACK
The trip to Hill 813 was formidable, for 800 yards down the slope was wide open and spotted
with well-prepared dugouts. On the hillside, firing up at the two leading platoons of Company
C, were light machine guns, burp guns, mortars, rifles and rifle grenades. Upon our heavy return
fire the nearer ranks of enemy began to yell “Kamerad!” but those behind them still fired. Just before
reaching the draw that led to the valley bottom, two PWs were taken. These were fired upon
by their own men, and one American was killed as he took the PWs in charge.
First Lieutenant WILLIAM S. RYBERG, with the 1st Platoon, and the company commander,
Captain MORLAN W. NELSON, moved around to the left and got into this draw running on
down and flanking the positions. The 2nd Platoon, led by Lieutenant JOHN W. HAWK, followed
the 1st Platoon down this draw. On the right of the draw was a nose sticking out from Monfenaro.
Lieutenant RYBERG, out in front of his platoon, led them onto the nose to flank the position
on the hillside. He was instantly killed by machine gun fire. Pfc. HORACE H. RAINEY was
killed here too, at about the same time. Pfc. GLENN R. BAILEY, the 2nd Platoon messenger,
running across the open field further to the left under heavy fire, was also killed.
A BAR man, Pfc. ELMER T. PERKINS, advancing with the 2nd Platoon, was being fired on
by a machine gun. He stood it as long as he could and then jumped up and, standing in plain
view, had it out with the German machine gunner, killing him with a hail of fire.
The 2nd Platoon, passing the 1st, continued down to the left of Monfenaro to the mouth of
the draw where it came out at the foot of Hill 813. Here they were in full view of the enemy on
813, and a barrage of artillery and heavy machine gun fire pinned them down.
Mar 5
37
It was now getting toward dusk. Captain NELSON was pinned down at the base of a large
tree. The wire had come part way up to him, but the wiremen were also pinned down about a
hundred yards away. Counter-battery fire was badly needed. Pfc. ALEXIS POUTIATINE
grabbed the wire reel and raced across the open distance for the captain’s tree. Machine gun fire
followed his course; tracer bullets appeared to pass between his legs. By a miracle, he wasn’t hit,
and the request for artillery fire was sent back. Two weeks later, while in division reserve at Pietra
Colora, POUTIATINE picked up a booby-trapped German bazooka while helping to clear out
some buildings and was killed.
Under cover of darkness and the artillery barrage, the company reorganized. Then, with the
2nd and 3rd Platoons abreast, they moved up in the dark and occupied Hill 813, taking six prisoners,
but meeting little resistance.
COMPANY A ATTACK
Company A had less trouble taking Castel d’Aiano. Partisans had made arrangements to
guide them through the minefields and safely into town. S/Sgt. ABRAHAM J. SANTONI, a rifle
squad leader, conducted valuable negotiations with them. He was mortally wounded when
struck by a mine after concluding these conferences and while returning with the company
commander.
The 2nd Platoon took the first row of houses on the south side. The chief resistance was in a
cement factory where about half a platoon of Germans were defending themselves with automatic
weapons. When one of them was killed, the rest finally surrendered. After they surrendered,
some of them were hit by their own artillery, which started thundering down in the town
at about this time.
The 1st Platoon took the east edge of town and Famaticcia. While the platoons were working
through town, a heavy artillery barrage south of town cut them off from the command group and
the rear. Captain HUGH D. KLEMME, in his command jeep, circled around and drove into town
from the east, reestablishing control.
The tanks were ordered back into town to fire back against enemy mountain positions to the
right. But heavy shellfire fell on all rifle companies of the battalion all that night and the following
day. Company A was moved forward to fill the gap between Company C’s position on Hill
813 and Company B’s position at Castel d’Aiano. The 3rd Platoon was shifted over as far as Objective
“Love” where they linked up with the 2nd Battalion.
In the 1st Battalion, casualties were light during the attack. Company A had two deaths and
two wounded; B, one killed and three wounded; C, three killed and two wounded; D, one
wounded; and Headquarters Company, one killed and one wounded. However, the battalion
continued to suffer some casualties in their foremost position in the northward salient. They
were under continuous observation and frequent artillery barrages.
2nd Battalion—In Support
During the day of 5 March, one 37-mm gun was brought up to Casone and used to support
the attack of the 1st Battalion on Hill 813 beyond Castel d’Aiano. This gun, and some heavy machine
guns, were fired in the afternoon on German troops retreating down the rear slopes of Mt.
della Spe. Tragically, First Lieutenant ROBERT B. PFUSCH, of Company E, was mortally
wounded on the final day while returning from a reconnaissance across the road east of Casone.
He was hit by artillery, evacuated, but succumbed the following day.
This ended the action for the 2nd Battalion. Their losses were light in number compared to
the ground they covered. Company E had lost four killed and sixteen wounded; Company F
38
three killed and ten wounded; Company G three killed and three wounded, while Headquarters
Company lost two killed and four wounded.
Conclusions
During the four-day battle, from March 3rd to 6th, the 87th lost in total battle casualties 186
men, 43 of whom died. It cleared the enemy from a mountainous area over 6,000 yards wide. Six
hundred German soldiers and officers were captured and driven through to the PW cage during
the three-day period. An unknown number of enemy dead, and quantities of enemy armament
and equipment were removed from the occupied mountains.
PRISONERS
From the PWs some interesting facts were learned. During the night before the attack, 2-3
March, elements of the 114th Jaeger Division were relieving the 232nd Division. The 721st Regiment
of the 114th Jaeger Division was supposed to assume control of the area on the morning of
the 3rd, but the 87th Mountain Infantry beat them to it. The German relief was never finished.
The 3rd Battalion of the 371st was captured pretty well intact. Into our hands came the battalion
commander, a major, six staff officers and the battalion ambulance, complete with driver, aid
man, and two wounded Krauts.
The prisoners of the second day were less surprised than those of the first, but a lot more disgruntled.
They came largely from the unit relieved the night before. They had been halted as
they marched to the rear, turned around and thrown back into line to try to save the situation for
the Germans. One prisoner, who believed that German PWs were used as forced labor, complained,
“I don’t mind being taken prisoner, but I surely hate losing out on my rest.”
The units facing us at the end of the period were a mauled lot, and reserves had to be drawn
on to stiffen and fill our their lines, in particular the 29th Panzer Grenadier Division. One deserter
on March 7th was from this unit, and he had been bitterly disappointed that the attack had
stopped where it did. He was hidden in a house waiting for the attack to pass him by so that he
could surrender. Since the Americans didn’t show up, he came over to them.
The morale seemed to have deteriorated since the previous attack. This is partly due to the
pounding they had just taken on this front, and partly due to the news from other fronts. They
were well oriented on the situation at home, and they knew the war was lost. The crossing of the
Rhine and the fall of Cologne had been a severe blow. One deserter taken was a fiddler from a
division band which had been disbanded to furnish more front-line soldiers.
While the average German was still more definitely a potential deserter, the measures to prevent
desertion had increased and become more brutal, working mercilessly not only against the
family of the deserter, but also against his commanders and associates. Any German sergeant
could shoot with authority a suspected deserter.
A sergeant from the elite Mittenwald Battalion, made up of Austrians and Bavarians, said
that every man in his company was anxious to desert and would when the chance came. He
claimed that when an absence was discovered, the unit would be pulled out of the line or else the
whole company would soon be over to desert. Actually, the battalion was pulled out within the
next few days.
It was apparent from a study of PW information that rather than the looked-for counterattacks,
the enemy had been knocked reeling back off his feet, and his activity was frantic preparation
for our expected continued advance. In any event, no counterattacks developed, not even
such small-scale ones as the Germans launched against us at Belvedere.
39
ARTILLERY FIRE
Heavy artillery fire fell on the front line battalions during the following days. At first every
day there were casualties. Of those that were fatal, Company A lost Pfc. JAMES CAUDILL and
Pfc. LUTHER P. LEWIS on 6 March. Company C lost S/Sgt. LOUIS O. BROWN; Company D,
Pfc. WALTER O. FLOWE; and Company E, Pfc. FEDER H. BENJAMIN on the 7th of March.
Company H, Second Lieutenant FRANK P. BAKER on the 8th; and Company A, Pfc. JOHN C.
MURPHY on the 9th. The casualties tapered off when the fire slackened more and more as the
month wore on. In Company F, Pfc. HARRY Y. SCHAEDLER was killed on the 12th; in Company
L, Cpl. ALAN H. RINFRET on the 25th; and Company I, Pfc. JAMES F. NEVERGALL on
the 26th of March.
The artillery fire was greatly reduced by a counter-battery system set up by Major HALVOR
O. EKERN, regimental S-3, and operated under Captain ARTHUR BRODEUR. The gun positions
were sighted from various OPs and triangulated in the regimental CP. This accurate information
was quickly transmitted to our artillery for immediate counter-battery fire. Enemy artillery and
mortar fire noticeably diminished after this system began to function.
The regimental CP, established on the eastern slope of Mt. della Vedetta at Varia di Sotto at
1300 on 4 March, was maintained throughout the rest of the month, with the exception of a brief
period north of Mt. Acidola. The battalion positions shifted constantly. The regimental OP established
on top of the ridge above the CP was shelled out by friendly artillery, fired from just below.
It appeared as though our supporting artillery couldn’t get their shells over the hill. After
several had crashed into the rocks on either side of the OP, a maddened enlisted man rushed
down the hill and “bawled out” the gun crew. They listened, and then fired another round into
the hill. Then First Lieutenant DAVID S. ARNOLD raced down the hill to the battery position.
The gun crew was apathetic; the officer to see was at breakfast. After the difficulty was explained
and supposedly ironed out, another shot was fired. It, too, crashed into the hill. After a few
more tries, most of the regimental Headquarters Company had gathered around registering disapproval
of the performance. Then, without warning, a shell cleared the hill. The men cheered
wildly; the booing ceased. However, the I & R Platoon abandoned their OP, grateful that there
had been no casualties.
COMMENDATIONS
The achievement of the whole Division during both the February and March actions was recognized
by the following commendations:
a. From Field Marshal ALEXANDER, Supreme Commander, Mediterranean Theatre of Operations,
to Major General HAYS:
8 MARCH 1945
MY HEARTIEST CONGRATULATIONS TO YOU PERSONALLY AND YOUR DIVISION
FOR A VERY WELL PLANNED AND WELL EXECUTED OPERATION. WELL DONE. I
AM DELIGHTED AT YOUR SUCCESS.
FIELD MARSHAL ALEXANDER
b. From Lieutenant General MCNARNEY, Commanding MTOUSA:
8 MARCH 1945
MAY I OFFER MY SINCERE CONGRATULATIONS TO THE OFFICERS AND MEN OF THE
10TH MOUNTAIN DIVISION. YOU HAVE SHOWN BY THE SUCCESS OF YOUR FIRST
BATTLE TEST OFFENSIVE CAPABILITY WHICH WILL BE A CONSTANT SOURCE OF
REAL CONCERN TO OUR ENEMIES. GOOD LUCK AND GOOD HUNTING.
MCNARNEY
40
c. From Lieutenant General MARK W. CLARK, Commanding 15th Army Group:
7 MARCH 1945
MY CONGRATULATINS TO THE OFFICERS AND MEN OF THE 10TH MOUNTAIN
DIVISION ON THE SUCCESS OF THEIR FIRST MAJOR OPERATION, THE CAPTURE OF
MT. BELVEDERE.
YOUR DIVISION, IN ITS INITIAL BATTLES, HAS ACQUITTED ITSELF WITH THE
COURAGE AND DARING OF A VETERAN COMBAT UNIT. THIS SPEAKS MORE
ELOQUENTLY THAN WORDS OF THE EFFICIENCY OF YOUR PRE-BATTLE TRAINING
AND THE SPIRIT OF OFFICERS AND MEN.
THE 10TH MOUNTAIN DIVISION HAS PROVED ITSELF TO HAVE THE FIGHTING
QUALITIES REQUIRED FOR SUCCESSFUL INFANTRY COMBAT. I AM VERY HAPPY TO
HAVE THIS DIVISION FIGHTING SHOULDER TO SHOULDER WITH THE OTHER FINE
TROOPS IN 15TH ARMY GROUP.
MARK W. CLARK
d. From Lieutenant General L. K. TRUSCOTT, JR., Commanding General Fifth Army:
8 MARCH 1945
UPON THE CONCLUSION OF THE FIRST FULL SCALE OFFENSIVE OPERATION
AGAINST THE ENEMY CARRIED OUT BY THE 10TH DIVISION, I DESIRE TO EXTEND
TO EVERY OFFICER AND MAN IN THE 10TH MOUNTAIN DIVISION MY SINCERE
CONGRATULATIONS ON THE MAGNIFICENT MANNER IN WHICH YOU HAVE
ACCOMPLISHED A VERY DIFFICULT ASSIGNMENT. OVER DIFFICULT TERRAIN
AGAINST STRONG OPPOSITION, YOU HAVE SEIZED EVERY OBJECTIVE IN RECORD
TIME. YOU HAVE INFLICTED SEVERE LOSSES UPON AT LEAST TWO GERMAN
DIVISIONS AND HAVE COMPELLED THE ENEMY TO EMPLOY RESERVE DIVISIONS IN
YOUR AREA.
I AM DELIGHTED WITH THE SPLENDID PERFORMANCE OF THE 10TH MOUNTAIN
DIVISION. YOUR SUCCESS CLEARLY INDICATES CAREFUL AND METICULOUS
PLANNING AND EXECUTION. I ESPECIALLY COMMEND THE COMMANDERS AND
STAFF OFFICERS WHO ARE RESPONSIBLE.
THE 10TH MOUNTAIN DIVISION IN ITS FIRST OPERATION HAS BEEN AN INSPIRATION
TO THE ENTIRE FIFTH ARMY. YOU HAVE SET A HIGH STANDARD AND
HAVE DEMONSTRATED THE HIGHEST QUALIFICATIONS IN LEADERSHIP AND
COMBAT. YOUR OUTSTANDING SUCCESS IN YOUR FIRST OPERATION AUGURS
WELL FOR A BRILLIANT FUTURE. I AM PROUD INDEED TO HAVE THIS DIVISION
FIGHTING SHOULDER TO SHOULDER WITH THE VETERAN DIVISIONS OF THE FIFTH
ARMY.
L. K. TRUSCOTT, JR.
e. From Major General WILLIS D. CRITTENBERGER, Commanding General, IV Corps:
IN THE OPERATION OF 3 MARCH TO 7 MARCH 1945, INCLUSIVE, THE 10TH
MOUNTAIN DIVISION HAS AGAIN DEMONSTRATED ON THE BATTLEFIELD ITS
RIGHT TO BE CLASSIFIED AS A SPLENDID COMBAT UNIT, NOT ONLY CAPABLE OF
UNDERTAKING A SUSTAINED ADVANCE AGAINST A WELL INTRENCHED AND WILY
ENEMY DEPLOYED ON RUGGED TERRAIN, BUT EAGER TO DO SO. THE ENEMY
ESTIMATE OF “ELITE MOUNTAIN TROOPS,” APPLIED BY HIM TO YOUR DIVISION
AFTER SHORT BUT BITTER EXPERIENCE, IS A DESERVED COMPLIMENT.
THE SPIRITED ATTACK OF YOUR ELEMENTS, AND THE SMART, ALERT FIGHTING
WHICH ALL RANKS DISPLAYED WERE DOMINANT FACTORS IN YOUR SUCCESSFUL
41
PENETRATION OF THE ENEMY’S MAIN LINE OF DEFENSE. HE WAS OVERWHELMED
BY THE RELENTLESS PRESSURE OF YOUR ADVANCE. THE ADROIT SCHEME OF
MANEUVER USED BY YOUR BATTALIONS RESULTED IN A LARGE BAG OF PRISONERS
OF WAR AND MATERIEL THAT CANNOT BUT HASTEN HIS FINAL DEFEAT. THE FINE
PHYSICAL CONDITION OF YOUR TROOPS ALSO CONTRIBUTED IN LARGE MEASURE
TO THE FAVORABLE OUTCOME OF THE ATTACK.
AS YOUR VARIOUS UNITS NOW ARE DISPOSED IN FIRM AND CONFIDENT CONTROL
OF ALL OBJECTIVES, IT IS A GREAT PLEASURE FOR ME HEREBY TO COMMEND YOU
AND YOUR OFFICERS AND MEN, NOT ONLY FOR A PRECISE AND MASTERLY
EXECUTION OF YOUR MISSION, BUT AS WELL FOR THE DASH AND VIGOR THAT
NEVER FOR A MOMENT LEFT THE ISSUE IN DOUBT.
WILLIS D. CRITTENBERGER
ACTIVITIES DURING THE REMAINDER OF MARCH
After consolidating the newly won positions, and “sweating out” counterattacks that never
came, the battalions were shifted around frequently. The 2nd and 3rd Battalions relieved the 3rd
Battalions of the 86th and 85th on the west flank of the Division early on 9 March. Later on the
same day, the 1st Battalion 87th was relieved by the 86th in the north sector, and they moved to
the left to establish positions around Sassomolare. The following day, the 2nd took these over,
and the 1st withdrew to an assembly area at Pietra Colora. The 3rd Battalion was also relieved.
Elements of the BEF took over their positions, and they retired to Malandrone.
On the 12th, the 3rd Battalion left for a rest area at Campo Tizzoro, and the 1st Battalion went
to the Fifth Army Rest Area at Montecatini, leaving only the 2nd Battalion at the front.
Montecatini, a former mountain resort, was an amazing surprise to the men of the regiment,
with night clubs, shows, wine, women, and song; hot water, even rest for those who wished it. It
was an unexpected relief to the men from the constant shellfire and the confining existence in a
foxhole.
On the 15th, the 1st and 3rd returned to division reserve at Pietra Colora and Malandrone.
The following day, the 3rd took over from the 2nd who went into reserve with the 1st to prepare
for a stretch at Montecatini, leaving on the 19th. During this period, life behind the lines sometimes
became more important than what was going on “out there.” Talk shifted to Florence and
Rome and Montecatini as leaves and passes were issued. The weather grew more and more
pleasant, and the Italian countryside blossomed forth in spring loveliness. Flowers grew between
the shell holes, and fruit trees covered their shrapnel-torn branches with fragrant blossoms. Still,
shells fell and litter teams sometimes carried friends away across the new grass. The enemy was
no different, even though his homeland was burning away behind him. It was still a grim business
for the men on the line, but the interludes refreshed the spirit.
SUCCESSFUL PATROL
A patrol from Company I went out the night of 19 March to capture German prisoners in
front of their sector. It was one of the most successful patrols ever sent out in the Italian Theater.
They brought back one-half of an entire company (23 men) without suffering a casualty, or having
either side fire a shot. First Lieutenant ALEXANDER JONES and Sgt. ALEXANDER
BEAUCHESNE led the carefully organized patrol. They, with 28 men, were able to send a reinforced
squad around to the right rear of a German-occupied town. They crept with the rest of the
patrol to within 75 yards of the town without being detected. Then, as a prearranged artillery
box-barrage sealed the town off, the reinforced squad supported the balance of the patrol as they
Mar 19
Mar 12
42
moved through town and cleaned the sleepy Germans out of the houses. Fifteen minutes after
the barrage started, the entire patrol was back at the rendezvous with the 23 Germans. The patrol
returned uneventfully to the lines.
At the PW cage it came out that the German company commander had left the town just before
the attack. One of the PWs, a former actor, did a humorous “take-off” of the German officer’s
return to find that all of his men had disappeared. All prisoners agreed that he would die
for having lost half his company, regardless of the circumstances.
The 2nd Battalion returned to the Pietra Colora area on 23 March, and that night the 1st Battalion
relieved the 10th Anti-tank Battalion and the 10th Cavalry Reconnaissance Troop on the
right flank of the Division without incident at 2040.
On the evening of 27 March, after a 24-hour postponement, the 1st Battalion, 365th Infantry,
of the 92nd Division, relieved the 3rd Battalion and came under regimental control in that sector.
The 3rd Battalion moved to Campo Tizzoro where a training area had been set up. The next day,
in the rain, the 1st Battalion was relieved and moved back to Pietra Colora leaving none of the
87th battalions on the line for the first time since the 2nd of February. However, the 365th operated
under the 87th, so the regimental CP was active.
RETURN OF THE COMMANDER
The 3rd Battalion held a parade on the smoothest and flattest field that could be found at
Campo Tizzoro. Decorations were presented to officers and enlisted men of the battalion by
Brigadier General ROBINSON E. DUFF, the assistant division commander.
The officers and men of the regiment were genuinely delighted to see the regimental commander,
Colonel DAVID M. FOWLER, return to duty. Colonel FOWLER made his first appearance
at the 3rd Battalion parade. The sun had just broken through the overcast, and the field was
damp and very green from the spring rain, and the 92nd Division Band had drawn crowds of
Italians to the ceremony. As Colonel FOWLER moved across the field with a slight limp, a murmur
of admiration passed through the troops. There was no man there who had been less concerned
with his own safety or more concerned for the safety of the men of the 87th, and the men
of his command recognized it. He had been away from the regiment five weeks.
The month ended with the native people preparing for Easter, and the soldiers watching with
hope in their hearts the tremendous progress of the Allied armies in western Germany.
Mar 27
43
SPRING OFFENSIVE
(1 APRIL — 20 APRIL)
PREPARATION FOR BATTLE
he 87th Mountain Infantry spent the first two weeks of April 1945 planning and preparing for
their part in the final spring offensive of the Fifth Army in Italy. The days were warm and
mild. The fruit trees of the Apennines, many of them torn and shredded by artillery fire during
the winter stalemate, were in bloom on the mountainsides. The narrow mountain roads, built for
oxcart and foot travel, had been pulverized into dust by the 2 1/2 -ton trucks and jeeps coming to
the front with supplies. Tanks, tank destroyers, armored artillery, artillery fieldpieces, and heavy
equipment of all types stretched to the rear as far as the eye could see. For the soldier resting in
the spring sunshine, gathering his gear and cleaning his rifle, it was a reassuring sight, as reassuring
as the war news from Europe’s other battlefields. It all made the end of the war seem more
than a remote possibility.
During the days of preparation there was the never-ending rattle of eleventh hour “zeroing
in” of small arms. Men attended flame-thrower schools, or were transported to other areas to
watch demonstrations of new weapons. Selected personnel were given practical work in actual
minefields. And through all the apparent “peace and quiet” of the lines, maps of unconquered
portions of Italy were distributed to the units—even road maps of the Po Valley and beyond.
There was more in the air than spring.
The general plan of the 10th Mountain Division’s role in breaking through the northern Apennines
was made known to higher commanders about 1 April. The mountain division was to
spearhead the main Spring Offensive. The enemy was to be driven out of the mountains, and the
wide valley of the Po was to be taken away from him. It was hoped that denying him the tremendous
productive and fertile valley of the Po would smash his elaborate plans for a defense in
the “Redoubt” area of the high Alps. The valley, with its immensely productive fields of wheat,
rice, corn, and grain of all kinds, could feed an army in Italy, as well as provide food for the hinterland.
The industrial cities in the north produced great quantities of war materiel. The Fifth
Army would test the vulnerability of this garden fortress. As the days went by, the big mission
was broken down into finer detail for the smaller units.
The month opened with one battalion of the 92nd Division under 87th control on the left
flank. The 1st Battalion of the 87th went to Campo Tizzoro for training on the 1st of April. The
3rd Battalion was in division reserve at Pietra Colora. Only the 2nd Battalion was on the line, and
it was under control of the 86th in the sector near Castel d’Aiano. Misfortune dogged the 1st Battalion
at Campo Tizzoro. While firing on a range on 3 April, a high-tension wire was shot down
and fell across the telephone line to the pits. Two men holding phones, Pfc. WILLIAM D. HUFF
and PRENTIS F. DAVIDSON, were electrocuted. The next day, two men were wounded by
faulty mortar ammunition.
During the two-week period before the jump-off, battalions rotated between the training
area, a reserve area, and front-line positions near Castel d’Aiano. On the 4th, the 3rd Battalion
relieved the 2nd Battalion here and the 2nd moved to Campo Tizzoro after a brief stay at Pietra
Colora. Active patrolling was continuous from the front-line companies, and both the Germans
and Americans attempted to evacuate civilians from the proposed battle areas.
Several German agents in civilian clothes were caught in the sector, and they reported widescale
use of specially trained spies. Our own OSS, too, was sending agents regularly into the
German lines. Meanwhile, the flood of evacuees coming into our lines greatly complicated the
T
Apr 1
44
problem of detecting secret operators. The Germans posted evacuation orders which, translated,
read as follows:
“Your district may become a battle area within the next weeks. In order to save your life and
your property, it is in your interest to evacuate this district up to the line Semalano di Sopramonte,
Righetti, Montetorte, and find safety north of this line. If the evacuation officer agrees
with the area selected by the evacuee, he will vouch for a safe evacuation of livestock and property
as far as the individual can supply the transportation. The area has to be evacuated by the
5th of April at 1900. Whoever shall be found in this area after that date shall be shot as a spy
without challenge. Signed: the Commandant of the German Troop at Rivoca.”
Hundreds of the evacuees, however, sought safety in the south, behind the American lines,
instead of in the north. On the 2nd, the 2nd Battalion area near Castel d’Aiano was overrun with
milling herds of cattle, pigs, goats, chickens, horses, and donkeys; and with hundreds of Italians
with their pitiful collections loaded on all manner of wagons and carts, or being carried on their
backs. For the next few days, truckload after truckload of livestock and civilians were shipped to
the rear to be handled by AMG.
On 4 April, the 10th Division Field Order No. 4 was delivered to Regiment. The field order
drew the picture into sharp focus. Leaves and passes to Rome and Florence were forgotten.
Maps showing the progress of the First and Third Armies across Germany became less important
than the 1:25,000 map of the terrain north of Mt. della Spe. After diversionary thrusts by the reconstituted
92nd Division over on the west coast, and by the Eighth Army on the east coast, the
10th Mountain Division was to jump off at 0700 on the Mediterranean Theater D-Day. The
springboard of the attack was the salient wedge gained in the March offensive, the northernmost
tip of which was Mt. della Spe. The gains of the limited offensive of March had a place in the
“big picture.”
From Mt. della Spe, the 85th and 87th were to jump off simultaneously. The 85th on the left
was to drive to the north and seize the commanding mountains directly ahead of them, and thus
secure the left flank of the Division. In the center, the 87th was to make the main drive, hitting
north of the town of Torre Iussi, and then turning sharply to the right, seizing a long series of
steep, rugged hills that stretched for five miles to the east and northeast. This terrain belt of hills
had been selected by the German for his main line of resistance.
On the right, the 86th Mountain Infantry was to follow along inside of the arc formed by the
87th’s turn to the east and mop up the German areas forward of his main line of resistance. Once
the 87th had shoved back this line to the east, with the 85th holding on the west, the 86th was to
drive into the breakthrough. The 86th action was to be like a football halfback swinging to the
right and then cutting back through the big hole opened by the tackle and held open by the
guard; then racing down field through the secondary. The 87th would be the charging tackle; the
85th would be the checking guard. The 1st Armored Division was to attack on the right (east) of
the 10th Division, moving north along Highway 64.
The difficulties of cracking the initial line cannot be over-emphasized. The first and most obvious
difficulty was the terrain. The hills were steeper than any the regiment had fought on.
Their sides were lightly wooded with chestnut trees, although in many places were bare, rocky
cliffs, outcroppings, and boulders. In places, on the gentler slopes and tops, fields were cleared
and small clusters of farm buildings were built in against the mountainsides. Between the mountains
were deep, wooded draws with precipitous sides, difficult to cross. The valleys, although
cultivated, were gouged out in a deep network of draws with small fields between them. The
location and formation of the band of hills was jumbled and without apparent geographical pattern,
so that individual hills and locations were difficult to identify.
Apr 4
45
In addition to the natural terrain obstacle, the other difficulty was loss of surprise. The German,
this time, knew what was facing him across the line. At Belvedere, the 86th had amazed
him by scaling the cliffs; the 87th and 85th confounded him by attacking in the dark. On della
Vedetta in March, the German was still taken aback by the speed and direction of the attack. But
what surprise could there be in April? The jump-off salient pointed at his center like an arrow.
He knew that the only unit that had been able to punch a hole in his lines all winter was
crammed into this foremost salient of their own making. He knew they were mountain troops.
He also, rightly or wrongly, believed them to be “hand-picked,” “elite corps,” made up of, to use
his own words, “physically superior soldiers, sports personalities, and young men from wealthy
or politically significant American families.” (From captured enemy documents describing the
10th Mountain Division.)
Therefore the usual advantage of the mountain attack, surprising an enemy when he depended
too heavily on natural obstacles, could not be realized. The enemy expected to be attacked
exactly where the attack came. Knowing that rugged terrain had not yet slowed down the
mountain troops, he built up a complete defense with elaborate fire plans covering each key high
point and draw. He prepared concentrations on the ridges that he occupied, so that if forced to
retreat, he could ring immediate fire on the attacking troops when they reached his old positions.
He manned his well-prepared positions with the crack 334th Infantry Division. On D-Day he had
moved all three of the regiments of this division onto the immediate sector in front of the 10th
Division, so that the whole German 334th Division was on the line, and the 94th Division was in
reserve. The only surprise felt by the Germans was that our attack was begun in such excellent
visibility so late in the morning. It is no wonder that both the 85th and 87th were momentarily
stopped in their tracks before some elements had crossed the line of departure.
As the plans for the great spring drive developed, the men thought of their friends who had
fallen in February and March. The military cemetery in which they lay had been completed near
Florence. On 5 April, nearly a hundred officers and enlisted men of the regiment attended a memorial
service for the dead of the 10th Division.
On 6 April the 1st Battalion had moved from Campo Tizzoro to a forward position at Tora,
east of Castel d’Aiano. The next day, the 1st and 3rd Battalions, which had been under 86th control,
were returned to 87th regimental control. Then, early on the 9th, the 3rd Battalion was relieved
by the 85th and went back to Passatore (621229) to remain in reserve. The same night, the
battalion from the 92nd Division was relieved on our left by the BEF and their sector passed from
our control.
As the days passed in increasing tenseness, the road became dustier, was oiled to cut down
the telltale dust, and then the oil was ground into dust again. Enemy agents were caught; a
Company D man was wounded by a sentry on the 7th when he didn’t answer the challenge. The
“get-away man” of a 1st Battalion patrol was lost on the 8th, but he returned safely in the morning.
Some deserters came in. The enemy was observed occasionally and fired on with artillery.
Civilians escaping to our lines supplied information on gun emplacements and minefields. Mineblowing
demonstrations were held. Attached British artillery fired several effective missions.
The 87th regimental field order was being worked on day and night. Aerial photos, terrain
sketches, and intelligence reports were studied.
On the 9th, the 2nd Battalion left Campo Tizzoro for Cargnole, their assembly area, between
the 1st Battalion at Tora and the 3rd Battalion at Passatore.
The 87th regimental field order was presented to assembled officers in a small garden plot
above Varia di Sotto on 9 April. S/Sgt. PHILIP A. ANDERSON, of the S-3 section, had reproduced,
in the freshly plowed earth of the garden, the terrain over which the opening phase of the
Apr 9
Apr 6
46
battle would be fought. Present were General DUFF, the assistant division commander, Colonel
FOWLER, regimental commander, and the battalion commanders.
The 1st Battalion was designated to lead the column of battalions, followed by the 2nd and
3rd Battalions. Company A, 701st TD Battalion, was to be attached to the 1st Battalion, and
Company A, 751st Tank Battalion, to the 2nd Battalion. The 2nd Battalion was to jump off after
the 1st Battalion had taken the initial objective, Hill 903, and push on to the northeast on the left
of the 1st Battalion. During the first phase, the 3rd Battalion would support the 1st with its heavy
weapons, and then move forward in reserve as the 1st and 2nd Battalions occupied the band of
hills, and rolled up the German main line of resistance from west to east. The 3rd was also to be
ready to assist the other battalions from a forward assembly area on Hill 903. In the second
phase, the 86th would drive through these hills to the north and northeast. The 3rd Battalion was
to follow the 86th through the “hole” and seize and mop up key terrain on their left. In this
phase, tank destroyers would be attached to the 3rd Battalion.
The field order also assigned the two platoons of Company C, 84th Chemical Battalion, in direct
support of the leading battalions. The 616th Field Artillery and 1125th Field Artillery (Armored)
Battalion had similar missions. Also in support was the Air Corps, with elements under
the control of a jeep radio team called “Rover Pete.” Company C of the 126th Engineers would
support with the principal mission of opening roads for the tanks. The order was clear and direct,
and well understood by all parties. D-Day was announced as 12 April; H-Hour was to be
0700.
On following days, flights were arranged for key officers; an engineer mine school on methods
of launching the “primacord snake” was held. The troops were cautioned against looting
prisoners for watches, money, etc.
On 10 April, administrative details were arranged with supporting units. The liaison men,
Rover Pete, reported from the Air Corps.
On 11 April, the regiment moved the CP forward to a farm building at Tora. Division sent
out a frantic inquiry about a stray mortar round that landed near the Division CP. It was arranged
with Captain LEE E. NEVILLE of the 751st Tank Battalion and Captain PATCH of the
701st Tank Destroyer Battalion, that in the first phase of the attack, one platoon of Company A,
751st, would support the 2nd Battalion. Later, the rest of the company would support the 3rd
Battalion. Company A, 701st TD Battalion, after supporting the 1st Battalion initially, was to
leave one platoon in reserve and support the 3rd Battalion. The terrain was nearly impassable for
tanks, so their employment was planned mainly for the later phase when the 3rd Battalion would
be heading north along the highway from Tolè. At 1828 word came that the attack was postponed
24 hours.
On 12 April, more details were arranged. The airplane identification panel code was sent out
to prevent strafing of friendly troops. To complicate matters, Lieutenant Colonel EMMETT L.
NATIONS, commander of the 2nd Battalion, was suffering with a bad fever, and was in danger
of being evacuated. On the 12th at 1745, a message came from Division announcing that the attack
would begin the next morning. But at 1807, another message announced that the attack was
to be postponed another 24 hours to the 14th. Shortly thereafter, Colonel NATIONS was taken to
the hospital. Major PAUL TOWNSEND assumed command of the 2nd Battalion.
Meanwhile, for the troops, the waiting had been a nerve-racking strain. The 12th had been
overcast. It wasn’t a bad day, but effective air support required perfect weather, and the forecaster’s
report on the afternoon of the 11th had not been satisfactory. The men experienced various
reactions to the delay, some impatient, some grateful for a reprieve. There was little to do
Apr 12
47
since all was in readiness, weapons clean, gear in order. The army term “sweating it out” must
have been born for some such anxious period. Those in observation posts watched the shellfire
fall on both sides. Several haystacks were fired by tracer and white phosphorus fire. Haystacks
seem to have been not only favorite German positions but also very rewarding targets.
The waiting men looked hard at each other these days as though to remember well each face.
These men knew from experience how quickly the faces of the dead dim in memory, how blurred
the image soon becomes, even though the loved name is repeated over and over. They studied
each other gravely. Some optimists still snatched at every radio news report. The attack in Germany
was moving rapidly; the Americans were reported but 76 miles from Berlin. More than a
few hoped there would be no drive in Italy. Perhaps it would end in time. It was so hopeless for
the enemy to fight on. Unfortunately, hopeless Germans made desperate fighters. The enemy
was determined to hold Italy’s Po Valley, for while it was his, there was a refuge for him in the
“Redoubt.”
Tora was a half-dozen stone farm buildings huddled together on the steep side of a narrow
valley running north and south. The command posts of the regiment and the 1st Battalion were
there. To the south waited the 2nd and 3rd Battalions. Forward a quarter of a mile at the head of
the valley on an east-west ridge was the front. From OPs on this ridge the German line could be
studied: Torre Iussi, the little town in a grove of pine trees; to the right, Hill 903, its lower slope
scarred where the road skirting it cut into rock and dirt banks of its steep sides; Hill 868; Mt.
Pigna; Rocca di Roffeno. All looked peaceful and uninhabited. Only puffs of smoke from our
leisurely artillery landing across the valley broke the incongruously peaceful-appearing country.
The regimental OP, a stone barn atop Montesinistro, though it stuck up before the German line
like a billboard, oddly enough drew no fire. Perhaps its very obviousness was its protection. At
any rate, Sgt. BENNETT BOGGESS and T/5 JOHN HAWKINSON of the I & R Platoon, twice
shelled from OPs in the March campaign, named this one “Aiming Stake OP,” with its white
walls and red roofs perched dead center on a hilltop opposite the German OPs.
Directly west, across the narrow valley, and over a sharp ridge, was the CP of the 85th, less
than a half mile away. Between the valley sides, barely hidden by the ridge at Montesinistro was
jammed the indescribably varied equipment and paraphernalia of attack: hundreds of vehicles—
track and wheel; field guns, self-propelled guns, tank guns; stacks of ammunition; crates on
crates of rations; small mountains of gas cans. The valley was covered with tentage and dumps,
and over the maze of ruts cut in the new grass, the jeeps, 6-by-6s, and heavy engineer trucks
crawled back and forth. It was a sobering sight to survey the waiting valley in broad daylight
and realize that just over the saddle ahead were the means and the will to obliterate all of this
ant-like activity in the entire valley. At night too it was alarming, and “Bedcheck Charlie,” the
German plane that came over regularly at about 2230, must have spotted some of the many
chinks of light shining from tent cracks when men entered and left CPs. However, only occasional
shells came in. No real damage was done.
All of the advance planning cannot be related in detail, but the following report is typical:
“Three days while awaiting the attack, the A & P Platoon of the 3rd Battalion kept busy bringing
ammo to the line under cover of darkness and in getting all gear ready for D-Day. During one of
these trips Lieutenant NOEL C. CLAD, platoon leader, was severely bruised when his jeep rolled
over on a narrow, treacherous road in pitch darkness. Approximately 500,000 rounds of caliber
.30 and .50 MG and 2,400 rounds of 81-mm were hauled to positions overlooking Torre Iussi, Hill
903, and Rocca di Roffeno. The battalion was issued its full basic load, and an additional basic
load was placed on a 1 1/2 - ton, a 3/4 -ton, and eight jeeps and trailers. The pioneer tools and demolitions
were separated into different-sized kits and placed on four jeeps and trailers. During the
day preceding the attack the platoon developed a mine-breaching apparatus that was very effec48
tive. It consisted of 13 strands of primacord attached to three 2.36” rockets, which were wired
together with their ignition wire spliced in series. One end of the primacord was staked down
and then, from a distance of twenty feet, the rockets were fired by a small battery. The rockets
carried the primacord out across the mined area, and then a cap placed in the near end detonated
the primacord. It proved able to clear positively a path one and one-half feet wide, and to uncover
mines for four feet in width. Twenty mules were obtained as an additional means of transport
for ammo and equipment for the platoon.”
At 0200 on 13 April, as the 87th men slept, waiting for the jump-off that would end the five
and a half year war in Europe, the sad news that shocked the world reached the area by radio.
Some soldiers were waked up, others learned in the morning that their Commander-in-Chief,
President Franklin Delano Roosevelt had died.
Friday the 13th was fair. There was some slight haze; clouds passed the sun from time to
time, but it was a beautiful, clear day. The reason for the second postponement of the night before
could possibly have been an uncertain weather prediction, but there was another factor.
Some men still hoped that the “high command” was waiting for developments in Germany.
There was an unconfirmed, and untrue, radio report that the Allies were in Berlin that day. Some
men were sure that the great offensive had been shifted from Friday the 13th in deference to the
age-old superstition that still lingered in the middle of the “enlightened” 20th century.
On the afternoon of the 13th, the hour of attack was set back an hour and a half to 0830 of the
14th. A warning came from Division that no one was to break defilade until positive word was
given that the attack was on. The 14th dawned fair and clear. At 0653, another 45-minute delay
was called, setting the time for jump-off at 0915. Finally, one last change set H-Hour at 0945. The
air preparation was to be from 0830 to 0910, and the artillery and other ground weapons were to
fire preparation from 0910 to 0935. The attack was set. “This was it!” After all these delays, the
roar of bombs, artillery, and supporting heavy machine guns was convincing proof that the big
drive was on.
FIRST DAY—14 APRIL
1st Battalion—Torre Iussi
The Air Corps preparation consisted of four Thunderbolt fighter-bombers at a time, on the
front of the Division. For forty minutes they peeled off and dove over the German positions, setting
several fires with firebombs, and doing considerable damage to buildings along the mountain
line with demolition bombs. They also characteristically dropped a bomb on the CP of the
2nd Battalion at about 0830, and another in the 85th regimental area that set their ammo dump on
fire.
The ground support was more effective. Starting promptly at 0910, all the artillery units,
from Corps down, fired for 25 minutes. The ground shook, and great billows of dust and smoke
clouded over the line of mountains to the north. Both air corps and artillery officers claimed that
nothing could live through the preparation. It was a tremendous spectacle, but ten minutes later,
as Company B, the leading rifle company, crossed the line of departure, the enemy had crawled
out of his deep holes and was waiting in the settling dust, very much alive.
The small arms support was under the control of Company D. The mortar platoon under
First Lieutenant THOMAS H. COLLINS was emplaced well behind the line of departure. With
this platoon were the attached mortars and machine guns of the 3rd Battalion, nine .50-calibers
from the 616th Field Artillery Battalion, fifteen additional water-cooled .30-calibers, and twenty
Apr 13
Apr 14
49
additional .50-calibers. The 37-mm guns from the 3rd Battalion gun platoon were also used in
support. Altogether, more than sixty machine guns were fired under the direction of Company D
that morning. The 3rd Battalion guns alone fired 500,000 rounds. One gun fired so continuously
that three barrels were burned out. Second Lieutenant DONALD W. HOFFMAN of Company H,
attached to Company M during the initial supporting fire, was wounded by shellfire.
COMPANY B—HILL 860
The morning of 14 April, Company B left its rear assembly area at 0500 and marched to the
forward assembly area on the reverse slope of Montesinistro, arriving there at 0600. After the
two days of postponement, the men were still not certain that today would be the beginning of
the offensive, until Thunderbolts came in, bombed and strafed the valley and ridges to the front.
There was then no doubt that this was the day. The company commander, Captain CLARENCE
H. SWEDBERG, called the platoon leaders and NCOs together once more and gave them the battle
plan. Very little resistance was expected the first day, with the devastating preparation of air
and artillery promised.
The company left the assembly area at 0910 hours, with two platoons forward, 1st on the
right, 2nd on the left, and 3rd in reserve. One machine gun platoon of Company D, under First
Lieutenant WILLIAM S. SPINNEY, was attached, and one light machine gun squad was attached
to each of the leading platoons. One section of short (stubby) mortars under First Lieutenant
OLAN D. PARR was also attached to Company B. The distance from the assembly area to the
line of departure was about 1,500 yards over rough terrain. Pfc. WALTER LULUE, a BAR man of
the 2nd Platoon, slipped on the steep incline, injuring his ankle so that he had to be evacuated.
Most of the time, while approaching the line of departure the men were under clear observation
of the enemy, and they began receiving small arms fire before they actually reached the line
of departure.
The 1st Platoon moved out across the LD on time with two squads abreast and one in reserve.
As they approached the first group of houses, Pfc. WALTER L. HANEY, 1st Platoon messenger,
was hit in the shoulder and foot by sniper fire. Then a thunder of fire smashed into the
men and the two leading platoons were pinned down. The Germans threw artillery, mortar, and
everything they had into the area. The 2nd Platoon tried to advance to the left, but was caught in
the fire and unable to move far. They radioed back for artillery support, but were refused. The
men were disillusioned about the effectiveness of the artillery preparation. The town of Torre
Iussi had hardly been touched, and the Germans had set up a strong point in their main line of
resistance there. With the aid of the bazooka, the 1st Platoon cleaned out the first group of
houses by 0950 and took eight prisoners. The 3rd Platoon, which was following, ran into a minefield
near the road junction at Serra Sarzana, and S/Sgt. DONALD G. HAIGHT was killed. They
selected a new route and caught up with the rest of the company.
The mission of the 1st Platoon was to clear out Torre Iussi only a few yards down the road.
They went up the reverse slope of Hill 860 to the left to start the assault from above the town.
Here they took five prisoners at 1000. All types of fire hit them, coming from the town and from
the narrow valley to the north. S/Sgt. WAYNE C. CLARK and S/Sgt. HARRY M. SHEVCHIK
were killed as they moved down to the town and Pfc. GERALD E. MULVANEY, Pfc. HENRY M.
LEMMENES, Pfc. LEON BURROWS, and Pfc. JOHN M. GABRI were all wounded by machine
gun fire. The rest of the 1st Platoon doggedly moved into the town and flushed out fifteen prisoners.
S/Sgt. JACOB R. NUNNEMACHER, who spoke German, asked the prisoners if there
were any more Germans in the nearest house. The Krauts said “No.” He started into the building,
and was immediately shot and killed by a sniper.
50
While the 1st Platoon was attempting to clean out Torre Iussi, the 2nd Platoon was flanking
enemy emplacements to the left on Hill 860. Upon reaching the top of this hill, First Lieutenant
HAROLD E. GARFINKEL, Pfc. WAYNE E. HERMON and Pfc. PAUL F. SCHILLER were all
killed by machine gun fire. S/Sgt. BETTA FOTAS took a squad of men to wipe this out, but he
and Pfc. FRANCISCO L. SANTIESTEBAN were killed and Pfc. ASCENCION L. SIMENTAL and
Pfc. JOHN B. MEYERS were wounded. T/Sgt. OSCAR L. CLEMENT assumed command of the
2nd Platoon.
The 3rd Platoon, in reserve, moved to the reverse slope of Hill 860 and dug in waiting. First
Sergeant WALTER R. HARD, JR. had been wounded by artillery, and T/Sgt. ERNEST W. DAVIDSON
took over his duties. In the attached machine gun platoon from Company D, Pfc.
EARNEST B. STOLLER was hit by a sniper on the road, and Pfc. BURLEY F. YOUNG, JR., and
Pvt. HAYDEN CLAYCOMB were wounded by mortar fire.
The fifteen remaining men in the 1st Platoon were still trying to clean out Torre Iussi. About
1130, they discovered that they were trapped by machine gun fire inside the enemy main line of
resistance, and were unable to move forward or withdraw. Communication was out, and a runner,
Pfc. LEWIS A. HOELCHER, volunteered to take a message back to the company. Finally,
withdrawing one man at a time, the 1st Platoon got back to the reverse slope of Hill 860 and dug
in. Second Lieutenant GILBERT G. HOUSLEY called for 81-mm fire on the buildings but was
unable to locate the Company D mortars. Then, finding the forward observer with the company,
he learned that the radio was out. A runner was sent back, and 4.2s partially leveled the town.
Sgt. THOMAS A FOLEY was wounded by shrapnel from mortar fire and while being evacuated
was killed when a mortar round scored a direct hit on his litter. The squad of light machine guns
had tried to give the 1st Platoon covering fire while it was assaulting from Hill 860, but were
forced to the reverse slope by shelling which killed Sgt. MARVIN G. HALE and Pfc. JOHN M.
WILBUR. Second Lieutenant RAY WILSON, weapons platoon leader, was hit by enemy sniper
fire and evacuated. S/Sgt. LLOYD P. WICK took command of the weapons platoon. During the
action T/5 ALBERT MANCHIO was killed and the following men wounded: T/Sgt.
WOODROW SLONE, T/4 HAMILTON J. ALLEN, Pfc. RODERICK W. BOYLES, Pfc. ROY C.
COBB, Pfc. LOYAL F. COLOSKY, Pfc. EMMETT H. DUNKIN, Pfc. NEWT L. DURHAM, Pfc.
CHARLES HANSON, Pfc. HELMAR J. HUNT, Pfc. JOHN C. KNEER, Pfc. ADOLPH REINHARDT,
Pfc. MELVIN H. WISEMAN, and Pvt. CLELL DOYLE.
It was a tense morning for the regiment. The two previous offensives, with their initial surprises,
had started off with great speed and the first objectives taken ahead of schedule. This time
the enemy had expected the attack. He was ready, deep in the ground safe from our artillery,
and he was ready behind sandbags and stone for our riflemen. By noon, scores of casualties had
gone through the 1st Battalion aid station, and the little town of Torre Iussi still held out athwart
the regiment’s route to its initial objective, Hill 903. From the thick stone-walled buildings in the
pines, bullets spit all over the valley, not only holding off Company B, but searching the approach
trails and pinning down the rest of the battalion and firing into the flank of the 86th on the
right of the 87th. Not only in Company B had casualties been heavy, but also the long column
approaching the line of departure had been pounded as the men inched forward on the exposed
slopes. Even back over the Montesinistro ridge at the head of the narrow valley, where the heavy
weapons had pulled back on the lifting of their supporting fire, shellfire caused casualties.
Back in the regimental CP, Lieutenant Colonel SCHMELZER and Captain ARTHUR
BRODEUR were poring over the S-3 operations map, coloring with a red or yellow crayon each
advance of the 1st Battalion. For more than two hours the map lay untouched while the ringing
telephones brought bad news, but little good. For a while it looked as though the attack had
failed. Company M, out of the fight after its supporting role, was eating rations and congratulat51
ing themselves on the lack of counter-battery fire. Without warning, a short concentration of
shells came in, killing S/Sgt. WALTER R. HUCKABEE, Sgt. ROBERT W. STROMBERG, and Pfc.
MARVIN D. LEDBETTER. Wounded were S/Sgt. ROLAND E. CLARK, Sgt. RAYMOND W.
HUGHES, and Pfc. JOE ADAMS, Pfc. DENZEL R. EAREHART, Pfc. LEAROYD A. HOOVER,
Pfc. JAMES R. MORECRAFT, Pfc. ARVO SUORSA and Pfc. ROLAND A WEIPERT. Sgt.
STROMBERG had just been ordered to leave the battle for Officer Candidate School, but hadn’t
been reached before he was killed. In this same area, three men from the 37-mm gun crew of the
1st Battalion were wounded: Sgt. WILLIAM F. WILSON, Pfc. OLLIS E. SIKES, and Pfc. DAVID
O. CUNNINGHAM. Also, M Company wireman, Pfc. WAYNE H. WILSON, had been wounded
by machine gun fire while in the company OP on Mt. della Spe.
The entire area, forward from the Montesinistro ridge to Torre Iussi, was littered with dead
and wounded mules, and men hit by machine gun, sniper, mortar or artillery fire, or mines. The
continual pounding and the roughness of the steep trails made the evacuation problem hazardous
and difficult. The Medical Section of the 1st Battalion lost Pfc. HOWARD MCMILLIAN, Pfc.
AREL BAJKAN, and Pfc. RUDOLPH W. HEINS, all killed by artillery fire while lying on the
ground tending a wounded man. Pfc. DOUGLAS ATON broke two ribs while bringing in a
casualty, and after taking care of the casualty, had to be evacuated himself. Pfc. GENE L.
RIGNEY was wounded on Mt. della Spe.
At 1220, Company A was ordered to pass through Company B, take Torre Iussi and seize Hill
903. Company C was to take Mt. Pigna, the original objective for Company A, and Company B
would become reserve. Actually, Company A did succeed in taking both of its objectives, Torre
Iussi and Hill 903. But an hour and a half after being ordered out, the regiment, not being well
informed of the progress being made, directed the 2nd Battalion to jump off at 1355, with two
companies abreast bypassing Torre Iussi on the east and capturing Hill 903. This attack was to be
coordinated with the 2nd Battalion of the 86th on the right, and was to be supported by two battalions
of artillery.
COMPANY A—HILL 903
Company A crossed the line of departure thirty minutes after Company B. As they climbed
down the northeastern slopes of Mt. della Spe, they were held up by the tail end of Company B
during the fight for Torre Iussi. Company A was pinned down behind Company B and both
companies stretched out in one unbroken continuous line along the wagon trail, reaching back
almost to the assembly area. Mortar and artillery fire punished the men, and snipers and a machine
gun opened up from the high ground to the left front and worked over the column. Many
of the men did not dig in, as the column was expected to keep moving, and casualties were heavy
under the terrible concentration of 105s, 120s, and mortars. At the sides of the trail, the men
found rocky ravines or draws to seek cover in, but these were wooded and tree bursts took their
toll. Pfc. MOSE CAREY, still on Mt. della Spe, was hit by artillery and later died of his wounds.
The 3rd and 2nd Platoons had led the company, while the 1st and weapons platoons had been
further to the rear where the artillery barrages were heavier. They suffered the most casualties.
As the attached 1st machine gun platoon of Company D moved out with Company A, they
suffered casualties. The platoon, under First Lieutenant ANTSELM BRADLEY, came under
sniper fire from the front when they crossed the road below Mt. della Spe. They moved off of the
road just as artillery fire crashed down on them. Pfc. EARL R. BUMGARNER and Pfc. TIMOTHY
H. DOUGLAS were wounded.
Some time after 1200, the 2nd Platoon, abreast of the 3rd on the left, moved up on Hill 860
under the artillery and machine gun fire. The 3rd Platoon moved through pinned-down Company
B, and was itself pinned down for two hours just short of the town from which elements of
52
Company B had been driven. During this advance the 1st Platoon lay in the ditch along the road
and drew fire. An 88 hit a mortar hole in which Pfc. CASPER A. BEHRING was crouching. He
was wounded, and First Lieutenant JAMES E. HAWKINS III was hit by flying shrapnel.
The “536” radios were on the same frequency as those of one of the companies of the 86th on
the right. Consequently, their use became too confusing, and a messenger, Pfc. RICHARD D.
JOHNSTON, was sent back with a message to First Sergeant GILBERT S. BATES. He was shot in
the chest, but climbed back onto his feet and continued on for three hundred yards. He delivered
the message and then fell dead at the sergeant’s feet.
T/Sgt. RAYMOND H. TIGER of the weapons platoon was injured by concussion. In the machine
gun section, S/Sgt. WALTER L. MONTGOMERY, Sgt. CECIL T. WILCOX, and Pfc. JAMES
A. CONOVER and Pfc. RALPH J. BREWER were all wounded.
Back with the company command group, executive officer First Lieutenant THEOPHILE B.
RANGER, S/Sgt. JOSEPH L. SARRI, Pfc. EDGAR J. HATCH, JR. and Pfc. JOSEPH ZANN, were
all wounded by artillery. Pfc. BASIL E. DAY was lightly wounded while serving as battalion
runner. Also Pfc. JOHN K. BRYANT was hit. In the 1st Platoon, wounded by artillery were: Pfc.
CLARENCE J. SEGREST, SR. and Pfc. JAMES E. BENFIELD. Pfc. CARL R. AMASON, of the 2nd
Platoon, was hit; and one of the world’s finest skiers, Sgt. FRIEDL PFEIFFER, was seriously
wounded. Also, Sgt. MARK E. CAUCH was hit in the leg. Pfc. OKEY C. DEAN, while applying
first aid to a wounded man, was hit and killed. When the order came for Company A to pass
through B at about 1200, Company B had completely withdrawn from the town, but some of its
elements were abreast of the town up on Hill 860. As the 3rd Platoon, Company A, entered Torre
Iussi, elements of Company F, 86th Infantry, came abreast of them on the right, and went through
the east section of town where most of the resistance seemed to be coming from. They cleaned
out five machine gunners just beyond the town, killing two and capturing three. Then the 3rd
Squad of the 3rd Platoon passed through the town and moved into a draw beyond to establish a
base of fire so that the rest of the platoon could cross the valley to Hill 903. The artillery laid in
on them and nine of the twelve became casualties as they gave covering fire. Pfc. JESUS M. SALAZAR
was killed. S/Sgt. JAMES D. GRAVELLE, Pfc. HENRY A. GREEN, Pfc. WILLIAM C.
ALBRIGHT, Pfc. JOHN C. GUINN, Pfc. ALLEN E. LUGINBILL, Pfc. NORMAN G. OLIVER, Pfc.
ARTHUR V. RECTOR, and Pfc. PAUL E. WANTULOK were wounded.
T/Sgt. WILLIAM H. WEBB, JR., platoon sergeant of the 2nd Platoon, stood out in the open,
guiding his men through the minefields that had to be crossed in the draw beyond Torre Iussi.
He was killed by artillery, as was Sgt. LLOYD A GORMAN. Pfc. WILLIAM B. ADDY was
wounded. A little farther on, two more men, Pfc. GRADY L. BREWER and Pfc. JOHN A.
ANASTASI, were wounded. The 3rd Platoon captured two more prisoners in the draw. Altogether
14 prisoners were captured in Torre Iussi out of about 35 estimated Germans in the town.
From the draw, the 3rd Platoon led up onto the left shoulder of Hill 903, receiving some machine
gun fire from the valley to the north. Pfc. WILLIAM W. GOLDSMITH was wounded by
this fire, and Pfc. EARL O. ENG was wounded by artillery. Much of this fire seemed to be coming
from the lower slopes of Hill 898, and the company mortars were set up to snipe at it. Captain
HUGH D. KLEMME of Company A and Captain JAMES C. KENNETT of Company F met in
Torre Iussi and coordinated their attack. The two companies, however, had bottlenecked in the
town, and Company F had been held up here and by a steep bank too high to climb unaided.
The 3rd Platoon climbed rapidly up the hill and reached the western crest a little ahead of Company
F coming up on its right. Having reached the crest, they swung to the left and out toward a
knob to the northwest. Pfc. MICHAEL SAWYER was wounded out here when a bullet glanced
off another man’s helmet and struck his leg. A machine gun opened up from the knob, and the
53
3rd Platoon set up a base of fire. The 1st and 2nd Platoons, moving up the hill, went to the top of
Hill 903 first and then to the left knob, passing behind the 3rd Platoon. They then flanked around
to the right of the machine gun and drove it off the hill. Having taken the knob, the company
received mortar, machine gun, and small arms fire from Hill 898 across the valley to the west.
They dug in on the knob between 1700 and 1800. Later, Company E, holding Hill 903, tied in
with them.
After Torre Iussi was taken, Company B was given the order to dig in on the reverse slope of
Hill 860. The enemy artillery concentrations were still coming in and causing casualties. When
Company A moved through and headed for Hill 903, Company B followed in a column of platoons,
2nd, 3rd, and 1st. The company was still under mortar and sniper fire. Company B arrived
on the reverse slope of Hill 903 at dusk and dug in for the night.
COMPANY C—BATTALION RESERVE
Under the command of Captain MORLAN W. NELSON, Company C crossed the line of departure
in battalion reserve. The company was held up behind Company A at the foot of Mt.
della Spe’s wooded slopes, and remained pinned down there most of the day. Both artillery and
mortar fire pounded them throughout the day, starting even before they had left the assembly
area. The occasional halting forward movements to keep contact with the company ahead forced
the men to keep looking for new cover. At one time, the 3rd Platoon, leading on the hillside, was
moving into the cover of a ravine. Some of the men had taken cover in old shell craters on a clayslide
area, when a straight line of shells burst one after the other across the craters, landing full in
one of them, killing Sgt. JOSEPH E. STREUMEYER. Behind the 3rd, the 2nd Platoon had reached
the foot of Mt. della Spe when a dud struck the side of the trail, followed by a shell that wounded
Sgt. MURRY L. LOEFFLER and Pfc. MARTIN W. LUECK, Pfc. FELIX F. CHURCH, Pfc. ALBA D.
BARTHOLOMEW, and Pfc. CLIFFORD J. ARCHER. In the weapons platoon, Pfc. JOHN T.
KELLY and S/Sgt. JOHN H. ASHCRAFT suffered almost a direct hit, the concussion of which
temporarily paralyzed one of them and shocked the other. Pfc. ROBERT W. WINBUSH, a medic
who had been running from casualty to casualty throughout the bombardment, took care of both
of these men and miraculously remained unhurt.
At about 1600, the company started to move again and got down into the cover of a ravine.
At this time, Pfc. PAUL J. BROWN, a BAR man who had insisted on trying to keep up with the
company on a badly injured foot, was unable to go further. From the ravine, the 3rd Platoon had
to move out into the open in order to watch and become familiar with the route of Company A
through the minefields in front of Torre Iussi. They were held up here on a hard, clay hillside,
unable to dig in successfully, and kept from advancing by Company A’s difficulties with the
mines. Trees overhead made the shallow holes they could dig less effective, and tree bursts
killed Pfc. CARL H. ORTWEIN and Pfc. ELMER FRISTOE, and wounded Pvt. OWEN J. RICKER.
The heavy shellfire seemed to be drawn by the mule trains moving along the trail, and many of
the animals were killed. The 3rd Platoon was spread out on this hillside area for nearly three
hours. They watched as almost miraculously the shellfire lifted just long enough for Lieutenant
Colonel ROSS J. WILSON, the battalion commander, to travel down the road past them, and then
started thundering in again right where he had been. The number of casualties gives no indication
of the severity of the shelling. Only the roughness of the terrain saved many lives. Pfc. ROY
L. HART, an assistant BAR man, had a shell land practically on top of him, but he crouched in
under the overhanging bank of a stream. When the earth settled, he was buried under a foot and
a half of dirt with only the shovel handle sticking from his pack showing his position. When
quickly dug out, he was uninjured.
54
2nd Battalion—Hill 903
COMPANY E
At 1325, when the decision was made to move the 2nd Battalion to the east of Torre Iussi and
take the initial regimental objective, Hill 903, Company E was ordered to attack on the right and
Company F on the left. Company G was to be in reserve. At that time, as far as was known, the
1st Battalion was still pinned down.
Company E, with the 1st machine gun platoon of Company H attached, was to lead off. They
had been waiting for four hours behind the line of departure and had been under artillery fire.
During the morning, Pfc. OTTO KORBAN was hit, and S/Sgt. JOHN L. WIGDAHL had been
wounded at 1130. Major PAUL A. TOWNSEND, the acting battalion commander, gave them
their orders and they jumped off just before 1400. After being temporarily held up by Company
C as they crossed the line of departure, they moved on across the valley in a column of files, with
2nd Platoon leading. Reaching the foot of Hill 903, the 3rd was echeloned to the right rear, with
the 1st following the 3rd. The valley was mined, but the company passed through the minefields
without difficulty. However, two men, Sgt. ALFRED E. MAHONEY and Pfc. EDWIN P. HADSELL,
were injured crossing the rough terrain. Machine guns were attached to the leading platoon,
and one mortar squad was with each platoon. At the very southernmost point of the road
nearing the base of Hill 903 was a cluster of buildings at Point 750. First Lieutenant RICHARD L.
CROOK led his 2nd Platoon around these buildings, and men from the weapons platoon cleared
the houses and took 24 prisoners without difficulty. Heavy shellfire fell around the buildings as
the company pushed on up the hill, and Pfc. RAYMOND R. LINDSAY and Pfc. EUGENE E.
SULLIVAN were wounded as the 2nd Platoon climbed the steep, wooded and rocky slope.
There was little resistance except for some small arms and mortar fire coming in from the left,
which wounded Pfc. LELAND A. HUFFORD. The gullies and rock outcroppings afforded good
cover against this fire. S/Sgt. THADDEUS BENEDICT was wounded by a round of friendly artillery
fire further up the hill. As they reached the top they fired at the retreating Germans withdrawing
over the hill, and wounded two of them. Twenty prisoners were taken. The company
dug in on the reverse slope, and five BARs and two machine guns were sent over the crest onto
the forward slope. The mortars were emplaced and the company took positions to cover Company
F moving up.
COMPANY F
Company F had moved up late in the morning and dug foxholes just behind the regimental
OP. At 1355 they started out for Torre Iussi behind Company E. They moved in a column of files
through artillery and sniper fire, led by the 1st Platoon and attached machine guns, followed by
the company machine guns, 2nd Platoon, mortars, 3rd Platoon, and a section of heavy machine
guns from Company H. As the company approached the road junction at Serra Sarzana, south of
Torre Iussi, the leading elements took a footpath short-cut across the fields while the company
followed along by the road. T/Sgt. JOHN C. DECKER of the weapons platoon stepped off the
trail to check on his men. A schu mine blew off his foot. He lay on the side of the trail joking with
his men about his foot as they went by, and telling them to do a good job for his sake. The road
from here on to Torre Iussi was a grim sight with men and mules scattered. Parts of mules were
everywhere. The hardest soldier was shocked by broken and dismembered bodies in his own
familiar uniform.
In the attached machine gun platoon of Company H. Pfc. CLARENCE W. LINN, JR. was
killed by artillery fire ten minutes after the platoon crossed the line of departure on Mt. della Spe.
LINN had been a jeep driver; this was his first day of line duty.
Apr 14
55
By this time Torre Iussi had been cleaned out by Company A and part of the 86th. On the
north edge of town the company reorganized and received orders to continue on to Hill 903. An
artillery shell crashed into the company, wounding Pfc. JOHN W. VALENTINE and Pfc.
PALMER E. COUILLARD. As the company moved down through the deep draws between
Torre Iussi and Hill 903, they were under intense artillery, mortar and long-range machine gun
fire. They were to move up the draw to the north and then up Hill 903 on the left of Company E.
First Lieutenant EUGENE CLAWSON, even though the two lead scouts had gone through
the marshy draw safely, probed and dug up a large number of mines and put them on the side of
the poorly defined trail. He then ordered that four men at a time should cross the exposed field
through the mines. Pfc. CLARENCE E. LOCKMAN, the messenger, while guiding four men
through, was wounded by artillery. Then Pfc. DENNIS R. HUNTLEY, the lead scout of the 2nd
Platoon, took LOCKMAN’s place and, leading a group of four, missed the trail and set off a mine,
blowing off his foot. HUNTLEY, in order to be with the company for the spring offensive, had
gone AWOL from the hospital, where he had been recovering from a wound received at C. Florio
on 20 February, and had arrived just a few days before the jump-off. HUNTLEY sat by the trail
for 26 hours, cared for by Pfc. GEORGE HIRAK. HIRAK had undertaken alone to clear the minefield
and tried vainly to get litter bearers up to where HUNTLEY was lying under small arms and
artillery fire. HIRAK finally moved HUNTLEY over to the shelter of a cliff. During his long wait,
HUNTLEY pointed out the various mines to the men coming through, and guided the troops by
voice while HIRAK taped off the area. Pvt. JAMES K. INGRAM had taken HUNTLEY’s place as
guide, and another mine destroyed his foot. When HIRAK, of the A & P Platoon, had first arrived,
he had probed and cleared the mines out of the trail, and established movement at a 20-
yard distance. It was later discovered that there were 3,000 mines in this marshy draw. The enemy
had carefully placed them in the hummocks so that a man stepping from hummock to
hummock would hit them. HUNTLEY, who had been for 26 hours under spasmodic shelling,
was found to have six mines under him when he was moved. Apparently the distribution of his
weight in the reclining position was so even that the mines were not detonated.
Company A, preceding Company F through Torre Iussi, was by this time well up the draw
and starting up Hill 903 on the left. The weapons platoon of Company F had been emplaced on
Hill 860 to fire support for the two assaulting platoons, the 1st and 2nd, as they went up Hill 903.
Captain KENNETT boosted every man in the 2nd Platoon up from his knee to his shoulder, and
then to the top of a steep bank as they came across a road. A sniper on the shoulder of Hill 903
wounded Pvt. JOHN V. IHLENFELD as the 2nd Platoon moved up. Sgt. JOHN J. LANDER, suffering
from shellshock, stayed back with Pfc. JOSEPH E. SADOWSKI who raked the ridge with
his BAR. SADOWSKI was then wounded by a sniper from the right.
The 2nd Platoon on the left climbed up the left nose of Hill 903 and into a saddle. They received
some fire from Hill 894 beyond Hill 903 as they came over the hill. Sgt. AUSTIN T. CRANOR
spotted four Krauts near the top and yelled at them in German to surrender. The Germans
waved the American over as if they wished to give up. S/Sgt. LOUIS H. BARGMANN and two
men left their cover and started over. As fire opened on them, they dropped and returned fire
with a BAR and rifle grenades. Lieutenant CLAWSON and two men flanked around the base of
the hill to head the Germans off, but they escaped.
On the other side of the hill, Pfc. WILLARD WILLIAMS and Pfc. MILTON JOHNSON approached
the top of the hill on the right, in front of the 1st Platoon, and broke over the crest at an
enemy artillery OP, taking the occupants completely by surprise. One Kraut reached for a rifle,
but WILLIAMS loaded him up with BAR slugs. The other two, after a glance at their dead comrade,
threw their hands into the air. In the OP was an artillery radio and firing data chart, which
was sent back. Many of the barrage areas were thereby known and avoided.
56
On top of the hill the company reorganized on the forward slope, actually on the knob to the
northeast marked 894. Here they awaited further orders and, at 1800, made contact with Company
B, which had followed A up on the left. Company E made contact, too, from the right. As
they organized defensively, the 3rd Platoon passed through onto the forward slope and received
machine gun fire out there from the valley near Tabole. The area was well dug up with unoccupied
German dugouts complete with abandoned weapons.
General DUFF appeared on the hill to confer with the acting battalion commander, Major
TOWNSEND, and the company was ordered to take Hill 868 before dark.
COMPANY G—BATTALION RESERVE
Company G was in battalion reserve at the outset. The 1st Platoon under Second Lieutenant
STANLEY JAZWINSKI was detached from the company to form a tank combat team riding tanks
of the 751st. Shortly after 1330 the company left foxholes behind the LD and followed the leading
elements of the battalion across the shell-torn valley to Hill 903. Artillery fire came in on them,
but there were no casualties.
COMPANY H—MORTAR PLATOON
The 3rd, or Mortar, Platoon of Company H, in reserve with Company G, moved up in the
morning to supporting positions at approximately 1000. The 1st and 2nd Sections emplaced at
Calvana southeast of Torre Iussi. There during the day they were frequently pinned down by
heavy enemy shellfire.
The 3rd Section remained in a draw to the right of Mt. della Spe from where they fired several
missions. Just forward of Mt. della Spe near the cluster of buildings called Serra Sarzana,
S/Sgt. ORTON TALBOT was hit and wounded by artillery. Second Lieutenant HAROLD V.
STOUT and Pfc. LOUIS W. PETR moved forward with Company F as forward observers. After
nightfall, the 3rd Section displaced forward on the southern slope of Hill 903.
2nd Battalion—Hill 868
During the afternoon, information of the enemy was pieced together by the IPW team under
S/Sgt. LEO A. HANDEL. It was learned that the 755th Regiment of the 334th Infantry Division
was opposing the 87th Infantry. This meant that all three regiments of the enemy division had
been thrown into the line. There was now no reserve regiment of the 334th Division, and obviously
this situation was based on a desperate confidence of the German command, not only that
the Allied thrust would come where it did, and when it did, but also that the German position
was strong enough, and their troops good enough to stop the 87th in its tracks.
The enemy that were met on the first day were good. They were young, many of them fanatical.
Not many were captured; many more were killed. Many stayed in bypassed positions
and fired into our flanks and rear. Eighteen machine gunners on the steep slopes of Hill 898 just
north of Torre Iussi fired all day on April 14th and 15th into our passing reserve battalion, service
elements, and artillery battalion, even though the 85th occupied the very hill they were concealed
on. They finally had to be rooted out man by man. During the afternoon, the IPW team was able
to plot mortar and gun positions, CPs, minefields, and profitable artillery targets. They also
learned that the 90th Panzer Division was in German reserve.
At 1730, Major TOWNSEND acknowledged an order for the 2nd Battalion to take Mt. Pigna
upon the securing of Hill 903, which was reported taken ten minutes earlier. Actually, Company
A had passed over the main summit of Hill 903 on its way out to the northwestern knob just
ahead of Companies E and F, but the 2nd Battalion found the eastern high ground still held by
the enemy, and they completed the capture.
Apr 14
57
Between Hill 903 and Mt. Pigna was Hill 868, which the 86th reportedly took at 1620. Companies
F and G jumped off for 868 just after 1900.
COMPANY G—STRADA
At 1913 the company was committed to attack the village of Strada and the south side of Hill
868. They moved down the eastern slope of Hill 903 with the 2nd Platoon on the right and the
3rd Platoon on the left. The weapons platoon and attached heavies under Lieutenant EDWIN H.
RICHARDSON were to support the action from a finger of high ground to the southeast of Hill
903. The mortars were set up on the reverse slope of this finger with observation on the crest.
The mortar squad noticed three German dugouts 75 yards up the draw from their position,
and moving up to investigate, flushed out a dozen Germans. The company commander, Captain
RALPH ALLEN, JR., as his company moved into the attack, established an OP about 200 yards
from the town. A sniper opened up, the first shot hitting Captain ALLEN in the shoulder. At the
same time the 3rd Platoon, two squads abreast, hurrying to try to take the town before dark, were
fired on. Pfc. FREDERICK D. WEIDER and Pvt. ROY J. WALLACE were wounded before the
platoon realized it was under fire. The men scrambled for shell holes and a nearby hedge. Some
of the fire seemed to be coming from Strada, and some from German positions in the rear already
bypassed by Company F on the left. Four of the men were behind a hedge not fifteen yards
across the road from the nearest building. They were firing on other buildings in the town when
German hand grenades thrown from the house near them drove them off. Instead of running
back, they rushed to the cover of the buildings. With their own grenades they drove three prisoners
out of the building. These prisoners were questioned as to the location of mines and booby
traps in the town, but they either couldn’t or wouldn’t give any information. As the rest of the
platoon rushed up, a German lieutenant fled back over a hill leaving his men to surrender from
dugouts surrounding the town. A total of 18 prisoners were taken. All buildings were flushed
out. The company reassembled at Strada under command of the wounded captain.
Meanwhile, Company F had been moving up the long, narrow ridge of Hill 868 north of
Strada. They had run into difficulty and Captain KENNETT came down to urge Company G to
move up on his right. However, the ridge was too narrow to put both companies abreast. Company
G echeloned to the right, and Company F was able to move on and take Hill 868. During
this action, Company F had been crowded over to the right (east) side of the sharp knife-edge
ridge by heavy fire from the valley to their left. This shoved them over onto G’s portion of the
hill and Battalion ordered Company G back. As Company G followed F up the hill, S/Sgt. ROBERT
C. CLUKAY was shot and wounded. CLUKAY, guide of the 3rd Platoon, had caught sight
of two Germans coming out of a bypassed dugout. With two other men he went over to take
these prisoners and check the dugout. As he moved up, the Germans still hiding in the dugout
opened fire and wounded him. All three Germans were dispatched by CLUKAY. This was the
third wound for Sgt. CLUKAY in two months. Company G reorganized after dark on the hill,
tying in with F on the left, and making contact with the 86th on the right. Captain ALLEN was
evacuated at 2200, and First Lieutenant OSCAR E. DUTTWEILER took over the command of the
company. Throughout the night and until after daylight the next morning, the company was under
intense shellfire. Most of this fire was landing on Company F on the left. No one was hurt in
Company G.
COMPANY F—TABOLE
Company F jumped off abreast of G on the right. Machine gun and mortar fire was coming
in on Hill 894, a knob on the northeast end of 903. It was coming from the valley to the east as the
1st Platoon moved out on the left and the 3rd on the right. The weapons platoon, as well as First
Lieutenant DAVID M. SNYDER’s heavy machine gun platoon from Company H, set up on 894 to
58
support the attack across the valley. The platoons moved down south of Tabole, part of the company
passing through the town of Strada. The group of buildings called Strada, which Company
G had already cleaned out, was passed through without resistance, and the company, now south
of their objective, turned left (to the north) and started up the razorback southern arm of Hill 868.
By this time the 2nd Platoon which had been following, but which had stayed on higher ground,
and had not swung so far south, had reached the hill abreast of the other two platoons and to
their left. Therefore the 2nd Platoon, and part of the 1st, was on the left of the razorback ridge
while the rest of the company was on the right.
The route of the 2nd Platoon, while direct, had crossed a very steep ravine that had injured
Pfc. JOSEPH I. MACTAVISH and Pvt. LEONARD P. GOLDAPSKE. They wouldn’t go back until
the hill was taken, however, and were with their platoon on the sharp, steep ridge. At this point
machine guns opened up from the valley they had just crossed from a point immediately north of
Tabole. The 2nd Platoon out on the exposed left face of the ridge was helpless. Pfc. GEORGE J.
LAWRENCE was killed, and the platoon leader, First Lieutenant EUGENE H. CLAWSON, was
wounded. Also Pfc. HERSCHELL D. KIMBRELL of the 1st Platoon fell, seriously wounded, on
the exposed ridge. KIMBRELL was in a very bad spot, and Second Lieutenant FRED R. FRICK
unquestionably saved his life by leaving his covered position, going over onto the exposed side of
the ridge and carrying KIMBRELL back. It was here that First Lieutenant DONALD DWYER was
fingered by fate as a bullet neatly slotted his lieutenant’s bar, leaving it for him to wear. So thick
was the air with bullets on the left that one of the men reaching up to twist off a stubborn branch
interfering with his field of fire had the branch sliced off cleanly in his hand by a passing slug.
Lieutenant CLAWSON, six feet four, weighing 240 pounds, couldn’t be evacuated until 12 prisoners
were sent to carry him down after the hill was taken.
At the same time on the right, the 3rd Platoon received some fire from its right in the area
that Company G was expected to be moving into. No one was hit, but the company held up
while Captain KENNETT chased down to G, who had taken some prisoners at Strada, and got
them moving. Company G, as mentioned, had just lost its captain. Company F, from their advanced
position on the flank, assisted G to move up by delivering fire from BARs, bazookas, and
antitank grenades against burning buildings holding them up from over on Mt. Pigna. Then
Company F continued on up the hill under some sniper and machine gun fire from both sides.
Company G was held back, by Battalion order, on the lower slopes near Strada, the hill being too
narrow for both companies to go up abreast. As they reached the top of Hill 868, an enemy
popped up out of a dugout, and Lieutenant FRICK shot and wounded him. S/Sgt. PAUL
STETTNER was brought up to question the prisoner and he disclosed that there were many others
over on the forward slope. STETTNER hollered over for them to come out with their hands
up. In answer he got a grenade thrown at him. He yelled to them again and fifteen of them came
out. At dark, Sgt. ROBERT ARKLANDER and two men reconnoitering positions passed over
some dugouts. A head popped out and the sergeant opened fire, bringing out a whole stream of
Krauts. Altogether, 35 prisoners were rounded up on the hill that evening.
Since they were under machine gun fire, especially from the northwest, as they organized defensive
positions, they dug in on the reverse southeastern slope facing the unknown country to
the east. However, some fire came from both directions. They were joined in the evening by the
weapons platoon. The soil on the hill was so rocky that digging was difficult. Many of the men
had to start several holes before they found a spot free enough of boulders to get down deep.
At 0200 of the 15th, a terrible concentration of artillery fire started falling on the company positions.
With short lulls the shells smashed the area throughout the remaining hours of darkness,
and until 0800 when it wound up with a 45-minute steady concentration. The fire came from the
east—heavy stuff mixed with high velocity 88 fire. Friendly artillery added to the terror of the
59
morning. Because of the rocks, some foxholes were hallow, but so thick was the pattern of fire
that most of the deaths were from direct hits killing two or three men in a hole. Killed were: Pfc.
ALFRED A. GARNEAU, Pfc. CECIL D. LARGENT, Pfc. ANDREW F. SIMPSON, Pfc. LEWIS M.
THOMAS, and Pfc. SIDNEY B. UTTER. Wounded were: S/Sgt. QUINCY W. GINTER and
S/Sgt. MARSHALL MORRIS, Sgt. BOYCE E. WILLIAMS, Pfc. JAMES M. BUTTON, Pfc. WILLIAM
L. TAYLOR, Pfc. LESLIE L. MUNCTION, Pfc. JAMES H. SORAGHAN, Pfc. GEORGE L.
PRICE, JR., Pfc. ARNOLD J. BURCH, JR., Pfc. WILSON G. MACDONALD, Pvt. GEORGE KISSEL,
Pvt. NEVIN P. KENDRICK, and Pvt. EARL B. KLINE. Sgt. WILLIAMS and Sgt. MACDONALD
refused evacuation until two days later when their wounds had become infected.
T/5 LAURENCE ADAMS and Pfc. GEORGE WARDNER exposed themselves time and
again running through the barrage to administer aid to the wounded. Captain KENNETT ran
back and forth all night long checking his men, finding the wounded, and encouraging the rest.
It was miraculous that he was not hit. He carried one man with both legs broken to the shelter of
his own foxhole, and remained outside thereafter. The extraordinary concern shown by Captain
KENNETT for his men, and literally complete disregard for his own comfort or danger, created in
the men of Company F something akin to a religious devotion toward their leader. It was a tangible
factor in all of Company F’s activities. The men constantly brought him food and urged
him to eat; he seldom thought of it himself. They vainly tried to keep him behind the scouts in
attacks and under cover during barrages. As the campaign went on, they became less concerned,
as it appeared that some force greater than they protected him.
From the top of Hill 903, after dark, the 2nd Platoon of Company H supported Company F in
its attack on Hill 868. Then the 2nd Section remained on Hill 903 for the night, while the 1st Section
displaced and dug in on Hill 868. Sgt. RUSSELL F. FICKETT and Pfc. ARTHUR LUCERO
were both wounded on Hill 903. At dawn with artillery still coming in, Sgt., WILBUR E.
SODERBERG was hit in the hand by an artillery fragment while cutting trees for a roof to his
foxhole.
COMPANY E—TABOLE
When the battalion moved out with Company F on the left and Company G on the right, E
followed G traversing down the southeastern nose of Hill 903. They swung left (north) and came
in on the town of Tabole from the right (south), passing behind Company F. They dug in around
the little village through which part of F had passed ahead of them. Company F moved on to the
east and was working its way up Hill 868 while G was behind in the vicinity of Strada. As darkness
settled, the 2nd Battalion was ordered to hold up in their present positions and not to continue
on to Mt. Pigna until morning. During the night heavy shellfire passed overhead, mostly
landing on Company F. Company E had no casualties, but “sweated it out” all night long.
1st Battalion—Night on Hill 903
COMPANIES A AND B
Back on Hill 903 Company A “buttoned up” for the night. The company organized a reverseslope
defense where the enemy artillery, which was reaching for them, couldn’t hit. Mortar fire,
however, landed in the area. After receiving the order to hold that position all night, Battalion
had ordered Company B to move up to fill in the gap between A and E.
Company A had established outposts on the forward slopes. These were manned by twohour
shifts. At about 0300, three Germans crawled up the slope. They challenged squad leader
Sgt. HOWARD H. BREITMEYER of the 2nd Platoon, as he crossed back over the ridge after
checking the outposts. They fired at him with a burp gun. The bullet passed through his belt
without wounding him. He lay on the ground listening to a commotion down below in the dark,
Apr 14
60
trying to make out what was going on. The Germans had reached a forward foxhole and
dragged Pfc. ROY F. BREITENBACH out of the hole. The other soldier in the same hole, helpless
to aid his companion, pretended to be asleep and wasn’t noticed. Then as Sgt. BREITMEYER
made out the shadowy figures retreating down the hill, he fired and shot one of the Nazis, an SS
sergeant major. The other Nazis then shot BREITENBACH in the stomach and fled. S/Sgt.
BERTRAM A. BIDWELL went down and pulled the badly wounded BREITENBACH up over the
ridge to safety, but he soon died of his wounds. From the body of the German sergeant major the
men picked up the German password for the next three days.
At about dark, a machine gun section under section leader Pfc. AMOS P. CROSS was hit on
the trail between the knob and Hill 903. CROSS was wounded and Pfc. ANTHONY L. SKOMP
was killed. At this same time, acting squad leader Sgt. FRED T. CLARE of the 1st Platoon and
S/Sgt. ROY E. LAWSON of the 3rd Platoon were wounded. Another machine gunner, Pfc.
HENRY A. GREEN, was also wounded. Brigadier General ROBINSON E. DUFF, arriving on the
hill, assisted dressing the machine gunner’s wound at the company aid station. He said, “Hell,
there are no medics for forty miles.”
At dawn, 15 April, Pfc. JAMES A. ALDAHL, who had spent most of the night evacuating
wounded, was killed by a shell that hit the crest of the hill. Pfc. JACOB H. BEAL and KENNETH
L. GRANT were wounded with him. The men suffered that night because of the lack of water,
and had little to eat. Many of the mules of the Italian Alpini Pack units were killed as they went
forward with supplies. All through the night enemy mortar rounds came in, but casualties were
light. The plan was to jump off at 0700 the next morning, and the battle plan was given. The men
had little sleep.
COMPANY C—HILL 860
As darkness neared, the 3rd Platoon weapons, and 2nd Platoon of Company C moved up
onto the eastern slope of Hill 860 overlooking Torre Iussi to dig in for the night. Before the jumpoff
that morning the 1st Platoon had been separated from the company and had moved down
with the tanks. The tanks had difficulty with the terrain and drew AP fire as soon as they crossed
over the ridge, driving off the men of the platoon and leaving the tanks in the rough terrain unable
to move either way. Fortunately, the AP fire drawn by the tanks was less dangerous than
the fragmentation the rest of the area was catching, and the 1st Platoon escaped lightly.
However, up on Hill 860 the situation was grim. S/Sgt. MARION F. LAY and Pfc. JOHN B.
KEELEY, JR. went down to a house on the edge of Torre Iussi at the bottom of the hill to get some
boards to cover their foxholes. An almost direct hit killed LAY and wounded KEELEY. The
company, minus the 1st Platoon, was shelled all night in their dugouts on the reverse slope of
Hill 860, the weapons platoon down below. One squad of the 3rd Platoon under S/Sgt. WILBUR
MORROW was detailed to help the engineers. They spent all night walking and looking for the
engineers and never did find them. Meanwhile, artillery shells, including some white phosphorus,
landed on the hill all night. Sgt. JACK PEHR was killed as he came out of his foxhole. Also a
headquarters lineman, Pfc. RUDOLPH B. WIEBOLDT, was wounded. During the night Lieutenant
DONALD FOX came with a patrol from Company A, trying without success to make contact
with the 85th on the left. The shelling continued throughout the night. Pfc. PAUL L. THYGESEN
and Pfc. GROVER R. MANTOOTH had both been casualties during the day.
COMPANY D
Late in the afternoon the mortars of Company D started to displace to Hill 903, and the battalion
OP group established themselves on Hill 860. Here at about 1830, a mortar round killed Second
Lieutenant WILLIAM B. BLOCKER, JR., the company forward observer. The mortar platoon
61
spent the night on Hill 903 while the two machine gun platoons remained with the companies to
which they had been attached.
Situation at the End of the First Day
By nightfall, the 85th Infantry had “buttoned up” on Hills 909, 913, and 898. The 1st Armored
Division had started its attack on Highway 64 late in the afternoon at 1700, and some elements
were in Vergato and had gone as far as the railway station. The BEF had jumped off on the
left, too, and had taken Montese, the pinnacle town that the 88th had looked at from “Shrapnel
Junction” during March.
During the night four air targets were fired. Five planes attacked each target by flares.
The enemy password key for the rest of the month, the enemy radio net sketch, radio frequencies
and call signs, were all captured and sent to G-2 before midnight. Also, overlays were
distributed to battalions of the enemy’s mortar and artillery barrage and concentration areas
taken from captured maps.
SECOND DAY—15 APRIL
At 2055 of 14 April, General HAYS, commanding the Division, ordered the regiment to renew
the attack in the morning at 0700 in a coordinated attack with the 85th Mountain Infantry on
the left. The 1st Battalion was to jump off to the northeast at the same time the 2nd Battalion was
to begin the attack on Mt. Pigna. The attack of both battalions was to be preceded by a 20-minute
artillery preparation. Rover Pete was ordered to “plaster” Mt. Pigna before 0700. The 3rd Battalion
was to move forward to an assembly area on the south slopes of Hill 903.
2nd Battalion—Mt. Pigna
COMPANY E
Company E jumped off at 0700 leading the battalion to take Mt. Pigna to the northeast.
Company F, on Hill 868, was to hold south of Pigna for a time and support this attack of Company
E. T/5 ALAN HUNTLEY, a radio operator, was killed, and S/Sgt. GEORGE MARCH of
the battalion S-2 section, was wounded by an artillery shell on top of Hill 868. The attached
heavy machine guns from Company H prepared supporting fire from around Tabole. Two light
machine guns were attached to the leading 3rd Platoon and one to the 1st Platoon which followed
right behind them. The mortar squads were attached one to each platoon. As they moved
north up the valley toward Santa Lucia, they ran into Company B southeast of the town. Company
F held up while E started up Mt. Pigna from the southwest.
The 1st Platoon moved over to the left, coming abreast of the 3rd Platoon as they climbed up
the wooded, rocky slopes. They received some machine gun fire from Hill 840 lying southeast of
Pigna. Also, snipers fired from Pigna itself. When the 3rd Platoon was just short of the crest, artillery
and mortar fire hit them with a terrific barrage. The men were caught out in the open as
the accurate barrage came down on the hillcrest just as they swarmed over it. Killed were:
S/Sgt. THOMAS O’NEIL, Pfc. HECTOR W. BRUNEAU, acing mortar sergeant, Pfc. FREDDIE
DICKENS, Pfc. CHARLES G. STICE, and Pfc. ROBERT A BERGENDORFF. Wounded were:
First Lieutenant GEORGE J. FOX, S/Sgt. LESTER L. HAMILTON, Sgt. KENNETH E. JOHNSON,
Pfc. HARRY R. GILMORE, JR., Pfc. WILLIAM W. SHIEW, Pfc. EDWARD C. OGDEN, Pfc. RAYMOND
D. HUCKLEBERRY, Pvt. BILLEY W. HARMON, Pvt. ARTHUR J. HOLLAND, Pvt. WILLIAM
J. WOLFE, Pvt. ROBERT O. THOMAS, and T/5 VINCENT B. DOWD of the Medics. Pfc.
JOHN A. KASABUSKI was killed by a hand grenade at this same time. As the barrage tapered
Apr 15
62
off to spasmodic firing, fifteen Germans surrendered from positions on top of the hill, and several
others fled down the reverse slope. The company dug in and reorganized atop Mt. Pigna.
The battalion attack was to move on to the southeast to Hill 840, while E remained on Mt.
Pigna to support the advance of Company F with machine gun and rifle fire.
COMPANY F
At 0900 on 15 April, Company F was ordered to attack the southeast side of Mt. Pigna. This
was a smaller peak known as 840. Company E was to attack Pigna on the left, and the attacks
were coordinated. The men had had no sleep, nor any water or rations since jumping off the day
before. At dawn on Hill 868, the 1st Section of H’s attached machine gun platoon was hit by
friendly artillery fire. Two artillery observers were killed and six men from the artillery were
wounded. They had all been in the same hole with their radio. Moreover, since the radio had
been destroyed, there was no way to lift the friendly fire, and the shells continued to come in for
45 minutes. Finally a British artillery observer was able to relay a message and the fire was lifted.
Pfc. DELNOE LE FEVERS of Company H was hit twice by this fire while traveling back to Hill
903 for water. Lieutenant DAVID M. SNYDER had a very narrow escape. He left his foxhole,
and immediately afterward, while it was occupied by Company F men, a direct hit blew up the
foxhole. One of the machine guns was hit by this artillery fire.
As Company F attacked Hill 840 south of Mt. Pigna, the heavy machine gun platoon supported
the attack from Hill 868. Company F took off with the 3rd Platoon leading, then the 2nd,
and the 1st. The weapons platoon and heavy machine gun section remained on 868 and laid
down a curtain of fire on Mt. Pigna and Hill 840 for both attacking companies.
The 3rd Squad of the 3rd Platoon led the company down off Hill 868 and turned left on the
road toward Mt. Pigna. They soon started receiving sniper fire. Then the entire platoon, except
the leading squad, was pinned down by machine gun fire. First Lieutenant FLOYD E. ALEXANDER,
the platoon leader, was hit here but he refused to be evacuated. The 3rd Squad went on
through the sniper fire, becoming separated from the company. They started up Pigna, hit a trail
and turned to the right to work up the draw between Pigna and Hill 840. Here they came to a
bunker and cleared it out, and sent a prisoner to the rear accompanied by one man with a
sprained ankle. Starting about halfway up 840 they ran into more sniper fire. Just as Pfc. FRANK
S. KOVAR got up to see where the sniper was, another shot cracked from the sniper. KOVAR
yelled, “I see him! Let’s go! He’s right up on the hill!” He pointed and fell over dead. Pfc.
DONALD M. MCCOY, JR. was also shot dead. The five men left in the squad were reorganized
by squad leader Sgt. STANLEY LESZKO. One of the men, Pfc. BEN F. GUNNELL, had been injured
coming down off of 868, but had kept up. One platoon of the 86th appeared on the knob to
their right, and with this encouragement, they pushed further up the hill, Sgt. JOHN H. EASTMAN,
JR. getting a sniper wound on the way. Then they waited for the 86th, but the men of the
86th were driven back and weren’t seen again. S/Sgt. LOUIS H. BARGMANN of the 2nd Platoon
made contact with the squad, and they returned to the road to rejoin their platoon. Sgt.
BARGMANN and Sgt. LEO SADIN were met by Captain KENNETT who planned the attack using
the 1st Platoon to flank around to the right.
Down on the road, Pfc. ROBERT M. KING had been wounded, but the platoons, after waiting
for Company E to catch up on their left, were ready to move out. The 2nd Platoon under S/Sgt.
LEO SADIN, was receiving heavy mortar fire, wounding Pfc. VINCENT J. MESSINA. They were
to move up the hill to the right of where Sgt. LESZKO’s squad had been, climbing the southwest
crest of Hill 840, and coordinating their attack with the 1st Platoon, flanking around further to the
right. This flanking position got the 1st Platoon into a position to make two Germans with rifle
grenades helpless and the 2nd Platoon was able to advance and take them prisoner. However,
63
Pfc. TOIVO H. LEINONEN, a scout providing flank security for the platoon, was killed by a machine
gun just as he, Sgt. HOWARD E. RUX and S/Sgt. LEO SADIN came over the brow. The
two captured Krauts were sent to get the German machine gunners down on the north slope and
bring them back. They started down the hill, their hands still in the air. The men of the platoon
yelling at them in anger as they left, and the Germans not sure what it was all about, ran faster
and faster. It looked as though they were making a break for it. Pvt. STANLEY F. JANOWICZ,
Pvt. RENE A. DI GIACOMO, and Sgt. RUX ran down to the flank to cover the pair. They ran into
a whole maze of pillboxes and trench systems on a flat, table-like area just short of the top of the
mountain. There were Germans hidden under the leaves in the trenches and in pillboxes. JANOWICZ
stumbled and fell before one of the pillboxes, and a German lieutenant reached out and
shot him with a burp gun. Fortunately, JANOWICZ wasn’t too seriously wounded. The German
was later dragged out from where he was hiding under a bed in a pillbox. Meanwhile, the two
Krauts had done their work well, and they appeared again leading fifteen or twenty prisoners
from the various strong points. Other prisoners rounded up more, and a total of 45 were collected
by the 2nd Platoon on the left alone.
Second Lieutenant FRED R. FRICK and the 1st Platoon had had no fire on the way up, and
they passed by the 2nd Platoon as they cleaned up the pillboxes on the reverse slope tableland.
They went over the top of the hill and collected a few prisoners.
Lieutenant FLOYD E. ALEXANDER’s 3rd Platoon, after some heavy initial mortar fire,
reached the top without a fight, going to the right of the 1st Platoon. They cleaned out dugouts,
dragging out Germans all the way to a draw running down to the northeast. Then while the 2nd
Platoon still rounded up prisoners on the reverse slope table, the 1st and 3rd were pinned down
by machine gun fire from Mt. Sette Croci to the northeast.
Company G cleared off Sette Croci and the company was able to move down the forward
slopes. About 60 prisoners had been taken from this one little hilly offshoot of Mt. Pigna, and all
manner of supplies and equipment were intact in the elaborate pillboxes.
COMPANY G—MT. SETTE CROCI
Company G, in reserve, moved out at approximately 1000 behind the leading elements of the
battalion and followed up the slopes of Pigna. Near the top of the hill, snipers bypassed by
Company F opened up on the right. Someone yelled, “Go after those guys. They can’t shoot all
of us.” One squad of the 2nd Platoon was selected to flank to the left of the snipers. They moved
up the slope and over. Pvt. DALLAS MCGRAW was wounded by machine gun fire.
Pfc. OLIVER R. HANCOCK took another squad with a bazooka team down a trail to the
right, and came up to within fifteen feet of the snipers who were right on the trail. From behind a
rock, HANCOCK threw a couple of grenades into some well-concealed and camouflaged dugouts.
Another squad went down into a draw further to the right and had come up behind these
dugouts. After the grenades exploded, a white flag appeared from the dugouts and five Germans
surrendered. Pvt. FRANK J. MALOZZI was wounded at this time.
Reaching the top of Mt. Pigna, the company passed through Company F towards Mt. Sette
Croci with the mission of taking this mountain. Before the company crossed the line of departure
small arms fire was dusting off the shoulder of the hill they were on, from machine gun emplacements
on Mt. Sette Croci. They pushed through this fire, crossing the line of departure at
noon, and moved down the forward slope into a draw forty or fifty feet deep. The company filed
down the precipitous sides using a narrow, difficult trail. They had been told that the draw was
mined. Only two mortar rounds interrupted their progress and they suffered no casualties.
Emerging from the draw, they came upon open fields stretching up the hillside to the top of the
64
hill, which was lightly wooded. Second Lieutenant JOSEPH H. SHEPHERD, JR. led the 2nd Platoon
up on the left, went over the nose under small arms fire, and cleaned out seven or eight emplacements
on the top. The company weapons, meanwhile, had supported this action with overhead
fire from the right side of Mt. Pigna. On the right flank, First Lieutenant JACK K.
BENNETT led the 3rd Platoon up under the supporting fire to the enemy’s left flank. Here Sgt.
HERBERT E. STECKMAN’s squad took 22 prisoners from off the top right side and forward
slope of the mountain. This action was completed rapidly and without casualty.
COMPANY H—MORTAR PLATOON
Company H’s 1st and 2nd Mortar Sections moved forward and rejoined the 3rd Section on
the southern slope of Hill 903. They dug in here and fired several missions for support. Then
around 1400, the platoon displaced forward and into a draw to the left of Mt. Pigna and just beyond
Santa Lucia. Here they dug in for the night, firing several missions, and guarding the left
flank of the regiment.
2nd Battalion—Hill 807 and Le Coste
COMPANY G
At 1400 Company G pushed north in the battalion lead for Hill 807. This was a result of a
sudden change of mission, for the battalion had previously been directed to continue in a more
easterly direction to capture Mt. Mantino. This latter mountain had just been assigned to the 86th
Mountain Infantry, so the 87th was directed to turn sharply north. Major PAUL TOWNSEND,
doing a remarkable job of leading the troops in this complicated terrain, accepted the change with
his usual calm confidence. There had not been time to make more than a map reconnaissance. It
was impossible to get observation forward. Neither could they learn any information about
friendly troops. The extended wire lines were becoming very unreliable. The country ahead was
wooded, with patches of small fields, and dissected by networks of deep erosion draws. As the
3rd Platoon led over the difficult terrain, they had to string out in single file in many places in
order to get through. Remembering the bypassed resistance they had been running into, they
carefully flushed out all dugouts and houses.
At this time the 3rd Battalion, heading east for Mt. Croce, was passing through the northbound
2nd Battalion. Company I, 3rd Battalion, advancing across in front of G, fired into a house
and then went on by it. Company G then went up and flushed out a half-dozen prisoners from
the house. Between the company and its objective, Hill 807, lay another deep draw. The company
machine guns had been left back on Pigna before crossing the first difficult draw. Therefore
Company I prepared to support Company G’s crossing, and took up positions to give this covering
fire. The fire was not needed, as the draw was crossed uneventfully. This maneuver of two
battalions crossing each other as they pressed forward in their attacks, and of one company of
one battalion pausing in its own attack to support elements of the other battalion attacking in another
direction, was one of the most unusual and complicated situations of the campaign. The
two battalions were still crossing each other at dark, and by this time dozens of prisoners were
milling around in the valley amongst them. That no one was lost is a great tribute to the control
of the organization.
Once across the draw, Lieutenant OSCAR E. DUTTWEILER and a field artillery forward observer
went forward to adjust the artillery preparation on Hill 807. By this time the company machine
guns and mortars had moved up and had taken positions to fire support with the artillery.
Company E came abreast on the right and started up Hill 807 at about 1830. Then, as Company E
reached the start of the steep pitch, Company G jumped off with the 3rd Platoon on the left and
the 2nd on the right. The supporting artillery fire was very good. Moving up the hill they took
Apr 15
65
two officers and three enlisted Germans out of the first dugout. One of the officers protested that
the American soldiers were not gentlemen for making him keep his hands up. The soldiers were
unabashed; the officer kept his hands up. Higher up the hill they fired at a hasty machine gun
position on the northeast slope of Le Coste to the left of Hill 807. One squad assaulted the position,
surrounding it with fire. A German captain hurled a hand grenade which rolled between
Pfc. RUDOLPH MARON’s legs. Pfc. JAMES LE ROSSIGNOL shot one German; the other three
surrendered. They took three more prisoners from a nearby dugout.
Directly ahead of them was the left shoulder of Hill 807. Still further to the left ran the long,
narrow ridge of Le Coste. The 1st Battalion attacked Hill 807. However, Company G could neither
hear nor see any sign of activity on Le Coste. Lieutenant SHEPHERD, on the right, went up
on Hill 807 toward machine gun fire near the top. He got pinned down by this gun with two
squads abreast and one to the rear. They fired four or five grenades of white phosphorus, and
then S/Sgt. HERBERT STECKMAN, Pfc. LOVELL O. HARRIS and Pfc. ROBERT D. MOOTZ
worked their way up, creeping and crawling, to within ten feet of the gun and opened fire again
with white phosphorus grenades. Suddenly another gun on the left flank, over on Le Coste,
opened up. It peppered them and the whole of the two leading squads. MOOTZ was fatally
wounded; HARRIS was seriously hit. Sgt. RAYMOND C. KLOCKMAN was wounded, also Pfc.
JOHN M. BENSON, and Pvt. WILLIAM V. MCKEON. The fire on the hillside was intense. Even
those who weren’t hit had their packs riddled by machine gun fire. Through this fire Pfc. RALPH
LEAVITT dashed up the hill and dragged back the wounded BENSON who was forward on an
exposed ridge. The platoon made litters from raincoats, blankets and shelter-halves, and used
the recently captured prisoners to carry the wounded to the base of the hill where they were
cared for by the weapons platoon.
While the 2nd Platoon was held up on the exposed nose of Hill 807 by fire coming from Le
Coste on their left, the 3rd Platoon under Lieutenant JACK BENNETT, tried to advance up on the
right nose of Le Coste. They hoped to clean out the machine gun firing on the 2nd Platoon. This
machine gun, being on the north reverse slope of Le Coste, was masked from their fire, but had a
clear field of fire on Hill 807. As Lieutenant BENNETT’s 3rd Platoon reached this mask, they in
turn were fired on by snipers from the German reverse (north) slope of Hill 807. When they tried
to move further to the left on Le Coste and thus over the ridge, two machine guns opened up
with enfilade fire from further west on Le Coste. They now were pinned down by this fire from
their left. Pfc. JEROME GREEN volunteered to run back through the fire to Lieutenant DUTTWEILER
to explain this situation.
It was rapidly growing dark. Battalion headquarters and Company F had moved up behind
Company G. Before GREEN got back, Lieutenant BENNETT was able to withdraw his platoon
under cover of darkness. Also at this time, the 1st Battalion was heard far down on the left slope
of Le Coste. Company F advanced into the gap between the 1st Battalion and the nose where the
3rd Platoon had been held up, and took this section of Le Coste without trouble, in the dark.
Then Company G was able to move up over the crest, with the 3rd Platoon on the right nose of Le
Coste. The open slope on the left end of Hill 807 remained an unoccupied gap between Companies
G and E. Contact was made on both sides and fifteen prisoners worked all night carrying
wounded back. Artillery fell during the night, but most of the firing was over.
COMPANY E
At about noon, after Company F men had worked their way up and had taken Hill 840 by
flanking action, Captain LE GRAND A. PENDREY of Company E walked over to 840 to meet
Major PAUL TOWNSEND for further orders. He was instructed to move off of Mt. Pigna and
follow Company G in its attack up Mt. Sette Croci to the east. The company reached the top of
66
Mt. Sette Croci without incident, and at 1600 they were ordered to lead the battalion off to the
north to Hill 807.
The company moved out, the 2nd Platoon on the right and the 3rd Platoon on the left. They
crossed through a deep difficult draw and across the valley and up the wooded slopes of 807. To
their left was one platoon of Company G. The section of Hill 807 in front of Company G was an
open slope, and while the platoons of Company E moved up through the woods to the top of the
hill without difficulty, the platoon of Company G was pinned down on the bare shoulder by machine
gun and sniper fire. Sgt. ARTHUR HARRINGTON and Sgt. JOHN DIANI, from the 1st
Platoon, moved over under the covering fire of the platoon to assist Company G. As they closed
in on a machine gun from the rear, they came under heavy fire. The two sergeants, however,
kept on going, and the German machine gunners fled up the hill with their gun. Some enemy
snipers further up the hill followed them.
Another platoon of G was pinned down to the left on Le Coste ridge. As darkness fell, Company
F moved up still further left on Le Coste allowing G to move forward again. Company E
dug in on Hill 807 for the night, but the barren shoulder to the left was unoccupied. Company G
occupied the east end of the long Le Coste ridge and the gap between Le Coste and Hill 807.
Wire was laid up to 807 during the night that somehow had direct connection with General
HAYS. The company was cut in on many Division conversations. They overheard Colonel
FOWLER order the 1st Battalion to move onto their objectives with more speed. He said, “The
2nd Battalion is carrying the ball. The 1st Battalion has not even been running interference.”
This referred to the fact that the 1st Battalion was thought to have taken all of Le Coste ridge
before the attack of the 2nd Battalion on Hill 807. Actually, while E and G fought up 807, the 1st
Battalion was fighting for the extreme left end of Le Coste, which was of no assistance to the 2nd
Battalion. Fire from Le Coste had held up Company G on 807, and then G, attempting to go up
Le Coste, had been pinned down by fire coming from Hill 807. In the absence of the 1st Battalion
on the right (eastern) half of Le Coste, Company F after dark had to move up to solve the situation.
As will soon become clear, the 1st Battalion was having difficulties of its own.
COMPANY H
The 1st Platoon of Company H, still attached to Company E, crossed over Mt. Pigna and Mt.
Sette Croci during the day through frequent shelling. From here they had moved forward to Hill
766 and delivered overhead fire in support of Company E’s attack on Hill 807. After dark they
displaced and arrived on Hill 807 at 2200. There they dug in for the night. Only a few of the men
were able to get rations, and they had no water except what some of the men in desperation had
taken from the mud holes. During the day, so great had been the desire for water that in one
place water had been drunk from streams that the mules had fouled up. The digging in, so necessary
under the constant artillery fire, at times was nearly impossible on the rocky Italian mountaintops.
Pfc. JACK M. BROWN, going back for ammunition just before dark, was hit in the leg
by shrapnel.
COMPANY F—LE COSTE
At 1700, Company F moved over onto Mt. Sette Croci, and later, at 2100, they were sent to
Hill 815 directly north to await further orders. It was a long, difficult march in the dusk for the
weary, thirsty troops, down the steep hill, through the draw on an azimuth, and up to the top
again, under some artillery and mortar fire.
On their arrival at dark, the company was ordered to take the central section of the long hill,
Le Coste. Company G had been, and still was, pinned down on the right end, and F was to pass
by G and take the hill, the 1st Battalion being on the west end. The weapons and heavy machine
67
gun section set up on 815. The fire was good and lifted on a red signal as the company took the
hill. Ten Germans gave up without resistance. The hill was organized defensively in the order of
their coming up, with the 1st on the left, 3rd on the right, and the 2nd in the middle. That night
rations and water caught up and were issued to the company.
Early in the day the battalion aid station had moved to Mo. Dozzone, southeast of Mt. Pigna.
From here they handled the large number of casualties of the day over a litter haul of three difficult
miles. Prisoners were used to carry many of the litters because of the shortage of litter bearers.
Two men of the section were wounded near the aid station: T/5 VINCENT B. DOWD and
Pfc. EDGAR F. ALLEN.
1st Battalion—Advance to Le Coste
Meanwhile, the 1st Battalion had jumped off and taken a series of small hills on the way to Le
Coste. All of these hills were very exposed on the regiment’s left flank. The attack of the 85th on
the left had not gotten far. Its right battalion was in fact still on the hills due west of Torre Iussi.
Therefore, each of the hills taken by the 1st Battalion on the second day was entirely exposed to
the commanding ground to the northwest, supposed to be taken by the 85th as well as the rolling
country to the north.
COMPANY B—HILLS 834 AND 838
Company B moved out at 0700 for Hill 834 with Company A on the left. There was little opposition,
and many prisoners were taken. However, enemy sniper fire continually harassed the
men. While halted on Hill 834, Sgt. WILLIAM J. BETTENBERG, 3rd Platoon, was killed by a
sniper bullet. Company A passed through while B waited on Hill 834. From 834 the company
moved to the next objective, Hill 838. Opposition was light, and only occasional artillery and
mortar fire was received. The 2nd Platoon cleared out Hill 838 and took many prisoners. Orders
were received to dig in and prepare to attack Le Coste. The foxholes had no more than been
completed when an artillery concentration came in, and small arms fire combed the area. Second
Lieutenant GILBERT G. HOUSLEY, leader of the 1st Platoon, was killed in his foxhole by an 88.
Pfc. JAMES C. SERAKOS, Pfc. JOHN J. TOMICH, Pfc. WILLIAM E. WELLS, and Pfc. WALTER
DILLER were all killed by 88s. S/Sgt. ALBERT N. FRANK was wounded and evacuated, Sgt.
SYLVAN D. WALDRIP taking over the 1st Platoon. Also wounded were Pfc. MAURO R. ALEMAN,
Pfc. LAWRENCE A. DE VORE, Pfc. LEONARD R. DYER, Pfc. DONALD F. ELDER, Pfc.
ROY E. FERNANDEZ, Pfc. HARRY F. GATES, Pfc. CHARLES E. HULL, Pfc. LESTER A.
MANUEL, Pfc. HERBERT B. STOUT, Pfc. JAMES E. TOOHILL, Pfc. VIRGIL H. WASHBURN,
Sgt. RALPH L. EDLUND, and S/Sgt. EARL G. SONRICKER.
COMPANY A—HILL 802
Meanwhile Company A was to take Hill 802. They followed as B took Hill 834. Machine gun
fire at this time hit them, wounding Pfc. RAYMOND J. CYCHOSZ. Hill 834 was taken in a hurry,
and then A moved up over the hill through B. Hill 802 lay directly to the north and a deep draw
separated the two hills. As they crossed down into the draw, they came to a muddy stream, the
first water they had seen since they pushed off. The men greedily drank the dirty water.
The 1st and 2nd Platoons abreast attacked up Hill 802, through machine gun and sniper fire
coming both from Vedetola to the right front, and from Hill 834 in the left rear. They took the hill
with little trouble, receiving fire on top only from a group of houses in the valley to the left rear.
Then artillery pounded the top of the hill forcing them back onto the reverse slope. Here, safe
from the artillery, they were opened up on from the rear by machine gun and sniper fire that
drilled all over the slope. Second Lieutenant OWEN W. FLIGG, JR., the D Company forward observer,
was instantly killed. Then the enemy artillery took more elevation and dropped rounds
Apr 15
68
into the trees as the machine gun fire continued to rake the hill. One tree burst killed Pfc. ERIK
H. HAMILTON and Pfc. PAUL L. KLEIN, and wounded Pfc. HERBERT B. CLARKE, JR. and
DONALD W. BAKER. T/Sgt. MASON B. FLAGG, S/Sgt. WILLIAM A. PRICE, Pfc. LOUIS F.
ANDERSON, WILLIAM C. ALBRIGHT, SALVATORE J. TOSCANO, and ALOIS J. HOELLER
were all wounded by this combination of fire.
Company B had moved on and left Hill 834 open. It was believed that had they stayed there,
this fire from the rear would have been neutralized. Actually, Company B was ordered off to
attack Hill 838, but Company C was expected to close in behind B. At 1220 Colonel FOWLER
ordered the 1st Battalion to get Company C forward closer behind A and B. Company C at this
time was back with the Battalion CP on Hill 903, where their company commander had just been
wounded. Fire from the sector of the 85th had slowed their progress through the Torre Iussi
minefields in the morning.
Captain KLEMME’s messenger, Pfc. HARRY H. DUNN, was killed by this fire on Hill 802,
and the mortar sergeant, Sgt. EUGENE C. LOUMAN, was wounded. The 3rd Squad from the 1st
Platoon was sent back to occupy and hold Hill 834 to protect the company’s rear. As they moved
back across the ravine, two men, Pfc. ALFRED R. OAKES and Pfc. WILBUR H. CORNISH, were
wounded by artillery. Reaching the top, the squad opened up on the sniper fire and silenced it.
Then Lieutenant DONALD FOX led half of his 3rd Platoon down into the valley and assaulted
the machine gunners. They were covered by company fire, and advanced directly into the face of
the machine gunners for about 500 yards. Pfc. GEORGE B. GREGORY was hit and S/Sgt. WILLIAM
A. PRICE also was wounded, but the men kept going down into the grassy valley. Assaulting
the positions, they killed six Nazis, took four prisoners, and the rest fled. This was a brilliant
maneuver.
COMPANY C—BATTALION RESERVE
Company C was to follow Company A to the northeast from their reserve position on Hill
860. They moved out, led by the 2nd Platoon, then the 3rd, and the weapons platoon. One squad
of the 3rd was designated as rear guard security, for the country to the northwest of the regimental
left boundary had not been secured. After they passed through Torre Iussi, and as elements
were picking their way through the heavily mined draw, sniper fire opened up on them at close
range. One observer, T/5 RANDOLPH C. SMITH, from the 616th Field Artillery was killed and
another wounded. A little later, First Sergeant LESTER S. ERSLAND was sniped at, the fire
throwing dirt into his eyes, blinding him and throwing him off the narrow trail through the
mines. As he stumbled off, he tripped a schu mine and fell on four others, dying instantly. The
majority of the company, by this time, was on Hill 903 occupying the old positions of Company
A. They had crossed in two separate groups which joined at this time. Their movement had
been covered with BAR fire by Pfc. JOSEH ZIMINSKY who had also covered for part of the 2nd
Battalion. Some shellfire had hit the draws during the crossing, in addition to the sniper and
mine danger, but no one was hit.
The men who still had some of yesterday’s ration left had lunch while waiting orders on the
reverse slope of Hill 903. The hillside was quiet and the men moved about in the open, and some
of the men sat by their holes. Captain MORLAN NELSON was returning with the order from the
forward slope where he had just left Colonel ROSS WILSON. Captain WILLIAM D. CAMPBELL
of the 616th Field Artillery was with him. Just as they reached their hole, a single mortar round
crashed in. Both captains were wounded, also Pfc. GERALD E. BIRDSONG and Pfc. CHARLES
MILAUSKAS. Second Lieutenant JAMES A. ANDERSON III assumed command since First Lieutenant
RICHARD C. POWERS, the executive officer, had gone back where the First Sergeant fell
to get the company records. At about 1400 the company moved out, dropping down the forward
69
slope and striking the road running up the valley. Some time around 1500 or 1600 they met the
1st Platoon, which had been with the tanks, and First Lieutenant JAMES H. PENROSE took over
the company.
COMPANY B—LE COSTE
Company B remained on Hill 838 until the order to attack Le Coste was given at 1445. Corps
artillery fired 100 delayed-action 155-mm shells on the north slope to “crater the ground,” in addition
to the regular preparation. At 1500, the company moved out, 2nd Platoon leading, 3rd and
1st following. The heavy machine guns of Company D and the 37-mm gun platoon of Headquarters
Company supported the attack. At the bottom of Hill 838, the 2nd Platoon received enemy
machine gun fire from its right front, and the platoon shifted to the right under cover of a
wooded knoll, to try to locate the enemy positions near a group of houses. The 1st and 3rd Platoons
moved up and took positions on the left of the 2nd. The 3rd Platoon moved on to Le Coste,
covered by fire from the 2nd Platoon and the light machine gun section. Pfc. WILLIAM R.
ROACH was hit by the heavy mortar fire that began to fall at that time. The mortar fire raked the
open draw to be crossed ahead, and also the company’s position at the foot of Hill 838.
S/Sgt. JAMES R. FERRIL advanced to the top of the knoll on the right, and was promptly hit
in the arm by machine gun fire. By this time the mortar fire was growing heavier, and the 1st
Platoon, followed by the command group, crossed the open field to Le Coste on the double. After
the 1st Platoon had taken positions on the objective, the 2nd Platoon moved to its left and
crossed in the same place. The 3rd Platoon had attempted to clear out the houses down the slope
to their right, and S/Sgt. EIVIND JAHR, Pfc. WILLIAM E. CULLEN, Pfc. HAROLD V. WEEDMAN,
Pvt. THEODORE WEIDEMAN, Pvt. DALE L. BERTCH, Pvt. EDWARD A. BILLOTTI, Pvt.
JAY R. BULTMAN, Pvt. LORA N. HAUGHT, Pvt. DON K. KILLOUGH, Pvt. EUGENE A. RICE,
Pvt. KENNETH S. RYMAL and Pvt. LLOYD A. HARRIS were wounded by machine gun fire.
Then Captain CLARENCE H. SWEDBERG ordered T/Sgt. OSCAR L. CLEMENT, acting platoon
leader of the 2nd Platoon, to take a volunteer group armed with automatic weapons and grenade
launchers to clean the houses out. The group returned to report that the enemy had withdrawn.
Seventeen Germans, carrying white flags, came out of a dugout at the foot of Hill 838, walked
up to our positions, and surrendered. Second Lieutenant GEORGE B. BOSWELL put them to
work as litter teams to evacuate the wounded men of the 3rd Platoon.
After the west end of Le Coste was secured, and foxholes dug on our reverse slope, the 2nd
Platoon, at about 1900, was ordered to go back to a group of German aid station buildings on the
ridge 200 yards north of 838, and set up defenses for the night, with the 37-mm gun platoon of
Headquarters Company. The rest of the company dug in on Le Coste. Holes were dug protecting
the buildings, and were manned in shifts until morning.
COMPANY A—LE COSTE
Company A was ordered to attack Le Coste in conjunction with Company B at 1500. It was
impossible to be sure which of the many hills to their front was Le Coste, so the company waited
for the 15-minute artillery barrage to open up, and with this as identification, moved forward.
The reorganized company was cut down to two rifle platoons and a weapons platoon of one machine
gun squad and two mortar squads. The 2nd Platoon established a base of fire on Le Coste,
covering the assault of the 1st Platoon. They advanced up the hill under machine gun fire from
the draw to the left, and against some sniper fire from the left and from the top of the hill. This
did not hold them up, and they gained the top of the left end. Cpl. DAVID C. HOYT, with two
other men, ran over the crest of the hill, and was shot and killed by fire from bypassed dugouts to
the rear. Sgt. GEORGE C. MCCUTCHEN, the acting 1st Platoon sergeant, led four men along the
70
ridge to the right. They ran into four enemy and captured two of them. A BAR man, LEE L.
HALL, when artillery started to hit the hill, jumped up to move into a safer position. A shell hit
and killed him. Pfc. MELVILLE W. BORDERS, JR., firing with his M-1 at a Kraut one hundred
yards away in the bushes, was struck and wounded by a rifle grenade. The same grenade
wounded Sgt. FLOYD P. BUTLER. Pfc. BORDERS, who was seriously wounded and in danger of
bleeding to death, was saved by Pfc. WELDON STOREY who stayed all night by him changing
his tourniquet. The 2nd Platoon, delivering covering fire from the rear for the assault, received
heavy artillery fire that burst in the trees above them, as well as some machine gun fire. Pfc.
EMIL BIJAK, Pfc. LAZARO BARRERA, Pfc. VERN A. UPTON, and Pfc. MANUEL G. ABASTA,
JR. were wounded and lay in this area all night ABASTA later died of his wounds. The artillery
fire became so fierce that the platoon had to move out, firing as they went.
At this time Company B, which was to attack on the right abreast of A, was held up by machine
gun fire, and had been able to get only one platoon up onto Le Coste. The 1st Platoon of A
had made contact with B. The 2nd Platoon of A was crossing the draw to move up onto the hill
when a German counterattack struck them. The platoon rushed into position behind a knife-like
ridge. German grenades started dropping over the ridge on the men occupying the reverse slope.
Pfc. JOHN R. BENTON, Pfc. LOUIS H. KOSITS, and Pfc. FREDERICK J. HARE were wounded.
The platoon was in a bad position because the men were unable to see over the ridge without exposing
themselves to the waiting Germans. To regain the initiative, Pfc. ALLEN CURTIS jumped
up on one knee and with his BAR fired one whole magazine of ammunition. He killed three of
the Germans, and may have hit several others. This aggressive action shoved the counterattack
back, but enemy troops could be seen forming for a larger scale assault of the whole hill. It was
1800 and the men were very weary. Their apprehension for their dangerous situation combined
with their fatigue and their many casualties put them in low spirits.
Suddenly an artillery shell whistled just over their heads, barely clearing the ridge, and fell
on the enemy below. Others followed by the dozens. At first the apprehension of the men grew.
These shells were falling too close for comfort. This was no time for a friendly artillery barrage to
fall short and disorganize the company. Their fears were unfounded. This was the first of many
magnificent close-support “box barrages” to be fired by the British artillery 5.5s at crucial moments
when most needed by the troops. As the shells tumbled over right in the box, the scared
men took heart, the gloom lifted, and they felt like cheering. Meanwhile Company B had infiltrated
across onto Le Coste, one at a time, and had reassembled on the hill. Down the left in the
valley was a little town clustered around a church. A machine gun opened up in the tower pinning
down the exposed left flank. The artillery barrage shifted over into the valley and the machine
gun fire ceased. All of Company B had reorganized on the hill by 2000, and both companies
dug in for the night on the western half of Le Coste.
The regimental attack order for the day had assigned the whole ridge to the 1st Battalion.
The 2nd Battalion, with the mission changed during the day to seize Hill 807, assumed that the
whole of Le Coste would be occupied by the 1st Battalion simultaneously with their occupation
of 807. Therefore, when no sign of the 1st Battalion was seen on the eastern end of Le Coste,
Company F was sent after dark to seize and occupy the eastern half.
Also wounded on Le Coste during 15 April were Pfc. JOHN D. SMITH, Pfc. TROY R. WINSLETT
and Pvt. RONALD V. WILSON. Pfc. FRANK S. LONCKI, a 1st Battalion driver, was
wounded by rock fragments from an artillery burst while evacuating wounded from Le Coste.
COMPANY C—BATTALION RESERVE
Company C reached Hill 834 at 1700 and dug in for the night. They were still in battalion reserve
with A and B on Le Coste. The 85th Mountain Infantry had made little progress on the left,
71
and Company C had the almost impossible task of being a reserve for the 1st Battalion while being
held back nearly a mile to protect the gap between regiments. At dusk, elements of the 3rd
Battalion were still passing through on their way up to Mt. Croce where Company K was fighting.
Sgt. EDWARD D. STACKWICK, moving his men, glanced around at a man who came up to
him. Then he looked again. The light was poor, but the man was a German and Sgt. STACKWICK
took him prisoner with his shovel. The digging wasn’t pleasant in this area; one man uncovered
a buried Kraut, and much worse, another man dug up a schu mine. The night was very
cold and the men had no blankets, and had had no food or water since jumping off the day before.
COMPANY D
Late in the morning, the mortars displaced forward to a point just south of Mt. Pigna. Here
they set up at about noon and fired in support of the attack on Hills 834, 802, and Le Coste. The
OP was established on Mt. Pigna in a field of schu mines. At dusk the mortars moved forward
again to a position between Hills 815 and 838. This entire movement was by hand-carry.
The machine gun platoons had moved along with their respective rifle companies. The 2nd
Platoon, moving up Mt. Pigna behind Company B, was hit by artillery fire at about 1600. S/Sgt.
JAMES C. WHYTE was killed. At about noon, artillery falling on Hill 812 had wounded Pfc.
JAMES A. GILMORE, Pfc. CARL L. DUMPS of the 2nd Platoon, and Pfc. JOSEPH R. HIGDON of
the company medics. Also Pfc. LOUIE J. GWATNEY had fallen in the rough terrain while carrying
a machine gun and had badly injured his hand. The 1st Platoon, following Company A in
their attack on Hill 802, came under frequent shellfire. On 802, Sgt. GUSTAVO E. FELIX and Pvt.
JOSEPH S. WARNER were hit by artillery just as the attack was jumping off at about noon. Late
in the afternoon at about 1800, while the platoon was digging in on Le Coste, a shell landed in the
hole with Pfc. J. B. SPARKS. Miraculously he was not killed, but seriously wounded. The shovel
he was using was blown to fragments. Second Lieutenant OWEN W. FLIGG, JR., forward observer
with Company B, was killed by machine gun and sniper fire just after the company occupied
Hill 838. The company had been forced back from the forward slopes by artillery fire and
then was opened up on by snipers from the valley to the rear. In the “stubby” mortar section,
which had been switched from B to A during the attack on Le Coste, Pfc. HENRY LEYMAN was
killed during the assault.
3rd Battalion—Advance to Mt. Croce
In the morning Colonel FOWLER had ordered that the 3rd Battalion be committed at 1300 to
take Le Coste, the long ridge which was later seized and held jointly by the 1st and 2nd Battalions,
and Mt. Croce to the east. Earlier, General HAYS had directed that the 3rd be used to assist
the 1st if its attack slowed down anywhere. The 3rd Battalion was to come into this attack from
the south. The 1st Battalion was expected to be still fighting on 802, with Company C protecting
the left flank and rear. It was still hoped that tanks could be gotten up for the attack with the 3rd
Battalion, and the weary engineers continued their efforts to open the mined and blown roads
forward.
However, the 1st Battalion reached 802 and 838 before noon, so it was directed to continue on
to Le Coste, and the 3rd Battalion was to remain behind Mt. Pigna in reserve. At 1447 a new mission
was given to the 3rd Battalion as a result of a new directive given to Regiment by General
HAYS. Lieutenant Colonel ROBERT C. WORKS, commanding 3rd Battalion, had just returned
from a reconnaissance of Le Coste to Hill 838, then held by Company B, when the order reached
him to “attack Hill 807, if the 2nd Battalion doesn’t get there before you do, and continue on to
capture Mt. Croce before dark.”
Apr 15
72
After the leading company of the Battalion, Company I, had moved east down the draw from
Vedetola to Treviso, killing or capturing 40 of the enemy, and crossing at right angles through the
2nd Battalion already moving north from Mt. Sette Croci, Colonel WORKS met Major PAUL
TOWNSEND on Hill 784 and learned that the 2nd Battalion was taking Hill 807. Therefore, at
1800, after his battalion in moving parallel to the front had passed through two other battalions,
Colonel WORKS issued the order to seize Mt. Croce further to the east. Meanwhile the 3rd Battalion
had done some fighting en route.
COMPANY I—HILLS 815, 784 AND 766
Starting at 0900, Company I led the battalion along the wagon road into Torre Iussi. The 1st
Platoon was leading, and as they reached Torre Iussi, they and part of the 2nd Platoon were
pinned down by machine gun fire coming from Hill 898 northwest of the town. This hill was
presumably occupied by one company of the 85th. However, eighteen Germans with several
machine guns were located down on the steep sides of the hill. Even though bypassed the day
before, they continued fanatically to fire into the town. Repeated requests to the 85th through
regimental headquarters finally brought about their capture. Sgt. ARMANDO CIANCHETTI
and Pfc. MORRIS LIEBMAN, both from the 2nd Platoon, took BARs over into a clump of trees.
From there they were somewhat able to neutralize the machine gun fire and cover the withdrawal
of the pinned-down elements. Sgt. ALEXANDER J. BEAUCHESNE got his 1st Platoon
organized under this covering fire, and moved them across through the woods, into the draw,
and up onto the road running south around the base of Hill 903. The rest of the company in the
rear had not been pinned down, and they led the battalion across the valley about 500 yards
southeast of Torre Iussi and came up onto the road south of Hill 903. A few men from the 2nd
Platoon and the two men with the BARs still remained in town. Lieutenant ROBERT STEWART
went back from the road, rounded these men up, and rejoined the company.
As the various elements of the company reached a point of safety on the road behind the
shoulder of the mountain, Lieutenant MAURICE EWING, of the 1st Platoon, directed them up on
the steep hillside into dispersed positions. Then he went up the hill with one other man to set up
an observation post while the company dug in. Some artillery started dropping in on this area.
Lieutenant EWING, although he had left his rifle down below in a foxhole, returned with two
frightened prisoners. Also, T/5 EUGENE S. FITZSIMMONS, a company medic, discovered a
German in a foxhole nearby. Since as an aid man he was unarmed, he grabbed the German’s rifle
from him, and ordered him to move up to the company area. The company dropped their packs
in this assembly area.
Sgt. BEAUCHESNE captured a prisoner as the company advanced up the saddle east of Hill
903, and the platoon scout, Pfc. LEON STEWART, flushed out two more Germans from a dugout.
The objective of the company had been Le Coste, but because of the unexpected progress of the
1st Battalion, the order was changed and the company was ordered to clear the high ground on
either side of the draw east of Vedetola by seizing Hills 815, 784, and 766. The company marched
down and turned right (east) into the valley north of Mt. Pigna. The 2nd Platoon made their way
to Hill 815. They saw a German run into a house halfway up the slope, and covering the house
with rifle fire, assaulted it with a squad of men. They threw two grenades into the house, and
two Germans came out with their hands in the air. The hill was taken without further incident.
The attached platoon of heavy machine guns was emplaced on the southeast slope of Hill 838
to support the attack of the 3rd Platoon on Hill 784. The platoon moved without difficulty up the
hill and occupied it. Then Second Lieutenant CHARLES F. BARNWELL and Pfc. EARL H. STEVENS
went down to make a reconnaissance near the town of Seccadella. Sniper fire hit them,
killing STEVENS and wounding Lieutenant BARNWELL. Platoon sergeant GEORGE BREED73
LOVE took command immediately. He sent three or four men over to seek out the snipers. They
killed one and wounded the other. A total of six prisoners were taken from the hill. The 1st Platoon,
under Lieutenant EWING, meanwhile had been moving toward Hill 766 further to the
south, crossing some rough country and a very deep draw. They reached the objective and
moved up the hill without being fired on. On top of the hill they received two rifle grenades,
fired at them from a draw to the right side of the hill. No one was hit, and elements of the platoon,
working their way down, took ten prisoners from a cave well stocked with ammunition.
Their objective was occupied and consolidated by 1700. It then took them two hours, over the
rough terrain, to find the rest of the company.
Three men from the 1st Platoon had been lost while returning, and they didn’t rejoin the
company until the offensive had moved out into the Po Valley. One man found himself in Company
B and continued to fight through the action with Company B.
That evening the company waited on Hill 784 from 1900 to 2000 while the rest of the battalion
passed through them on their way to attack Mt. Croce. At 2400 the company was moved to the
town of Coste on the south slope of Mt. Croce and spent the night there, some in foxholes, others
in the houses.
COMPANY K—MT. CROCE
Company K had followed I past Torre Iussi, the town that had proved so costly to the 1st Battalion
the day before, and through the valley west of Mt. Pigna. On reaching the battalion assembly
area northeast of Pigna at noon, they ran into sniper fire coming from Hill 834, which had
already been taken and left behind by the 1st Battalion. Elements from the 3rd Platoon went up
and cleaned up the hill taking two prisoners, and bringing down a wounded 1st Battalion man.
The company rushed though the own of Vedetola as it was being shelled, and hurried into a deep
draw beyond. While moving down this long draw, more shellfire hit them, killing S/Sgt. JOHN
C. MARRONE, and wounding Pfc. RODNEY M. VINCENT, both from the 2nd Platoon, and Pfc.
DONALD M. MARSHALL of the weapons platoon. Pfc. MARSHALL W. JAMES, Pfc. PHILIP A.
SANTASIERO and Pfc. JOHN J. SLIFKA injured themselves falling on the rough terrain.
At 1600 Company K was ordered to take Mt. Croce. Company I had finished taking Hills
815, 784, and 766 by 1700 and was firmly established on 766. Captain ROGER EDDY, the company
commander, took the platoon leaders out of a very deep draw and moved up to the left to
make a visual reconnaissance. The 1st Platoon was to lead the attack, followed by the 2nd and
3rd. The machine guns were to be attached to the leading platoon, and the mortars were in the
rear. While the company waited in the draw they were hit by intense mortar fire.
When the leaders returned, the company moved out into a terrific mortar barrage. S/Sgt.
EDWARD LYJAK, and Pfc. LORN W. PHILLIPS and Pfc. CLIFFORD E. MACQUEEN were
wounded. They moved through the fire to the main Tolè road, and up the road, not clearing out
the buildings as they went. A half-mile from Tolè they turned right at a road junction and started
up along the south edge of Hill 807. The 1st Platoon reached the top of the shoulder of Mt. Croce
before being opened up on by an enemy light machine gun. The fire came from a house to the
right rear below them on the Locari Scuola road. Squad leader S/Sgt. CLAUS SCHROEDER and
platoon guide S/Sgt. JOHN J. WELCH were killed as the platoon kept advancing. The platoon
leader, Second Lieutenant ROBERT S. BARR, Sgt. CARL P. HUJANEN, Pfc. MARVIN C. LUTZ,
Pfc. EDWARD SNYDER, and Pvt. CHARLES W. ADKINS were all killed as the 1st Platoon
pushed on up the hill against rifle fire. Pvt. WILLIAM J. SHERRARD, the platoon runner, was
wounded. Also Pfc. SEVILLE S. FUNK and Pvt. JACK R. BERGLUND were shot by rifle fire, and
Sgt. ROBERT F. ZATREPALEK got a rifle shot in the neck. T/Sgt. ARTHUR O. SCHIMKE of the
1st Platoon, running forward up the hill, took twelve prisoners out of dugouts without firing a
74
shot. Then he moved the platoon on without orders up to Mt. Croce. They had excellent artillery
support. Starting at 250 yards distance, the support lifted when the platoon came within 100
yards, under excellent control by “300” radio. Mt. Croce was taken without a shot being fired by
the platoon. The company reorganized at 2030 just at dark, the 3rd Platoon on the left, 2nd and
then 1st in a defensive position.
During the reorganization, heavy mortar fire killed S/Sgt. WARREN H. SEEBADE, and
wounded S/Sgt. THEODORE R. MUENSTER and Pfc. PAUL P. PAONE. Also Pfc. DENZIL
WILLIAMS was hit in the ear by shrapnel, and Pfc. WILLIAM R. ROBERTS had to be evacuated
because of shellshock. They could see the mortar position only 150 yards away, and fired at it.
Five of the enemy mortar men started up the hill toward them, but were driven off by one squad
of the 2nd Platoon. Then the company defense was consolidated on the hill, and contact was
made by patrol with the 2nd Battalion on the left, on Hill 807. Company L next appeared moving
through in a column of twos, and took positions on the right rear on Mt. Croce.
The 1st Platoon was next hit by a counterattack. It was of only about seven-man strength,
with two light machine guns, but it caught the men digging in. Two more men of the 1st Platoon
were wounded: Acting squad leader Pfc. CLARENCE C. LEVERS, and Pfc. WILLIAM D.
FLETCHER, were both hit by hand grenades. The 1st Platoon, by this time, was cut down to 18
men, but with Sgt. JAMES C. TOOMEY of Company M and his heavy machine gun, the enemy
was finally repulsed. TOOMEY stuck by his gun as the riflemen withdrew. Alone, he fired furiously
at the counterattacking Germans, and then as they spread out he grabbed an M-1 and killed
three of them. The riflemen from behind him got two or three, and the rest were driven off. The
18 men of the 1st Platoon were then reinforced by two squads from the 3rd Platoon. At the same
time, a squad was requested from Company L.
All night, long-range harassing machine gun fire fell, just enough to keep the men awake. It
sounded like the Germans were pulling back, but early in the morning another counterattack
struck the 1st Platoon. The Germans attacked with one squad and a machine gun. The 1st Platoon
fired a rifle grenade which hit the German machine gunner squarely and wounded his assistant,
breaking up the attack. However, Pfc. ROBERT L. WAGNER, Pfc. ARNETT W. MINEAR,
and Pfc. JAMES W. ARNOLD were all wounded by hand grenades.
COMPANY L—BATTALION RESERVE
When the battalion moved out at 0900 on the 15th, Company L was in battalion reserve, following
K. They marched along the road toward Torre Iussi passing the previous day’s carnage of
mules and men, turned right before Serra Sarzana, cut across the valley and passed around the
southern edge of 903. They then turned left to the north between Hill 903 and Hill 868, and circled
around through the valley north of Mt. Pigna.
As the company approached the houses of Vedetola from the west, they came under machine
gun fire, but were able to keep moving. Beyond the village they moved along into a draw, and
on through the draw toward Treviso, when artillery fell on them, killing Pfc. GLENN L. CHRYSLER
and T/5 MERVIN H. LEWIS. T/Sgt. RAYMOND G. FLYNN, Sgt. CLARENCE E. KENTZ,
Pfc. OWEN R. JOHNSTUN, and Pfc. ROBERT J. WILLIAMS were wounded. Pfc. PEDRO L. ISLAS
was also wounded, but stayed with the company. They captured four prisoners through
here and used them as litter bearers. By 1700 Company I had taken the last of its three hills, and
L, echeloned to the right, was following K up Mt. Croce. East of the little town of Coste they captured
an enemy CP including two battalion commanders. Then they occupied the high ground to
the right rear of Company K on Mt. Croce and dug in for the night. Pfc. WALTER W. HODGE
was killed here by artillery. Sgt. NEAL C. YORKER had been hit in the arm by a shell fragment
earlier in the evening.
75
COMPANY M
Company M, using mules instead of jeeps, had three casualties in the morning when hit by
mortar fire across the minefield beyond Torre Iussi. Wounded were Pfc. JOHN H. WIGGINS,
Pfc. JOHN W. RUIS, and Pfc. HOLLIE BOWERS, all from the 1st Platoon. Later that night on Mt.
Croce, Pfc. MOSE KEARSE, a 2nd Platoon machine gunner attached to Company K, was killed by
shrapnel. Pfc. J. B. BALLEW, Pfc. JACK ARIAIL, and Pfc. CLOYCE E. COLLIER of the same platoon
were wounded at the same time.
In the other section of the same machine gun platoon, which was still attached to Company I,
Pfc. VERN E. CROWELL and Pfc. MAYFORD W. LAWRENTZ were wounded at nearly the same
time.
In the 1st Platoon, Pfc. JAMES E. COBB was hurt and evacuated, and Second Lieutenant
JAMES T. MILLS, the mortar platoon leader, was wounded by shell fragments outside of the
company CP. The battalion gun platoon had trouble with the mules which had to be used because
of the blown-out narrow mountain roads and the narrow trails through the minefields.
The men had trouble keeping the bulky, heavy weapons on the backs of the small Alpine mules.
Throughout the push in the mountain phase, the mules remained a problem for the gun crews.
They had to be overloaded; they tired easily; and then would lie down in their tracks, rolling off
their loads. It was an ordeal in an open valley under observation to get the mule to his feet and
repack his load while artillery and mortar fire came in. The gun platoon had difficulty keeping
up with the rapid battalion advance.
Wire had to be laid by mules until the advance reached the Po Valley. Many of the mules
were killed or maimed, and while the use of mules brought many headaches, it was agreed that
they are invaluable for mountain fighting. The only alternative is backpacking.
THIRD DAY—16 APRIL
3rd Battalion—Mosca Ridge
On the afternoon of the 15th, the 2nd Battalion of the 86th Infantry had the mission of seizing
Mt. Mantino, while the 3rd Battalion, 87th, was directed to capture Mt. Croce. Both battalions
were successful by dark. The 3rd Battalion, 87th, was then directed to continue the attack early
the next morning, along the ridge to the east to Mt. Mosca. This attack was to provide a line of
departure for the 86th Infantry to push vigorously through to the northeast. The 86th was expected
to cross this LD about 0900. The area between Mt. Mantino and Mt. Croce had not been
assigned to any unit. Early on the 16th, Colonel CLARENCE M TOMLINSON, 86th Infantry, reconnoitering
beyond Mt. Mantino, was hit in the arm by sniper fire and evacuated. Lieutenant
Colonel ROBERT M. COOK, executive officer, replaced him as regimental commander. The attack
of the 86th, delayed partly by this change of command, did not cross the LD before 1500. It
will be evident that this delay seriously affected the action of the 3rd Battalion, 87th, all during
the day, because its left flank was thus left entirely exposed.
COMPANY K—MADNA DI RODIANO
At 0200, the order came in by phone to attack to the east toward Madna di Rodiano at 0600,
with K on the left, L on the right, and I in reserve. The attack would run along the ridge that extended
about 4,000 yards east to Mt. Mosca.
In the morning, after a 20-minute artillery and mortar barrage, the 3rd Platoon, Company K,
led off, followed by the 2nd and 1st. The initial situation was confusing. There was a heavy
Apr 16
76
morning fog, and the LD was under mortar and small arms fire. Colonel ROBERT C. WORKS,
making his reconnaissance, had four of his party of seven wounded at the outset, including his K
Company runner, Pfc. FRANK S. BISHOP, and Captain WALKER T. WEED II, Battalion S-3. Another
one of the group was hit later. At the moment of crossing the line of departure, a 20-man
enemy counterattack hit the company from the left. All of the 3rd, one-half of the 2nd Platoon,
Lieutenant TOIVO RANTA, and five men of the 1st Squad had crossed. The rest of the platoon
stopped. Pvt. FREDERIC L. PALOW was wounded in the legs by machine gun fire. The platoon
was split.
Captain ROGER EDDY took the rest of the company way around to the left and then forward.
In this way they came around to the rear of the counterattacking Nazis. They shot one
and drove back the rest.
The squads crossed the line of departure on their own initiative and rejoined their platoons.
One squad with one machine gun was left under First Lieutenant JACK T. BURNETT to guard
the rear since the enemy counterattack was not completely broken. The 2nd Platoon passed
through the 3rd, and they were ordered to swing to the right and then forward as far as possible.
If necessary, they were to join Company L on the right. Then the 3rd Platoon and two squads of
the 1st Platoon, plus the heavy machine gun section, went forward along the top of the ridge. On
each knob they left a half-squad to prevent the enemy retaking the knobs and following them
along the ridge. These squads were under fire all morning, but were successful in their mission.
During the morning, the Battalion S-4, First Lieutenant EVERETT J. QUINE, had personally
flushed out 25 Germans from a single house, including a major and a captain. The captain gave
the complete defense plan of Tolè to the IPW Team.
Although Company K had occupied Mt. Croce at dark the night before, there were considerable
pockets of resistance remaining which they had to fight through before crossing the line of
departure and heading east. At 0900 in the morning, Lieutenant Colonel HAY, of the 3rd Battalion,
86th, was heard by Company E over their direct wire, complaining to Division that they were
receiving fire from Mt. Croce, and that they were sure that there was an enemy observation post
there. He said the 3rd Battalion, 87th, had done a poor job of cleaning out. This indicates the
misunderstanding that existed about the area between Mt. Mantino and Mt. Croce. This intervening
area had not been cleaned out, nor had the 3rd Battalion, 87th, been directed to do so.
At 1100 the company was low on ammunition. They were on a small hill, the last before
Madna di Rodiano, the first objective. No physical contact had been made with Company L, or
with the 2nd Platoon of K. To the right front, however, could be heard the sound of firing. Then a
mortar barrage fell on them, an exceedingly heavy one. At this point they were ordered forward
to join Company L in the attack to the east. Without reconnaissance, in the heavy barrage, a
fragmentary order was given and the company moved out. They had thirteen casualties in five
minutes. The shells were bursting in the trees. Killed were: Pfc. DAVID H. C. DENNIS, Pfc.
ORLON J. YODER, and Pfc. JAMES M. STEVENS. Wounded were: S/Sgt. ERLING O. OMLAND,
Sgt. WILLIAM M. GROVES, Pfc. ELMER L. SIMPKINS, Pfc. RAYMOND E. HATCHMAN,
Pfc. CALIXTO L. MURO, Pfc. VICTOR PESPENI, Pfc. DONALD J. FRANK, and Pvt.
JOHN E. MORO. Pfc. GEORGE ZORICK, the commander’s runner, was wounded while running
a message. Also Lieutenant BURNETT, who had rejoined the company, was wounded through
his helmet, creasing his scalp. Pfc. ORVEL E. WOLF of the attached machine gun platoon from
Company M was wounded by artillery while going after ammunition. To go through the mortar
fire was suicidal, so the company stopped and moved to the right over the ridge. From here they
moved down to Madna di Rodiano without further fire, and there found the 2nd Platoon which,
with Company L, had already taken the town and a host of prisoners, 75 men and 4 officers, and
an entire aid station.
77
To go back: the 2nd Platoon, after it swung to the right off of Mt. Croce in the morning leaving
the rest of the company, had an interesting action by itself. They crossed over the ridge and
dropped down to the town of Capponara. There they ran into Company L in the town. Having
been ordered to keep moving, they skirted around the right and south edge of town and worked
east on the right of L. Therefore L Company was between this platoon and the rest of K as both
companies moved toward Madna di Rodiano along the high ground. The platoon soon came to a
group of buildings and flushed out a prisoner. S/Sgt. JOSEPH LEUTHOLD asked the prisoner in
German if there were any other Germans in the houses. The prisoner in a loud voice declared
that there were no others in the buildings, but as he spoke he slyly pointed to one of the buildings.
The sergeant tossed a grenade into this house and eight more Germans came out hands in
air.
This was at about 1100. Some shellfire was coming in, but it wasn’t bothering them much, as
most of it was going down into the valley or hitting Company L further up the ridge. Therefore
the platoon was able to move rapidly and reach a point due south of Madna di Rodiano from
where a rocky lane ran up into the hilltop town of scattered houses and big shade trees. They
moved up the lane.
At the first house a German machine gun was firing west. They tossed in a grenade from behind,
and the platoon sergeant, T/Sgt. PHILIP THURSTON, took two prisoners. From here looking
up the lane they saw six or eight Nazis running out of the front door of the church. The
church was on the west side of the lane so that the door was away from the forces of Company L
fighting toward the church rear. The leading 2nd Squad opened fire and killed three, the rest
fleeing back into the church. This sudden fire from the southern flank must have thrown panic
into the Germans, who until then had been beating back Company L’s successive attacks from the
west. As the platoon waited, a German medic came from the church and said he had a wounded
man inside. Wary of trickery, and covered by the platoon, Lieutenant TOIVO RANTA, S/Sgt.
EDMUND D. BENNETT, Pvt. CARL MORELLI and Pvt. MICHAEL KARPEN moved cautiously
to the church. Lieutenant RANTA stood at the front door, covered by the others, and shoved his
rifle in—ordering anyone inside to come out. Out filed 67 Nazis and two horses. Inside were six
more wounded in a small anteroom. The building was a combination arsenal and aid station. A
wagon outside flew a Red Cross flag. The horses had pulled the wagon down filled with
wounded, and back filled with ammunition. By this time it was noon, and the last units of Company
L, and the 12 men, remnants of the 2nd Platoon, arrived from the west. One of the 12 was
fatally shot by a sniper. The squad went to locate the sniper without success. Some mortar fire
came in at this time too, wounding one L Company man and hitting some prisoners. After allaround
security had been set up, the rest of Company K arrived.
COMPANY L—“BANZAI RIDGE”
Through the morning fog Company L, too, ran into small arms fire, both automatic and rifle,
and had to fight their way to the line of departure near Coste. The area was one of small,
wooded knolls, confusingly broken up, and the fire coming from three sides through the fog
added to the confusion. Before they left Mt. Croce, Pfc. HARRY E. HESKELL was wounded.
Later, a machine gun section leader, S/Sgt. ALLEN C. STROMER, was killed by a machine gun,
as was Pfc. ROBERT P. REICHE. Some mortar fire started crashing into the area too. Sgt. KENNETH
RAFFETY, of M Company, a squad leader in the 1st Platoon, was fatally wounded while
supporting the attack. The 1st Platoon, leading to the line of departure, had its platoon leader,
Second Lieutenant WILLIAM J. WOLFGRAM, killed by machine gun fire, and the platoon, as it
reached the LD at 0630, had been cut down to nineteen men. Killed with Lieutenant WOLFGRAM
was Pvt. CHARLES H. REYNOLDS, JR. by the same machine gun. Pfc. SAM GALLEGOS
was killed by a sniper. Also at this time Pfc. LYNN R. BURTON was hit in the arm and leg by
78
machine gun fire and Pfc. JOHN F. KAZMIERCZAK was hit in the mouth. Pfc. THOMAS H.
WARD, Pfc. HENRY A. GREINKE, Pfc. SAMUEL G. TORRICE, and S/Sgt. ALVIN C. SMART
were hit by mortar shrapnel during this same advance. Cpl. HENRY B. SMITH of Headquarters
Company, who was an acting squad leader for the 1st Platoon, was also hit by machine gun fire.
At the same time, lending uncertainty to the situation, Company K was fending off a counterattack
on the left. In spite of this precarious position, the battalion commander, Colonel
WORKS, urged the companies on, believing the 86th Infantry on his right (south) to be waiting
for him to clear the ridge, so that they might cut across his rear, driving north and then northeast
to work out along the ridge nearly parallel to his on the left.
Actually the 86th didn’t cross until 1500, six hours after schedule, and the German occupation
of this ridge throughout the day, armed as they were with direct-fire, high-velocity weapons, cost
the 3rd Battalion dearly. Because of the nature of the rough terrain and the fog, neither of which
permitted a view, and because the enemy had to be fought back from the line of departure, reconnaissance
of the usual nature was impossible. Company L was ordered to “advance by leaps
and bounds as the situation permitted.” Colonel WORKS’ party, trying to make a reconnaissance,
was under aimed fire and lost three of its seven men, plus a fourth later on.
The 2nd Platoon passed through the remnants of the 1st on the LD and moved out on the
right side of the ridgeline. Company K was over the crest on the left where fire was so heavy that
their 2nd Platoon was sent on a flanking mission over onto the south side of the ridge with Company
L. In order not to intermingle with L, this platoon flanked wide and way around to the
right of L, so that K, less one platoon, was on the left of Company L, and the one platoon of K was
on the right, farther down the slope. This platoon moved fast and Company L could see them a
little ahead and down to their right, work fifteen Krauts out of a house.
As the 2nd Platoon of L moved along the ridge, a heavy artillery concentration was landing
harmlessly in the valley to the right. They cleared a stone house and haystack, killing two snipers
and taking three prisoners. They moved rapidly through the swirling fog toward the company
objective of Madna di Rodiano. The weapons platoon received most of the enemy fire. Pfc.
HEINZ KATZMANN, an acting squad leader for the mortars, was hit by artillery while directing
fire. He refused to be evacuated and kept on for two days.
Pfc. ROBERT W. GUSTAFSON, wounded and ordered out of action, first directed his squad
into a fine German dugout as shells came in the area with increasing fury. GUSTAFSON, waiting
until all others were inside, found there was no room for him, and although they called him in, he
yelled back that he would “sweat it out” on the ground. Three artillery shells landed almost on
him, and an unselfish man died.
The 2nd Platoon, meanwhile under no fire, stopped to reorganize in defilade below the last
ridge before their objective. One squad was missing and out of contact. The remaining two
squads formed as skirmishers and attacked the ridge frontally. As they neared the crest, the fog
was lifting, but all opposition seemed to have ceased when, without warning, a fanatical Nazi
officer opened fire point-blank with a burp gun. He was in a shallow foxhole in front of a large
bunker. A BAR man and two riflemen dispatched him quickly, and the squads charged up,
grenaded the bunker and captured fifteen surprised enemy.
Unfortunately, this maneuver must have attracted enemy observers, for as soon as the prisoners
had been disarmed and sent toward the rear out of the line of fire, a concentrated barrage
of 81-mm mortar fire laid in on the ridge where the squads were reorganizing, and machine guns
opened up on them. There was no cover. The squads scrambled back down off the ridge. Pfc.
BERNIE C. GAY and Pfc. HERALD W. MUNDORFF were wounded by rifle grenades, and Pfc.
79
JAMES E. HALL by mortar fire. It was now some time after 1000, and from this time until Madna
di Rodiano was taken was as desperate a period as any the 87th experienced. Pfc. FRANCIS P.
GALLES, serving as battalion runner, was sent back from the battalion CP to order Company I
forward. He was hit in both knees by machine gun fire back in the Locari Scuola area.
Back at the foot of the ridge, four of the men of the 2nd Platoon, led by Sgt. STANLEY J.
SLUSARK, worked up unobserved to the forward slope of the ridge where there was some concealment.
There the barrage pinned them down. The rest of the platoon, at the first lull, tried
desperately to reach them. As they crossed the skyline in their charge, the barrage laid in again
and beat them back. Pfc. EDWARD B. SAWYER was seriously wounded by shrapnel, Pfc. WILLIAM
WILLIAMSON by machine gun fire and Pfc. THOMAS C. MCGUIRE by mortar fire.
Back at the bottom of the hill they were joined by the missing squad. They attacked again
with this added strength. For the third time they were forced back. Pfc. STEVE SINCEK was seriously
wounded by machine gun fire. While reorganizing for the third time, Sgt. SLUSARK, one
of the four pinned down on the forward slope, came crawling around the side of the ridge. He
had been seriously wounded, shot through the hip, and had dragged himself back to give the
position of his three buddies, who were holding off a large group of enemy riflemen. The platoon
was desperate. The radio had been shot out of the radioman’s hands, so the platoon had no
contact with the company.
It was decided by Lieutenant JOHN H. GRAHAM, the platoon leader, to make a “Banzai
charge” through a slight saddle to the left, and to reach the forward slope by this route regardless
of the cost. By the time the enemy saw the new tactic and had adjusted fire, the charging men
were high on the ridge. They charged on, trying to get below the line of grazing fire across the
ridge. They hit a draw and were rejoined by the three who had been pinned down. One man,
Pfc. DANIEL CALLINAN, had his head creased, and Pfc. ALLEN F. SCHAUFFLER was seriously
hit in the neck attempting to bring the wounded man over to the platoon. Wounded in this
final assault were: Pfc. RUSSELL PINKERTON hit by rifle fire in the chest, Pfc. MICHAEL SAVINO
hit by shrapnel, S/Sgt. JOSEPH A., CAMPBELL hit twice by machine gun fire, and Lieutenant
GRAHAM injured when thrown to the ground by a shell bursting near him. Pfc. EAGAN L.
FOSTER was killed by machine gun fire.
The platoon, with but twelve out of forty left, now went on to take their objective. They
fought their way into the little village of Madna di Rodiano. The 3rd Platoon was charging up at
about the same time. Here they saw German prisoners emerging from the church. Unbeknown
to them, the 2nd Platoon of Company K had come in on the extreme right flank from the valley to
the south, and captured the 67 Krauts now coming out of the church, followed by the two horses.
Outside was the first-aid wagon the enemy had used under a Red Cross flag to haul up ammunition.
However, the heroic fight of Company L for the ridge had made this entry possible.
In town another of the heroic twelve was cut down as Pfc. LEE R. NORRIS was shot in the
stomach by a sniper and died in a German medic’s arms. Then Pfc. FRED J. WAHL was
wounded by mortar fire as he marshaled the prisoners after the attack was over. This fire hit
prisoners as well.
The 3rd Platoon, following the 2nd in the attack, came under heavy fire. Pfc. VERNON J.
CARTNER was wounded by mortar fire, and during the attack at the church Pfc. MICHAEL
NICOSIA and Pfc. HOMER P. JUMP, JR. were killed by machine gun fire. Pfc. PAUL T.
PUSKARICH was fatally wounded. Pfc. JOHN G. NIX and Pfc. HILARY A. NEWTON of the 1st
Platoon were wounded in the same action.
80
To the men of Company L, the hill will always be known as “Banzai Ridge.” The pitiful sight
of helpless wounded and smashed dead comrades will never be forgotten by the survivors of that
charge.
COMPANY K—HILL 787
Just after arrival at about noon, Company K reorganized and prepared to capture the last hill
before Mt. Mosca, Hill 787. K on the left was to take the nearer hill overlooking the town from
which there was, even at the moment, machine gun fire. Under artillery support, Hill 787 was
taken without casualties. The 2nd Platoon on the right grenaded an enemy dugout and took five
prisoners.
Then they reorganized, using enemy dugouts for defense. At this time they again came under
intense friendly artillery fire. It was stopped by a “300” radio message. That was at 1500.
During the afternoon, Company I, which had moved onto Mt. Mosca, complained about a rifleman
shooting into their rear from a little grassy knoll, Hill 779, in front of Company K’s position
on 787. Captain EDDY, to make sure, sent the whole 3rd Platoon and part of the 2nd. Pfc.
ROBERT TURNER, the scout out ahead, sighted a German at a dugout entrance surrounded by
several others. He immediately opened fire, shooting from the hip, and killed two of the Germans.
Then one of his bullets must have struck a large German Panzerfaust charge, for a third
German blew up. Eight prisoners were then collected and sent back.
Late in the day, Company K, with the rest of the battalion, was relieved by infantry of the 1st
Armored Division, and withdrew to Rodiano, south of Madna di Rodiano. Their ammunition
was 80 percent expended. The men had no water, no food, and were close to exhaustion.
COMPANY L—HILL 765
Captain JOSEPH J. DUNCAN, while reorganizing Company L by the church at Madna di
Rodiano, was ordered on to Mt. Mosca. Company K was still on the left and both companies
jumped off at 1330 after a thirty-minute artillery preparation which was to lift at 400 yards and
then lift on call. The 3rd Platoon, under First Lieutenant WILLARD W. DORA, led off. From a
house on Hill 765, beyond and above the church, machine gun fire had caused many of the casualties
in the assault of the church. Lieutenant DORA led his platoon forward so fast up the
wooded hill that they were caught by their own artillery fire. S/Sgt. CHARLES E. HOGUE and
Pfc. BRUCE E. BERENDS were wounded by enemy fire, but Lieutenant DORA and Pfc. CHARLES
R. MEISER, JR., lying down near each other as DORA looked at his map, were killed by one
of their own artillery shells, and Sgt. WILLIAM CONGER was lightly wounded. Pfc. JOSE
VASQUEZ, sent to contact the 2nd Platoon, was hit by the same fire. However, the hill was
quickly assaulted and seventeen prisoners were taken. Here on 765 and 787 they were ordered to
dig in behind Company K. The company had only about eighty men left.
Meanwhile, Company I, which at about noon had been ordered to move forward from reserve
near Mt. Croce, with the objective of attacking Hills 765 and 787 from the south, had arrived
and was ordered on to take Mt. Mosca.
COMPANY I—MT. MOSCA
Back at dawn, while K and L were moving to the line of departure, Company I moved up
onto Mt. Croce and remained in battalion reserve during the attack along the ridge to Madna di
Rodiano. The 2nd Platoon took positions on the left, and the 3rd Platoon on the right. A morning
fog hung heavily over the mountain, cutting visibility down to a few yards. The company
tried to dig foxholes in the hard, rocky ground as some sniper fire was directed at them. Next, a
heavy concentration of 120-mm artillery fire landed in the company area. An assistant squad
Apr 16
81
leader in the 2nd Platoon, Sgt. ORVAL R. MCDANIEL, was killed, and S/Sgt. THEODORE B.
REINERO, of the 1st Platoon, Pfc. THEODORE G. HOOPLE, Pfc. ANTHONY J. BABICH, Pfc.
JACOB C. LOWERY, and Pfc. STEVEN J. MOTYKA, were all wounded. The company moved
over to the right to a position in some cover.
Captain ADRIAN RIORDAN, the company commander, moved forward to make a reconnaissance
through the fog. The high ground was open with brushy knobs and little trees here
and there. He met Captain EDDY of Company K, and they were pinned down for a time by
automatic fire.
The machine gun section was out on a point to the right front. Sgt. EDWARD R. CRIST and
Pfc. OSCAR B. SATHERS moved forward from this section, went over the ridge and down the
hill about twenty yards to the front. Here they came upon three Germans in a dugout, and
opened fire on them with M-1s. The Nazis ran off in the fog, and it was not known whether they
were hit or not. Then two others ran from the dugout and were fired upon as they disappeared.
The two men entered the dugout, a large permanent installation, and found extensive wiring and
equipment, which indicated that it had been an artillery observation post. Simultaneously with
the occupation of this position, the artillery fire, which had been continuously landing on the hill,
ceased.
Before the two men could complete their examination of the dugout they were called back.
The company was moving forward at battalion command to close up behind Company L. Pfc.
HANS MOSER, JR. was wounded by a tree burst as they started out. Captain RIORDAN, finding
the battalion commander, Colonel WORKS, at his OP, had the two objectives Hill 787 and Mt.
Mosca, pointed out to him. By this time the fog had lifted.
Shortly after noon the company moved along the southern traverse of the long ridge and contacted
Company K, which had already taken the first objective, Hill 787. Here they set up their
own machine guns and the attached heavies and their 60-mm mortars on the south slopes of Hill
787 in order to join the artillery preparation planned to fall on Hill 779, on the east knoll of 787,
and on Mt. Mosca. Although the initial objective could not be seen, they moved out over the hill,
down into a deep ravine and up the far side without being fired on. They reorganized southwest
of the knoll, 3rd Platoon on the right, 1st on the left. More artillery was called for on Mt. Mosca.
The “300” radio was working well and the company “536s” were functioning very well. As they
moved up, the 3rd Platoon hit a group of houses on the side of another knoll, Hill 761. Here they
engaged in a short fight against automatic weapons (not machine guns). Under the platoon fire,
two men were designated to move up to the houses, and then the whole 3rd Squad was sent up
after them. Twenty-six Germans were flushed out of these houses and captured.
Meanwhile the 1st Platoon had pushed out into the exposed north end of the knoll where
they took two more prisoners. Here on top, however, automatic pistol and machine gun fire,
coming from Hill 779, cut into the platoon’s left flank. Most of the men were safe in the woods to
the right, but Lieutenant MAURICE EWING and six men were out on the open knoll. EWING
yelled to his men to make a dash up over to the woods, and jumping to his feet reached safety
himself. The six men behind him, seeing the bullets pepper the open hillside all around them,
froze to the ground. EWING continued to yell to them, and Captain RIORDAN commanded,
“Get off that hillside before you are all killed!” Pfc. JOHN D. SPRENG had been fatally wounded
as the fire opened up. T/5 BARTON C. MORRISON, the company medic, ran to his aid. As he
dressed the dying man’s wound, he was hit in the leg, and running over a few yards, he lay flat
on the ground. There more machine gun fire struck him. He was mortally wounded. The other
four men got over the hill.
82
Then the company cut south of the exposed knoll and swung back on the east slope, then
across the saddle and up onto Mt. Mosca. The 3rd Platoon went around to the right flank, and a
light machine gun was sent forward. All but the very top of Mt. Mosca over to the northwest was
occupied. As they cleaned up this area, enemy were driven out of holes all over the slope. Five
were killed and about twelve taken prisoner from the wooded northern slope. After the company
was on top of their objective, one German, completely outfitted in full field equipment, and
carrying a heavy pack and rifle, marched up the hill toward them as though he had just reached
the front. As he hove in sight, the company, being otherwise unengaged at the time, opened fire
in unison with all weapons. Fire engulfed him, tearing off his equipment and breaking his rifle in
three pieces, but the astonished young soldier emerged from the barrage unharmed, threw his
hands into the air and surrendered.
As the company reorganized, two or three men moved over onto the exposed eastern slope to
investigate. As soon as they appeared over the ridge, accurate artillery fire dropped on them.
Pfc. DENZEL C. CARRICO was wounded and the other two men withdrew. In the reorganization,
the 2nd Platoon was sent back onto the south slope of the grassy knoll, Hill 761, to take positions
with the heavy machine guns. Here they dug in under some artillery fire and some sniping
fire still coming in from Hill 779 in the rear. A sniper wounded S/Sgt. EDWARD H. VITALIUS
of the 1st Platoon. Company K was radioed to clear out this enemy pocket. They sent a platoon
and captured about 16 Germans.
Pfc. VITO ACCIARITO was wounded by a mortar shell. Then three short rounds of friendly
artillery struck Mt. Mosca, wounding T/Sgt. ALEXANDER J. BEAUCHESNE. During the rest of
the afternoon, and until relieved after dark, the company continued to be subjected to enemy artillery
fire. Pfc. LUTHER E. DOANE, JR. and Pfc., HOMER H. LOWE were killed from the 2nd
Platoon. Pfc. ROY D. TAYLOR of the 3rd Platoon was wounded. In the 1st Platoon, Pfc. HARRY
R. ARCADO was slightly wounded by shellfire, and Pfc. MALFORD C. HEIMER was more seriously
wounded. Sgt. BRADFORD ROUSSEAU had been occupying a foxhole with the 1st Platoon
when a member of the 3rd Platoon ran up and accidentally stabbed him with a bayonet,
thinking him a German. Pfc. HERMAN A. FREYER, JR., Pfc. AUGUST J. KAPUSTA, and Pfc.
JOSEPH FRIEDMAN of the weapons platoon were wounded by artillery. Early in the day, the
battalion runner from Company I, Pfc. JAMES A. BAKER, had been wounded while with Colonel
WORKS’ reconnaissance party. Pfc. CECIL C. FLOWERS was wounded while carrying a litter
with the medics.
Elements of the 11th Armored Infantry Battalion (1st Armored Division), which relieved
Company I after dark, received several casualties as the shellfire continued. Company I withdrew
to the town of Rodiano for the night with the rest of the battalion.
OTHER CASUALTIES
During the afternoon the advance 2nd Battalion aid station was hit and suffered six killed
and nine wounded. Killed from the 2nd Battalion were Pfc. RAYMOND V. DE SORCY, Pfc.
WILLIAM G. MILLER, Pvt. SAMUEL L. IRVIN, and Pvt. GEORGE SMITH, JR. Two men from
Company F, sent back to Service Company to help evacuate wounded, were hit here: Pvt. BENJAMIN
KASEN and Pvt. GEORGE E. SLAUGHTER. S/Sgt. RICHARD A. ROCKER of Battalion
Headquarters was wounded lightly during the day near Vedetola beyond which the battalion
headquarters spent the night.
2nd Battalion—North to Baccuchi
While the 3rd Battalion swung wide the gate along the German line to Mt. Mosca so that the
86th Infantry could drive through, the 2nd Battalion was assigned the mission of buttressing the
83
flank of the open door. Company F was to punch north from Le Coste to the town of Torre.
Company G was to follow tanks through Tolè on the main road north, and Company E was to
mop up Mt. Croce and drive to San Trinita beyond Tolè on the same road, and finally Company F
would leapfrog beyond Baccuchi.
COMPANY F—TORRE
Torre was directly north and down hill from Company F. At daylight on the 16th, looking
out through the heavy morning haze, they found the knob on the northernmost slope of their hill
was organized with some well-dug positions. An observer on the extreme left of the company
adjusted assault mortars at two Krauts at a 100-yard range. A BAR opened up on two other
Krauts crawling up a ditch, and killed one of them. Then the 2nd Platoon, with S/Sgt. LOUIS H.
BARGMANN leading, jumped off, squads abreast, and overran the positions. To their surprise,
instead of a handful, thirty prisoners were taken.
The weapons platoon, the 2nd Platoon of heavy machine guns of Company H, and four tanks
moved up on the knob to support the attack on Torre. The 2nd Platoon led off. On the left flank
S/Sgt. RUDOLPH W. KONIECZNY led a bazooka team of Pfc. THEODORE F. AUBREY and Pfc.
JOE DUNN, KONIECZNY as usual toting his powerful BAR. The sergeant got so far ahead that
the rest of the men were running trying to keep up with him. He was first to Torre, which was
entered without resistance at 0900.
Artillery then started landing in town, wounding Pvt. JAMES C. IASSOGNA and Sgt.
KERMIT T. GOODMONSON, and the platoon pulled back to the knob on Le Coste. At 1100 the
company moved off of Le Coste, marching to Mt. Croce, arriving there and digging in at 1600. At
about dusk (2030) the company left for Baccuchi over rough terrain, but without being fired on,
followed by the 2nd Platoon of Company A. They dug in again at 2400.
COMPANY G—TOLÈ
First Lieutenant GORDON A. ANDERSON, the executive officer, had assumed command of
Company G the evening before as soon as he caught up with it. Also during this evening the 1st
Platoon, with one platoon of tanks and one of TDs, caught up with the company. In the morning
of the Mt. Mosca attack, Company G, led by the 1st Platoon, the tanks and TDs, was given the
mission to take, secure, and defend Tolè. They moved up the main road toward Tolè at 1015.
The road had not been previously checked for mines, but sixteen men of the 1st Platoon rode
two tanks right down into town under the command of Second Lieutenant STANLEY F. JAZWINSKI.
The company following had dismounted a mile short of town and within sight of the
leading elements, when long-range machine gun fire opened up on them from beyond the town.
The tanks fired back, hitting some scattered houses in the area from which the fire was coming.
Meanwhile in the town, JAZWINSKI’s sixteen men had jumped off the tanks and worked their
way through town clearing out the houses without resistance. The rest of the company followed
them into town, and almost at once heavy shellfire dropped on them. The town became a cloud
of dust, flying masonry and tile. Many men were hit, including Sgt. PETE BRITO, Pfc. RALPH E.
NANNINGA of the 2nd Platoon, and Pfc. HENRY J. SHAW and Pvt. ROBERT J. KNOWLES of
the 3rd Platoon.
After this shelling eased off, the 1st Platoon moved into the far end of town. There they
found a big headquarters of the enemy abandoned only five minutes before. Italian civilians told
them a general had left just before they arrived. An elaborate German kitchen was found, potatoes
all peeled, the day’s menu laid out on the table, and beside the menu a piece of bread and
jam with one bite gone. As the rest of the company secured the town under intense shellfire, the
1st Platoon with the tanks and TDs advanced another mile beyond the town. From near the town
Apr 16
84
of Baccuchi they observed Germans on their left on a hill. The tanks fired six 76-mm shells into
Baccuchi and into machine gun positions on the left. Then the 1st Squad of the platoon was ordered
into town. Machine gun fire opened up on the leading scout, Pfc. FRANK MOON. The
entire squad, by creeping and crawling, crossed an open field and then rushed for thirty yards to
the cover of a sunken road. Pvt. ALBERT F. GROEGER hit the ground after dashing across the
field and was fatally wounded as he lay stretched out on the ground. The platoon was then ordered
to withdraw since it was discovered that they were 300 yards beyond their assigned objective.
Pfc. ROGER COREY directed tank fire on suspected German positions on two hills to cover
the platoon withdrawal. Then Sgt. WILLIAM MCGOWAN made it back and ordered two tanks
to move forward into a field to cover the evacuation of the fatally wounded GROEGER. This field
was very exposed, but Lieutenant FOX, the tank commander, was one of the few aggressive tank
men the regiment had experience with. Under the direction of Sgt. MCGOWAN and Sgt.
FRANCIS J. DUFFIN, Lieutenant FOX moved his tanks out and covered the withdrawal of the
men. One tanker was wounded. This action took place at 1300, and shortly thereafter the platoon
and tanks were back in Tolè and the defense of the town was set up.
The 3rd Platoon had followed the tanks out and were dug in along the road. As the tanks
and the 1st Platoon withdrew, they remained in position out there. Friendly aircraft searching
out enemy tanks dove and strafed the road, wounding T/Sgt. GEORGE E. KEARNS of the 3rd
Platoon. After the first plane dove and fired, the men displayed panels and shot up two yellow
flares. The second plane dove, but seeing the panels did not fire.
Tolè was shelled throughout the afternoon and evening. Artillery fire wounded Sgt. PETE
BRITO for the second time, and Pfc. EDWARD M. SCHUSTER, while bringing six prisoners from
the right. BRITO’s wound was treated by a captured German medic.
At 2200 Company G moved out on order to take Hill 687. On their way, led by the 2nd Platoon,
the company went through Baccuchi, clearing the buildings along the way. On the far side
of town Lieutenant JOSEPH H. SHEPHERD and his scout were fired on. Then the 3rd Platoon,
moving up on the right, had its lead group with Lieutenant JACK K. BENNETT fired on as they
came abreast of the 2nd Platoon. The tanks had left to refuel, but after a brief holdup, both platoons
moved forward in the dark and found the positions on the hill unoccupied. Company F
occupied the hill to the northeast, but there was a gap between the companies in which Company
F took 60 prisoners the next morning. The objective was secured at 2300 and the company dug in
for the night. During the entire day’s action 73 prisoners had been taken, and the company had
suffered eleven casualties. Other men wounded in Tolè by artillery fire were: Second Lieutenant
EVERET E. NORCROSS, JR., Pfc. ANTHONY S. KOWALSKI, Pfc. MICHAEL LAGUNA, Pfc.
MILFORD E. MILLER, and Pvt. WILLIAM P. RIDGEL.
COMPANY E—S. TRINITA
As Company E went east along the ridgeline to mop up Mt. Croce, with the 1st machine gun
platoon of Company H attached, they found no opposition, but the draw they had to go through
was blanketed with mortar and artillery fire. On Mt. Croce, from which the 3rd Battalion had
jumped off at 0620, were Colonel FOWLER, and Lieutenant Colonel NATIONS, who had come
back from the hospital the evening before to resume command of the 2nd Battalion. It was desired
that Company E attack to the north to take Baccuchi and San Trinita, two clusters of buildings
directly north on the road from Tolè, now held by Company G. Having little ammunition,
the company was unable to move out immediately. They sent back for ammunition, and while
waiting on Mt. Croce watched three unidentified tanks moving away on the Tolè-Baccuchi road.
They also could make out individual soldiers near the tanks. They were eager to open fire on
85
these targets, but did not dare on the possibility that they might be friendly. The targets moved
out of range.
At about 1400, the ammunition having arrived, the company moved off down the forward
slopes of Mt. Croce and passed through Torrello. The 2nd Platoon led, followed by the 1st and
3rd Platoons. On the way down, while moving through a draw, Pfc. CHARLES L. DOUGLAS of
the 1st Platoon was wounded by mortar fire. Upon reaching Baccuchi, the company ran into one
platoon of Company L of the 86th Infantry, who were pinned down and had suffered casualties
by flank fire coming from San Trinita. Presumably this fire was from the tanks previously seen
withdrawing. The company requested tank support. Some tank destroyers were already in the
vicinity, and others moved up under Captain PATCH. Lieutenant RICHARD L. CROOK’s 2nd
Platoon, which had been in the lead and which was consequently pinned down, was to attack on
the left and the 1st on the right, both to be supported by the TDs.
As they jumped off at 1800, tank fire was still coming in from the north, wounding Lieutenant
CROOK. After advancing some distance, Pfc. HARRY S. HART, also of the 2nd Platoon, was
hit. Before they reached San Trinita, two friendly planes dove on the attacking company and
strafed. Then they roared on, dropped bombs and strafed San Trinita before making their turn
and coming back. On the first run no one was hit, although one man’s bayonet was sheared off.
Yellow smoke signals were immediately set off to mark the company as friendly troops, but by
the time the plane had completed their strafing run and made their turn and circled back, the
smoke was completely expended. Sgt. JACK HEPFER of the 2nd Platoon, who had determinedly
lugged the colored phosphorescent identification panels, hastily spread them out, and the planes
pulled out of their dive without firing.
The company got excellent tank destroyer support, Captain PATCH being very aggressive,
and moved easily into San Trinita, taking eight prisoners. The wounded HART was taken back,
and the company dug in at San Trinita for the night. In the abandoned German dugouts, candles
were still burning, and the hungry men found cheese, bread, and German whiskey. Ironically,
their first rations since the jump-off reached them that evening. Heavy artillery, mortar, and
sniper fire hit the town during the night, and the Germans were still so close to the town that they
could be heard talking.
COMPANY H—MORTARS
Supporting the attack of Company G on Tolè, the 3rd Section of Company H at 0800 displaced
near the battalion and company CP at buildings between Hills 838 and 815. From here
several missions were fired on Tolè. At about 1000, the 1st and 2nd Sections moved up and
joined the 3rd. At 1500 the whole platoon moved to the vicinity of the battalion and company CP
at the village of Coste. They fired several missions at San Trinita and Tolè in support of the main
attack. They spent the night here.
1st Battalion—Le Coste Ridge
COMPANY B
Company B remained in its positions on Le Coste until 1700 on the 16th, when the 2nd Platoon
was ordered to go to the battalion CP several hundred yards to the east to act as security.
Just after having completed digging foxholes near the CP, under sporadic enemy mortar fire, the
platoon was ordered to move out and rejoin the company.
Retaining positions on Le Coste, the company was then spread out thinly on a defensive line
running east along a road south of Tolè. The positions ran from left to right, 1st, 3rd, and 2nd,
with the weapons attached to rifle platoons. Company C was on Hill 807 to the east, and A was
Apr 16
86
on Le Coste to the left. The 2nd Platoon found abandoned German foxholes to occupy for the
remainder of the night. At 2400 several replacements joined the company. Throughout the night
and the next morning, the road and ridgeline along which the company was stretched, received
shelling from heavy guns, but there were no casualties.
COMPANY A
Company A stayed on Le Coste throughout the day. After B extended over to the road junction
at Tolè, Company A moved over to join with B. Replacements arrived, but the company lost
more of their valuable men through shellfire. S/Sgt. BERTRAM A. BIDWELL, Sgt. HOWARD H.
BREITMEYER, Pfc. HERBERT F. HOLMGREN, Pfc. MICHAEL A. GUERRA and Pfc. WILLIAM
H. APLIN were all wounded.
On the morning of 16 April, Company C moved out to Le Coste and relieved Company F.
First Lieutenant ROBERT F. BOYER was in command, having rejoined the company during the
night after his recovery from a previous wound. In the evening, at 2200, the company moved to
the east again. They took positions on Mt. Croce at 2300, the 1st Platoon stopping on Hill 807 just
south of Tolè, which was in the hands of Company G.
Situation at the End of the Third Day
By the night of 16-17 April the biggest task of the 87th had been accomplished. The enemy
main line had been broken. The secondary line shown on captured enemy maps had been penetrated
by 86th and 87th units in front of San Trinita. The prisoner bag was swelling steadily, the
3rd Battalion alone taking more than 200 during the 16th.
On the 15th, Regiment had established a forward CP at 750 south of Hill 903. Consisting only
of the S-2 and S-3 sections, it was able to move quickly, jumping three times within eighteen
hours on the 17th in an effort to keep in close contact with the battalions. The regimental wire
section worked ceaselessly to keep all three battalions tied in to these changing locations.
During the night of the 16th, the 10th Anti-tank Battalion prepared to relieve the 1st Battalion,
87th, and free them for further advance to attack Mt. Serra through the 2nd Battalion not
later than 1500 on the 17th.
Information from IPW indicated that enemy defending companies were down to about 45
men. However, they had received orders for the morning to “hold to the last man.” General
HAYS gave the information that a column of enemy tanks was approaching along the road to
Tolè.
It was learned from a captured German officer that the Mt. Mosca attack had achieved some
surprise on the 3rd day, for the Reconnaissance Battalion of the 94th German Division defending
the ridge, had expected to be attacked from the southeast by the 1st Armored elements that had
taken Vergato. The opening of the road from Vergato to Tolè, announced during the night, reduced
the difficult and hazardous use of the narrow mountain trails. Units of the 1st Armored
Division were given priority on this road, and it soon became clogged with armored vehicles so
that regimental supply and evacuation were much delayed.
FOURTH DAY—17 APRIL
At 0910 of the 17th, General HAYS visited the CP and told Colonel FOWLER that the “breakthrough”
had been accomplished and that the 87th must “keep pushing and exploit the breakthrough.”
At 0925 all three battalion commanders were ordered to alert their units and be ready
to move fast. The regiment was ordered to push toward Mt. Serra and Mt. Prospero.
87
By 1200 noon, Major General HAYS was awaiting an answer to his call to Lieutenant General
LUCIAN K. TRUSCOTT, commanding general of the Fifth Army, as to how far north he could
push the Division.
2nd Battalion—Mt. Serra
COMPANY F—THE COOKS’ PATROL
Before their attack on Mt. Serra, Company F had a surprising action. On the night before,
during darkness, Captain JAMES C. KENNETT and Lieutenant DONALD M. DWYER walked
out on reconnaissance of their new position. After walking a short distance, they found themselves
almost surrounded by German voices, but it was too dark to see anything. They returned
and silently moved the 1st Platoon, now down to twenty-one men, and two machine guns out to
take up positions where they had heard the voices. They reinforced the platoon with mortar men
who were used as riflemen. At this time the 2nd Platoon had only sixteen men left, and the 3rd
but twenty-two. Sgt. GERALD O. HALVERSON had broken some ribs while diving into a foxhole
and had been evacuated.
At dawn, the 1st Platoon found themselves, in their forward positions, right on the edge of a
minefield and barbed wire entanglements, and only 100 yards from the German positions. The
Germans started toward the company, apparently innocent of their presence, and the forward
platoon opened up. S/Sgt. WILBUR WRIGHT of the mortar section hit two with his carbine. The
volley of fire from the close range surprised the advancing Germans and they dropped all their
weapons, except one machine gun they were carrying, and ran back. A sniper started firing from
the left, and S/Sgt. RUDOLPH W. KONIECZNY went off alone, promptly killed the sniper and
reported back. Sgt. KONIECZNY, who was AWOL from the hospital where he had been convalescing
from his previous wound, was piling up a large score of personal victims.
Then Sgt. WRIGHT asked for volunteers for a patrol to investigate the German strength in
front of the leading platoon. The mess sergeant, S/Sgt. BAYNE HILL, and the cooks, T/4 VERNE
HARTENSTEIN, and T/5 CHARLES DOLSON, and mortar men Sgt. MICHAEL DE BAGGIS,
Pfc. PALMER E. COUILLARD, already once wounded, and Pfc. EUGENE BURNS, all volunteered
for the mission. S/Sgt. PAUL STETTNER went along with a “536” radio and as interpreter.
WRIGHT led them carefully around the German flank to the right rear. From here they
could make out a series of trenches that completely covered the company’s positions. The patrol
had outflanked the Germans without being seen, and Sgt. WRIGHT was able to crawl to the end
of the trench and watch the heads of the enemy in a dugout 25 yards away. After getting a good
firing position he yelled at them in English to surrender. A Nazi warrant officer answered with a
burst from his automatic pistol. WRIGHT pulled his carbine trigger and killed the warrant officer.
That “broke the ice,” and with the officer dead, 52 Germans marched out of the dugout and
surrendered to WRIGHT and his cooks and mortar men. Sgt. STETTNER called five more from
another dugout. Then the platoon went through the dugouts, finding no less than ten machine
guns, many other automatic weapons, grenades, rifles, and all kinds of ammunition. The elaborate
bunkers had excellent camouflage, with wire netting, and were steel-shuttered and seemingly
impregnable.
COMPANY F—“BLOODY RIDGE”
At 0930 the company received orders to attack to the north and seize Mt. Serra. The 1st Battalion
was to go through to San Prospero. The battle for Mt. Serra, or “Bloody Ridge” as it was to
be called, was the grimmest that Company F was to encounter. The ridge itself was one of the
least imposing of the long list of hills and mountains captured by the regiment, but its defenders
put up probably the most determined resistance encountered by the 87th. The day had started
Apr 17
88
off smoothly for Company F, with over fifty prisoners and an elaborate fortification system taken
without a casualty, but the rest of the day was rough and bitter.
The company started out with the 2nd Platoon of machine guns from Company H attached.
The 3rd Platoon with one section of heavy machine guns led on the right. The 2nd Platoon was
slightly echeloned to the left on the other side of the road with the second section of “heavies,”
and the mortars, and the 1st Platoon followed the 2nd. As the platoons moved up toward the
series of three low knobs bending to the right and forming Mt. Serra, the men had to run to keep
up with the five supporting tanks. The 3rd Platoon to the right was fired upon from the first
knoll, which was to the left of the road bend. A squad leader of this platoon, S/Sgt. OLE B. DALEN,
lost his arm when struck by a Panzerfaust charge, and the platoon guide, S/Sgt. JAMES P.
RYAN, and Pfc. RANDOLPH HABURNE were killed by Panzerfaust charges. Pfc. ROBERT A.
CARLSON was hit here too.
As the 3rd Platoon men threw themselves to the ground, the 2nd Platoon broke into a run to
rush the knoll where the fire was coming from. Fire from further left killed Pfc. FLOYD H.
LUNSFORD, the scout for flank security, and wounded Pfc. WILLIAM M. SCANLON, Pfc. RENE
A. DI GIACOMO, and Sgt. ARTHUR J. COFFEY. The 1st Platoon rushed down after the 2nd.
They were to flank to the left if the 2nd were pinned down. Pfc. TONEY A. KNUTSEN and Pvt.
GEORGE C. SLIGER were wounded. At this time, two sections of machine guns were on each
side of the road, one on the left with the 2nd Platoon, and the other with the 3rd. One of the tanks
remained two or three hundred yards in the rear. As the men on the left came up the knoll, the
Germans were still there. They had no intention of retreating. One man from Company H killed
six Krauts with his carbine. Sgt. DAVID BURT killed one with his pistol. Many were killed from
a distance of three or four yards. Pfc. JOSEPH MCNEALUS came over the hill face-to-face with a
Nazi. Joe pulled the trigger faster. Two machine gunners from Company H, Sgt. BERNARD D.
RUTERBORIES and Pfc. JAMES GILLIES, JR. set their gun up over a foxhole; a German stuck his
head up from underneath and surrendered. The 2nd Platoon of Company H fought up forward
with the riflemen, the 2nd Section fighting savagely on the first knoll. The action was so furious
that it was remarkable that the platoon was able to keep together and well organized.
However, the 2nd Platoon, in spite of the desperate fighting on the knoll, managed to establish
a base of fire, using German foxholes and the defilade of a sunken road, and the help of the
heavy machine gunners on the knoll. Not that they had cleared the knoll in the usual sense, for it
was being fired on from every side, and the tanks were drawing all kinds of fire. But the platoon
and attached gun were nevertheless able to deliver a terrific volume of fire—both light and heavy
machine guns being right up on the line. Pfc. HUGH B. GIVENS was shell-shocked here and
evacuated.
On the way up, Sgt. KONIECZNY went off on another one of his frequent solo missions to
clear out a bunker. He was never seen alive again, and the details of his death are not known.
Later, members of the company found his helmet near two German bunkers, but couldn’t locate
the body. It was found later, some distance away at the foot of the hill. Sgt. KONIECZNY had
just been promoted to Technical Sergeant, but he never heard the news. With the death of
KONIECZNY, the 87th lost one of its oldest and most colorful members. From his exploits on
skis at Mt. Rainier to the two BARs he managed to fire simultaneously in the Apennines,
KONIECZNY’s exploits were legendary. He might have been safe in a hospital bed from his previous
wound; but no hospital could hold him when his outfit was jumping off.
Under the covering fire of the 2nd Platoon, Lieutenant FLOYD E. ALEXANDER led the 3rd
Platoon, and the attached heavy machine gun section forward to the group of buildings on the
second knoll under severe artillery fire. Pfc. ANDREW KEREKES was injured on the movement.
89
One tank stayed back by the first knoll and three went on with the 3rd Platoon. Pfc. ROBERT H.
MCCAIG was wounded at noon by artillery at the houses. From the houses Lieutenant ALEXANDER
pushed on with only sixteen men toward the third knoll.
Heavy fire pinned them down 100 yards beyond the houses, and the tanks were ordered on
to support them. Two of them moved up, followed by the third. The platoon moved on another
250 yards and gained a hold on the objective, the third knoll. Here Pfc. WILLIAM E. FISHER was
wounded and Pfc. HOWARD KUMPULA seriously injured his leg. Since the tanks’ aerials were
shot away, communication with one another was impossible. One tank started to swing its turret
around to fire at a knocked-out German tank, now occupied by our machine gunners. The men
couldn’t make the tankers hear to stop them, so machine gunner Pfc. GORDON E. SUNDSTROM
jumped up on the tank, which was drawing machine gun fire from front and both sides. He
stopped the tank from firing and miraculously was not hit. Captain KENNETT, too, climbed up
on the tanks as bullets rang against their steel armor, to point out targets. The tanks started to
withdraw in spite of Captain KENNETT climbing up on their hulls and issuing direct orders to
stay. A tracer bullet struck the rear end of one tank and fired up the blankets and gear lashed on
the outside. The crew leaped out, abandoning the undamaged tank. The other two tanks retreated
behind the buildings, leaving the remnants of the 3rd Platoon forward on the third knoll
without tank support, and drawing high-velocity fire onto the buildings in which the supporting
machine guns were located.
Some men of Company H were hit, and Pfc. MORRIS J. KRIEGER of Company F was killed.
After the heavy machine gun section had set up in a house and fired five long bursts, six rounds
from a German self-propelled gun crashed into the building, knocking out one of the guns. The
men came under terrific fire. Some time about 1400 the machine guns were running low on ammunition.
The three heavies alone fired 9,000 rounds during the attack, and the .50-caliber fired
another 1,000.
Pfc. ROBERT A. MOTHERWELL volunteered to go back from the forward position and get
some ammunition from the carriers. On the way to the rear he was hit in the leg by a sniper. He
went on in spite of his wound. As he came forward within shouting distance of the guns, he was
hit again, by artillery, and couldn’t go any further. He was able to yell to the men, and they came
and got the ammunition.
Due to lack of ammunition, however, and the scant number of men left, Lieutenant ALEXANDER
bitterly brought his squad-sized platoon back to the shelter of the houses on the second
knoll. High-velocity fire, attracted by the tanks, was whizzing in at the houses, tearing the roofs
and striking one heavy machine gun. Also mortar fire was falling in the area, one direct hit killing
Pfc. FRED J. ANETSBERGER and seriously wounding Pfc. HANSON A. COOK from Company
H in their machine gun dugout. ANETSBERGER had killed seven Nazis before his death.
Other Company H men were hit and knocked about. The heavy machine guns took an aggressive
front-line part in the action. Sgt. DONALD B. WALES, while taking his gun out of action,
was knocked off his feet, stunned and wounded. He was able to walk back, and he took with
him some F Company casualties. A British 5.5 artillery observer and his radio operator were both
killed. Sgt. FORREST RYAN, a machine gunner, was in a foxhole with his second gunner. He
had his hand on the other man’s knee when a piece of shrapnel penetrated the hand. The second
gunner, thus saved from a wound in his knee, cried out in annoyance, “Son of a gun, I’m cheated
out of a million-dollar wound!”
Throughout the action Captain KENNETT ran back and forth all over the area. He tried desperately
to keep the tanks up with Lieutenant ALEXANDER to support his men. When their
aerials were shot away, he recklessly climbed up on the bullet-splattered tanks to point out en90
emy machine gun targets. When the luggage and gear lashed on the rear of one tank had been
set on fire, and the tank abandoned by the crew in panic, Captain KENNETT ran up and unlashed
the five-gallon can for the water that his men so badly needed. Then he ran around
among the men with water and ammunition, inspiring them by his lack of concern for himself.
So hot had been the firing and scarce the water, that one machine gun crew, when their gun went
dry, passed a can from foxhole to foxhole to collect urine. This they poured into the machine gun
water jacket.
At about 1500, the foxhole on the first knoll, used as a CP, received a direct hit. Killed was
Pfc. THOMAS I. MALLOY, and fatally wounded were Second Lieutenant MELO VUKOVICH
and Second Lieutenant CLARENCE K. MUSICK. Wounded were First Lieutenant HAROLD F.
ROSSI, 1st Sgt. ALEX MILLER, and Pfc. MARIO S. CALCAGNO, and three men from artillery.
Pfc. LESTER L. ALLISON of Company H was killed by the same hit, and a sergeant of H Company
was wounded in the legs.
Immediately afterwards, S/Sgt. NELSON COCHRANE, Sgt. DAVID BURT, Sgt.
MELINKOVITCH, Sgt. WILBUR WRIGHT, and Pfc. STANLEY GOSNAY organized the men
around the CP, cut trees and prepared litters, and carried the casualties down to the aid station
under intense shellfire. Pfc. JULIUS G. SUSTARIC was wounded in the chest by a sniper as he
helped evacuate the wounded. He crawled for about 250 yards to near the aid station, where he
lost consciousness and was picked up and taken to the aid station. The wiremen, Sgt. THOMAS
CORRIGAN, Pfc. JACOB BOYCE and Pfc. JOHN POWERS were just reaching the CP, and they
helped evacuate the wounded.
By 1700 the company finally received the order issued by Battalion much earlier to stay back
in place and let Company E pass through. There were less than eighty men left in the company.
Before Company E passed through, some TDs came up and did some good. Then an old tank
officer ran out on the field and organized the tanks and led up some new ones, which supported
Company E. When E passed through, they were well supported by Company F, Company H,
and the tanks.
Four hundred and fifty Germans were captured on the hill. One of them remarked in good
English, “Well, this wasn’t as easy a one to take as the others have been, was it?” Few Nazi
comments are so close to the truth. Company F, with less than 100 men, had been attacking a
well-fortified hill defended by 500 Germans. Odds of five-to-one against the attacking force is
not even mentioned in the books.
COMPANY E—MT. SERRA
In the morning Colonel NATIONS arrived at San Trinita to go over the situation with Captain
PENDREY. Company E was to the right of F on Hill 693, ready to attack Mt. Serra. Company
E waited in place during the attack. Artillery and mortar fire started falling on the buildings
at San Trinita, killing a radio operator from the 84th Chemical Warfare Service. Lieutenant
GORDON ANDERSON effectively returned fire with his chemical mortars. Colonel ROSS WILSON,
commanding the 1st Battalion, arrived at about noon to make a reconnaissance in preparation
for his battalion to tie in its attack on San Prospero. The 1st Battalion had been slow to move
its companies from the defensive positions along the Le Coste ridge until properly relieved by the
85th Infantry, and the companies weren’t yet past Tolè.
The 1st machine gun platoon of Company H, attached to Company E, had supported the attack
of Company F on Mt. Serra. Their guns at San Trinita ran out of ammunition at about 1400.
They had fired 9,000 rounds from three .30-calibers, and 1,000 rounds from the .50s. More ammunition
was gotten up to them 45 minutes later. German medics were observed most of the
Apr 17
91
day, apparently bringing up ammunition. They never took back a casualty, although there were
six of them running to German positions all day long under Red Cross flag immunity. Both the
1st and 2nd Battalions had CPs in the San Trinita church, and Colonel WILSON finally ordered
fire from the platoon on the bogus medics.
At 1600 Company E was ordered to pass through F at 1700 to take the final objective on Mt.
Serra. They jumped off at 1710, moving along to the right of the ridge under its cover on the reverse
slope from enemy fire. There, on the right of the road, the supporting tanks ran into a
German minefield. The clearing of these mines momentarily held up the attack, but they soon
caught up. An excellent artillery preparation and effective supporting fire from Company H was
laid down. The 2nd machine gun platoon fired support for Company E, as they had with F. Four
of the tanks that had supported F joined the tanks and TDs with E. As soon as the company,
flanking around F, came abreast, the leading 3rd Platoon built up a base of fire with one squad.
Another squad flanked around to the right. By well-executed fire and movement the squads and
platoons advanced from commanding ground to commanding ground.
Beyond the second knob the 3rd Platoon remained in supporting positions and the 1st Platoon
then advanced in the same manner and seized the third and last knob. In the 3rd Platoon
Pvt. RALPH HUBBARD was killed and Pfc. BERNARD V. GILLARD was wounded by sniper
fire. The 2nd Platoon, in reserve between the second and third knolls, had many casualties from
artillery, some after the hill was taken. Wounded were: S/Sgt. CLIFFORD A. NOBLE, Sgt.
THEODORE M. BRINK, Pfc. EDWARD J. PRICE and Pfc. OTIS H. NIBLETT.
From the weapons platoon S/Sgt. JOSEPH E. LONGPRE, Pfc. FRANCIS J. MCCABE, Pfc.
WILLIAM F. TILLMAN, and Pfc. FREDERIC G. KINSON from company headquarters, were
wounded. GILLARD had been the lead scout for the 3rd Platoon. He was hit on the side of his
head by sniper fire and painfully wounded. After throwing his hand grenades, he crawled back
to the machine guns and lay on the ground by them directing their fire to targets he had seen.
The two machine gun squad leaders, Sgt. FRANCIS J. BLAIS and Sgt. HENRY C. CHASE, had
their machine guns right behind the scout. From there they engaged targets of opportunity and
built up tremendous bases of fire as the squads flanked forward. At times they had to be held
back lest they pass the scouts. Sgt. BLAIS was alone with his machine gun at the end of the action.
Pfc. ROBERT H. LATHROP was killed while bringing up ammunition for BLAIS’ gun, and
BLAIS started to get a litter for LATHROP as he died.
More than 25 of the enemy were killed and 150 prisoners were taken. Lieutenant JOHN J.
DOHERTY, crawling up to one dugout, threw in several grenades and fired into it. Seventeen
prisoners walked out. DOHERTY, weapons platoon leader, was up in the front action throughout,
directing machine gun fire.
Early in the battle, a BAR team, advancing around the right, took 25 prisoners, including one
high-ranking officer. This team, acting First Sergeant OWEN W. THOMPSON and Pfc. TOBIAS
BAUER, went after some Germans waving a white flag, pointed out to them by tankers. When
they came in sight, one of the Germans was setting up a machine gun. They killed him instantly,
and the others surrendered. Sgt. BURTON BATCHELLER moved some of the 1st Platoon onto
the exposed forward slope to fire on enemy at San Prospero to support the 1st Battalion attack.
The company reorganized and dug in. The 2nd Platoon of H, under Lieutenant EDWIN H.
RICHARDSON, moved out with them. They stayed on Mt. Serra all night under some light mortar
fire. Pfc. JOHN LYONS was hit, not seriously, and did not report to the medics until the next
day. The company had received six replacements on the 15th and ten on the 16th. They stayed
on Mt. Serra throughout the next day.
92
1st Battalion—San Prospero
COMPANY C
Company C was pulled back to an assembly area south of Mt. Croce in the morning. They
were told that the 2nd Battalion would take Mt. Serra and the 1st Battalion would move through
them to San Prospero. At 1300 the company moved to the forward assembly area behind two
companies of the 2nd Battalion near San Trinita, where the company leaders were given an orientation.
Shortly after jumping off, the 3rd Platoon on the left and the 1st on the right crossed over
the ridge and started down the long open forward slope that stretched out more than 1,000 yards
to the north. Here the terrain was more gentle, with more rolling, grassy hills than the terrain of
the opening days of the offensive. The attack had broken through the rugged wall of rocky,
wooded mountains from Hill 903 to Mt. Mosca. However, some of the roughest terrain ever
fought over still remained.
As the 3rd Platoon moved down, Company F was still fighting bitterly for Mt. Serra on the
left, and C came into machine gun, mortar, and artillery fire as they came abreast. They were
able to keep moving until two or three hundred yards from the houses beyond La Ca. Here a
machine gun opened up on the platoon after allowing the scouts, runner, platoon leader, and
four men of the 3rd Squad to go by. The platoon lay flat in the tall grass unable to move. Only
those men without packs were safe as the bullets mowed across the grass tops. Pfc. MANFRED
BUTLER was fatally hit in the neck by machine gun fire, and Pfc. ROBERT N. GANZ, JR. was
wounded as his rifle grenade was detonated. T/Sgt. DONALD E. MIRON and S/Sgt. GEORGE
L. MYER were both hit in the hand as artillery started coming in as soon as the platoon hit the
ground. Pvt. RICHARD W. HAWK was also wounded by artillery.
Fire from mortars and Company D’s heavy machine guns, as well as rifle grenades, were put
on the enemy machine gun positions, but it didn’t stop the gun. The reason was discovered later.
The gun was being traversed and fired by a system of ropes and pulleys ingeniously controlled
from a deep safe dugout a little way off. All the elements of the platoon, except the one squad
pinned down before the gun, were able to swing further to the right. The 1st Platoon was able to
move forward and take the buildings, although in doing so T/5 BILL PORTOLOS was wounded
in the leg. The company command group, supposedly following the 1st Platoon on the right,
suddenly found itself following a single squad that had gotten way off to the right. They moved
up toward La Ca. By this time, the pinned-down squad, by crawling through the grass and by
individual dashes, had extricated itself, and the 1st Platoon had withdrawn to the rearmost group
of houses where the entire company reorganized. Pvt. EVERETT L. JONES had been wounded,
and Pvt. WILLIAM E. HEMSTREET had been killed during the action.
It was decided to circle around to the right, down into and along an old creek bed. The 2nd
and 3rd Platoons were to make a combat reconnaissance up to the town. They moved without
difficulty to a point below and to the right of town in the creek bed. Here they had excellent support
from the tanks, which had been reorganized and taken over on Mt. Serra by a tank officer
with a more aggressive spirit. The tanks came rolling right down the main road to San Prospero
atop the ridge, banging away at the town. Excellent support also came from 105s and 75s, and
British 5.5s. Under cover of this barrage in the late afternoon the 2nd Platoon on the left went up
a steep side road into town, while the 3rd in defilade filed up a traversing trail into the east edge
of town. The rest of the company followed the 2nd up the road in a column of twos. The Germans,
expecting to be attacked from the west, were stunned as they were caught pouring out of
basements to man positions. Sixty-four prisoners were taken, and another twenty-seven the next
morning.
Apr 17
93
A sniper in the church hit machine gunner Sgt. DAN T. BENNER of the weapons platoon and
Pvt. JESSE N. BAIRD. BENNER was slightly wounded by fragments from his own grenade,
which was shattered, but not exploded, by the sniper’s bullet. The 3rd Platoon got into a house
with an Italian family in it. They claimed no Germans had been there for three or four months.
From the basement the soldiers dragged out a German medical captain and twelve men, three of
them wounded.
On the west side of town another machine gun was found rigged up with ropes and pulleys
to be fired from a dugout. On this side of town too, at dusk, Lieutenant JOHN W. HAWK and
the 2nd Platoon was fired on. Two BAR men, Pfc. WILLIAM THOMAS and Pfc. ROBERT E. DE
WICK, dropped to the road and crawled along the bank to where they could fire into the house.
They threw in grenades and fired rile grenades. During lulls in the firing they could hear the
Germans talking inside. They set the building on fire, but the Germans got away in the dark,
abandoning three machine guns.
During the evening one of the strangest incidents of the campaign took place. Sixty of the
prisoners with five guards were sent down the ridge road that ran back to the south to our rear.
It was getting dark as they started out, and the lead guard soon picked up tank tracks in the dirt
road and followed them. Unfortunately, the tracks had been made by German tanks and shortly
made a sharp turn off to the west and northwest. Mile after mile the column followed the road
that wound its way deep into Kraut territory. They passed a couple of stray Krauts, but it was
dark and apparently no one was sure who the other party was. In any case, the Krauts didn’t
challenge and the guards with the sixty prisoners allowed the armed Krauts to go along the road,
possibly thinking them deserters.
A little further on they met an unmistakable German mule train, which they captured, making
the driver a prisoner and driving off the mules. It finally began to dawn on them that they
had taken the wrong road. They turned around and started back. After returning about a halfmile,
they were fired upon by a German machine gun to the right of the road at a close range of
ten to fifteen yards. The burst of fire hit a good many of the prisoners. The lead guard, Pfc. WILLIAM
THOMAS, scrambled up onto the bank and emptied his pistol into the machine gun position,
seven rounds point-blank from the edge of the hole. Then, since the column had scattered
or lay dead on the road, and since they were still deep in German territory, THOMAS and another
guard made their way directly back to the company. The company wrote the prisoners off
as lost.
However, Pfc. ALLEN BRILL and Pfc. GLENN DORCHEUS, after the firing abruptly ended,
reorganized and rounded up the prisoners, both the well and the wounded, and got them back
on the road. The enemy medical officer, previously mentioned, and several German aid men
patched the wounds. Thirty-eight were mustered to start back to the lines, some of the wounded
being carried. A short distance below San Prospero, BRILL, marching in the rear, was tapped on
the shoulder by an armed German sentry and spoken to in German. BRILL swung around, disarmed
the surprised Nazi, and shoved him into the column without breaking the column’s cadence.
They came back through the lines with 39 prisoners. Of the sixty they started with, they
felt sure that ten or twelve were killed on the road by the short-range machine gun burst.
Throughout the night Company C, in San Prospero, could clearly hear large numbers of
German horse-drawn vehicles moving out to the north. Unfortunately, artillery communication
was out, and the tanks were unable to get up the steep road into town to bring direct fire on the
fleeing enemy. A fine opportunity was missed.
With the daylight of 18 April, Germans were uncovered all over the company area. Men out
looking for eggs from the friendly Italians had Tedeschi pointed out to them. One group brought
94
back nine, five of whom were wounded. Another man climbed out of his foxhole to relieve himself
at dawn, and stopped, as he looked down onto two Germans in the next foxhole. Later in the
morning a deserter directed the men to a house where they interrupted ten Germans in various
stages of shaving, cleaning weapons, washing and sleeping. They were perfectly willing to come,
but first they demanded time to wash and pack. After a rather indelicate American command
from Pfc. WALTER HOFFMAN of company headquarters, they hustled out unwashed and unpacked.
Altogether, twenty-seven prisoners were collected in the morning.
HOFFMAN was then sent out with two men and a BAR to get seven other Germans who
were reported to be willing to surrender. However, when they were spotted, they were armed
and working their way carefully up a draw toward them. A brief firefight followed. Although
the Germans waved a white flag, they returned the fire. Two of them were hit and the other five
were chased but without success. By the time they returned, the company, having been relieved
by Company F, had pulled out at about 1400. The company spent the night of 18-19 April east of
Merlano under occasional heavy artillery fire.
COMPANY D
Company D moved up on mules for the attack on San Prospero. The mortar platoon got lost
while Lieutenant THOMAS H. COLLINS and Captain J. DUANE VANCE made their reconnaissance.
As they were going through Tolè they caught one of the terrific barrages laid on the little
town. Quick action on the part of T/Sgt. RUDOLPH WUOTILA saved the platoon from casualties.
As the barrage was moving up the main road toward them, he led the platoon off onto a
trail, and joined the command group south of San Prospero. Lieutenant KENNETH W. ALPERT,
company executive officer, received word by radio to rush two jeeps of ammunition to a point
south of San Prospero. Supply sergeant HARRY HINSLEY, delivering the ammunition, stopped
the jeeps as he hit the barrage at Tolè, and the men came under sniper fire as they sought cover.
He moved forward alone and got six prisoners from a building just beyond Tolè. Then he raced
on with his jeeps and reached the designated point ahead of the battalion. He sat waiting with
the jeeps loaded with ammunition until the battalion arrived. Over on his left rear, the 2nd Battalion
was attacking Mt. Serra.
COMPANIES A AND B
At approximately 1030, the 1st Battalion was ordered to move out to an assembly area in the
rear of Mt. Croce. Then the battalion, with Company C leading, moved almost due north behind
the 2nd Battalion to a position on the reverse slope of a gently sloping ridge just south of San
Trinita. Here they were able to get “wonderful cool water.” Companies A and B remained there
for 24 hours while Company C took San Prospero. During the afternoon and evening, a twentyman
detail from Company B manhandled a re-supply of ammunition all the way up into San
Prospero from San Trinita.
At Bortolani, where the aid station was shelled on the morning of the 18th, five scout observers
of the 1st Battalion S-2 section were withdrawing from the battalion OP to rejoin the companies
for the march to Merlano. As they sat in the shelter of a stone house, a shell clipped the roof
corner and exploded in midair. Wounded were: Pfc. WALTER S. BOURNE, Pfc. LEWIS J.
FLETCHER, Pfc. DONALD H. HENDERSON, Pfc. WALTER LAUBER, and Pfc. ROBERT A.
VON NEUMANN. Five other men were wounded and one killed by the same freak burst.
3rd Battalion—Mop-up to C. Costa
In the morning, while Company F prepared to attack Mt. Serra, the 3rd Battalion moved
north, three companies abreast, past Madna di Rodiano to mop up the valley beyond. Around
and in Madna di Rodiano were dozens of dead, both Nazis and American. Twenty German bod-
Apr 17
95
ies were counted in one building alone, and there were many of ours out in the woods nearby.
The high ground by the town will always be hallowed ground for men of the 87th, where so
many 3rd Battalion men had died the day before. The 3rd Battalion had completed the breakthrough,
and other units had already started the fast drive for the valley of the Po. Already the
86th had moved across the threshold and were well out on the ever-diminishing hills to the
north. The 1st Armored units were expected to move out too, along the road through Tolè and
down into the valley of the Samoggia River.
The companies crossed the valley abreast almost without incident. The day was extremely
warm and the march long. A good many men dropped out from heat exhaustion. Two prisoners
were picked up in the valley and another one was taken from an artillery position. They offered
no resistance. One hastily laid minefield was discovered and dug up. Lieutenant RUSSELL M.
MCJURY, suffering from sickness, left Company I and was wounded at the aid station. Sgt.
KENNETH D. ARMSTRONG of Company K was wounded by a single round of artillery. Early
in the afternoon the company closed and dug in at the battalion area around the town of C. Costa.
Here the terrain was more open, the gently rolling fields cut up by stonewalled lanes, and with
only occasional trees. The battalion could see heavy artillery barrages landing on the roads in the
Tolè area to their left where the roads were jammed with tanks and trucks heading north.
Around the town were many abandoned artillery pieces. A little distance away, one was still
firing into the battalion area. Captain JOSEPH J. DUNCAN sent a patrol with Lieutenant WALTER
P. STILLWELL, JR. to locate it and knock it out. Captain DUNCAN himself, his runner, Pfc.
WALTER F. SMITH, JR., Lieutenant HARRISON H. KING from Company M, and Pfc. ALBERT
E. SORIA, the radio man, crawled up to watch from a very exposed OP in order to give the patrol
what support it might need. Their position must have been observed, for a shell struck the rock
ledge just above their heads, killing Captain DUNCAN and Pfc. SMITH, and fatally wounding
Lieutenant KING. Captain DUNCAN’s death removed a brilliant and inspiring leader from our
ranks; his continual regard for his men’s welfare and his repeated personal heroism won not
merely the respect, but the love, of his men and associates. His loss was greatly mourned by all,
even at a time when there were so many fine men to mourn for. Lieutenant WILBUR S. SHEETS
assumed command of L Company. The battalion remained in place for the night.
Situation at the End of the Fourth Day
For the fifth day it was planned for the 86th and 87th to continue the attack. The 85th was
ordered to prepare to push past the 87th and through the 86th to spearhead the continuing drive
north toward the valley of the Po. The left boundary of the Division’s advance was defined as the
Samoggia River, and the 87th was assigned to hold and mop up the left part of the Division Zone.
In accordance with this directive, the 2nd Battalion was ordered to hold open the doorway from
Tolè to San Prospero so that the 1st Armored Division could move through and get abreast of the
10th Mountain Division by moving rapidly past San Prospero to the main road on the west bank
of the Samoggia River. For the past four days, the left flank of the 87th had been exposed, and all
looked forward to the comparative security to be provided by the “tankers” working abreast of
the regiment. This rosy prospect never fully materialized. The other two battalions of the regiment
were directed to move rapidly north in the assigned zone and mop up the few pockets of
resistance that might still remain. This mopping up, however, was not to delay the forward
movement of the leading elements. They were to bypass the resistance and push on.
96
FIFTH DAY—18 APRIL
This was the beginning of the pursuit following the breakthrough. These phases cannot immediately
be recognized by the troops of a regiment. The division commander, General HAYS,
undoubtedly recognized it, and tried to instill into all his troops the urgency of bypassing resistance
and continually driving ahead—something like Farragut’s “Damn the torpedoes! Go
ahead!”
Information of the enemy was increasingly vague. No one knew where he could go with
safety, or where he would meet a stubborn, fanatical enemy. Units began to operate with greater
distances between them; control by radio became the normal means of communication; GIs began
to realize why they had been required to make 25-mile hikes in Texas. Officers remarked, “They
never taught us this at Benning!” Those who referred to their field manuals to learn what should
be done during a ”pursuit” were disappointed to find just one short paragraph of generalities.
Later, as the campaign unfolded, these officers realized that no one could foresee the variety of
fantastic incidents that make up “the big picture.”
3rd Battalion—Savigno
In the morning, the 3rd Battalion was ordered to mop up the area to the north as far as the
Samoggia River. Company K moved out at 0800 with L on the right, and marched up onto an
open ridge to the north without resistance. At 1100 the company reached the high ground overlooking
Savigno down on the river. Colonel FOWLER arrived and directed that a company go
down into the valley to clean out the town and seize the bridge just beyond. Nothing was known
of the enemy situation in the town. The 2nd Platoon of Company K was sent straight into town,
while the rest of the company made a wide flank on the left with the mission of attempting to join
the 1st Armored Division tank elements moving down the valley toward the town. The 2nd Platoon
moved rapidly and entered the town.
An Italian civilian had declared that there was no enemy in the town, but the streets were
ominously deserted. There were no cheering people to welcome them. The 3rd Squad moved
directly down the main street. The 2nd Squad swung around to the right of town to meet them
on the far side. Lieutenant TOIVO O. RANTA, the platoon leader, followed the 1st Squad. There
was some scattered sniper fire, but they moved rapidly through the buildings finding only one
dead German. They found the road junction at the end of town to be mined, and as the squads
reached this point they were opened up on by a machine gun from across the river. The 3rd
Squad holed up in a convenient building to cover the 2nd Squad which had joined them from the
right, and which now moved out again to the right toward the bridge. The road to the bridge ran
parallel to the river, and was up on a fill affording cover from the machine gun for the squad
moving on its right. After they were sufficiently far down the river from the machine gun, the
going on the right became impossible, and they crossed the road through a hole in the thick
hedgerow. As the first man popped through the hole out onto the field by the river, two machine
guns directly across the river from them opened up at a range of 150 to 200 yards. It was a set-up
for a machine gunner. An ideal range, and the ten men popping into an open field. The men
claim that an American with a BAR couldn’t have missed getting all of them. No one was hit by
the initial bursts, and the men lay flat on the field “sweating it out.”
Captain ROGER EDDY, at about the same time, came under fire from one of the guns firing
from a house just across the river. One at a time, since the hole was only large enough for one,
each man jumped up, ran, and dove through the hole, scrambling across the road. Each time the
machine guns fired. No evasive action was possible, for there was but one hole as plain as a
Apr 18
97
bulls-eye, and every man in the field went through it with bullets zinging around him. No one
was hit. For such a target some of the men would have changed sides!
Captain EDDY decided this was a job for the TDs or tanks, and radioed for armored support.
The 1st Armored unit had been stopped way up the river. The battalion commander instructed
them to wait where they were for the TDs to arrive to support them. One TD soon appeared and
fired six rounds into houses across the river. Then the TD started up a side road into town. It
blew a mine in the road and was disabled, although no one was hurt.
Meanwhile, the 1st Armored elements had been approaching from up the river, and their
first tank arrived in town at just about the time the TD hit the mine. As the medium tank cruised
about the town, the 2nd Platoon withdrew. The company was then ordered up onto the high
ground to continue the advance. The company climbed back, and bivouacked with Company D
near Merlano for the night.
COMPANY L—SAVIGNO
In the morning L moved out on the right of K down into the valley of the Samoggia River.
Part of Company K went through the town of Savigno and came under intense machine gun fire
from across the river. Later, Company L, heading for the bridge, received some fire which killed
Pfc. RICHARD B. NOCITRA and wounded Sgt. RUSSELL W. BERG. After one TD and one tank
of the 1st Armored Division arrived and relieved Company K, part of a platoon of Company L
moved out and dug in along the river bank, while two rifle squads of the 2nd Platoon, with bazookas,
and one section of light machine guns went across the river to guard the bridge. The rest
of the company dug in to the rear of the town in a field.
After the tank had come and gone through the town, foot elements came in and were opened
up on, and pinned down, by a machine gun sniper.
At 2330 Company L was ordered by radio to pull out and up onto the hill overlooking the
town and bridge. It took the rest of the night to collect all of the men from the scattered positions
across the river, and to lead them back up the hill.
COMPANY I—BATTALION RESERVE
Company I remained throughout the day in battalion reserve, while K and L mopped up
Savigno on the bank of the Samoggia River. Company I moved up beyond Mt. Nonascoso. They
were then ordered to assemble near Mongiorgio. As they approached this town they ran into
elements of the 1st Battalion, so they holed up in the fields east of Mongiorgio. The company encountered
no artillery, which was a glorious experience for the men.
1st Battalion—Merlano
COMPANY A—MOP UP
Company A moved out to the battalion assembly area, behind the 2nd Battalion, at San
Trinita, on the morning of the 18th. There they waited from 1000 to 1200. They were then given
the mission of mopping up along the Division left flank from San Trinita to Merlano. As they
moved along the gently rolling ridgeline, some German 88 fire wounded Pfc. MAX B.
KUHLMAN, and two brand new replacements, Cpl JOHN H. HAYWORTH and Pvt. JOHN R.
FORBES, JR. They entered the town of Merlano with scouts and point forward. The leading elements
expected to be fired on at any moment. Cautiously moving into the main street, they were
surprised to come upon Captain TOM STEWART of Battalion Headquarters, shaving himself in
the street. He and Lieutenant DARROCK CROOKES and Cpl. OLIVER ANDREWS, JR. had entered
the town in advance of everyone else.
Apr 18
98
At 1700 orders were received to attack Mongiorgio. Company B, supported by TDs, was to
attack around the right. Company A was to attack directly. Mongiorgio was the first of several
riverside towns to be encountered by the regiment. It was built high on a commanding pinnacle,
walled in and surrounded by cliffs like a medieval fortress. As Company A reached the second
of a series of deep draws which ran from a ridgeline down towards the river on their left, they
received sniper and automatic weapons fire coming up the draw from across the river. They
swung to their right behind Company B. Here artillery fire hit them and they couldn’t move.
They dug in. This was heavy-caliber shellfire, many of them delayed-action 170s or 210s that
threatened to dig them right out of their foxholes. The company moved to a new area, and received
shellfire there too. They moved three times in succession trying to evade these shells
which dug huge craters. Lieutenant DONALD FOX was wounded by clods of dirt that struck
him in the face as they reached their new area. Although half-blinded by blood, he refused aid
until he had the men in position. Also wounded in the company were: S/Sgt. GEORGE C.
MCCUTCHEN, Pfc. JOE FLORES, Pfc. DONALD A. HAYNES, and Pfc. BURTON C.
NEUMEYER. Two men from another company nearby were killed in the area, and a tank was
knocked out. At 2000, the message came that the attack was delayed till morning, and the company
was to dig in for the night.
COMPANY B—SULMONTE
Around noon of the 18th, Company B began a march. It did not end until they reached Sulmonte
that night. Passing along the ridges on the other side of the valley east of San Prospero,
the company moved unopposed through hilly country to a ridge overlooking Mongiorgio and
Sulmonte. By then it was late afternoon. At 1800 Companies A and B were ordered to attack
Mongiorgio, passing through a battalion of the 86th Infantry to do so. The attack was to be made
with six tanks, with the 2nd Platoon on the left of the road and the 1st on the right. However,
only five tanks jumped off with the company. They advanced in good formation across level,
grassy country, but one of the tanks pushed on ahead of the company up the road. When it had
almost reached Sulmonte, and was for the moment backing and filling, trying to make a rightangle
turn, it was directly hit by a round from a German TD and knocked out.
At almost the same time, the flat open ridge along which Company B was advancing was
swept by grazing machine gun fire from the direction of Mongiorgio. The 2nd Platoon, fortunately,
had joined the 1st on the right side of the road, and the company advanced by rushes in
the direction of Sulmonte. At the same time, heavy shells began to drop right in, and the whole
company raced for cover under the protection of the steep reverse slope of Sulmonte. Pfc. ANDREW
R. SISENSTEIN and Pfc. AUSTIN C. WHEELER were wounded. Together with a company
from the 86th Infantry, they dug in there for the night. The Germans were throwing some
very heavy shells, but they all cleared the ridge. There were no casualties, but very little sleep.
Company C, as has been noted, bivouacked near Merlano.
COMPANY D
Company D reached the vicinity of Mongiorgio late in the afternoon behind Companies A
and B. The mortar platoon had 900 rounds of ammunition ready. One section of Lieutenant
ANTSELM R. BRADLEY’s 1st Platoon was attached to each of the attacking companies. Lieutenant
WILLIAM S. SPINNEY’s 2nd Platoon was kept in general support. From behind the line of
departure, east of Mongiorgio, the mortar platoon was not able to reach the town, so they moved
forward 600 yards, putting them beyond the line of departure. It developed that an enemy sniper
outpost lay between the line of departure and the mortars. The 37-mm pack howitzers of the battalion
fired at these enemy dugouts, and Lieutenant SPINNEY’s heavy machine guns chased the
enemy as they fled from the dugouts down the hill on the left hand side. This happened at about
Apr 18
99
1800. The mortars were able to register on Mongiorgio and on the enemy reverse slope. When
the attack was called off until morning, the men spent the night in position.
2nd Battalion—Mop Up to San Prospero
Companies E and F rested in position. Company G at 1100 moved out on a mop-up operation,
going over onto the forward slope and working north on the high ground parallel to the
Samoggia River as far north as San Prospero. One platoon from Company H was attached for
this operation. They met no opposition, and spent the night in San Prospero, previously taken by
the 1st Battalion.
During the morning, the 1st Platoon of H stayed in place receiving a complete ration and water.
The Italians came back to their houses from their hiding places in the woods, and furnished
the men with wash water. Their packs caught up with them, as well as the new supply of ammunition,
some cigarettes, and socks. At approximately 1300 they moved out with Company E
to San Prospero. On the way Pfc. ERNEST C. HAMPTON was wounded by artillery. However,
he was so far forward that he didn’t report back to the aid station, but continued on, finally reporting
back the next day with some prisoners. The 2nd Platoon of Company H remained in the
same area throughout the day while other units passed through. Some artillery fire fell on the
area. Lieutenant DAVID SNYDER was stricken ill and had to be evacuated. One replacement
was received.
All sections of the mortar platoon remained in the same areas throughout the day and night.
Several missions were fired and a heavy artillery barrage was received late in the morning at C.
Bacucchi. This barrage killed Cpl. ANDREW E. DALTON, JR.
Two men of 2nd Battalion Headquarters were wounded during the day. T/Sgt. HARRY
COOPER, delivering ammunition to Company F, was hit near Bortolani by shell fragments while
lying in a ditch by his jeep. Pfc. BARNEY JABLOWSKI, while removing the dead in the same
area, was hit and wounded. Two others from another unit were killed.
SIXTH DAY—19 APRIL
Colonel FOWLER issued the following order at 0010 on the 19th of April:
“10th Mt Div will continue attack at 0800 on 19 April with the 85th Mt Inf on the right, 87th
Mt Inf on the left. The 87th will jump off from present front lines near Merlano at 0800 with 1st
Battalion on the left and 3rd on the right. The 1st Battalion with Co A 751st Tank Battalion and
Co A 701st Tank (1 platoon) attached, will attack left guiding on the river and mop up in zone.
The 3rd Battalion, with 1 platoon of TDs attached, will attack from line now held by 3rd Battalion
front line units. It is to advance rapidly and capture the high ground in zone overlooking the Po
Valley keeping contact with the 1st Battalion. (This directive to maintain contact later proved
impractical, and was revoked.) The 2nd Battalion in regimental reserve is to follow the 3rd Battalion
at 1,000 yards. The 616th FA Battalion reinforced by the 604th is in direct support. Company
C 84th Chemical Battalion priority to the 3rd Battalion. Patrols to front will return before
0730 with information as to whether enemy positions are occupied. If not, advance will be made
without artillery preparation. If occupied, artillery preparation will last fifteen minutes from
0745. Display panels along line of departure for one hour starting 0630. The 86th Mt Inf will assist
by fire until passed through.”
During this day the troops began the series of long movements which carried them across the
Po and to the Alps. The regimental CP moved three times to keep up, and the regimental commander
spent most of the day visiting his battalion commanders.
Apr 19
100
1st Battalion—Mongiorgio
At approximately 0800 on the 19th of April, Companies A and B resumed the attack on
Mongiorgio. An urgently requested air mission had not been flown. Company B was still on the
right of A, with a platoon of tanks on the road on the right of B.
COMPANY B
Company B moved out in a column of platoons, 1st, 2nd, weapons, and 3rd, with the heavy
machine guns of D giving support fire. The company moved out in good order some 400 yards,
when the German machine gunners in Mongiorgio opened up, pinning the company down for
several minutes. Meanwhile, the lead tank ahead and to the right opened up on the church steeple
in Mongiorgio which was thought to have a machine gun in it. The tanker scored about half a
dozen hits on the tower.
The 1st Platoon was attempting to advance when Pfc. ERVIN A. HARMON was hit in the
head by machine gun fire. A few minutes later, our tanks began to receive direct fire from Tiger
tanks across the wide valley to our left. Pfc. PETER A. PANTSARI and Pfc. ZALE R. RUBINS
were instantly killed by a direct hit from this fire, and Pfc. EDWARD F. ELEPHANT was
wounded in the hand and evacuated. Three of the tanks were knocked out by this time, but the
fourth tank kept moving on down the road into town, firing both its machine guns and 76s as it
went.
While the tank was moving into town, the 1st and 2nd Platoons shifted to the right to take
advantage of cover, and moved by rushes up into the village. Several prisoners were taken, but
many Krauts pulled out to positions to the north. The 2nd Platoon manned positions in the
buildings to repel a counterattack, while the 1st Platoon under Sgt. SYLVAN D. WALDRIP
moved out in front of the buildings with elements of Company A. Several more prisoners gave
themselves up, and one small group, told to move to the rear, took off down the hill. All were
killed as they ran away. During the battle T/5 MARLIN A. PERKINS was killed and the following
wounded: Pfc. FORREST I. BASS, Pfc. ROY E. GAROUTTE, Pfc. FRANK J. HERZIG, JR., and
Pvt. RALPH H. BARNARD.
COMPANY A
Company A was to move out at 0800 with tanks, with Company B on the right. The line of
departure was near the road junction at Sulmonte. From here the exposed road ran directly
along the ridge-top and through the gate into town. The tanks didn’t arrive in time, but the two
companies moved out abreast. Half an hour later, the tanks arrived and moved up the road
abreast of A and on its right. The tanks silenced machine gun fire which had initially opened up
on the attacking elements, but all four were eventually knocked out.
The company entered the town and took the first group of houses surrounding the church
without difficulty. Beyond the church was an open clearing and another group of houses. As the
men started across this clearing, the enemy opened up from the houses beyond. Pfc. GROVER P.
WOODS and Sgt. EDWIN R. GORDON were killed, and Pfc. ARTHUR M. CROSS and Pfc.
FORREST A. BARTHOLD were wounded. The attack was halted and the Germans counterattacked.
First Sergeant GILBERT S. BATES killed six of the enemy with his Tommy gun, but German
grenades and mortar fire struck the church and the surrounding area, and the weary men of
the company started to retreat. S/Sgt. JOSEPH C. FARRELL was killed, and Pfc. STEPHEN O.
ROSE, Pvt. GEORGE F. HUMBURGER, Pfc. EARL MASTERSON, and T/5 CHARLES T.
MCNERNEY were wounded by machine gun fire. The machine gun section had started the day
with twelve men and ended with only one. During the day they had three different section leaders.
101
Then, guns of the British 178th Medium Lowland Artillery, with observation from Merlano,
laid in on the German-occupied group of houses with a perfect pinpoint barrage. The tiles few
high in the air as the German-occupied houses were zeroed in. The counterattack died and
Mongiorgio was taken.
Company C had swung onto the right to take the town of C. Lezza and the high ground
above it to the north of Mongiorgio. Company B was ordered to withdraw, and A was to remain
in Mongiorgio. From the town they watched the 1st Armored units moving down the valley
across the river. Germans in bunkers, organized in antitank teams, were holding up their progress.
They would blow the tracks, stopping the tank, and then lay a sticky charge against the
tank, blowing it up. As the crews fled from the burning tanks, they were being captured. Three
tanks were burned this way. Captain HUGH KLEMME called for concentrated “time fire” from
the 616th Field Artillery, and put his company mortars, the attached 81s from Company D, and
the “stubby” mortars on the German bunkers. Then as the enemy were driven out of their holes,
the company opened up on them with machine gun and M-1 fire.
After dark, some 88 fire came into the town. One round slammed in the doorway of the
building the machine gun section was in. Pvt. SIDNEY W. BENNETT was killed and six men
were wounded: Pfc. WILLIAM B. ADDY, Pfc. RUBEN CLEMENTS, who lost an arm and a leg,
Pvt. JOSEPH J. FITZPATRICK, Pvt. JOHN A. BERGMAN, Pvt. EDWARD D. FLACZYNSKI, and
also S/Sgt. DOUGLAS A. MINNERLY of the 2nd Platoon. Pfc. MOSES A. BROOKS was slightly
wounded. On their way back, S/Sgt. LAWRENCE E. HOTALING and Pfc. EDWIN W. STANKE
captured one German officer and two enlisted men who had been wounded in the morning.
COMPANY B—MARCH TO C. SILVESTRI
About noon, Company B was ordered to withdraw to Sulmonte, leaving A to hold Mongiorgio.
The company soon found that the move was not for a rest. Colonel FOWLER, the regimental
commander, came up and asked Lieutenant DONIPHAN CARTER if they were ready to attack
again, and just as C-rations were being issued, the first meal that day, the company was ordered
to move again to the north. Most of the men still had had nothing to eat all day. The attack
formation was organized as 1st Platoon, weapons platoon, 3rd Platoon on the right, and the
2nd Platoon on the left. After advancing several hundred yards, they left the rolling, grassy hills,
and were confronted with a desolate, heart-breaking series of knife-edge, bare, clay hills. By this
time they could see men of Company K on il Poggio and hear firing from that direction.
The 2nd Platoon on the left, struggling up and down across the transverse series of ridges,
couldn’t keep up, and after thirty minutes was forced to fall in behind the rest of the company
which was parading in single file across the skyline along the ridge to the right. The 2nd Platoon
lost several men from exhaustion and heat as it proceeded. The 1st Platoon and the command
group reached il Poggio first, and Sgt. HARRY V. MCCLINTICK took a small group to clear a
house of snipers. Company K had already moved out for C. Silvestri. After a halt for breath, the
company moved down into a deep valley in the direction of C. Silvestri. Sniper fire, which had
bothered the company all afternoon, finally took effect. Pfc. ROBERT J. LA BOMBARD was shot
through the head.
After another couple of miles of rugged terrain, the company moved up to C. Silvestri where
some Company K men left to guard the rear were holed up in houses and barns, receiving occasional
mortar and machine gun fire from the rise ahead. Company B started to dig in below the
buildings, but before holes could be finished, a concentration of mortar fire came in and killed
and wounded many men. Those killed were: Sgt. SYLVAN D. WALDRIP, T/4 PAUL T. WILSON,
Cpl. EDWARD O. WOZENCRAFT, Pfc. ROBERT L. STANGER, Pfc. EDWARD J. KOSA,
and Pfc. ROBERT W. GRABOWSKY. Wounded were: First Lieutenant JOHN S. GYLES, Sgt.
Apr 19
102
WALTER MIILU, T/Sgt. RAY S. DOTY, Pfc. EDGAR D. BOYER, JR., Pfc. KAYWOOD C.
SNOOK, Pfc. DALE R. WOLD, Pfc. VERNON E. CAMPBELL, Pfc. TOM B. CHAPLIN, Pfc. ATTILIO
L. DEINI, Pfc. JACK P. DICKINSON, Pvt. ARLAN A. HINESLEY, Pvt. JAMES C. JOHNS,
Pfc. HARRIS P. STEED, Pfc. STERLING E. RED EAGLE, Pfc. CLIFFORD L. JOHNSON, Pfc.
THEODORE KANELL, Pfc. HENRY P. MARTIN, JR., Pfc. WAYNE L. NICHOLS, and Pvt. JOSEPH
J. BECKMANN. German medics captured by Company K were used to evacuate many of
these casualties. Others wounded were Pfc. FRANK J. NEMEC, Pfc. HARMON W. WARD, JR.,
and Pfc. JAMES A RANDOLPH.
About 1900 Company B began to dig in a defensive position 100 yards north of the farm
buildings in a vineyard, with the 1st Platoon on the left, 2nd in the center, and 3rd on the right.
There was no action during the night.
COMPANY D
When the attack on Mongiorgio was resumed the following day, the mortars fired 500 rounds
before the artillery got registered on the town. The 1st Platoon, moving with the attack, suffered
no casualties, and after the town was taken they fired across the Samoggia River to assist the 1st
Armored units moving up along the road. The “stubby” mortar section under Lieutenant OLAN
D. PARR moved forward with Company A and assisted in this fire across the river. Pfc. CECIL S.
OVERTON from this section was wounded.
During the action from Torre Iussi to Mongiorgio, every one of the fifteen men and one officer
in the “stubby” mortar section was at least scratched, although only two were lost: Pfc.
HENRY LEYMAN, who was killed on 14 April at Le Coste, and Pfc. CECIL OVERTON, seriously
wounded on 19 April. Pfc. EDWARD B. COSETTE was wounded on 15 April, and S/Sgt.
ROGER W. HARLOW at Mongiorgio on 19 April should have been evacuated, but refused.
The mortar platoon was ordered forward toward Mongiorgio, and the mortars were in the
act of displacing when a counterattack developed in the town. They quickly set up and were
ready to fire, but the counterattack was broken up by British artillery. The mortars were then
ordered up to il Poggio. Pfc. JACK GOLDBERG, radioman for the mortar platoon forward observer
attached to Company A, was fatally wounded by artillery fire.
COMPANY C—VENERANO
On 19 April Company C, in battalion reserve near Merlano, marched to Sulmonte, arriving at
1300. Some artillery continued to come in as they marched, and they brought some small arms
fire on Sulmonte as they approached, erroneously thinking the fire over to the left on Mongiorgio
was coming from there. Companies A and B had spent the night at Sulmonte before resuming
the attack on Mongiorgio. So all the company found at Sulmonte was Pfc. WALTER HOFFMAN,
the company headquarters man, who had made his way up there alone looking for them.
Company B had by this time pulled back from Mongiorgio, leaving A holding the town.
Company C was given as an objective the village of Venerano and the steep hill beside it. This
turned out to be C’s grimmest battle. In early afternoon, the 2nd Platoon jumped off on the left
and the 3rd on the right. They were supported by five medium tanks. The 3rd Platoon moved
down a draw skirting the edge of a heavily wooded hill on its right. To the left were open rolling
fields sloping down to the south. Across these fields the 2nd Platoon was advancing. The 3rd
Squad of the 3rd Platoon and attached machine gun squad had already swung to the right (north)
around the west edge of the wooded hill, and hit a trail leading up to the steep hill objective,
when the 2nd Squad behind them was opened up on by cross-firing machine guns and rifle fire.
The squad dumped itself instantly into the ditch running along beside them only to find that another
machine gun was adjusted to fire up the ditch. Pvt. JOHN L. HEICHEL was killed, and Pfc.
Apr 19
103
GILBERT R. ERICKSON, Pfc. DAVID A. BLEICH, Pfc. PAUL W. ZURCHER and Pvt. DONALD
C. HOGUE were wounded. The squad leader, Sgt. EARL A. FOLSE called back after the first
shots, “Is anyone hit?” There was another burst of machine gun bullets, and he was silent. Later
he was found hit a dozen times.
Calls for medics brought more fire. The squad was helpless; a slight movement of the weeds
and fire would cut the weeds down. The acting platoon sergeant, S/Sgt. CASIMIR POVELAITES,
finally made a break for it during a lull. He reached the bend around which the leading
squad had disappeared, and threw himself into some old German dugouts there. Although he
had called back his intentions, no one followed. After waiting ten minutes, he raced 150 yards
across to a group of houses on the company left, and there contacted the 2nd Platoon whose 2nd
Squad, accompanied by the inevitable Pfc. WALTER HOFFMAN from company headquarters,
had reached the building and then were pinned down in it. The rest of the 2nd Platoon was
pinned in another house further back up the hill.
The 2nd Platoon was not much better off than the 3rd. Lieutenant JOHN W. HAWK had
held his platoon at a hillcrest as they had moved down, while the 2nd Squad under S/Sgt.
VERNON STONE moved down under the platoon’s covering fire to investigate the two groups
of houses. This accomplished without incident, the whole platoon followed down toward the
2nd Squad, which was by this time in the further of the houses down the hill. Then the machine
gun crossfire opened up, spraying the whole area. Machine gunner Pfc. HOWARD R. NORLIN
was killed instantly. Lieutenant HAWK and his runner, and the leading elements of the 3rd
Squad were caught midway between the houses and made a break for it back up the hill to the
first house. The rest of the platoon was able to move further to the left and climb the hill in defilade,
and then under cover of the house, join the platoon leader in the first house.
For two hours they were “holed up” in the two houses: the 2nd Squad in the lower house
where they had been joined by POVELAITES; the rest of the platoon in the first house. They tried
to set up men in windows to pick up the machine guns, but rifle grenades and artillery drove
them away.
Meanwhile Lieutenant ROBERT F. BOYER, the company commander, had run down to the
place where the tanks had stopped—some 300 yards short of the battle. He ordered the tanks to
move in against the machine guns. One tanker told him that the platoon leader of the tanks had
been wounded in the arm and evacuated. Lieutenant BOYER finally found the platoon sergeant,
but he would not take over command. He said the road was too narrow. When ordered to find a
new route down, he declared it couldn’t be done. However, he never left his tank. Finally
BOYER ordered him to at least move up onto the ridge, behind which he was then in defilade,
and fire from there into the houses down where the firing was coming from. He then declared he
couldn’t risk the expensive equipment. In exasperation, Lieutenant BOYER then ordered him to
“get the hell out of here.” Even this they did not do, but sat where they were for an hour, and
then withdrew to some houses far to the rear.
Sgt. POVELAITES, from the lower of the two houses occupied by the 2nd Platoon, yelled up
the hill to Lieutenant HAWK, who had the radio, for tanks. Other tanks were sent and they lumbered
along the lower road 300 or 400 yards below POVELAITES and the 2nd Squad. He
couldn’t move out of the house to show them where he was, or where the enemy was, and so
they moved right on by. Next, Sgt. POVELAITES thought he could fire at some buildings where
the German machine guns probably were, if he had some antitank grenades; so he yelled up to
Lieutenant HAWK for some. A twelve-year-old Italian boy agreed to carry them down from the
upper to the lower house, and he arrived safely with six antitank grenades, four fragmentation
grenades with adapters, three grenade launchers and blanks. However, intervening trees made
104
the effectiveness of the fire uncertain, so the youngster returned with a message to Lieutenant
HAWK as to where the fire was probably coming from.
Back with the elements of the 3rd Platoon pinned in the ditch by the woods, the situation was
not good. An enemy grenade hurled from the woods bounced off of Pfc. VENAR RIDDLE’s back
and rolled away. Rifle grenades started coming in, and worst of all, enemy artillery falling in the
woods had set the woods on fire. Three men made a break. They had heard Sgt. POVELAITES
directing them to run for the houses. When they got to their feet, however, they started straight
down the hill for the houses the Germans were in. They saw some Germans down there, but at
first mistook them for friendly troops. They were within fifty yards when they noticed the German
uniform. Seeing their mistake, they turned and ran for the other house to the left, where the
sergeant was. The Germans then fired, hitting Pfc. ARNOLD E. RIIPPA in the back of the neck.
They all kept going, however, and made the house. RIIPPA was taken to the cellar and treated,
and the Italians, huddled in the cellar for safety, fortified him with wine. The men were able to
give the exact machine gun positions. After this, Lieutenant HAWK rushed the balance of the
platoon, one man at a time, down to a stream bed, and the whole platoon assembled at the lower
house.
Back in the ditch, the 1st Squad of the 3rd Platoon, behind the 2nd Squad, was able to withdraw
from the ditch with some of the 2nd Squad’s wounded. Acting squad leader Sgt. GROVER
C. HUBLEY, Pfc. PHILLIP MCBRIDE and a couple of other men crawled and dragged the
wounded back to cover, and then carried them to the trucks. The fire had been continuous. Pfc.
DAVID A. BLEICH, for example, had been hit three or four times. Every time he moved he drew
fire. Finally they threw him bandages, and the enemy, apparently recognizing the bandages,
stopped firing at him, even though he commenced to move a great deal while dressing his own
wounds.
At about 1800, Lieutenant HAWK and the 2nd Platoon, noticing the firing had been quiet for
fifteen minutes, moved out of their house in squad column down the trail toward the German
houses. They drew no fire and found the houses empty. The machine guns were gone, but two
sandbagged positions at the upstairs windows, and great piles of brass indicated where they had
been. After setting up a temporary defense there, they moved on to their objective at 1900. The
remnants of the 3rd Platoon, too, were able to move on from the ditch.
While these actions had been going on, the leading 3rd Squad of the 3rd Platoon, with its
leader, Lieutenant WILLIAM HACKETT, had kept going early in the afternoon when the rest of
their platoon had been pinned in the ditch behind them. Following around the bend to the right
between the wooded hill and their steep objective, they cut to the left off of the trail into a thickly
wooded draw, and up the slope behind the town onto their objective. One low hill between them
and the objective was skirted. Sgt. STEPHEN SCULLEN’s machine gun was placed there to fire
short bursts at an enemy machine gun position spotted on the objective. His neutralizing fire was
effective, and the seventeen men climbed right up onto the objective and over onto the forward
slope overlooking the river road far below. Suddenly fire opened up on them from houses along
the road, catching them out on the forward slope. The men dove into old German positions. At
this point, a German lieutenant appeared out of the woods on the hill with a fully loaded machine
gun. He quickly dropped it over the bank, surrendering himself to Lieutenant HACKETT.
Pfc. RICHARD ZIMMERMAN picked up the gun and fired it down the hill at the Germans. Enemy
fire still pinned the squad to their holes. It was impossible to get back behind the hill. The
German officer was put on the hillside, and told to tell the others in the houses below to surrender.
He refused, but the enemy stopped firing when they saw he was a German. During this lull
in the firing, the squad was able to withdraw from the exposed slope. They then got Sgt. SCULLEN
and his gun down a vertical cliff, the only way down from his position without exposing
Apr 19
105
himself, and set up an OP on the hill. Another German officer walked up to surrender, hands in
the air. He contributed the disquieting information that twenty more Germans were expected to
relieve them at any moment. So Lieutenant HACKETT worked his men back up onto the hilltop.
This time in order to keep in cover, they climbed trees that grew against the cliff, and stepped off
onto the top. One man was left to guard the prisoners. Pfc. FRED E. ZARLENGO, noticing a
white flag down at the enemy positions, went down onto the forward slop to wave the “wouldbe”
prisoners up. He was instantly killed. Lieutenant HACKETT then set up a 500-yard defense
with fifteen men. About an hour later, at 1830, the 1st Platoon arrived.
While both platoons were pinned down, the 1st Platoon in support under Lieutenant JAMES
H. PENROSE had been swung around to the right of the wooded hill to approach the town and
hill from the north. Company headquarters, the mortars, and the 1st Squad of the 3rd Platoon
followed. They came under machine gun fire while still half a mile east of the objective, and had
to advance one man at a time until they reached a draw that gave good cover. They were held
up there as they approached a house, when a machine gun opened up on Lieutenant PENROSE,
S/Sgt. GERALD GILMAN, and the two scouts out in front of the platoon. A BAR was quickly set
up in the rear, and covered the withdrawal of the four men. The platoon then worked their way
further to the left under some sniper fire from C. Lezza to the north, but got into another draw
leading down to the objective. They were hollered at by HACKETT’s men up on the objective
who spotted them at this time, just as they came under some scattered artillery fire. They were
able to work down the draw and join HACKETT’s men on the reverse slope of the objective and
secure his precarious defense. Lieutenant HAWK’s 2nd Platoon and the rest of the 3rd Platoon
arrived at about 1900, completing the assembly of the company.
Lieutenant HAWK proposed almost immediately that he go clean out C. Lezza, the town just
to the north that had been firing on the 1st Platoon earlier. He collected eight volunteers, and
Lieutenant WILLIAM SPINNEY with two others from Company D. They had support from
SPINNEY’s heavy 30s, and the company mortars under Lieutenant JAMES ANDERSON, besides
artillery support. A radioman from Company D was hit in the shoulder before they moved out.
Then at dusk they started down to the objective. At first they went too far to the right, and as
they came back over a knob, they were fired on by long-range machine guns. They returned fire
with the heavy 30s, catching the Germans as they raced to man their positions around the town.
They charged the hill, shooting from the hip, and moved up to the buildings, some from the
south and some from the east.
While Sgt. MURRY L. LOEFFLER and his squad were flushing out a barn, five Germans ran
out past Pfc. OLLEN E. HINES and Lieutenant HAWK. One stopped and surrendered, but the
others ran down the road. HAWK threw down his rifle, and grabbing HINES’ grenades, as well
as his own, chased them, throwing grenades as he ran. HINES shot one in the back, two dropped
from the grenades, and then HINES hit the remaining one. While Lieutenant HAWK was looking
around for his dropped rifle, HINES noticed two Germans standing behind a brush pile with
rifles at “port arms.” They wouldn’t throw down their rifles, but just stood there. HINES started
around the pile after them, clockwise. They ran around to where he had been. He stopped; so
did they. Then he ran suddenly counterclockwise, but they were off before he got there, looking
back at him across the brush pile. Round and round they ran, around the brush pile, until they
finally had had enough and gave up. Still they carried their rifles until HINES smashed them out
of their hands.
That was not the end of this strange town, however. HAWK and HINES entered another
house and found four Krauts in one room and four more in the next, accompanied by a beautiful
Italian girl. The rest of the squad had also collected more prisoners, and as the group stood
around between the houses with their captives, a burp gun was fired into their midst from a hole
106
in a loft nearby. Also a machine gun opened up 100 to 150 yards away. Some confusion resulted,
but the prisoners were hastily collected and everyone got off the hill and back to the company.
The final count was thirteen prisoners, eight of whom were German officers.
3rd Battalion—Advance to Mt. Avezzano
COMPANY K—C. IL POGGIO
At 0600 of the 19th, the 3rd Battalion had started moving out, with Company K leading, to
mop up the left flank as the Division continued to exploit the breakthrough to the north. The line
of departure was a point southeast of the pinnacle town of Mongiorgio, which the 1st Battalion
would take in a renewal of the previous day’s attack. The terrain changed suddenly from rolling
hills to eroded, sharp, knife-edges of clay separated by deep, narrow, wooded draws. The company’s
first objective was il Poggio. It was on a high pinnacle from which knife-edged ridges and
eroded draws radiated down hill. The draws dead-ended against the sheer cliffs below the
houses. The knife-edge ridge was the only approach from the south. To the north, on the German
side, the approaches were easier.
Captain ROGER EDDY held the company up behind Company L of the 86th, while he joined
the battalion commander, Lieutenant Colonel WORKS, in his OP near Badia di Sopra to examine
il Poggio. The OP received mortar fire while the reconnaissance was made. Pfc. ROBERT E.
CAMPBELL was killed. Wounded were Pvt. STUART S. FISHER, the company runner, T/Sgt.
ARTHUR O. SCHIMKE, the 1st Platoon sergeant, Pfc. ROBERT F. TURNER, and several men
from the 86th. Colonel FOWLER arrived at this time to order the advance to continue at once,
and to bypass the buildings, which apparently were accurately registered for enemy mortar fire.
No one could be seen on il Poggio, so it was decided to send a three-man patrol up the exposed
knife-edge ridge to investigate the buildings and talk with the Italians who might be there.
Sgt. JOHN E. GALLAGHER led the patrol. After they disappeared down into the steep valley, it
took them an hour and a half to get over the difficult terrain to where they came within sight
again. From there they were watched moving easily along the exposed ridge to within 100 yards
of the houses on top. Suddenly a machine gun fired on them, and lead scout Pfc. ANDREW
BATTILORO toppled off the narrow trail and rolled over and over down 300 yards into a draw.
The other men escaped down along the ridge and returned to the company with valuable information
on the lay of the land and the enemy positions.
The platoon leaders were then oriented, and the TDs, heavy machine guns, and artillery were
ordered to bring fire for the attack. While the company made the difficult march to the hill, the
supporting fire from the TDs and artillery leveled the houses and neutralized the known enemy
positions. During this barrage a German medic appeared, braving the artillery fire, and started
down the steep bank towards BATTILORO. As he walked steadily towards the house slowly
waving his flag, the artillery and TD fire lifted long enough for him to pass, and then resumed
fire as he descended the hill. He reached BATTILORO, apparently administered first aid, and
then climbed the hill, re-crossing the artillery-beaten zone and disappearing over the ridge.
When he reappeared leading three German litter bearers, the fire lifted again and they descended
the hill and picked up our wounded man. BATTILORO, having been hit three times by the enemy
machine gun, must have died on the litter, because the German medics left him and returned
to the other side of the crest. Every supporting weapon of the 3rd battalion had been
trained on those aid men, and the itching finger of just one trigger-happy gunner could have
blasted these brave Krauts into Valhalla. Whether their motive was to stop the heavy fire on their
positions, to capture a PW for interrogation, or to relieve the suffering of a wounded man, their
valor proved that the German was still a courageous and disciplined soldier, capable of continued
determined resistance.
Apr 19
107
The weather was exceedingly warm, making the difficult climb and descent from draw to
draw doubly fatiguing. Seven men of the 2nd Platoon were lost due to heat exhaustion. After
moving slowly over the ridge, the 2nd Platoon went rapidly along the exposed knife-edge against
no fire. They moved up under excellent close-support artillery and machine gun fire, and
swarmed over the hill, driving forty Germans off, and taking twenty-five prisoners. Sgt. EVERT
L. NYLUND, JR. was killed by rifle fire, the only casualty in the 2nd Platoon. The 3rd Platoon,
meanwhile, had been sent on a flanking move by a much longer route to the right, and they
didn’t arrive on the hill until later. Captain EDDY sent for the 1st Platoon and weapons to come
up to organize defense. As they moved up, they came under intense mortar fire. Pfc. HOWARD
C. THOMPSON, as he walked the narrow knife-edge, had a shell land next to him. He was hit by
shrapnel, and blasted off the ridge by concussion, rolling over and over down 200 yards to the
bottom. When he was finally evacuated many hours later, he was both wounded and shellshocked,
but miraculously very much alive.
After the 1st Platoon reached the hill, one squad and part of the 2nd Platoon came under rifle
fire from the left front. Then from the OP in the house, six Germans could be seen crawling up
the hill to counterattack. A few men from both platoons were far down on the forward slope, cut
off and unable to move because of the fire. Fire was becoming more and more intense on the hill.
These men remained pinned down throughout the ensuing counterattack. At this juncture, the
company was glad to have the 3rd Platoon arrive, minus Pfc. NATHAN GARBER who had been
injured, and six men who had dropped out from heat exhaustion. Just as they were gotten into
position, a German tank appeared in the valley approaching the hill. Then two or three hundred
German troops were observed moving off to the north on a secondary road to the east of the
Samoggia River. Captain EDDY adjusted artillery fire on the fleeing enemy column (although his
own position was none too secure) and broke it up into confusion. By this time the house was
drawing all kinds of fire from machine guns, snipers, and mortars. Sgt. EDMUND D. BENNETT,
watching the counterattack, was wounded in the back of the neck when a bullet came through
the brick wall and struck him. Then the tank fired two rounds, one into the house. The whole
company scrambled back off of the hill, some taking cover behind the house, all in confusion and
some panic.
At the time the tank opened up, the prisoners stood lined up outside of the house with two
guards. When everyone started racing down the hill, the prisoners tried to escape. One of the
guards shot them all.
Captain EDDY and his officers and NCOs calmed the men and moved them back up onto the
hill. For some unknown reason the tank did not fire again. Company K was then ordered on to
its next objective, C. Silvestri. Before leaving, an effort was made to recall the men who were still
pinned down by sniper and machine gun fire, far down on the forward slope. Covering fire was
built up, and one by one the men made a break for it. Although they were called by name, two
men never came: T/4 STEVE TOBIS and Pfc. CASIMIR F. JILKA. Their bodies were recovered
later far down on the slope where the fire had gotten them.
The company moved off, leaving Sgt. PORTER SULLIVAN with eight men and a machine
gun to hold the hill against enemy counterattacks. The company left them with grave misgivings.
The sergeant was without communication; the “536” radios were long since gone. He was
instructed to rejoin the company on his own initiative, or when the company reached its next objective,
C. Silvestri. Before long, trouble developed on the hill. Six Germans marched up the hill
unarmed and waving a white flag. Behind them, attempting to remain concealed, could be discerned
ten armed Germans with machine guns. SULLIVAN’s squad opened fire. Sgt. HERVEY
BLACKBURN alone got five of the Germans with his M-1, and the attack stopped right there.
108
However, the squad was under fire as long as they were on the hill. Why the tank never fired
again, no one will ever know.
COMPANY K—C. SILVESTRI
The 3rd Platoon led the attack on C. Silvestri, another ridge-top cluster of buildings. Halfway
to the ridge-top, a German light machine gun opened up from the right front, and the leading
elements returned the fire. At this time Company I was on K’s right, and the men of Company I
started a great shouting and hollering that Company K was firing into their leading men. Fire
ceased abruptly. Amidst great confusion, it was finally agreed between the companies that the
positions of Company I were farther to the right than where Company K’s fire was falling, so the
firing was resumed. Then an effective mortar barrage started in on Company K. Sgt. FELIX
DUNBAR, with his great speed, set up his mortars in the rear of the leading 3rd Platoon and put
counter-mortar fire on the enemy mortars.
Unknown to Captain EDDY, Lieutenant EDWARD BINDER, leader of the 3rd Platoon, had
sent T/Sgt. HARRY SOUTHARD with a patrol of five men to flank to the right, and get the machine
gun that was still firing and holding up the 3rd Platoon. They were also to clear out the
group of houses below the top of the hill. When Captain EDDY reached the pinned-down 3rd
Platoon, he decided to send the 2nd and 1st Platoons on the same mission. So after sending one
squad of the 2nd Platoon, under Pfc. CLARENCE J. FEY, the acting squad leader, off to the left
flank, he followed the rest of the 2nd Platoon to the right, and ordered the 1st to follow him. The
2nd Platoon, under Lieutenant TOIVO RANTA, moved off to the right through a grove of trees
under sporadic mortar fire. Then they started up the hill.
Sgt. SOUTHARD, ahead, had gotten up to the town, cleaned it out and, running on to the
rear, had taken two prisoners. The machine gun was driven out but it was set up again a hundred
yards further up the ridge. S/Sgt. HERMAN S. AUSTIN was killed by a rifleman in a foxhole
on top of the hill. This rifleman then ran down the right side of the slope where some of the
2nd Platoon from the ridge could look down on him. They yelled at him and he seemed to
freeze, still holding his rifle at “port.” Sgt. ROBERT MANCHESTER drew a bead and shot him.
Sgt. SOUTHARD and his men, and men from the 2nd Platoon, crawled on up the hill after the
newly placed machine gun. Pfc. JACK PEHRSON of the 2nd Platoon got up close and threw a
hand grenade into the German position. They ran back off the hill.
Lieutenant RANTA and his 2nd Platoon then moved up and went over the hill under intermittent
mortar fire. Lieutenant RANTA came back, reported the hill taken, and himself
wounded. An enemy machine gun, firing from the valley to the right front between Companies
K and I, was silenced by some heavy enemy artillery which landed right on it.
The 1st Squad of the 2nd Platoon that had moved off to the left had its leader, Pfc.
CLARENCE J. FEY wounded by machine gun fire. Pvt. GARALD J. MORICAL of the 3rd Platoon
was shot in the hand. Pfc. DENZIL WILLIAMS, already wounded once on Mt. Croce, was
evacuated from the 2nd Platoon from exhaustion and shellshock. Sgt. SULLIVAN’s squad, trying
to rejoin the company, had reached the buildings near C. Silvestri when an unlucky shell struck,
wounding Sgt. ROBERT F. HUNT, Pfc. LEVI R. MCGOUGH, Pfc. JACOB MANDELMAN, Pfc.
WILLIAM E. THOMPSON, and Pfc. ROBERT C. CLARKE.
On the hill, Sgt. SOUTHARD and Sgt. PHILIP THURSTON of the 2nd Platoon were organizing
the position for defense. Sgt. ROBERT MANCHESTER had brought the 1st Platoon abreast
on the right, only lower on the hillside. Captain EDDY ordered him back to the grove of trees to
dig in for support. The captain moved to the hilltop to complete organization. The 3rd Platoon
had no ammunition, the 2nd had little, the 1st had a little more. The men were near exhaustion.
Apr 19
109
They were without water, and had marched and fought over fourteen miles of the most incredibly
difficult terrain in extremely warm weather. They had had little sleep the night before, a Kration
for two days, had been under fire almost continuously, and had fought three battles. They
had fought on with many of their leaders casualties, at a frantic pace, under fragmentary orders
and considerable confusion. Many of the men had dropped from exhaustion, but one group of
“old 87th” men never fell out until they were shot. Men like Pfc. OLAF HATLEN and Pfc. WILLIAM
WENTWORTH were old men, thirty-nine and forty. At Camp Swift they were told they
couldn’t make it; but they made it. They made the 87th an unbelievable machine of endurance
and drive. They were the old mountain men that were left, and the old mountain men were the
“guts” of the regiment.
At 1800 Captain EDDY, still busy reorganizing, received orders to continue the attack. He
radioed his answer back to the battalion commander, “Will be glad to support you with our bare
hands.”
The company pulled off the hill and continued north. They had marched fourteen miles, but
went on another six. The company medics were with them, as the company medics always are,
and the infantrymen loved them for it. But the tankers weren’t there, nor the artillery, nor the
combat engineers, nor any of the other combat arms. This was an Infantry show.
Down off the hill they found Company B, and K went into a column of twos. They left the
wounded Lieutenant RANTA on the hill with Company B, very much against his will. Sgt.
THURSTON took over the 2nd Platoon. Then the company marched on, taking it slowly to give
some other units time to get into the lead. After three miles, Lieutenant LARRY J. JENSEN and
Supply Sergeant HENRY O. ALBRO re-supplied the company with ammunition, water, and the
usual hot rumor.
The battalion commander, Lieutenant Colonel ROBERT C. WORKS, was met at Monte San
Pietro. He reported that Company L had already taken off. Company K then followed Company
I in support, following the attack as it got dark. The company moved through some artillery fire,
and finally dug in on Palzo Musico below the houses, weary and only too glad to halt and sleep.
COMPANY I—MT. AVEZZANO
That morning, the 19th, Company I had been ordered to go around the right flank of the 1st
Battalion, to pass through one battalion of the 86th Mountain Infantry, and then to march forward
and attack Monte San Pietro. After a visual reconnaissance, a fragmentary order, and a
short route reconnaissance, Captain ADRIAN I. RIORDAN moved the company out, 2nd Platoon
leading, with the light machine guns just behind, followed by the 3rd and 1st Platoons. The mortars,
as was customary in Company I, followed the second rifle platoon. Supported by TDs and
tanks, the company moved up onto Hill 262 and flushed out the two houses on top. The only fire
they received was sniper fire from great range.
After reorganization, they moved on toward their objective again, this time with the 3rd Platoon
on the right and the 2nd on the left, and with the machine guns in position between the two
platoons. The mortars too were emplaced, and an artillery concentration was put in a ravine 600
yards forward. As the platoon moved forward, the artillery was lifted and placed on Monte San
Pietro, on the high hill to their front.
The terrain had changed again from the rolling hills and ridges to sharp, clay, knife-edge
spines and deep erosion slots. Many of the slopes were nearly sheer, and there was constant
danger of the men falling. Pfc. LEON STEWART, marching on a bad ankle, fell and rolled down
a precipitous hillside, seriously injuring his back. Pfc. BILL L. BISHOP also fell while carrying a
BAR and broke his hand. The 2nd Platoon going forward received some fire from the left front.
110
The 60-mm mortars attempted to lay on this fire, but the range was too great. The mortars were
moved forward into a draw on the right flank, and more sniper fire commenced from the left
rear. Scattered rounds of artillery dropped all over the company area. Another man, Pfc. GUINTER
A. KRAUSE, fell and rolled down a bank breaking his ribs, and Pfc. JAMES “Scrap Iron”
LOWDON fell and hurt his knee.
Very little resistance was found in Monte San Pietro. About four enemy were seen, only one
of whom was determined to resist. He was killed and the others fled as the 2nd Platoon arrived
in town. Two other Germans were captured. The usual German artillery barrage hit town as
soon as the company moved in. Pfc. EDWARD J. LAFFERTY, Pfc. LONNIE I. ROSS, and Pfc.
RICHARD H. HOUSEMAN, were wounded. The artillery ceased abruptly, and Company L
started to pass through about 1600.
Company I was then ordered to continue on to its objective, Mt. Avezzano, the last high
ground before the Po Valley. They pulled up abreast and on the left of Company L at Palzo Musico.
The 1st Platoon was on the left and the 3rd on the right. Germans were seen over on the left
flank, but the men were not allowed to fire at them. Then machine gun and other automatic
weapons fire started coming from the left rear, and S/Sgt. JOHN R. BURGESS and Pfc. LEONARD
K. MUMAW were wounded. Fire was returned, and the 2nd Platoon, caught in the open,
was pinned down for about fifteen minutes. Sgt. MELVIN W. BEAMAN injured his ankle and
had to be evacuated.
Before the 2nd Platoon could extricate itself, the 1st and 3rd jumped off in the attack. They
moved down the steep forward slope of Palzo Musico and crossed the road in the deep valley.
As they started up the long steep sides of Mt. Avezzano, they were fired on from the left rear.
Sgt. LAWRENCE H. SAGE was hit by this grazing fire and tumbled down the hill, badly injuring
his knee. It was 0100 before the sergeant could be evacuated.
While the 1st and 3rd Platoons were moving up the hill, the weapons platoon, still on Palzo
Musico to the right of where the company was crossing, saw three or four Germans below run
out of the woods into the road. They were not fired on, and forty or fifty Germans followed. Pfc.
OSCAR B. SATHERS opened fire with his machine gun. The Germans were crowded on the road
about 700 yards away, around the bend to the right of the place where the company had crossed.
After the first burst, SATHERS paused for fire adjustment. His observer gave him no fire correction;
none was needed. SATHERS lay on the trigger for the longest burst he had ever fired. It
was the proverbial “machine gunner’s dream.” After a while he raised his head from the sight
and watched his tracers hose onto the crowded road. Then he poured bullets into the clump of
woods into which some of the Germans had fled. For SATHERS, these few minutes were the
height of the campaign. Seldom does a machine gunner have such a target.
The rest of the company followed the 1st and 3rd Platoons on up to the top of Mt. Avezzano
without resistance. Four prisoners were drafted to lug up the heavy machine guns. On top of the
ridge the men reorganized and dug in defensive positions for the night. The high ground commanded
the remaining low hills and fields between them and the valley of the Po.
During the night the Germans came back up the road between Mt. Avezzano and Palzo Musico,
and from time to time were driven away as they tried to bury mines. Up on the hill three
figures approached SATHER’s machine gun in the pitch dark. They walked so assuredly that
they were within fifteen yards of him before the distinctive curve of their helmets identified them
as Germans. By that time they were too close for machine gun fire, so he yelled at them. All
three dropped their rifles, one fled and two surrendered. One of the prisoners was a lieutenant.
111
COMPANY L—MT. AVEZZANO
At noon, Company L was committed from reserve to the battalion right flank, the men following
Company I at 1,000 yards. The 3rd Battalion passed the 1st Battalion as it still fought for
Mongiorgio at the left. Later, the company followed I past K fighting for C. Silvestri on their left.
The terrain the town marched through this day had changed sharply from the rolling ridges
of the day before. The entire region as it spread to the north, sloping down to the Po Valley from
the 900-meter hills of the first day, had gone through three major terrain changes. The first terrain
area, a band of mountains from Torre Iussi east to Mt. Mosca, was a region of steep rugged
slopes, largely wooded with chestnut trees and scrubby growth, and spotted with rock outcroppings
and with some rolling fields atop the hills. The valleys between these hill masses were
jumbled, rolling fields, dissected by networks of deep, eroded draws, usually wooded. Beyond
this mountainous band, which had constituted the German line, was an area of high open and
gently rolling ridge masses with rounded knolls, and only occasional patches of trees. The edges
of the ridge masses, however, were torn away by erosion, and especially on the Samoggia River
side there were series of ridge spines and draws running steeply down to the river valley. In the
third area, this last condition became general; the entire region was cut up into northing but deep,
steep draws and sharp precipitous knife-edge ridges, often so steep as to be bare of all vegetation.
After Company I took Monte San Pietro, Company L passed through them with the mission
of taking Mt. Avezzano before dark. At about 1600 they were ordered to take the Ca de Sarti
ridge, then Palzo Musico, on their way to Mt. Avezzano. The order was changed. Ca de Sarti
was to be bypassed. The company was spread out over a long distance, back over the eroded
draws and knife-edge ridges. The day was hot; the men were close to exhaustion. They had had
little or no sleep, no water since the night before, and no food. While they were assembling, Lieutenant
WILBUR S. SHEETS and Sgt. LEWIS HAUGE made a reconnaissance up along the Ca de
Sarti ridge, but the ridge was unoccupied. Thereupon they returned and brought the company
up at about 1630. Colonel WORKS came up and ordered them on to Palzo Musico to prepare for
the attack on Mt. Avezzano.
COMPANY L was led by a twelve-man patrol under S/Sgt. WILLIAM CONGER from the
3rd Platoon. They were to clean out the houses at C. Sassoli, and they became the company
point, firing at Germans down off the ridge to their right, as they moved along to Palzo Musico.
Here the company was fired on from houses in the valley to the rear. The company returned the
fire and the enemy ceased firing. Pfc. FRANCIS I. NORTHRUP was injured on the way up.
Company I pulled up abreast on the left rear where one of their platoons was pinned down
by machine gun fire from the left, just as both companies were jumping off at 1900.
The jump-off stopped just as it started, at the sight of many German troops pouring down
into the narrow valley to the road junction right at Company L’s feet. There were motorcycles,
horse-drawn vehicles, field pieces, command cars, and foot elements. The steep north face of
Palzo Musico dropped down to the dirt highway leading off to the east. Mt. Avezzano rose
steeply just across the road. The valley was just a V-slot, and through it poured the German column.
Every weapon available in the rifle company and attached machine gun section opened up.
The volume of fire represented the full potential of the infantry: bazookas, rifles, mortars, machine
guns, and rifle grenades. The Germans never knew what hit them.
From 1900 to 1920, before this action was finished, the artillery preparation for the attack was
fired. Company I was still getting some machine gun fire on the left, and Company L held up
until 1930, waiting for Company I to come abreast. Then Company L flanked around to the right
with all three platoons. Two officers and thirty-six men, the leading echelon, took the steep hill
Apr 19
112
without difficulty, consolidated their positions with Company I, and start digging in at 2100. The
2nd Battalion was expected to be on the right occupying that part of the long ridge. In their absence
Company L moved over and spread their positions along the ridge to the east.
During the night they were attacked from the rear and a brief firefight developed. S/Sgt.
DONALD FLYNN then recognized the platoon attacking up the hill as part of the 2nd Battalion,
85th Mountain Infantry, and yelled out the “Cease fire!” order.
COMPANY M—MT. AVEZZANO
As the weapons company moved across the line of departure and up onto Sulmonte, they
were hit by mortar fire. S/Sgt. WILLIAM I. ERIKSON, Pfc. JAMES A. NEVES, and Pvt. DONALD
G. JENNINGS were all wounded here. The company was supported effectively with 81-
mm mortars, although under German fire during much of the day. The machine gun platoons
followed the attacking rifle companies during the long, difficult day. One machine gunner of the
2nd Platoon, Pfc. PALMER W. HORTON, was killed by shrapnel as his squad displaced through
the deep draw below Monte San Pietro.
OTHER CASUALTIES
Third Battalion Headquarters Company had casualties during the day. Pfc. HANSEL R.
WILLIAMS, while driving for ammunition in his truck, was seriously wounded by automatic fire
back near Madna di Rodiano. Pfc. GEORGE T. DAVIS, just back from a replacement depot, was
killed by shellfire that night in a big monastery where the company spent the night.
2nd Battalion—Monte San Pietro
In the morning, the 2nd Battalion had assembled at San Trinita and entrucked. They rode
along the ridge-top past Merlano to the end of the road. Then they marched, Company E leading,
toward the regimental objective of Pradalbino.
COMPANY E
The immediate objective of the company was C. Marchese. They passed Mongiorgio on their
left while the 1st Battalion was still fighting for the pinnacle town. In the afternoon, they bypassed
il Poggio and C. Silvestri, both taken by Company K. A little beyond, in the vicinity of
Castello, Captain LE GRAND PENDREY was joined by Colonel DAVID FOWLER and Lieutenant
Colonel EMMETT L. NATIONS. Just then, artillery fire fell on the company, killing Pfc. LEO
T. HANDWERK.
Toward evening they marched off for Mt. Avezzano, but it had been taken by the 3rd Battalion,
who did not wait for them. One platoon of Company E was to occupy Hill 302, southeast of
Mt. Avezzano, and the rest of the company was to assemble behind the 3rd Battalion on Mt.
Avezzano. As they marched down into the draw beyond Monte San Pietro, with the 1st Platoon
leading, the point was opened up on by sniper fire. The firing came from both sides of the deep
narrow draw but no one was hit. As the leading men scrambled to get out of the confined area,
Pfc. SAMUEL F. ONSTOTT, a BAR man, was wounded. The whole battalion was held up behind
the 1st Platoon. Lieutenant SYDNEY ALLISON, the platoon leader, made contact with Colonel
NATIONS by “300” radio, and when unsuccessful in locating the snipers, was ordered to bypass
the area. It was now between 2300 and 2400. As the platoon climbed up out of the draw, a motorcycle
could be heard moving away; presumably the snipers had made their escape. The 1st
Platoon moved on to Hill 302, while the rest of the battalion, including the remainder of Company
E, moved up onto the hillside around C. Sassoli, where they dug in for the night. Some artillery
fire fell around C. Sassoli during darkness.
113
COMPANY F
Company F entrucked early in the morning and rode to a point east of Merlano. They were
to move to the left of the 3rd Battalion toward the regimental objective, Pradalbino. Actually, the
2nd Battalion marched in single file much of the time behind and to the right of the 3rd Battalion,
thus avoiding the extremely rough canyons and razorback ridges over which the 3rd Battalion
fought. Company F marched behind E without resistance, except for occasional mortar bursts, all
afternoon and evening, reaching Monte San Pietro at 2300. From here they moved down the
draw and spent the night under some mortar fire at C. Sassoli.
COMPANY H
In the morning, the 1st machine gun platoon of Company H left with Company E from San
Prospero for the entrucking point. Light artillery fire was coming in on them. They moved by
truck to a point east of Merlano. From there on foot they marched to within five kilometers of
Monte San Pietro. They marched again at 1600 and were caught in a draw by heavy artillery fire
from the left flank. They dug in here until after dark, then marched over to C. Vigo and dug in
for the night. Here they received some light artillery fire.
The 2nd Platoon moved forward the same as the 1st, by carrier to Merlano, then by marching
to positions from which to support the attack of Company F on Monte San Pietro. However,
Company I had already captured the town. The platoon moved forward through elements of the
3rd Battalion, finally halting for the night at 2400. The 1st Section was lost, but continued on towards
its objective, halting for the night at 0200. They had gotten lost when they encountered
enemy fire. They had to withdraw and then proceed along a new route. They were alone out in
enemy territory.
The mortar platoon moved to Merlano the same as the first two platoons. At about 1500 they
marched to Stulla from where several missions were fired at Monte San Pietro. At 1700 the 2nd
Section moved out, followed at intervals by the 1st and 3rd Sections. After an hour’s marching
they dug in near the battalion OP for the night. The 1st and 3rd Sections were about one mile to
the rear.
Situation at the End of the Sixth Day
During the afternoon of the 19th, the 85th Mountain Infantry, having moved through the 86th
and along the road to the Po Valley, reported running into little or no opposition. Their battalions
were reporting positions further and further out toward the end of the hills. Finally, some
reports had them in the valley. Actually, by nightfall, the 3rd Battalion on Mt. Avezzano, after
fighting all day over the tortuous terrain, was father north than the 85th Mountain Infantry.
SEVENTH DAY—20 APRIL
At 0100, the Field Order for the 20th read:
1. Elements of 10th Div will enter the Po Valley tomorrow (the 20th) to cut the highways
west of Bologna.
2. 87th Mt Inf will continue mission of mopping up previously designated areas.
3. 2d Bn 87th will advance north to Pradalbino and continue north mopping up on a
broad front to a position south of the main road (Highway No. 9) through Crespellano.
There they will establish a defensive position in the hills in division reserve.
3d Battalion in present area, rest.
114
1st Battalion in present position, await orders to be issued before noon.
616 FA Bn direct support 87th Mt Inf, priority to 2d Bn.
Co C, 84th Chem Bn, direct support 2d Bn with one platoon. One platoon in position
for possible employment with 1st Bn.
2d Bn to jump off not later than 200800.
Maintain wire to all battalions to insure rapid information, and orders if situation
changes radically.
The 10th Mountain Division was going to move out of the mountains!
2nd Battalion—To the Valley
COMPANY G—TOMBA
Company G was given the mission of capturing the town of Tomba and clearing the ridge
beyond to protect the battalion advance on their right. The company moved out at 0645, 3rd Platoon
leading. Small arms fire held up the 3rd Platoon, and the 2nd Platoon passed through and
took the right part of town. The 1st Platoon, meanwhile, pushed up and took the section of town
left of the road. Machine guns and mortars gave excellent overhead fire on the ridge from positions
where they were receiving heavy artillery and mortar fire from the enemy.
After part of the town was taken, one squad of the 1st Platoon moved over onto the forward
slope. They promptly received machine gun and sniper fire. Pfc. HARRY F. MARKSON was
killed by a sniper. Cpl. ROBERT J. MCBRIDE was wounded between two houses on the forward
slope. Enemy crossfire cut back and forth across the hill. The 2nd Platoon worked their way
around to the right and cleared out one machine gun nest, killing two and taking one prisoner.
This allowed the 1st Platoon to go through the town. However, Pfc. LEO A. WHITE, Pfc. ROBERT
F. O’NEILL, Pvt. RUDOLPH O. MARON and Pvt. CHESTER J. SAVICKAS were wounded
in the town. The 1st Platoon in town captured four Germans and killed several others.
During the afternoon in Tomba, the company experienced the heaviest shelling they had endured.
It was not only concentrated, but of a very heavy caliber. Many of the men weren’t actually
wounded, but were shaken up and dazed by the shock of the concussion. Lieutenant
GORDON A. ANDERSON was knocked down and suffered internal injuries, although he remained
with the company. During the fire, Sgt. RAYMOND STRAIT, from Battalion S-4, and a
driver came speeding up in two jeeps and went on past the company and way out in front to the
west of the hill. There were bullets whistling around them as they turned the jeeps around. One
jeep was hit in the radiator and abandoned. They brought the other one in.
Meanwhile, General HAYS arrived at the regimental CP. The Division was breaking into the
valley, and the 87th was to disengage and move down. At about 1500 the company received orders
to disengage from the enemy and bypass to the valley. This was accomplished under heavy
artillery fire. A covering force of Lieutenant DUTTWEILER and six men was left behind. Lieutenant
DUTTWEILER and T/Sgt. CHARLES THORNE, after the company had gone, raced out
through the heavy fire, started the damaged jeep, and drove it back to safety. The covering force
rejoined the company in the battalion assembly area without mishap. At dark they marched behind
the battalion to the last high ground on the edge of the Po Valley. Here they helped set up a
perimeter defense around the battalion area at 2200.
The 2nd Section of the 2nd Platoon of Company H gave supporting fire to Company G in its
attack on Tomba. They fired from positions near the battalion OP. The 1st Section also gave
supporting fire from the flank. Enemy mortar and artillery fire was heavy. The platoon displaced
forward at about 1200, and moved on until they reached the edge of the Po Valley at 2100.
Apr 20
115
Here they bivouacked for the night. During the day the tired men were liberally treated to wine
by welcoming Italians. At their bivouac area, the whole 2nd Platoon and part of Company F
were treated to a feast of bread, cheese, wine, milk and coffee by the grateful Italians. The Italians
gave them their beds, while the family went out to the dugouts. Many of the men slept in clean
sheets for the first time since longer than they could remember.
COMPANY E—C. MARCHESE
In the morning the battalion was to move around to the left of Mt. Avezzano toward Pradalbino.
Company E, with the 3rd Platoon leading, went over Palzo Musico, dropped down the
steep northern side, and crossed the creek and the road. Moving to the north, they traversed
along the western slopes of Mt. Avezzano, going over the crest, and ran into long-range machine
gun fire. The slope was exposed, and they moved down into a draw east of Tomba. There they
were fired on from close range, killing Pfc. GORDON D. ERICKSON, and wounding Pvt. ROBIN
E. HOOD of the 2nd Platoon, Pfc. MICHAEL A. HUSSLI of the 3rd Platoon, Pvt. FRANCIS P.
DESMOND and Pvt. RAYMOND SCHMIDT. Meanwhile, the 1st Platoon, moving down the valley
from Hill 302, where they had spent the night, went up onto Mt. Avezzano. The platoon
leader, Lieutenant SIDNEY ALLISON, made contact with Captain ADRIAN RIORDAN of Company
I. The whole company, with the exception of one squad of the 3rd Platoon, withdrew from
the west side of Avezzano around to the south, and went up Mt. Avezzano in defilade. There
they followed the 1st Platoon down the forward slopes of Avezzano and rejoined the lone squad
before their objective, C. Marchese. They were to attack C. Marchese as Company F attacked
Pradalbino. On Mt. Avezzano, Pfc. RICHARD G. SCHROEDER, Pfc. MILLARD R. SMITH, Pvt.
ELBERT E. THOMAS and Pvt. BOWNE P. TAGGART had been wounded by artillery at about
noon.
Enemy had been observed moving around in C. Marchese all morning long. As the company
closed in on the town, they awaited the promised artillery preparation. Only five artillery rounds
were thrown into the town. The company was able to move in close to the town without being
detected. On signal they opened fire with a volley of all weapons, catching the Krauts by surprise
and killing and wounding many. Machine gun and sniper fire was returned. Then, still
waiting for the promised eight-minute artillery barrage, they were told by radio that it had already
been fired; the five rounds was it. Unable to launch an attack successfully without some
kind of preparatory fire, the company waited and shortly received the order to disengage and
withdraw. Pradalbino had already been taken by Company F; C. Marchese no longer needed to
be captured or occupied. At 1800 they reached Pradalbino and organized with the battalion for
the further advance to start at 1830. They moved out with Company E on the right, F on the left,
heading for the valley of the Po. Company F was ordered to establish a roadblock at Muffa, but
ran into enemy fire that held them up. Company E reached C. Fazzuolo by 2030 and tied in with
Company F for the night.
The 1st Platoon of Company H took off behind Company E at 0700 for C. Marchese under
moderate fire of snipers and self-propelled guns. They delivered overhead fire on C. Sartorana.
At about 1700 they moved on to the north again, marching until 2300. S/Sgt. HAROLD D. ROSE
and Pfc. STEPHEN A. FORRESTER were wounded by a single artillery shell along with four
Company E men near Mt. Avezzano. They spent the night on the last slopes before the valley of
the Po.
COMPANY F—PRADALBINO
Company F went over Palzo Musico. Then they crossed the road and climbed up the ridge
running east from Mt. Avezzano. They passed to the right of Company I occupying Avezzano
and went down the slope past Company E which at this time, 1300, was pinned down to their left
116
at C. Marchese. With the 3rd Platoon leading, the company moved up and occupied the first
building at Poggiolo without resistance. Then the 1st Platoon went through the 3rd and took the
next two buildings. The 2nd Platoon in turn leapfrogged on to Pradalbino with only some sniper
fire from the left to worry their advance.
At 1600, after an hour and a half at Pradalbino, they were ordered to move out into the valley
of the Po to establish a roadblock at Muffa. They moved out with the 3rd Platoon leading. Late
in the afternoon, Lieutenant FLOYD ALEXANDER and his scouts had crossed over a ridge, when
the rest of the platoon behind them were fired upon by a machine gun from their left front. The
3rd Platoon was unable to follow ALEXANDER, but Captain JAMES KENNETT led them down
into a gully and crawled away from the exposed ridge through an erosion draw. Lieutenant ALEXANDER
and his two scouts went on to the previously designated company rallying point.
The company officers brought up the rest of the company by another route around to the right,
and although this too came under fire, they got to the rallying point and rejoined Lieutenant ALEXANDER
and Captain KENNETT and the 3rd Platoon. The two “300” radio operators were
unable to move during the day because they drew fire every time they tried to move in the open
daylight. The entire company was not able to reassemble until after dark. From the high ground
could be seen the enemy retreating out of the mountains. Out on the plain, columns of 10th Division
troops were visible.
They were unable that night to get all the way to Muffa, but spent the night at a villa on the
edge of the Po Valley where they picked up an English-speaking prisoner who had been unable
to keep up with the retreating Germans.
COMPANY H—MORTARS
The 1st Section moved out at 1000 and went by truck to the former battalion CP east of Mt.
Avezzano. From there they hand-carried forward to Buca where they rejoined the 2nd Section.
Then the 3rd Section arrived at 1400 and the platoon was reassembled. After firing several missions,
the 2nd Section displaced by hand-carry to Pradalbino and dug in for the night. The other
two sections displaced on carriers to the former location of the battalion aid station and spent the
night there.
1st Battalion—To the Valley
COMPANY C
That morning after Company C’s fight for Venerano, Lieutenant RICHARD C. POWERS took
five men for a mop-up patrol back up to C. Lezza where Lieutenant JOHN HAWK had been the
night before. Here they captured four more prisoners and a great many weapons, including four
machine guns. They blew up a quantity of German hand grenades, and then moved out on patrol
a mile beyond and returned. All they discovered was the remains of a jeep, which had apparently
struck a mine. Beside it were the remains of a German captain, an American captain
from the 81st Reconnaissance Squadron, and an Italian woman and baby. All had apparently
been killed instantly.
Back at Venerano, eight or ten more Germans wandered in during the morning and surrendered.
At 1300 the company marched east to Stulla, the regimental CP, where they entrucked
and rode to a point southeast of La Fornace. At 1630 they started marching to the Po Valley. As
they marched along in a column of twos, they passed diagonally through Company F of the 85th,
who were pinned down for the moment. Sniper fire opened up and Company C hit the ground.
After twenty minutes, the company continued on through. Some heavy artillery fell and then
later, as they moved along a ridge, the leading 1st Platoon came under fire of a machine gun.
They rushed across a 150-yard opening and set up a base of fire for the rest of the company.
Apr 20
117
Lieutenant Colonel ROSS WILSON, the battalion commander, arrived at this time with a tank,
himself acting as a first scout. The tank fired at a building in which the gun seemed to be located,
and the company was able to move on down into the valley, arriving near Crespellano at 2000.
After some confusion as to directions, they took up defensive positions and set up roadblocks
from C. Bosco to Portazza. During the day Pfc. HERBERT J. BRYAN and Pfc. JOHN J. PONZIO
had been injured.
The two TDs that were to support the roadblock couldn’t be located, so Sgt. GERALD T.
GILMAN and five men went out to find them. It was midnight, but the moon was very bright.
They found track marks near a bomb crater in the road, and then almost ran into a German sentry.
The sentry fired at once, wounding Cpl. EDWARD H. MERRILL and Pfc. ARTHUR E.
DUNFEE seriously, and Pvt. WESLEY E. HARRIS lightly. The squad, including MERRILL, fled
behind nearby buildings. However, DUNFEE couldn’t be rescued since he lay wounded right in
front of the sentry. Other weapons opened up on the squad as they worked through back yards
back to the road, supporting the wounded MERRILL and HARRIS. DUNFEE was later picked
up by another unit and was reported from an evacuation hospital. When they returned, the TD
had been found and was already in position.
During the night, three prisoners made a break for freedom. One was shot at once, and another
thereupon surrendered. Then this one again made a break for it and was shot. A machine
gun cut down the third one.
Earlier in the evening, a group searching houses around the CP broke into one that wouldn’t
open up. The Italians inside then set up wine, bread, and cheese in the kitchen for the men. The
soldiers were in and out of this house eating and drinking all through the evening. Some of them
were seated around the table at midnight when a knock sounded at the door. Two Germans
walked in. There was a wild scramble for arms as the Germans fled. Both were killed.
COMPANY A
Company A entrucked in the late afternoon to a point near La Fornace. After detrucking,
they were ordered to bypass all small arms fire, and to march across the Modena-Bologna road,
Highway 9, and to establish a roadblock at Calcara in the Po Valley. They marched out in the
battalion column towards the north. During the afternoon they ran into the rear of the 85th 2nd
Battalion, who were pinned down and engaging in a firefight. They followed Company C
around, and went through the 85th skirmish line in a column of twos. They were fired on by
snipers after going about 300 yards. Still in column they “double timed” around to the right and
ducked behind some buildings and around behind a hill. At dark they reached the valley. Here
both platoons soon became lost in the unfamiliar flatland. They held up, and Captain HUGH
KLEMME reoriented himself and the company leaders in a farmhouse. Then, joined by supporting
tanks, they moved along the road in the dark and dropped off each of the platoons for roadblocks.
At midnight, they closed in on Calcara and made contact with the 86th Infantry. Around
the battalion CP they captured fifteen prisoners. During the evening, Pfc. REX A. BROCKETT
had been wounded in the leg by machine gun fire.
COMPANY B
Company B pulled out of C. Silvestri at noon on the 20th and marched to Stulla, where they
entrucked to a point near La Fornace. At 1600 the battalion started marching towards the Po Valley,
in column of twos, a file on each side of the road, and a steady stream of TDs, armored artillery,
and other traffic moved along between. Just before dusk the company came out into the flat
of the valley, and after passing through a company of the 86th, continued marching until 0100,
when they took up positions around buildings housing the battalion CP.
118
3rd Battalion—To the Valley
COMPANY L
Company L stayed in place during the morning of the 20th, receiving some artillery and mortar
fire without casualty. At 1330 rations arrived. The men had had only one K-ration meal during
the last day and a half.
The whole battalion was scheduled to rest all day of the 20th. However, elements of the Division
were pushing out into the valley. Company A of the 86th Mountain Infantry had already
cut the Modena-Bologna road. Therefore the entire regiment was ordered out of the hills with
the least possible delay, bypassing resistance as much as possible.
At 1645, Company L led the battalion down a draw beyond Avezzano. At 1830 they bumped
into the 1st Battalion who were engaged in a brisk firefight up on the ridge to the right. Lieutenant
SHEETS went up to see what the situation was, and on his return met Colonel WORKS, the
battalion commander, who ordered them to keep moving forward in the draw. As they pushed
on, they ran into some sniper fire, and collected four prisoners. Further on, at 1900, a patrol was
sent to investigate some houses up on the ridge. There S/Sgt. JAMES C. MOREHOUSE, Pfc.
FRANCIS J. EDWARDS and Pvt. FRANK G. DE JULIO were wounded, possibly by friendly fire.
EDWARDS and DE JULIO had just joined the company at 1500 that afternoon, so their combat
time with Company L amounted to three and one-half hours.
Reaching a point near the valley, as the company marched on through the draw, they ran into
a machine gun firing from around a bend. The company was pinned down, and a patrol was being
formed to knock out the gun, when Lieutenant Colonel ROSS WILSON, commander of the
1st Battalion, rolled up in a TD. Four other TDs followed, and they drove out the machine gun.
Company L continued to lead the battalion down the draw and out into the valley, elements of
the 1st Battalion on their right and slightly ahead of them all the way.
COMPANY I
Company I had stayed in place until late in the afternoon. Just after noon a sniper with a machine
pistol fired from the flank on the house used as a company CP. S/Sgt. WILFORD A.
BAUER took a squad out to try to locate the sniper. Before he had gone twenty yards from the
CP he was hit twice and seriously wounded. The firing cased before the sniper could be located.
In the afternoon the company was ordered to march forward with the battalion to a point
southeast of Crespellano. The Germans had been routed from the mountains, and the drive
across the Po Valley had begun.
COMPANY K
When the battalion was ordered to march, bypassing resistance, to the valley of the Po, Company
K marched in the battalion column, Company L leading, with the 1st Battalion on their
right. Company L had some minor action which delayed the column, but K was not committed.
For the first day since the 14th, the men of the company didn’t have to leave wounded comrades
by the wayside. Company K marched over Mt. Avezzano and followed a draw north all the way
to the valley, bivouacking around Martignone.
COMPANY M
Company M enjoyed a morning of loafing around in the sunshine. A group of men showed
up, and two of them surprised the soldiers by speaking real “United States.” They were Air
Corps men who had bailed out over that territory and had been living with the Partisans. As far
as they were concerned, the day we arrived was V-E day for them.
Apr 20
119
Most of the company had spent the night near the foot of the mountain, and in the late afternoon
went to the top by jeep, and then took off on foot again down over the north slope and
along the creek bed through dense underbrush. They spent the night on the edge of the valley
near Ca Nova.
Situation at the End of the Seventh Day
After dark, the whole 3rd Battalion set up a perimeter defense on the last gentle slope of San
Martino, near Martignone, and the men dug in for the night. The 2nd Battalion “buttoned up” on
the last slopes further west, while the 1st Battalion spent the night out on the strangely flat valley.
Those men of the regiment who were still alive had reached their goal—the valley of the Po. For
months they had fought through the mountains. During this time, except for a few who had
gone on pass to Rome or Florence, no one had ever seen flat terrain. Now, in the dark, they were
resting on the edge of that unreal-looking expanse of green carpet they had glimpsed the past
two days, and had thought about since the beginning of the campaign. The 10th Mountain Division
had truly broken through, even as General HAYS had declared the morning after Captain
JOSEPH J. DUNCAN’s death, the 18th, the same day they moved down on Savigno. There had
been much fighting since then, however, and it had been difficult to recognize any breakthrough.
Now it was realized that the mountain fighters had opened the way through the mountains, a
way for the tanks and vehicles to pass through out into their own element—the easy flatlands.
That was the night of the 20th, yet the 21st was to be for the 3rd Battalion perhaps the greatest
fighting day of its career. The regiment was not to stop at the edge of the plain, but to march
on foot across the valley, abreast and to the left of the 86th Mountain infantry. The 3rd Battalion,
in reserve on the 20th, drew the assignment of leading. Their objective was a bridge north of Bastiglia
across the Secchia River. It was thirty miles away. Thirty miles straight north into enemy
territory with nothing out on their left, not even a friendly mountain to climb on to see what was
coming at them.
120
PO VALLEY TO LAKE GARDA
(21 APRIL — 2 MAY)
EIGHTH DAY—21 APRIL
ield Order No. 12 came in by telephone from Division at 0400 the morning of the 21st. The
Division was to advance in a wedge formation to seize and hold the Bomporto Bridge over
the Panaro River. The 86th Mountain Infantry was to lead in the center, with the 85th echeloned
to the right and the 87th to the left. The spearhead unit was to be known as “Task Force Duff.” It
included, in addition to the 86th, a platoon of TDs, a company of tanks, and a company of the
126th Engineers.
In accordance with this order, the 87th column on the left was to be made up of the 3d Battalion
and one platoon of TDs as advance guard, followed by Headquarters and Headquarters
Company and the 1st Battalion, with TDs interspersed, and the 2nd Battalion marching in the
rear to protect the left flank and rear of the Division. Even a march cadence was indicated: 104
steps per minute with a fifteen-minute break the first hour, and ten minutes per hour thereafter,
so that the troops would not become exhausted by too rapid marching. The initial point (IP) for
the march was the canal at the town of Calcara at 0800. The objective was twenty-five miles from
the IP, just beyond the town of Bastiglia. All troops were instructed to bypass resistance. The
mission was to get deep into the enemy territory, and behind the German forces.
3rd Battalion—March to Bastiglia
COMPANY K—PROVVIDENZA ROADBLOCK
Company K loaded in trucks at 0700 and reached the IP at Calcara by 0800. The men had no
chow, but they forded the canal by the blown bridge on time, and marched off into the unknown
valley behind the reinforced 2nd Platoon. The leading element under the command of Lieutenant
ROBERT S. KELLAR was point for the whole regimental combat team. The 86th combat team
was moving parallel to them on the right, and the 85th still farther to the right, but the Division
was spearheading in the flat, green valley, pushing into the unknown. Every mile gained would
make their position less secure.
The 2nd Platoon, marching in staggered column, was led by two scouts and a jeep and supported
from the rear by three TDs. The platoon moved in a generally westward direction to
Madna della Provvidenza, a mile and a half from Calcara, without incident. The 2nd Platoon by
0930 had gotten halfway through town, and the leading jeep and flanking scouts were 250 yards
beyond town when the scouts were fired on from a house 150 yards to the front. The TDs immediately
broke from the rear and pulled in behind houses. The jeep was knocked out, and Lieutenant
KELLAR was wounded by machine gun fire. Then Pvt. JOHN G. VASILIADES was hit by
rifle grenade fragments as the leading squad started to move to the right flank. Al three squads
were pinned down by a wave of rifle grenades. Two Germans then jumped through the hedge
not five yards from the disabled jeep, and set up a machine gun in a ditch. The 2nd Platoon had
started to withdraw from under the fire and were 25 yards back. Sgt. PHILIP THURSTON in the
ditch shot one of the Germans, but the other got the gun set up and opened fire. He commenced
spraying the area with lead. He fired right down the ditch he was in and killed Pvt. JOHN
CAMILLO and wounded Pvt. JAMES A. MIEHL who were in front and behind Sgt. THURSTON
flat in the ditch. All the while, rifle grenades were landing all the way back to town. These killed
Pfc. HAROLD R. GOULD, and wounded Sgt. MAX HOROWITZ, Pfc. PHILIP A. STREHLOU,
and Pvt. LOUIS G. CAPUTO, and slightly wounded Pfc. DONALD D. JUDD. T/5 HERBERT W.
A. SPAULDING was killed by machine gun fire. Somehow Sgt. THURSTON got out of the ditch
F
Apr 21
121
and back to town. Here he reorganized, and breaking his way into some buildings, got the men
off the streets and set up a defense. Pvt. STREHLOU, although wounded, was able to walk back
and give an account of the situation to Captain EDDY and Colonel WORKS. The colonel ordered
the reluctant TD crews forward under threat of courts-martial.
A wide flanking movement to the left (west) was ordered for the 3rd Platoon at this time.
Then feeling that this was not the most effective plan, the 1st Platoon with attached machine guns
was pushed up to the left of the road in the field, and the 3rd rerouted onto the right side of the
road to advance on the double, and attack the houses from which the fire was coming. Two prisoners
picked up in town revealed that there were 110 Nazis at the houses who intended to resist
to the death.
The platoons advanced rapidly, and by fire and movement, delivered heavy fire on the German
position. New rifle fire from the right rear of the 3rd Platoon killed T/5 WILLIAM L. HAMILTON,
and wounded S/Sgt. ANDREW O. FAULKNER and Pvt. EDWARD CICHORSKI, but
the platoon continued under the heavy fire. Pfc. WILLIAM WENTWORTH was killed by rifle
fire.
Then one TD inched up to where the middle squad of the 2nd Platoon had originally been.
Prisoners started popping up from the roadside after first throwing their pistols out in front of
them. Half of the 3rd Platoon, swinging wide, ran all the way around and closed in on the German
rear. Then they killed Germans when they ran right up to an enemy mortar squad in action.
They captured fifteen prisoners, including the German commanding officer who declared that
the rest of his company wished to surrender. The platoons were ordered to cease fire, and the
officer entered the buildings and brought out the rest of his company. The complete prisoner bag
was 65 officers and men, a complete German company either killed or captured. The TDs
guarded the prisoners while the company reorganized.
Company I had bypassed Company K at about 1030, and later when Company I became engaged
in a firefight, Company L went by and took the lead at about 1500. Company K marched
all the rest of the day following Company L. When Company L was held up at dusk at the bridge
near Navicello, K was in between the action there and the disastrous bombs dropped on the tail
of the column by a German bomber. The spirits of the weary men were greatly improved by the
cheering populace so generous with their wine, bread, cheese, onions and embraces. To the
plodding infantryman, this rapid, easy movement, even though on foot, through welcoming
throngs was an incredible experience.
COMPANY I—TANKS AT MANZOLINO
Company I was shuttled by trucks to the IP at Calcara right after K. Here they detrucked and
forded the canal. When Company K hit the roadblock about five miles from Calcara, and was
committed in a firefight, Company I was ordered to move cross-country on an azimuth of 340
degrees to bypass this resistance. They were supported by TDs. They soon ran into heavy fire
coming from a hedgerow 200 yards away. All three rifle platoons were pinned down, but the 3rd
Platoon managed to pass through the others and flank around to the left. Then the 2nd Squad of
the 3rd Platoon was sent forward to drive some snipers from a house. When the company was
originally pinned down, the TDs, instead of neutralizing the enemy small arms fire with their
guns, backed up about 200 yards. They refused to go ahead. Then they followed the 3rd Platoon
in their flanking movement to the left, and were ordered to fire into the house before the 2nd
Squad advanced. They wouldn’t fire. Then as the squad approached the building, without TD
fire, the TDs opened up over their heads, knocking the men to the ground with the blast. The
enemy fled from the building, leaving a burning barn behind them. Italians appeared from hiding
places and, in great alarm and agitation, jabbered in Italian about saving the “bambinos” in
Apr 21
122
the burning barn. In some danger to themselves, a few men broke in through the flames, and a
litter of little pigs raced out of the barn into the arms of the joyful Italians. These were their
“bambinos,” and the grateful natives rewarded the soldiers with wine.
The company continued on slowly, the TDs having difficulty with mud in the ditches. They
were ordered to stay up with the lead platoon and Lieutenant ROBERT P. STEWART was put in
one of the vehicles to better control them. One became stuck in a ditch and another stayed back
to pull it out, so that the company reached Highway 9 with only one TD. This was ordered to fire
down the road at enemy machine guns that were pouring fire up the road. The TD fired two
rounds of 76, and warmed up his machine gun with some fire, and the company was able to cross
the road in a series of rushes. Beyond this main highway from Modena to Bologna ran the railroad
embankment. A German machine gun crew was set up just over the embankment and
threatened to hold up the company. Pfc. ROY D. TAYLOR on his own initiative charged over the
railroad tracks, and shooting from the hip, wounded the three members of the crew, and captured
the machine gun.
The TDs having caught up, the company continued their advance to Manzolino. They picked
up occasional prisoners, but ran into no opposition. With the 3rd Platoon leading, the company
was passing to the left of Manzolino still moving on the azimuth. Abreast of the town, they
reached a canal which the TDs couldn’t cross. They then turned right to go through the town
where there were several bridges. In the distance, three German tanks had been seen running
parallel to them and disappearing into the town ahead of them. The 3rd Platoon, followed by the
2nd, then the TDs, and the 1st, entered Manzolino. A hundred yards beyond the town, the squad
leader of the leading squad, Sgt. CHESTER SUGIERSKI, noticed a swirl of dust rising from behind
a building down the road ahead of the column. He turned and yelled back down the column,
“Tanks!”
The men hit the ditches on the roadside, and the TDs wheeled around and rolled back to
town. The nose of the tank slowly emerged from behind the building at the head of the road
bend. Its gun fired before it had cleared the building enough to point down the road, and the
first round landed harmlessly to the right of the troops in the field. Poking its nose out a little
further, the next round hit the last building on the edge of town right amidst the troops. Pfc.
WILLIAM “Steering Wheel” PALMER was lightly wounded in the leg. He refused evacuation,
and the fragment was still in his leg two months later.
The 1st and 3rd Squads of the 3rd Platoon, out ahead of the company, were pinned helplessly
in the ditch before the tanks. Pfc. JOHNNY GRANTHAM was wounded here. With complete
disregard for his own safety, Pfc. GEORGE E. CABEZUT rose up from the ditch and fired
three rifle grenades right at the tank. Pfc. JOHN E. DUDA fired a single grenade in the same
manner. Then the tank depressed its muzzle and fired back point blank at these two brave men.
CABEZUT was instantly killed, and DUDA seriously wounded by the tank which was straddling
the very ditch they were in. Another tank came out from behind the houses, and six or eight
rounds smashed down the road. Pfc. ROY L. MCBRIDE was fatally wounded, and GEORGE
CABEZUT’s brother, Pfc. CLARENCE H. CABEZUT, was wounded. Also S/Sgt. GORDON C.
JOHNSON, Sgt. JOHN J. MURPHY, JR., Pfc. ROY D. TAYLOR, Pfc. JAMES D. MAMARCHEV,
and Pfc. WILLARD H. MILLS, all from the 3rd Platoon. In the weapons platoon, Pfc. GEORGE
D. TOUNG was wounded.
Sgt. CHESTER SUGIERSKI of the 1st Squad and Sgt. FRED BURCH of the 3rd Squad, 3rd
Platoon, opened fire from the ditch with rifles. From behind them, machine guns and bazookas
joined in, and a hail of fire bounced off the two tanks. Then the leading tank moved down the
road towards the riflemen of the 3rd Platoon, and they ducked back and flattened out in the
123
ditch. A light tank across the canal moved up from their left, crossed the bridge right beside
them, and moved up the road a few feet from their heads as they lay in the ditch. After it had
passed, they resumed fire and all three tanks moved off as small arms peppered their steel sides.
The TDs never fired a shot!
The wounded TAYLOR, during the engagement, helped drag back the more seriously
wounded, under fire. Sgt. BURCH and Sgt. SUGIERSKI carried back two other wounded men
from the ditch. The TDs, which had withdrawn 400 yards from the enemy, crept up 200 yards.
The “536” radios were not working at this time. Captain RIORDAN stood by the TDs and yelled
at them to fire. They claimed they couldn’t see. After the three tanks had withdrawn down the
road, enemy small arms fire cracked around the last house where the wounded had been collected.
A “paisan” was shot through the heart just as he stepped out of the doorway. T/5 JACK
PITTMAN got the wounded to a place of safety behind the house, and a medical jeep raced
through the town to the house and evacuated the wounded under heavy fire.
Colonel WORKS ordered elements of the 1st Platoon in town to move into the fields to the
right. The TDs were ordered with them; two went and one stayed behind the town. Out ahead
of the 1st Platoon, Lieutenant MAURICE EWING, Sgt. RALPH MASSEY, Pfc. TED MILLER, Pfc.
ROBERT M. DUDLEY, and Pfc. EDWARD W. VAN ROMER moved off 100 yards looking for a
ditch, just as an enemy tank drove up to not more than 100 yards from them. It fired and nicked
the barrel of the first TD. The crew fled. The second TD refused to fire because it would “disclose
their position,” they said. This crew fled also. Then the enemy tank shot at the handful of
men hiding in the shallow ditch with Lieutenant EWING. The shells hit the bank beyond the
ditch. The men worked down the ditch into a creek and lay in the water. Pfc. TED MILLER, a
company cook, begged for hand grenades with which to rush and attack the tank. The rest of the
squad refused to give them to him. Then the company opened up on the tank from town, and
rifle and small arms fire hammered its armor plating. Although the tank was completely undamaged,
the Nazi crew abandoned the tank and ran off into the woods. The TD crews, who had
fled from their armor, ran amongst the riflemen asking for a bazooka with which to engage the
tank. Before the tank crew had fled, Pfc. WILLARD M. NICHOLS, JR. borrowed a rifle with an
antitank grenade device and, running out into the field, fired two shots at the tank. NICHOLS
had been wounded on Mt. Mosca, but had refused evacuation. (He finally had to go to the hospital
when wounded again on 27 April.) Altogether, seven tanks had been sighted from the town
that day, but the German tanks seemed to be as non-aggressive as our own tank destroyers.
Eight Germans were captured in the action.
The order came from the battalion commander to “pull out and bypass.” Company L had
passed by both K and I, and was leading to the north. Company I moved in behind and K followed,
all in route march, along the road.
Just before dark, while Company L was held up as they “hounded” a retreating field artillery
battalion at a bridge, the column was bombed. As the plane initially passed over, the machine
guns started to open up on it. Then it was identified as an American A-20. Someone yelled,
“Cease firing!” A smoke grenade was thrown for identification, and it is possible that some of
the men rose up from their hastily chosen positions in the roadside and fields. In any case, the
plane came in low as the firing ceased and dropped four bombs, killing fourteen men in the battalion
and wounding thirty. In Company I, Cpl. SOLON R. LINDSEY, Pfc. JOHN LOWATTI, Pfc.
CARL C. PRATER, and Pfc. JOSEPH M. MARTINEZ were killed. Wounded were S/Sgt. PAUL
E. KEMP, S/Sgt. GEORGE V. GEISS, Pfc. ROBERT W. LAKE, Pfc. JAMES H. MORRIS, Pfc. EDWARD
E. MARTNICK, and Pfc. MELVIN R. TULLBURG. The plane was an American plane, but
later it was learned that it was a captured one with a German pilot and German bombs.
Apr 21
124
COMPANY L—ON TO BASTIGLIA
Company L was given only fifteen minutes notice before the weary men were out on the road
marching and shuttling the five miles to the IP at Calcara. Captain EDWARD N. HATHAWAY,
having reported to Regiment the previous afternoon, took command at daylight. The company
forded the canal by the blown bridge some time after 0800. The company was in battalion reserve.
Company K struck the roadblock at 0930 and fought at Madna della Provvidenza. Then
Company I took the lead and fought up to Manzolino, where they met the seven enemy tanks.
At 1500, Company L bypassed Company I. For four hours Company L led the battalion unopposed.
Their weary spirits picked up under the excitement of their rapid progress through village
after village of cheering people who plied the “liberators” with wine, cheese, bread, onions,
and even flowers.
At 1900 the company was approaching the bridge at Navicello when they came upon an unsuspecting
column of a retreating German field artillery battalion. They were marching, and had
packhorses with them. The TDs were pulled up and pounded their column. One enemy horsedrawn
vehicle was blown up by TD fire. Then at twilight, as the head of the column reached the
bridge, machine gun and rifle fire hit them, but some men rushed on across the bridge before it
could be blown. The TDs followed across and fired into more of the retreating artillerymen. Another
column of horse-drawn German vehicles was sighted coming toward the bridge from the
right rear. The 1st Platoon got into position and fired down the road, assisted by TDs. Fifty
German artillerymen were killed here by the TDs, machine gun and rifle fire. The head of our
own column was pinned down by friendly supporting machine gun fire where the road turned
right just beyond the bridge.
While the head of the column was held up by this action, tragedy struck further back near
Bagazzano. Just at dusk the enemy-piloted American bomber roared over the column, came back
and bombed the column as the men lay scattered in the ditches and fields. Of the fourteen deaths
and thirty wounded, Company L lost Pfc. RAFAEL BALDOR, JR., Pfc. FRANK J. LUIF, and T/5
MICHAEL G. NENNIG. Wounded were S/Sgt. KENNETH G. SHANER, Sgt. LEWIS HAUGE,
and Pfc. ALBERT E. SORIA.
At 2100 the column pushed on again from the bridge. In the dark they passed dead Germans,
horses, oxen, and all kinds of abandoned and destroyed equipment and guns. Down the
road, as the moon rose, a round from a TD fired a haystack where some Germans were seen to
run and hide. They were burned to death.
3rd Battalion—Battle of Bastiglia
COMPANY L
Company L was still leading the battalion as they reached the southern edge of Bastiglia at
2330. At the bridge crossing into the center of town they could see groups of Germans walking
around in the square, and standing around in groups talking. Some of them just across the
bridge waved amicably to the Americans. Individual German soldiers kept pedaling by on bicycles,
clearly believing themselves miles from the front lines. At first they were mistaken for
friendly Partisans because of their nonchalance. But in the moonlight the lead scout recognized
the uniform of the Nazis. He yelled to them, ordering them across the bridge with their hands
up. The nearest group standing in front of a building, the same way a group gathers outside a
corner drug store in the United States, took this command with good humor. They laughed and
talked among themselves as though it were a joke. Finally one of them yelled in alarm, “Americans!”
Apr 21
125
A pistol shot rang out. Colonel WORKS, up with the scout leading the battalion, thought he
hit one of the surprised Nazis. Then the scouts returned the German rifle fire. Pfc. ROBERT C.
DILLON, a BAR man and one of the lead scouts, was wounded by the German fire. Lieutenant
EARNEST W. RICKENBACKER, who had joined the company that morning, led his 1st Platoon
forward to the bridge. They took positions in the woods across the road from the canal. He
stood by the south end of the bridge firing his pistol into the Germans now scurrying around
across the canal. His pistol jammed just as two Germans from behind him started to run by him
to cross the bridge into the town. As they went by, he snatched the rifle away from one, and raising
it quickly, shot the fleeing German in the back.
Next the bazookas were called up, and the TDs pushed across the bridge, pausing on the far
side. Two Krauts on a bicycle came riding up the road from the east. Thirty-five yards away in
the moonlight they were fired on. They fell off the bike, and one came up and leaned against a
TD as though it were German. He was shot through the neck by RICKENBACKER. The Germans
had been driven back from the canal, and Lieutenant GUY B. BLOOD’s 3rd Platoon passed
through the 1st, which by now was badly scattered in the woods south of the canal. Company M
firing their machine guns through the woods had scattered and pinned them. The 3rd Platoon
sent squads up either side of the buildings, and they were met beyond the square by a moving
German personnel carrier. It turned north up the street, was fired on, but kept going. Another
personnel carrier followed towing a field piece, and another personnel carrier followed it. The
TDs opened up from the square, smashing round after round head on into the vehicles, spewing
the flaming occupants out onto the road, and lighting up their own side street. The TDs next
moved up to the far edge of town, and from there fired out into houses suspected of covering the
German machine guns. After a few minutes of this, a highly excited Italian ran up stark naked
except for a flaring coat. Six rounds had gone screaming through his bedroom. As an innocent
bystander, that was enough for him, and he had gotten out of bed in some alarm.
The TD then withdrew back to the square. Here some confusion had developed. Seven enemy
came in from the left and surrendered. Then some unit in the rear started pouring fire into
the square over the heads of the men of the 3rd Platoon. The captured Krauts scattered under
this fire as Lieutenant BLOOD fired after them with his carbine. Colonel WORKS ordered Company
L on out of town, and Lieutenant BLOOD got his leading squad out 250 to 300 yards. Here
he was fired on again by machine gun fire from a house across the field to the left. The TD was
called up. As it got into position behind the leading squad close up against a building, a Panzerfaust
bulls-eyed it twice. Captain EDWARD N. HATHAWAY, who had assumed command that
very morning, was leaning against the TD when it was hit, and the blow sent him reeling back
just as a shutter fell off the house and struck him on the head. He was half-stunned, but he continued
to run the company. The Panzerfausts started pounding in. Pfc. RAYMOND W. BIGGS
and Pfc. EMIL J. SMERCAK were wounded and two others were less seriously hit. The squad
withdrew under BAR covering fire back to the north edge of town.
Back in town there was great confusion. Fire was still coming from the rear in increasing
volume. Captain HATHAWAY was trying to organize a platoon combat team to push on
through the opposition, when Colonel WORKS ordered a skirmish line to be built up. Companies
K and I were by this time up in town too, and everyone was shooting all over, from the rear
as well as the front.
It was now about 0300, and the men had culminated their long drive through the mountains
with more than twenty hours of continuous marching and fighting over 25 miles of flatland.
Their great fatigue had been staved off somewhat during the day by the excitement of the
throngs of happy Italians. Many were kept going by the plentiful vino, but all were reaching a
126
stage of complete physical exhaustion. Sometimes men would fire, and only the sound of their
own piece going off would snap them back to consciousness.
Colonel WORKS was everywhere urging the staggering men forward. The battle swayed
back and forth through the town, a volley of Panzerfausts driving back the soldiers in a mad wave.
Then the TDs firing blindly back as the soldiers moved out again. At one time Colonel WORKS,
as the TDs were withdrawing against his direct command, in sheer anger tore off his helmet and
hurled it against the TD, which thereupon went forward again. The Germans were still thick inside
the town, but apparently badly disorganized. Many times Germans would be upstairs and
Americans down, firing up through the ceilings. Why there were not more American casualties,
even from friendly fire, no one will ever know. For sheer volume of fire in a small confined area,
Bastiglia between 0030 and 0300 was a place of terror.
At 0300 Company I was preparing to bypass the town and strike on to the bridge over the
Secchia River, the regimental objective, two miles beyond the town. At this time, Lieutenant
Colonel WORKS radioed to the regimental commander, Colonel FOWLER, “Are reorganized and
pushing on to objective.” The order came back for him to “dispose your troops for defense, and
rest.”
Company L was withdrawn at 0400. At this time casualties seemed to be heavy; soldiers lay
around in the gutters and against buildings in the grotesque positions of the dead. They were not
dead, but deep in the sleep of exhaustion. The company re-crossed the canal and bivouacked at
about 0430. Two 88-mm guns with half-tracks had been captured, and two and a half truckloads
of German dead were carted away by the Italians in the morning. Our casualties had been extremely
light. Besides the three wounded mentioned from Company L, one man from Battalion
Headquarters was wounded: S/Sgt. THEODORE C. MERRITT. That was all compared with the
mounds of German dead. S/Sgt. MERRITT, mess sergeant of Headquarters Company, had tired
of the inactivity of the rear area and had joined each company as it fought during the day. In anger
he single-handedly tackled an enemy strong point, but was stopped and finally wounded by
the same round that shook up Captain HATHAWAY.
COMPANY K
Some time after midnight, Company K entered Bastiglia behind Company L. The men’s exhaustion,
staved off all day by the stimulation of the triumphant march, was now claiming them.
Many were in a half stupor from sheer fatigue. A few had kept themselves going on vino, and
their torpor may have been aided by this, but most of the men were just “bushed” from the long,
continuous, day-after-day struggle topped by this final 25-mile march. Consequently, the wild
confusion in the square was no more than could be expected. The battle-massed lines swayed
back and forth like the battle lines of ancient Persia. When a German bazooka fired, everyone
surged to the rear; then they pushed forward again firing wildly in all directions. The TDs tried
to hide behind the infantry, but the infantry were in too flighty a mood to be hid behind. Every
time a TD scurried to the rear, twenty-five infantry men piled on top of it, “If you are leaving, so
are we!”
Some of the officers ran around trying to organize the men in the flashing darkness. A mortar
man, asked why he wasn’t firing his carbine, handed his mortar to the officer saying, “Here,
hold this.” He fired a few shots to windward, and then took his mortar back.
Another man sitting on the curb firing his rifle into the air was asked what he was doing.
“Making a helluva lot of noise, like everyone else,” he answered, and squeezed the trigger again
for emphasis.
Apr 21
127
Prisoners, enemy, and Italian civilians moved in and out of the dark buildings with the soldiers,
all in equal confusion. Captain EDDY went to sleep while receiving an order. Piles of grotesque
bodies, seemingly dead, in the gutters and against the walls, were in reality sleeping men.
Only the sound of their own firing kept others conscious. Yet the firepower was terrible for the
Germans, who were surrendering in wild confusion. One German surrendered to an American
sergeant, and then seeing the sergeant unarmed, went back into the building and got his own rifle
and handed it to him.
At 0400 the troops were ordered back out of Bastiglia and bivouacked south of the canal.
They rested most of the next day.
COMPANY I
At midnight, Companies I and K joined L in the furious battle for Bastiglia. During the four
hours of wild firing, the near-exhausted men were kept in some semblance of organization by the
fine efforts of Lieutenant ALEXANDER JONES, the company executive officer. Pfc. ATWELL G.
AUSTIN was deafened by German bazooka fire. Although they suffered no other casualties,
Company I, during the long struggle between the confused and sometimes drunken Germans
and the weary and often sleeping Americans, was swept back and forth in the crowded square
with the rest of the battalion. Due to excellent control amidst the confusion, they were able to
withdraw around 0330, when ordered to bypass and swing around the right flank to the north of
town. They were moving forward west of town toward the regimental objective, the bridge over
the Secchia, when Regiment ordered the advance halted and the men to rest. Company I spent
the rest of the night in defensive positions on the west side of town.
COMPANY M
Early in the morning Company M moved on vehicles out into the flatland behind the rifle
companies of the leading 3rd Battalion. Here began a new type of warfare for the men, a warfare
of movement and excitement. Company M opened the shooting by missing a ford across a canal
near Calcara and finding itself alone in a firefight with enemy snipers. It was no place for a
heavy weapons company, so they got out as fast as they could. This wasn’t easy because of the
cross-crossing pattern of drainage ditches, which blocked the progress of the vehicles. Dashing
about with machine guns lashed on the hoods of jeeps was reminiscent of gang fights during
Prohibition—and it was that kind of fighting. The paisans tried to tell the men where the Tedeschi
were, but were not of much help, as they were scattered in small groups on all sides.
An extremely attractive signorina showed up in one of the farmyards in which the men were
“Kraut hunting.” For the moment, the war was forgotten, and from the assemblage of GIs, it
looked like “mail call.” This was fairly typical of occurrences throughout the Po campaign. One
moment the men would be basking in the role of “liberator” with vino glasses and the local populace
applauding them, and the next moment they would be jerked back to reality by the sound of
firing ahead at a roadblock.
After that little episode, Company M rejoined the battalion in the column and took off again.
The battalion went on again against scattered, but often stubborn, resistance, zigzagging across
fields and through farmyards. They crossed Highway 9 and went on to Manzolino, where they
hit heavy resistance and tangled with German tanks. Sgt. JAMES TOOMEY put a tank out of action
here by the tremendous volume of fire from his .30-caliber machine gun.
After the firefight at Manzolino, the battalion quickly reorganized and soon was on the road
again. The weary rifle soldiers plodded on and looked with envy on Company M with its jeeps.
However, the frequent cries of “Machine guns forward!” showed how necessary the transportation
was in this “blitz” type of warfare.
Apr 21
128
Approaching the Panaro River, the column was attacked by an enemy plane near Bagazzano.
The .30-caliber machine guns and some .50-calibers opened up on it, but the plane was able to lay
its bombs and fly off. Killed was the splendid company executive officer, First Lieutenant WILLIAM
D. FLOYD, who had been with the company since the early days of the first year at Camp
Hale.
Shortly afterward, the head of the column was engaged in a sharp firefight at the bridge.
This was still intact, although prepared for demolition. There were teller mines lying on the surface.
Wiping out the resistance here, the company continued on to the town of Bastiglia, reaching
there after dark and taking an active part in the hectic battle in the square.
OTHER CASUALTIES
The gun platoon of 3rd Battalion Headquarters Company felt the tragic bombing at Bagazzano
keenly. Five men were instantly killed: Sgt. WID R. CORN, Pfc. GEORGE H. HEYDENREICH,
Pfc. EUGENE J. PIOTROWSKI, Pfc. SAMUEL H. STONER, and Pfc. WAYNE WILLIAMS.
Pfc. OSCAR W. HEMMER was fatally wounded. These men were moving their gun into
position when the plane came over. They made a dash for cover, but one bomb landed right on
them. Wounded were: Sgt. WILLIAM H. FRICKE*, Sgt. MERLE D. MEREDITH, and Pfc. EMIL
M. MATAYA.
In Bastiglia that night, the mess sergeant, S/Sgt. THEODORE C. MERRITT, in anger tackled
single-handedly an enemy strong point. He was stopped when wounded by an enemy bazooka
shell.
During the morning, two drivers, Pfc. JOHN WILLIS and Pfc. ALEX GUSKO, were missing
with their 2 1/2 -ton trucks. With them was an American serving as an officer in the British army,
Lieutenant GLENN. They disappeared during the shuttle movement to Calcara. Their story was
revealed later by WILLIS [see page 135], but GUSKO was killed that morning.
1st Battalion—To Bastiglia
The long march into the valley was largely uneventful for the 1st Battalion, as far as fighting
went. They worked cross-country two or three miles behind the leading 3rd Battalion, with
Companies A and C searching out the houses of the cheering Italians and picking up scattered
prisoners. But the 3rd Battalion was moving faster ahead of them, so the 1st Battalion was swung
back on the road into the triumphant column.
Like the rest of the columns, they captured startled Germans who blundered into their ranks.
Once, after dark, on the bridge at Navicello, they had a bazooka round thrown at them, and a
high-velocity shell whizzed down the road between their files, but throughout the day they were
hit by nothing but flowers, cheese, bread, onions, and the omnipresent wine.
Near midnight, on the 21st, the column was held up south of Bastiglia. The 3rd Battalion,
which had led all day, had started the four-hour struggle for the town. Company D had just
crossed some railroad tracks, turned sharply right, and elements of the company were resting
beside the little railroad station a hundred yards or so from the crossing. There was the sound of
occasional firing up ahead, interspersed with short periods of silence, and now and then maneuvering
tanks could be heard in the darkness. A bright moon offered some visibility, and all was
quiet around the railroad station. Off in the distance, the shrill-piping noise of a European train
became increasingly louder. The men, resting in vehicles along the roadside, listened idly as the
insistent whistling came closer and closer. A train on the battlefront was an incredible thought,
* Sgt. WILLIAM H. FRICKE died of these wounds in a military hospital in Pennsylvania on July 14, 1946.
129
yet they couldn’t think of anything else it could be. As the whistle got louder and louder, they
questioned each other in wonder. The long convoy of vehicles streamed back across the tracks
for miles behind them. With whistle still shrilling, the little freight train came clicking up the
track, passing neatly between two vehicles at the crossing and on to the station. Someone opened
fire from near the station, and the train ground to a stop. Most of the men in the convoy, however,
were too surprised to take any action, only diving into the ditches as short bursts of automatic
fire came from the train. Then the whole column opened up on the train from both sides of
the crossing. Figures could be seen jumping from the train trying to escape. Lieutenant KENNETH
W. ALPERT killed one German, and Lieutenant ANTSELM R. BRADLEY another, before
they had gotten more than a few feet. The two-man Italian train crew immediately surrendered.
First Lieutenant GEORGE F. EARLE, in the little station where the Italians were questioned,
found all in order: tickets were in the racks; change box in the cash drawer; the rubber stamps of
Fascist officialdom were each in place; and a telephone rang incessantly. The Italians claimed a
train was due in the station at any moment, and the phone was ringing to locate the stalled train.
Back at the crossing, the convoy had literally been cut in two by the rear end of the train, stationary
on the tracks. Then the rear four boxcars were uncoupled, and a crowd of soldiers rolled
them back down the tracks to clear the road.
The noise of fire from Bastiglia had swollen into a great crescendo by this time, but the telephone
in the little station seemed louder and continued to ring, unconcerned with the battle
nearby. Even after the telephone was pulled out from the wall, it continued to ring insistently,
until the railroad bridge a mile to the east blew into the air, taking the wires with it. This really
unimportant incident with the train, whose boxcars and flatcars were loaded with garden loam,
grain, and a small amount of ammunition, appealed to the men’s fancy because it was so incongruous.
The story of “the train” became a more important topic than many of the vital battles
fought during the offensive.
2nd Battalion—March Across the Valley
At dawn of the 21st, the 2nd Battalion marched down into the Po Valley in column of companies
to Calcara, with Bastiglia 25 miles further away. Because of the uncertainty of the situation
in front, Lieutenant Colonel JOHN SCHMELZER, regimental executive, held the battalion
beyond Calcara until he received word that the leading 3rd Battalion was making good progress.
When Company E moved out, the company on a front of four to five hundred yards, they flushed
eleven Germans from one dugout. Acting Sergeant ARMAND LEVESQUE, while rounding up
these prisoners, noticed one arrogant Nazi who still felt himself to be a superman and expected
treatment accordingly. The Nazi made a break for freedom, and the sergeant shot him through
the leg.
At about 1930 the lead scouts were fired on by machine guns. The 3rd Platoon built up a line
of fire with rifles, machine guns, BARs, and bazookas. They advanced under this fire, and were
even supported by the mortars. The enemy machine gun was knocked out; two Germans were
killed, two wounded, and the rest fled. Italians revealed that 15 Germans had just fled from the
right front. Captain LE GRAND PENDREY moved over onto the right with Sgt. ANDREW
GARIHAN’s squad and pursued the enemy by the use of machine guns and the company mortars.
These two actions were the first use of Company E mortars. Still moving on an azimuth of
340 degrees, the company hit their crossroads objective right on the nose. The company reassembled
on the road, and in a battalion column followed the 3rd and 1st Battalions—marching all
night to Bastiglia. After daybreak, the company dug in around houses south of Bastiglia, and
took some much-needed rest.
Apr 21
130
Company F’s part in the drive was simply a long 32-mile march. Only the excitement of the
cheering “liberated” Italian people, and their gifts of vino kept the weary soldiers going. Occasionally
there was shellfire, sniper fire, and frequently fighting nearby, but mostly it was straight
marching for mile after mile down the road, first by day, then all night to a point south of Bastiglia.
At dawn Company G had marched into the Po Valley and set up a roadblock at Muffa. They
were relieved there by the 10th Anti-tank Battalion at 1200, and began the forced march following
the rest of the regiment, which lasted all night. Pfc. TURIDDU F. CARTAINO was wounded by
artillery at Fossa Vecchia, just beyond Calcara.
Company H’s machine guns were attached to rifle companies. The mortar platoon followed
the battalion in the long march, reaching the battalion bivouac area at 0600 on 22 April.
Situation at the End of the Eighth Day
On the morning of the 22nd of April back at Fifth Army headquarters, a general addressing
the Army staff at the daily orientation meeting indicated the big spotlighted situation map behind
him and said: “Gentlemen, this morning the Armored Division has lost ground in the
mountains; while on the other hand, the Mountain Infantry is racing across the valley!”
NINTH DAY—22 APRIL
The Division plan for the 22nd was to move by all available motors and by marching, on one
road to the Po River near San Benedetto Po. Task Force DUFF was to lead early in the morning,
to be followed by the 1st Battalion, 87th, in trucks. Then two battalions of the 85th were to march.
The 616th FA battalion was to furnish all its available trucks to haul the 2nd Battalion and the 3rd
Battalion, 87th, in a shuttle movement, and then close at the Po with its own guns and personnel.
1st Battalion—To the Po River
On the 22nd, the 1st Battalion followed Task Force DUFF in trucks and shared in the celebrations
the long column received in every town. Frequently the confusion of the enemy was demonstrated
when some of their elements blundered into the battalion column. As Company D,
well back in the column, approached the bridge beyond Bastiglia, two German trucks came in
from a right fork and surrendered in bewilderment. Immediately afterward, three more trucks
appeared across the bridge coming straight toward the Americans. The men in the near vehicles
jumped out and yelled to the Germans to surrender. The surprised enemy poured from their vehicles
and opened fire with machine guns and burp guns from behind an embankment. Then, as
the size of the American column became apparent to them, they surrendered.
The battalion arrived on the south bank of the Po River by midnight. An enemy bombing
plane worked over them in the night, but did no damage to their positions around the Battalion
CP set up in a farmhouse. In the morning there was some leisure for heating C-rations and cleaning
up. On the way to the river the night before, one squad of Company A had been left with a
platoon of B to establish a roadblock south of San Benedetto Po.
2nd Battalion—To the Po River
Meanwhile, tragedy struck Company G. This company, last in the column, had arrived at
Bastiglia at 0830 of the 22nd, after marching a distance of 32 miles during the twenty-four hour
period. They rested south of town. About 1400, as the men were finishing their C-rations and
preparing to load on trucks for the shuttle movement to the Po, four heavy German shells
screamed in about the Company CP. The third round hit the corner of the CP building, striking a
Apr 22
131
crowd of men coming out of the house into the courtyard. Killed and wounded lay all over the
courtyard. Second Lieutenant STANLEY F. JAZWINSKI was killed, and also Pfc. MELVIN
BERNSTEIN, Pvt. CHARLIE I. GREEN and Pvt. ALFRED C. MCDONALD. Pvt. LAWRENCE E.
MCARDLE died of his wounds, and two company medics, litter bearers Pfc. ROY G. GAY and
T/5 HAROLD S. HARRIS, were killed. Also Pfc. PAUL J. BUCHANAN, a litter bearer of Company
E, was killed.
Wounded were: Second Lieutenant RUDOLPH L. MARKER, S/Sgt. ROGER B. COREY,
S/Sgt. MAGNE MALMIN, Sgt. WILLIAM M. KENNEDY, JR., Sgt. WILLIAM F. MCGOWAN,
T/4 JAMES T. MITCHELL, Pfc. GILBERT H. CYR, Pfc. MAURICE I. DASHEVSKY, Pfc. CALVIN
DE BUHR, Pfc. FRANCESCO DE CLARY, Pfc. FRANK ESOLA, Pfc. ROBERT C. GREGORY, Pfc.
JOSEPH G. LAMIRANDE, Pfc. LEONARD D. MCATEE, Pfc. LENIN PELLEGRINO, Pfc.
GILBERT W. PYLE, Pfc. VIRGIL L. RESLER, and Pfc. RAYMOND M. WIETOR. Two Company G
medics were wounded: Pfc. FRANCIS G. GIRARD and Pfc. CALVIN L. LONGSTRETH.
At 1600, the 2nd Battalion entrucked at Bastiglia and rode until nearly sunset. Then they
marched until early in the morning to a position 500 yards from the Po River. Some of the battalion
elements were able to ride all the way. They drove or marched past the wreckage of the retreating
army, lit up at night by burning buildings, vehicles, and exploding ammunition dumps.
The prisoners marched to the rear in long columns.
Company E moved to Gorgo, to the left of the divisional position on the south bank of the Po.
The rest of the battalion spent the night in foxholes between Gorgo and the river. That night
Lieutenant FLOYD E. ALEXANDER of Company F, with a squad and a half of the 3rd Platoon,
and a machine gun, were sent out to clear out and guard the left flank at the bend where the river
flowed north. He wasn’t able to find the battalion again until two days later, the day after the
crossing. During the day of the crossing, 23 April, S/Sgt. JOHN E. LANCE was wounded. Before
ALEXANDER’s men left the south bank, they picked up $2,000 of German paper money,
part of a fabulous amount that had been blown out of a dugout by shellfire.
3rd Battalion—To the Po River
The battalion was alerted to move out at 0800 on the 22nd, but the tired troops were called
back five minutes after they started to assemble, because Task Force DUFF had not been able to
cross the Secchia River as early as planned. They were alerted again at 1330, and finally began
the march at 1700. The battalion column, across the Secchia, stopped for a supper break at Limidi
and then marched on toward Carpi.
The men’s spirits soared, as the celebrating civilians rose to even greater heights of enthusiasm
than the day before, ringing bells, bedecking the soldiers with flowers, embracing and cheering
them on. At every house and hamlet, the people ran out with glasses and bottles, white or
red vino, and sometimes champagne or sparkling burgundy. There were baskets of bread,
cheeses, onions, and milk. It was an unforgettable day for the infantryman, whose normal, grim
hardships are neither seen nor recognized. Although many accepted the demonstration with the
ironic thought that Mussolini’s armies might have received the same welcome a few years before,
and perhaps the German armies even more recently, nevertheless an occasional sight would
touch the heart. Granting the extravagant emotion of these people, the soldiers could appreciate
welcome. The middle-aged man who was leaping up and down in a frenzy, with tears streaming
down his cheeks, as the troops passed by hour after hour, and who was still at it well on to midnight,
must have been at the very least pleased to see the Americans. “He must’a won a pool on
the day we’d arrive,” was the laconic remark of a passing GI. Company M traded cigarettes for
bicycles, and a good many German trucks and little Fiats were commandeered.
132
At 2000, trucks returned from the shuttle of the 2nd Battalion, and the 3rd Battalion loaded
thirty-five to forty men on a truck. The trucks roared off in the dust without lights at twenty-five
to forty miles per hour. The road was a narrow ribbon of Allied territory, stretching mile after
mile deeper into German terrain. All day Task Force DUFF had led the column; however, there
was nothing but enemy on either side of the long procession of men and vehicles. Step off the
road and one was in Kraut land. Occasionally a stray burp gun would fire toward the road to
emphasize this, but mostly the enemy hugged their dugouts for the night and surrendered quietly
in the morning. Or else they tapped a driver’s shoulder when the column halted and were
searched and waved to the rear. Columns and small groups of prisoners, either with or without
Partisan guards, were strung along the road all evening headed south. One group of prisoners
even caught the festive spirit, and cheered with their Italian guards as the American soldiers
passed.
Situation at the End of the Ninth Day
The march of the 10th Mountain Division on the 22nd, and far into the small hours of the
23rd, brought the infantry of the Division about 35 miles deeper into enemy territory—to the
south bank of the Po River.
Brigadier General DUFF, in command of the Task Force, was seriously wounded at San
Benedetto Po as he moved on foot to warn a tank crew of mines in the road.
Before daylight of the 23rd, all of the 87th was in position—all very tired: 1st Battalion on the
bank of the Po; 2nd Battalion a few hundred yards south near Gorgo; and the 3rd south of the
railroad at San Benedetto Po. Early in the morning, Colonel DAVID M. FOWLER, trying to find
out what was expected of the 87th during the day, found General HAYS at the Division CP, located
within a half-mile of the river. Having reported the locations of the battalions, Colonel
FOWLER was told that the 1st Battalion commanded by Lieutenant Colonel ROSS J. WILSON
would prepare to cross the river about noon; the 2nd Battalion under Lieutenant Colonel
EMMETT L, NATIONS should mop up the area around Gorgo; and the 3rd Battalion under Lieutenant
Colonel ROBERT C. WORKS should establish roadblocks south of San Benedetto Po to
protect the Division rear. Colonel FOWLER then visited each battalion commander in turn and
gave these instructions.
TENTH DAY—23 APRIL
At 1130, General HAYS called Colonel FOWLER to the Division CP and said, “Fowler, the
87th Infantry has the honor of crossing the Po—at 1200. You will establish a bridgehead, first
here, then expand to here, and finally here (drawing bold strokes on an overlay). The 85th on the
right will support by fire. Tank destroyers, tanks, and the 1125th Field Artillery Battalion (Armored)
will support you. Division artillery hasn’t closed. It will support as soon as it arrives.
No air support is available until 1330.” In the few remaining minutes, Colonel NATIONS was
informed personally, but Colonel WORKS was making reconnaissance for roadblocks, as previously
instructed, and his battalion began the march to the river under the executive officer, Major
JOHN C. MCKAY. (Colonel WORKS, with his reconnaissance party in two jeeps, received the
surrender of a large busload of German soldiers—sixty-five in all—and turned them over to the
86th PW cage.)
The crossing of the Po is probably unique in the degree to which preparation for the move
was sacrificed in favor of speed. A more detailed study of the river and the enemy situation
would have disclosed that enemy antiaircraft artillery west of the river bend would be able to
enfilade the positions of the troops waiting on the south bank, as well as the actual crossing of the
Apr 23
133
river. A crossing further east would lessen the effectiveness of this fire. Another important advantage
of a lower crossing would have been the avoidance of the crossing of the Mincio River
just beyond. The bridges over this deep tributary were vital to the continued advance of the Division.
No study of aerial photos had been made in the regiment. The only reconnaissance was a
quick “look-see” from the southern end of the German barge crossing. The enemy situation
across on the north bank, overprinted on a G-2 map, was received too late for study. Artillery
was rushed into position as it arrived from Bomporto, but no customary, heavy preparation fires
were possible. Air support for the initial crossing was completely absent. The air groups were in
the stage of moving to forward fields to be within range, and all of their communication equipment
was on the move. Finally, there was no bridging equipment immediately available, no
powered boats, nor any kind of amphibious vehicle. There was not even a satisfactory telephone
cable heavy enough to withstand the broad stream’s current. Therefore during the crossing there
were only the unreliable radio messages in code from north to south bank. Maps were not issued
in time to be pasted together. The regimental overlays were dashed off in about ten minutes.
General HAYS had first conceived of the possibility of an early crossing the night before. At
1800 of the 22nd, an engineer lieutenant was sent hastily to the rear to see what boats he could get
from IV Corps headquarters south of Bomporto. He returned at 0600 of the 23rd with fifty assault
boats on five 2 1/2 - ton trucks.
General HAYS was standing on the peaceful riverbank at 0830 when word reached him that
the boats had arrived five miles away. Fifteen minutes later he made his decision. The river
would be crossed without delay. He suggested 0930, but Lieutenant Colonel JOHN R. PARKER,
commander of the 126th Mountain Engineer Battalion, declared that 1030 was the earliest the
boats could be on the riverbank with engineer crews ready to paddle across.
1st Battalion—Crossing the Po
Colonel WILSON received the orders at 0930, and at 1015 Company A was ordered to “be at
the river in ten minutes.” However, the boats were still arriving at the river at 1030; there had not
been time for everyone to be ready. H-Hour was changed to 1200 noon. The south bank of the
river was low and flat, but three high banks or dikes ran along parallel to the river, fifty to a hundred
yards apart. The main blacktopped road ran perpendicular on an embankment of the same
height as the dikes, and stopped at an old ferry landing on the river’s edge. Initially, all of the
troops of the 87th and their supporting weapons were on the left of this main road to the ferry
landing. A battalion of the 85th was in position on the right (east) of this main road, to add their
firepower to support the crossing of the 87th.
As the five trucks carrying the fifty boats came down the road, in full view from the surrounding
countryside, the first three were directed to the left by the S-3 of the 126th Engineers.
They moved along the top of the river dike for about 300 yards, just as enemy artillery fire began
cracking into a grove of trees ahead of them, to the west of our troops. This was mostly 20-mm
AA flak, the first sign of enemy activity noted all that quiet morning. Four of the machine guns
of Company D were set up along the second dike just to the left of the road, and their six 81-mm
mortars were back of the last dike, not far from the house occupied by the 1st Battalion CP. The
3rd Battalion of the 85th had a similar set-up, with their weapons on the right side of the road.
The only fire up until 1030 had been their mortars registering on the north bank. The last two
trucks turned to the right off of the road and left their twenty boats east of the road, downstream
from the others, and supposedly in reserve.
134
The engineers then withdrew behind the dikes to reorganize. Each boat was to have a twoman
crew. Every ten boats had a platoon to man them and an officer in charge. There were
enough engineers so that each crew theoretically would have to make but three crossings. Actually
it didn’t work out that way at all.
The 1125th Armored Field Artillery had ten of its 105s just behind the 1st Battalion CP building.
Eight more were in position 7,000 yards further south. British 178th Lowland Medium
Royal Artillery of the 7th AGRA had twelve of its 5.5s in position near Zovo. Four tank destroyers
had moved up to the dikes the night before and two more TDs moved up on their left at 1115.
COMPANY A—FIRST ACROSS
Up behind the banks in the assembly area to the left of B, Company A received the order as
their two TDs moved up. At 1130, the enemy 20-mm and 88-mm fire, high-explosive as well as
time-fire, walked down the dikes toward the waiting troops. This fire was harassing but not serious.
Although at the time it was difficult to locate where this enemy fire was coming from, it later
developed that the Germans had two crescents of 20-mm “ack-ack” consisting of six dual mounts
and four quadruple mounts 2,500 yards due west. The river curved sharply south of the left of
the troops, upstream from the old ferry landing, and the enemy positions were across the river
where they formerly protected, against air attack, their own pontoon bridge demolished the previous
night after the Germans had retreated across it. Close to the AA batteries was an 88 in a
built-up position. Four other 88s were nearby to complete the battery. To the northwest, at
Giordane, five more 88s were in the yard of a house, but these five were all in AA positions, and
were masked from the river by trees. Beyond Giordane, on the south bank of the Mincio Canal
were six more dual-mount 20-mm guns.
As Company A was about to move to the boats at seven minutes before noon, the first bad
barrage of concentrated “ack-ack” began cracking over the troops. After five minutes, it let up
and Company A moved forward at two minutes past noon. Company D had got its other four
machine guns, under Lieutenant WILLIAM SPINNEY, up on the left of Company A just as they
moved off. Three guns pointed due west to protect the left flank, and the fourth joined Lieutenant
ANTSELM BRADLEY’s four guns to traverse 1,000 yards west from the ferry landing. East of
the landing were the eight guns of the 85th.
The company objective on the north shore was the group of houses called Gassole up the
river to the left. The 1st and 3rd Platoons were to make up the leading wave of four boats.
These two platoons, now only forty-eight men, moved into boats under the barrage, but free
from small arms fire. For the first time, the men were ordered to fix bayonets. The furthest boat
upstream was in command of Lieutenant WILFERD L. PHILLIPSEN of the 3rd Platoon. This
boat was the first to touch shore, and T/Sgt. GEORGE W. HURT of this boat is reportedly the
first man across the Po River. The men of this first wave were the first Allied soldiers to fight
their way across the great river. Others had crossed the Po. Prisoners had been escorted across;
fliers had dropped behind; and Partisans had sneaked over from time to time; but Sergeant
HURT changed the map when he and the others scrambled out of the first boat. They crossed
officially. Hitler himself was probably notified that American infantrymen were across the Po on
the 23rd of April. And where the Mountain Infantry has reached, there no enemy has ever held
forth again. The footprints of the men of the 87th, on the sandbars and up the grassy north bank
of the Po, were that day marked on the maps of the world.
Sgt. HAROLD M. CREGER of the 3rd Platoon, in the second boat downstream, with Sgt.
ALVIN C. HANEY, took charge when the engineers seemed helpless to control the paddling. He
Apr 23
135
commanded silence and counted cadence, keeping the men’s spirits up and their fright down, as
fire burst over the river. Someone called the crossing a longer trip than crossing the Atlantic.
The third boat, commanded by Second Lieutenant JAMES H. STEWART, of the 1sr Platoon,
was the second boat across, and its men were the first over the steep bank. The fourth boat
downstream, commanded by Sgt. WILLIAM F. WHITEHEAD, carried the remainder of the 1st
Platoon. This boat struck a sandbar which held them up. Three boats of Company B were moving
on the right, and one touched shore before the fourth boat of Company A got in. The north
shore landings were treacherous. The current, sweeping around the big bend at the left in a
clockwise direction, raced along the north bank, scouring out channels and piling up sandbars.
The boats were swept to broadside landings by the current, and several men stepped into deep
water off of the sandbars. Pfc. CLIFFORD G. ABNEY, JR. held his radio over his head to keep it
dry, even though he dropped momentarily into water over his head.
The three boats of the second wave carrying the command group, some weapons men, and
seven men of the 2nd Platoon, hit the water before the first wave had landed. By this time, fire
was heavy on the south bank, and the men were glad to leave. Some automatic fire started dusting
the beach from across to the right, and some sniper fire came from Gassole. Lieutenant
BRADLEY of Company D, spotting the enemy machine gun at some buildings down to the right,
manned one of his own guns and neutralized it. Then a TD, following his tracers, pumped in a
couple of rounds, which smashed the house.
Captain HUGH KLEMME led the first boatload of fourteen men in the second wave. In the
center boat was S/Sgt. JAMES A. GUNSALLUS and his 2nd Mortar Squad of only six men. On
the right, Sgt. EDGAR BREWSTER’s boat carried the 3rd Mortar Squad, while the 1st Squad remained
back with the 2nd Platoon, where they had been firing in support of the first wave. Sgt.
BREWSTER, determined to keep his boat from drifting downstream, pointed it partly into the
current, and crossed from the right to the left of the other two boats.
The third wave of S/Sgt. ANTON MASTALER’s 1st Mortar Squad, and men from the 2nd
Platoon, crossed with the leading wave of Company C under considerable fire.
Once across, the company moved 300 yards inland against scattered sniper fire, and swung
to the right and collected against the Fossa Bolognina canal dike. As the riflemen passed the
empty German bunkers along the dike, a figure in an American uniform ran out with his hands
up. His story is one of the most amazing of the war.
THE JOHN WILLIS STORY
The regiment, during its three months in combat, has the unique record of no man lost to the
enemy as a prisoner.* The two men still officially listed as “missing in action” both disappeared
during tremendous artillery barrages when not in direct contact with the enemy. Unquestionably,
their bodies were buried with the “unidentified.”
The closer this enviable record came to being broken was on the first morning in the Po Valley,
the 21st of April. On that morning Pfc. JOHN WILLIS, a 3rd Battalion Headquarters driver,
was captured. His experience gives some sidelight on the German situation at that crucial period
of the offensive. Crucial it was, because there is as yet no very good reason known why the still
very strong German forces could not have smashed in and cut our greatly over-extended supply
lines.
* The 87th Regiment did lose one man captured by the enemy: Pfc. George J. Syries of 2nd Battalion Headquarters
Company. He was captured on April 21, 1945 and returned to the Division in May after the hostilities
were over.
Apr 23
136
WILLIS had been driving in the shuttle movement on the morning of the 21st, taking the 3rd
Battalion from the mountains to the IP five miles away at Calcara. He had just unloaded men of
Company K from his 2 1/2 -ton truck and was returning for a load of Headquarters Company, 3rd
Battalion. With him was a Lieutenant GLENN, an American serving with the 8th Indian Infantry
Division, who had stopped in with friends in the 87th as an unofficial observer during the offensive.
Officially he had been on his way to the United States. Behind WILLIS and Lieutenant
GLENN was another 2 1/2 -ton truck driven by Pfc. ALEX GUSKO. The two trucks were bowling
along the easy roads, easy after the mountain roads they were used to, when a hand grenade
arced out and went off against the side of WILLIS’ truck. WILLIS leaped from his still-moving
truck into the road. GUSKO’s truck then struck him and knocked him across the road into a
ditch.
Lieutenant GLENN had jumped at the same time as WILLIS and made the ditch. The ditch
was bout 75 feet long on the edge of an open grassy field. GUSKO crawled to one end, WILLIS to
the other, and Lieutenant GLENN stayed in the middle. They were pinned down by six or seven
hand grenades hurled their way, one of which killed GUSKO. The only weapon they had was a
useless carbine GLENN had broken as he leaped from the truck. After a few minutes, the Germans
closed in on them with an MP, and Lieutenant GLENN climbed up out of the ditch with his
hands up. He ordered WILLIS out and they were taken prisoner. They were patted down for
weapons, but not searched by the men. An English-speaking NCO then ordered them to march
over to a German 88 position about a quarter of a mile from the road. From here a German general,
also English-speaking, gave them both a ride to headquarters on the back of his motorcycle.
The general said he had lived in California for fifteen years!
The German Headquarters was in a very elaborate villa. The guards, as they gave their Hitler
salutes to the general, were very tired-looking, and their clothing, while neat and clean, was
unpressed. The prisoners were taken inside and into a room with three intelligence officers. Italian
servants moved about the building, and the staff seemed to be living comfortably, if not in
traditional Prussian opulence. After the contents of their pockets were dumped on the central
table, they were sent to a yard in the rear and left there unguarded for three hours. Finally they
were called back and questioned pleasantly by the English-speaking officers. WILLIS refused to
reveal any information. Even had he been willing, there seemed to be little he knew that they
didn’t. They rattled off the names of all the units of the Division, all the regimental and battalion
commanders’ names, and the dates of activation of the three regiments. They were only in error
in the case of the commander of the 3rd Battalion, in which they still named Major GEORGE A.
FELCH, who was killed in action 21 February 1945 on Mt. Belvedere. What they seemed to want
to learn was something about the regiment’s armor. They asked WILLIS where he was born,
how many trucks and mules there were in the regiment, and a day-by-day record of moves. He
told them nothing. Still they remained pleasant and returned all but two articles from his pockets.
They kept his knife, and of all things, his draft induction notice, or famous “Greetings from
the President” letter which for some reason he had with him. They told him this would go on
permanent file in the German military records.
He was dismissed, and after another hour in the yard, he was separated permanently from
Lieutenant GLENN, and taken by motorcycle by back roads to the next town. There he was put
in with thirty other Americans. The American prisoners were in good shape, although they had
been marching thirty kilometers a day. The guards were exhausted. They had to march too, and
then some of them had to stay awake while the prisoners slept. They were sleepy and bitter.
That night, they marched from Castelfranco north for 53 kilometers to Gorgo on the south
bank of the Po River. They marched for fourteen hours, and left Castelfranco only three hours
before it was captured.
137
At Gorgo they were shut up in a theater, fed well on rice, bread, and horsemeat, and only suffered
from want of water. Only twice a day would the guards risk going outdoors to bring them
water. The reason was the constant strafing by American planes. During the daylight no German
dared show himself, but at night the retreating columns stretched for miles. There were few
motor vehicles, but the horses seemed to be numberless.
Sunday night the 22nd, at 2300, the 87th Infantry, unknown to WILLIS, was about a mile
away at San Benedetto Po when the prisoner column was rushed across the German pontoon
bridge north of Gorgo. Just around the bend, the 87th would make the first crossing of the river
at noon the next day. A few minutes after the prisoners left Gorgo, the town was taken by elements
of the 10th Division. WILLIS all this time was watching for his chance to escape. A prisoner
had tried the night before, but was brought back by a big 150-pound black dog, which had
been trained to search out or chase any American who made a break for freedom. After crossing
the Po, WILLIS decided to take the first opportunity to get away. After marching two or three
miles parallel to the river where it flowed north, a plane roared over in the moonlight strafing the
road. (This may have been the same German plane that bombed our troops on the other side of
the river.) In any case, the column scattered into the ditches, and WILLIS crawled under a pile of
brush and lay there. Finally the prisoners were collected on the road and marched off again. No
real effort was made to find him. Not even the black dog seemed to notice his absence.
At 0400 he heard the pontoon bridge blow, and crawling out of the brush, he started across
the fields for the river. Against the shore he found a large, heavy boat, and shoved off in it with a
board to paddle with. As he worked his cumbersome craft out into the broad river, the current
caught it. Although he struggled desperately, he couldn’t make any headway. The boat just
drifted down around the bend and swung him back against the north shore. Finally he gave up
and climbed the bank opposite the old ferry landing, where the 87th was to cross come noontime.
He found one of the many large dugouts there along the north bank, and finding it empty—to his
great relief—holed up at dawn.
At about noon, the sporadic mortar fire landing on the north shore intensified, and the German
airbursts started cracking over his head. Outside his hole, ten feet away, was a German soldier
firing a machine pistol toward the river. WILLIS couldn’t tell what was going on outside,
but he expected the German would duck into the dugout at any moment. Although unarmed, he
would be ready for him. He held his steel helmet in his hands ready to smash it into the German’s
face, kick him in the groin, and hammer him off his feet. Instead, the German suddenly
fled across the fields. Then seeing American GIs advancing abreast of his dugout, WILLIS came
out with hands in the air. It was Company A, and the men seeing a soldier in an American uniform
surrendering from an enemy dugout, were of a mood to shoot him on the spot. Someone
yelled, “He’s an American! Don’t shoot!”
Captain KLEMME restrained the men and got up to WILLIS, who was quite shaky from his
experience.
“What outfit are you from?” Captain KLEMME was suspicious of a German trick.
“87th,” WILLIS answered.
This seemed too pat to be true, and the men all remembered G-2 warnings about Americanspeaking
Germans trained in our ways to drop behind our lines and spread confusion. Captain
KLEMME was openly suspicious. “What company?”
“Headquarters, 3rd Battalion.”
“Yeah? Who’s CO of K Company?”
138
WILLIS looked around at the desperate faces and realized he was at that moment, just as he
had thought himself safe, in as ticklish a spot as he had been throughout his experience. He became
tense. He couldn’t think. K Company became just a name. Then just as Captain KLEMME
was turning away to leave him to the fate of spies, it came to him.
“Captain EDDY, “ he shouted.
“How about L Company?”
“Captain DUNCAN.”
Captain DUNCAN had been killed six days before, but KLEMME was satisfied.
“Hand the man a rifle, and let’s go,” ordered the captain, and WILLIS was back in the outfit.
Aside from being the only escaped prisoner taken from the 87th, WILLIS could claim another
distinction. The 87th was the first Allied unit to cross the Po River. The first man to step ashore
from the first boat in the crossing is a hard matter to determine, in the eager scramble to get out
of the boat and behind some cover. Sgt. GEORGE HURT, who was wounded a few minutes later,
was among the first two or three, and the men in the first boat concede him the honor. However,
Pfc. JOHN WILLIS went across twelve hours earlier. It would be hard to deny that he is the first
man of the first Allied unit to set foot on the north bank of the Po River.
Some days later, Lieutenant GLENN, who because he was an officer was moved separately,
was given his freedom. He expressed the hope that his captors be as well treated when they became
captured.
COMPANY A—TO THE MINCIO
Sgt. GEORGE W. HURT, the first man across, was shot from the rear by a sniper in a bypassed
emplacement as the company continued inland. Pfc. CLARENCE M. MINOR, Pfc. WILLIE
E. AILSTOCK, JR., and Pvt. ROBERT L. BAKER were also wounded near Gassole. The company
was reorganized by 1500. Across the canal were the battery of 88s and the six 20-mm guns
at Giordane, but they couldn’t engage the company behind the high dike. A patrol making a reconnaissance
bypassed the positions, and the Germans blew up the 88s and dumped the barrels
of the 20-mm guns into the canal.
The company took up positions for the night along the dike and tied in with Company C on
the left. The next day they expanded their positions, and Pfc. ARTHUR ABRUZZO had to be
evacuated with an injury.
COMPANY B—ROADBLOCK, SAN BENEDETTO PO
During the early morning of the 23rd, the 1st Platoon of Company B did some firing. The
platoon had been left with one squad of Company A, and a TD from the 701st, to set up a roadblock
south of San Benedetto Po. A large German half-track and a personnel carrier towing a
large gun moved up to a position within fifty yards of the roadblock at about 2030. They stopped
and stayed there. Our troops didn’t know whether they were German or friendly, so after half an
hour S/Sgt. HARRY MCCLINTICK and Pfc. VAN L. OFFICER, a BAR man, went down the
roadside. First they spotted two horses, and then they clearly recognized the German half-track,
and ran in alarm. Pfc. OFFICER stopped and fired his BAR at the big parked vehicle, while
MCCLINTICK ran to the TD. The TD next opened up with three rounds. Just previous to
MCCLINTICK’s arrival at the TD, an American jeep stopped and two soldiers declared they were
souvenir hunting. The TD crew warned them not to go down toward the suspicious vehicles, but
they went anyway. When MCCLINTICK arrived on the double, without having seen the jeep,
the TD opened fire. One of the three shots knocked the jeep off the road, and the German vehi-
Apr 23
139
cles were demolished. Then the TD fired beyond the front vehicles at some German-occupied
Fiats and trucks, and knocked them all out. MCCLINTICK, not satisfied, ran back a thousand
yards and got some chemical mortars to fire four rounds. Next he located three light tanks and
brought them up to the corner. They fired .50-caliber machine guns into the charred mess. In the
morning there were many dead Germans along the road, with two dead American souvenir
hunters from another regiment.
COMPANY B—THE PO AND THE MINCIO
When Company B moved up to the river late in the morning, they dug in, expecting to stay
there for five hours. The 3rd Platoon took positions on the right, next to the road to the ferry
landing, and the 2nd on the left, with the weapons platoon between them. The weapons were to
fire at all visible targets.
Pfc. THOMAS BRODEUR, with an assault mortar on the right, fired fifteen rounds at an enemy-
occupied house across at Nobis. Another company mortar fired eighteen rounds at bunkers.
The machine guns didn’t fire, although the heavies of Company D fired overhead as the rifle platoons
ran forward to the boats.
The airbursts from “flak” had broken out behind the machine guns, and when the 2nd Platoon
reached the boats the engineer crew had disappeared. The platoon carried its three boats to
the water. The 3rd Squad of ten men under S/Sgt. JULIUS C. ECKHOFF hit the water furthest
upstream; then the 2nd Squad of eight under Sgt. MARIO P. BELLETTI; then the 1st Squad of
seven under S/Sgt. ERNEST BOUCHARD. These twenty-five men were all that were left of the
2nd Platoon. As they stormed ashore across from the ferry landing, with machine gun and mortar
fire hitting their boats, the 2nd Squad, first ashore, took three prisoners behind the bank.
Their boats without engineer crews were swept downstream as soon as the men jumped ashore.
The platoon moved inland, guiding on Company A for 700 yards, and then swinging east to
some drainage ditches.
The 3rd Platoon following landed at Cabianca and moved inland. They had had engineer
crews to carry the boats to the water’s edge and help row them to the far side. As the platoon
crossed over the dike, T/5 THOMAS S. ROWE, a company aid man, was wounded. The platoon
was pinned down on the left side of the road by fire coming from the dike and tower in Governolo.
Killed here were Pfc. JOHN P. DELGADO and Pfc. EUGENE H. BAGNESKI. Wounded
were Second Lieutenant GEORGE B. BOSWELL, Sgt. EARL D. ALLEN, Pfc. JOSEPH KUBALIK,
Pfc. BRUNO J. WANDREI, Pfc. PAUL W. HARRIS, Pfc. LOUIS A. FULLER, JR., and Pfc. WILLIAM
H. VOOTS.
The platoon withdrew back to the left and found the 2nd Platoon at the drainage ditches.
Both platoons then advanced to Poziencella by moving up the ditch. Pfc. ARVIL W. CARTER
was shot in the ankle here about 250 yards north of the river.
The command group and the weapons platoon crossed in five boats to finish up the company
crossing. One man, Pfc. ELMER T. PEARSON, couldn’t find room in a boat as it was shoving off,
so he was told to wait for another company. “No, I’m coming,” he yelled, and running into the
water, he hung to the stern of the boat and allowed himself to be towed across. This is probably
some kind of a first in crossing the Po, too. No one has come forward to dispute the claim. One
boat of Company B moved exceptionally fast. The ten men paddling were all experienced, and
Lieutenant NORMAN D. GLICKMAN and an engineer counted cadence as the craft came across
like a racing shell, nearly catching up with the wave ahead. In spite of the heavy fire over the
river, no one of the company was actually wounded on the water.
140
Late in the afternoon the company was reorganized and moved up to the bank of the Mincio
River where they dug in for the night.
COMPANY C—IN SUPPORT
On the morning of the 23rd, Company C had been ordered to support Companies A and B as
they crossed. The company moved up to the bank and took up firing positions at about 1130.
There was some sniper fire, and Pfc. KENNETH G. COUTURE was hit taking a message to Lieutenant
RICHARD C. POWERS. Seven or eight minutes before H-Hour, the first German barrage
opened up, starting on the south bank, but to the left of the crossing area. Then it moved down,
as Companies A and B were loading on boats, to the banks where C and D were in position. The
foxholes were little protection against the heavy concentration of airbursts overhead. Pfc. CHESTER
W. VEST was fatally hit; wounded were Sgt. EDWARD D. STACKWICK, Pfc. HOMER A.
MATSON, Pfc. HENRY J. MASCIARELLI, Pfc. HENRY G. DESKE, Pfc. EDWARD L. CARAWAY,
Pfc. SHERMAN C. JENSEN, Pfc. ROBERT J. LOSBERGER, Pfc. ELMER W. FREEMAN, Pfc.
HOLBERT G. DOBBINS, Pfc. SAM PRAVATO, Pfc. STANLEY J. KACZMARCZYK, Pfc. ALFRED
G. SMITH, and Pfc. JOSEPH J. ZIMINSKY. Pfc. SYLVESTER J. LEPPEK of the mortars was killed,
and Pfc. LARRY KOLKKA mortally wounded. A total of three were killed and thirteen wounded
on the south banks supporting the crossing.
Then they loaded into boats and crossed with the first elements of the 2nd Battalion. The
barrage shifted to the river, and Lieutenant JAMES ANDERSON was hit lightly under the arm,
one of the two casualties of the regiment while in the boats.
The weapons platoon, as they loaded into boats, received machine gun fire and scattered.
They tried to load the boat twice, and twice they were driven out. Then a machine gun of Company
D silenced the enemy gun, and they crossed. Ten men of this platoon had a rough crossing,
for the flak was now adjusting to burst over the river. An 88 shell exploded in the water under
the boat, almost tipping it over. They moved inland with part of Company H, and then seeing a
big gap on their right, headed east in a skirmish line. A strange sight they were, ten men with
one M-1, one mortar, one machine gun, a few pistols and carbines under the command of Sgt.
STEPHEN SCULLEN.
Company Headquarters crossed in the boat with Lieutenant Colonel ROSS J. WILSON, battalion
commander. They came under sniper fire, one man’s rifle was hit in his hands, but Colonel
WILSON kept the spirits up by stroking the boat to the tune of “The 87th’s Best by Far” as only
the Colonel can sing it. This was by far the noisiest, if not the fastest boat, to cross that day.
From the boats, the company moved 300 yards inland where they ran into the rear of Company
B and were held up. Pfc. KENNETH F. CLARK was injured as he hit his own M-1 diving
for a foxhole. They were fired on by sniper fire, which killed Pfc. WILLIAM F. STEYERT. The
company dug in. Later they moved north reaching the dike at 1700. They filled in the gap between
Companies A and B and set up strong points. The 3rd Platoon moved into houses on the
left, and captured three prisoners, making a total of twelve for the company. The Germans were
obviously in a very confused state. At one time three Germans idly watched the column of
troops from a distance as they repaired wire. They made no effort to conceal themselves, apparently
not realizing the column was American.
Sgt. POVELAITES, and two men with a BAR, set up a covering position upstairs in a house to
protect a bridge over the canal at Governolo. He was excitedly called upstairs by the BAR man
who pointed out two Germans approaching the bridge on a motorcycle. Instead of firing, the
man gave the weapon to the sergeant. By the time POVELAITES got the BAR to his shoulder and
the sights lined up, the Germans were off on the motorcycle and had disappeared behind some
141
small buildings and under the bridge. The sergeant waited for them to come back up to the road,
and carefully squeezed the trigger. Nothing happened; the safety was on. He snapped it off,
aimed again and squeezed. The gun clicked and jammed, filled with sand from the Po River. He
worked on it furiously, and raised it to his shoulder again just in time to see the Germans, now
back on their motorcycle, disappear from view. While the enraged sergeant dressed down the
BAR man, ordering him to clean his weapon, the building lurched and quivered as the bridge
blew up. Fortunately, it was not of vital importance, because there was another bridge nearby.
COMPANY D—FIRING SUPPORT
During the morning of the 23rd, when the sudden decision was made to cross the river at
noon, a company OP was set up on the dike, and orders were issued to fire on anything that
moved on the other side of the river. With one company of heavy weapons of the 85th on their
right, Company D fired at suspicious areas on the north shore. Lieutenant ANTSELM BRADLEY
spotted two enemy OPs and one machine gun nest in his scope, and engaged them with fire.
Lieutenant WILLIAM SPINNEY’s machine guns of the 2nd Platoon were ordered to support the
rifle companies in the crossing, while Lieutenant BRADLEY with his platoon was to make the
crossing with Company C. To control the supporting fire, nine people were in the vicinity of the
OP, various forward observers, runners, and radio operators. As the first barrage opened up on
the south bank, seven minutes before the initial rifle companies pushed across the river at noon,
five of the nine were hit. Second Lieutenant OLAN D. PARR, the forward observer with Company
B, Second Lieutenant LEONARD P. LANDRY, JR., the observer with the mortar platoon,
Pfc. THOMAS J. BURK, Pfc. MONROE W. CANTOR, Pfc. RAYMOND N. CARINI, Pfc. BENJAMIN
E. GIBSON, Pfc. JAMES J. JOHNSON, Pfc. JOHN W. KING, Pfc. RAMON B. MELENDEZ,
Pfc. JAMES T. PENDEGRIST, Pvt. CHARLES H. BRYSON and Pvt. CLAUD H. FORBUS were all
wounded by this barrage of airbursts, 88s, and mortar fire. Pfc. LOUIS M. DORSEY was killed,
and Pfc. WALFRED S. SUTHERBURG was mortally wounded at this same time.
DORSEY, a wireman, when the wire to the OP was knocked out during the barrage, climbed
out of the hole saying, “I’ll lay ‘er till they hit me.” A few seconds later, he was dead. The other
wireman, Pfc. JOHN HEADDEN, who with DORSEY had heroically laid wire throughout the
campaign, seemed to bear a charmed life. Repairing the wire, he exposed himself throughout the
fire.
Lieutenant LANDRY had just rejoined the company a few days before, recovered from a previous
wound. This time he was wounded in the hand and back, but he refused to be evacuated
until he had moved the mortars forward and started them across the river.
First Sergeant FRANKLIN C. JONES, throughout the entire barrage was never in his foxhole,
but was out keeping control of the company.
Lieutenant BRADLEY, having successfully crossed the river with his platoon, collected a
group of disorganized Company A riflemen, and forming them into a small combat team, drove
north to the canal. The balance of Company D crossed without casualty in the second and third
waves, and rejoined the battalion in the defensive area along the canal. During the early crossings
made by the 1st Battalion, most of the enemy fire was on the south bank. No one was hit on
the river, and no one in Company D on the north bank. While the crossings were in progress,
Lieutenant KENNETH W. ALPERT, company executive officer, received a message to bring up
ammunition and to ferry it across the river. He drove up to the river’s edge with a jeep loaded
with ammunition, looking for the ferry. This was at 1400, and as the area was under considerable
shellfire, he was sent away by the general’s aide.
142
In the battalion headquarters group, S/Sgt. HOLLISTER KENT, operations sergeant, was
wounded just as they climbed down the bank of the dike on the north side of the Po. Colonel
FOWLER, seeing his shattered left arm, made some comment of sympathy, and Sgt. KENT replied,
“Don’t worry about me, Colonel. I’m all right.” T/Sgt. ROLF KING, Battalion Sergeant
Major, was in the same ditch with KENT when he was hit.
T/4 FRANK C. WHITMOYER, first cook with the 1st Battalion Headquarters Company, was
wounded by airbursts while hauling ammunition on the south bank of the Po.
2nd Battalion—Crossing and Bagnolo San Vito
COMPANY F—BICYCLE TRAGEDY
Company F, hurriedly assembling 500 yards south of the river, came under the first heavy
“ack-ack” barrage of the south bank. T/4 JOHN S. OSTROSKI was wounded before the company
moved to the bank. At 1300 the men moved into the boats, took paddles, and crossed uneventfully.
On the north side about thirty eager Italian civilians helped the men up the steep banks.
After assembling on the north shore, they moved off for the town of Bagnolo San Vito to the
left (west). They headed directly for the town, Captain JAMES C. KENNETT as usual out in front
leading his men. He came to a canal and, without detouring to use the bridges which were situated
a considerable distance in either direction, he waded in up to his shoulders and up the other
bank, his whole company following.
The town was to be attacked with Company E on the right. However, Captain KENNETT,
with a squad and a half of the 3rd Platoon and a machine gun, went ahead to “feel out” the town.
Pfc. GORDON SUNDSTROM, a machine gunner, brought his gun to fire on a sniper in a courtyard.
A German deserter had declared that fifteen Germans were in there with an assault gun
and furst charges. They were there, too. SUNDSTROM killed one, and fifteen surrendered. Pfc.
SUNDSTROM and Sgt. DAVID BURT, the machine gun section leader, went on up with the machine
gun, collecting prisoners as they went. They finally had to wait for some support after collecting
ten prisoners.
In the town, the company reorganized and at 1500 started mopping up the houses in town.
Sgt. MERLIN K. SOINEY, Pfc. HARRY HENKENSIEFKEN, and four other men, picked up several
prisoners as they worked through the town. Finally HENKENSIEFKEN alone entered a
German CP; four Germans surrendered. In the CP were all kinds of supplies, including radios,
telephones, and 200 rifles. While he was in the building, he heard the sound of a motor vehicle,
and knowing that there were no Allied vehicles north of the Po, he rushed to the window to see a
whole truckload of Germans go by. Soon after, an American plane zoomed, strafing the road,
and HENKENSIEFKEN decided to move back to the company.
Shortly after 1500 the company was ordered to establish a roadblock on the far end of town.
Sgt. LEO O. SADIN and five men from the 1st Platoon moved up to the last building on the right
of the intersection, where the main east-west road through town turned sharply to the left (south)
and another road joined it from the right (north). Here they organized in the building to cover
the roads without having actual contact with the enemy. They had caught glimpses of enemy
moving far down the road to the south.
Here one of the most tragic episodes of the campaign occurred. Captain KENNETT rode up
to the roadblock on a bicycle. With him, on another captured bike, was Pfc. CLIFFORD E. SPINDEN.
Captain KENNETT had always been fond of bicycles. On Belvedere, he and the late
RUDOLPH KONIECZNY had ridden bicycles all over the area down near Rocca Corneta under
enemy observation. In March, near Castel d’Aiano, he had found enough bicycles to mount the
Apr 23
143
whole weapons platoon, and he led them as they all rode down the hill back to the company on
forty-eight bicycles. Even on Kiska Island in 1943 he had managed to capture some Jap bicycles.
So he was quite elated to discover bicycles in Bagnolo San Vito.
Some time after 1600, Captain KENNETT had been ordered to send a strong combat patrol to
clean out enemy flak guns southeast of Bagnolo San Vito. With this in mind, the captain decided
to run out to the edge of town on his bike and look the situation over. He left machine gunner
SUNDSTROM and Sgt. BURT on the main street of town, indicating he was just going to the corner
where the roadblock was set up in the old German CP. As he left, he told them, “See you in a
few minutes.”
At the roadblock they warned him against going down the road, but he continued on. Two
hundred yards ahead, the road crossed a wide drainage ditch. After he passed, two Germans,
lying on the right-hand side of the road by the ditch, fired, hitting the captain in the back and in
the head, and wounding SPINDEN in the arm. SPINDEN jumped into a roadside ditch as the
captain lay in the road, and made his way back.
SUNDSTROM and BURT heard the firing, and someone from the roadblock ran into the
building yelling, “The captain’s in trouble!” They took a machine gun and set it up in a house on
the roadside fifty yards short of the captain. Some burp gun fire was coming down the road from
a distance. Then they crawled, with pistols only, down the left-hand side of the road out to the
drainage ditch, and called to the captain.
Back from the house Pfc. BROMEO MOGA spotted one of the two Nazis and opened fire.
Enraged, he emptied a whole magazine of BAR ammunition into one of the Germans. The remaining
German then came up onto the road. The two Americans halted him. They ordered him
to bring the captain over to them in the ditch. The German refused, repeating over and over,
“Nein. Nein. Finito.” SUNDSTROM captured the German with his bare hands.
An Italian came down the road in a Fiat. From the ditch they halted him and told him to
“pick up the captain.” He nodded complete understanding and drove off. Shortly afterwards an
Italian Fascist captain came crawling up the ditch. Apparently it was he whom the man in the car
thought of as “the captain,” and he had gone off and told him to report up there by the road. If
so, the Fascist made an error in crawling up to the rendezvous, for the alert BAR cut him down.
They brought Captain KENNETT’s body back to town, and the whole company was shocked
and angered. It seemed incredible that, after the infernos of blood and fire he had walked
through without harm, he should be instantly killed without warning on a peaceful warm afternoon,
while the whole company in town were congratulating themselves on the crossing of the
Po and the easy taking of the village. He died as he had lived, far out in front of his company,
making a reconnaissance that he wouldn’t ask another to do. As always, he was completely unconcerned
with possible personal danger. Never was any company commander better loved by
his command.
In the saddened town, surprised Krauts were collected here and there right through the next
day. That afternoon, four Germans walked along a path into town, and sat down in a restaurant
before anyone got to them to make the capture.
Lieutenant DONALD M. DWYER took over the company, completed the reorganization, and
set up defenses. Before dark, the men engaged in quite a bit of “Kraut shooting” as German columns
passed southwest of the town, affording the Americans an unequaled chance to sit comfortably
in buildings and take “pot shots.” Occasionally there was some enemy fire, but very little.
At dusk, a sniper hit Pfc. WILLIAM GENTRY in the foot, the only additional casualty.
144
That night seven Germans infiltrated the town. Pfc. BENJAMIN MEYER told them to halt.
They ran for it and MEYER wounded one. One ran away, but six ran into a house where they
treated the wounded man. MEYER tried to get them to surrender. They agreed, but wouldn’t
come out of the house. They finally emerged under MEYER’s order and threat, but they carried
their weapons and made a break for freedom. They ran around the corner right into the arms of
the 3rd Squad of the 2nd Platoon. There were three officers, one private, and a medic.
Later in the evening, a heavy machine gun under Sgt. JOSEPH MELINKOVICH opened fire
on an enemy dragging an AA gun across a road 300 yards away. The gun was abandoned and
used by our troops later on.
COMPANY E
Shortly after 1300 Company E, following F, moved to the south bank of the Po River from the
assembly area to make a crossing. They crossed during a comparatively quiet period. Most of
the fire was flak further up the river. Reorganizing on the north bank, the company swung to the
northwest with Company F on its left. Their objective was the town of Bagnolo San Vito. On
their way across the fields, the 3rd Platoon on the right was attracted to a house by Italians excitedly
calling to them. There were 25 Germans in the house. Five of them tried to get away. One
was killed and two were wounded. The rest sat in a room inside until they were ordered out and
made prisoners. One German was seen setting up a machine gun. The men yelled to him, but he
paid no attention, and was promptly killed.
The Germans were obviously confused by the appearance of the American column. One soldier
on a bike was ordered to halt, but paying no attention, was killed. Elements of the platoon
saw five men down a road carrying a machine gun towards them. One of the men waved, but
when fired on, the men surrendered. Then the company captured a truck with a 20-mm “ackack”
gun. The truck was loaded with new equipment. They entered the town of Bagnolo San
Vito to the right of, and slightly to the rear of, Company F and established defensive positions in
the right section of town. Company G, with only sixteen men, followed them into town.
S/Sgt. CHARLES STUBBS, with a half-squad, was detailed to hold a bridge to the left rear of
town. While he waited there, thirty Germans, led by a major, approached the bridge. Assuming
that the Germans were surrendering, two men went down the road to bring them in. A machine
gun opened fire and drove them to cover in the ditch. The whole group was pinned down
around the bridge. Pfc. G. B. PAYNE, firing his BAR, covered their withdrawal to cover. A full
squad was then sent up to reinforce the men at the bridge. A little antitank fire came in, and
some airbursts cracked overhead, but 35 Germans surrendered. The company spent the night in
town and from time to time during the night, Germans surrendered to them.
COMPANY G
Shortly after 1300, the company assembled on the south bank of the Po and, under some airbursts
which caused considerable confusion in the company, paddled the engineer boats across
the broad river. Most of the fire was falling over the south bank. There was so little fire over the
river that four boats of Italian natives were out directing the boats across, and women and children
lined the north bank pulling the men up the steep dike. Most of the boats grounded on a
sandbar near the north shore.
At the same instant airbursts cracked close overhead. The men plunged into the shallow water
and splashed for the shore. Close to the bank the current ran swiftly, and the shallow sandbar
suddenly dropped off to an unknown depth. Ten men fell into the water and had to swim for
their lives, many with their packs on. Pfc. ZOLTAN MOLNAR dove in and pulled Cpl. WILBUR
L. PULLEY out of the water after he became exhausted. MOLNAR attempted to return and save
145
another man, but he was too exhausted himself. Pvt. CARLTON HALE was injured in the water;
after he got ashore he had to be evacuated. Pfc. NYERAY O. MATHEWS was struck and
wounded in the head just as he fell into the water. Many of the men thought he was drowning
and tried to save him, but it was afterwards confirmed that he had been killed by the shell fragment.
On the north bank of the Po, Lieutenant OSCAR E. DUTTWEILER, with a mortar section, one
machine gun squad, and one squad of the 1st Platoon, moved inland and south of the 2nd Battalion
assembly area. Lieutenant JACK K. BENNETT followed with part of the 3rd Platoon and part
of Company H. The rest of the company, with elements of Companies E, F, and H, arrived at
dusk and moved into a defensive position at Bagnolo San Vito, already taken by Companies F
and E. While walking along the canal with these latter elements, Major PAUL A. TOWNSEND,
2nd Battalion executive officer, saw fifteen or twenty Italians across the canal, wildly signaling
them to go back. Before they could take any action, five high-velocity shells slammed in, catching
the men out in the open. They withdrew rapidly to the highway leading to Bagnolo San Vito,
and rushed to the town with the alarming news that the battalion left flank was in danger of being
“rolled up.” No such counterattack developed, but a large group of bypassed enemy surrendered
during the night by negotiations through Italians, and entered Bagnolo San Vito as prisoners
at about 2100.
COMPANY H
While Company H was still south of the river, S/Sgt. DONALD O. JASORKA was wounded
by an airburst. The 1st Platoon crossed the Po in the early afternoon following some heavy mortar
and high velocity fire. On the north bank near Villa Correggio, Pfc. EDWARD J. RINGLEIN
was killed by shrapnel, and Pfc. LONNIE L. DAVIS, JR. was wounded by an airburst. Two men
from Company G were saved from drowning by Pfc. DANIEL COLEY. They were two of the
group of ten who, wading ashore from the boats stuck on the sandbar, had fallen into deep water
and had to swim for their lives. COLEY dragged two of them out by himself. The platoon lost
contact on the north bank with Company E, but they helped organize lost elements of Companies
G and E, and moved inland and set up a defense at Bagnolo San Vito. The guns were set up defensively,
and S/Sgt. HAROLD V. BRADLEY brought in twenty prisoners.
The 2nd Platoon crossed the river in assault boats under heavy mortar and AA fire following
Company F. They pushed inward with Company F, and against moderate small arms fire, they
occupied Bagnolo San Vito. In the town they set up a roadblock and prepared to repulse a
threatened counterattack. All-around defense was established for the night.
The 1st Section of the mortar platoon at 0900 displaced forward to a point 300 yards from the
Po. The 2nd and 3rd Sections moved forward and started crossing the river at approximately
1245 under heavy airbursts. The 1st Section then crossed at 1300. The platoon was reassembled
after crossing, moving to a point near Bagnolo San Vito and receiving some sniper fire en route.
They fired one mission, which caused twenty-five Germans to surrender. S/Sgt. JOHN M.
O’BRIEN was wounded by shrapnel on the south bank of the Po while he was acting as a forward
observer with the 1st Battalion.
3rd Battalion—Crossing Governolo
COMPANY L
Company L was the first of the 3rd Battalion to cross the Po. They left their bivouac area
south of San Benedetto Po at 1200, just as the 1st Battalion began making the crossing. After
some delay, due to elements of both the 85th and 86th Regiments blocking the road, the company
reached the battalion assembly area and swung into the field on the left of the main road about a
Apr 23
146
quarter of a mile from the river. There, in already-dug foxholes, they “sweated out” a heavily
concentrated barrage of flak, high-velocity shellfire, and mortars. The company was ordered to
“get across the river.” However, during the heavy barrage, the engineers had stopped and
sought shelter on the north shore, and all but three of the boats were on the far side. These boats
were carried to the water during a short lull, loaded with the 3rd Platoon, and rowed across with
very little engineer assistance. Then the barrage commenced again with renewed fury, and everyone
on the south bank took cover. An engineer lieutenant refused to do anything about getting
boats back under the heavy flak concentrations that splashed the smooth river. The 88 and mortar
fire digging up the field where the men waited on the south bank was actually more dangerous
than crossing. Second Lieutenant WALTER P. STILLWELL, JR., T/4 ANTHONY C. CRISAFULLI,
Pfc. EDWARD H. BILODEAU, Pfc. MICHAEL J. FEDORKO, Pfc. VERNE W. STAMER,
and Pvt. EDWIN N. EGY were wounded.
Lieutenant Colonel WORKS and his battalion munitions officer, Lieutenant NOEL C. CLAD,
ran up and down the banks looking for boats. CLAD finally found one, and taking some men
from battalion headquarters, and a few men from Company L, crossed to bring some boats back.
Meanwhile the first three boats had been sent back by Company L men, two men to a boat. Two
of these had drifted downstream on the return, so they were just to the right of the ferry landing.
The other was probably the one Lieutenant CLAD had found above the landing. Then during a
furious barrage, no crossings were made for nearly an hour. When it let up, Colonel WORKS
broke over the bank with two squads of Company L’s 1st Platoon, and went toward the two
boats. First Lieutenant GEORGE F. EARLE, regimental liaison officer, met Colonel WORKS at
the boats. He was trying to cross to find Colonel FOWLER who had crossed about 1300, and had
lost both radio and telephone communication with the regimental CP south of the Po. Lieutenant
EARLE had just previously been buried to his neck in a foxhole by an 88 which landed a foot
from the edge and stunned him. Colonel WORKS ordered him to get the engineers out of the
dugouts on the far side, and bring the boats back. Three times the two boats were loaded, and
three times the squads and the two officers raced up the beach and lay flat under the ferry landing.
Time bursts kept cracking overhead five minutes at a time. Finally they crouched in the
boats and pushed off at about 1500.
On the far side, all seemed deserted. A few mortar rounds were coming in close to the bank,
but there was no fire inland, and the squads moved in with the 3rd Platoon 500 yards inland
where they had dug in to await orders. The engineers were urged out of a large dugout, and the
boats were brought back further downstream. The rest of the company came over in driblets.
There were no casualties on the water.
As the 2nd Platoon crossed further downstream, Brigadier General DAVID L. RUFFNER,
who took over the duties of assistant division commander after General DUFF was wounded the
previous night, had ordered them to move north to the bridge at Governolo. They moved up to
the Mincio River, and as they approached the bridge, came under sniper fire. They pulled back.
Colonel FOWLER arrived on the scene at that time and arranged for a flanking maneuver to the
left, in conjunction with an attack on Governolo by Company K, and for L to hold the bridge. It
took thirty minutes to reorganize, and in that time they were joined by the weapons platoon and
some of the 1st Platoon. Then, as they moved to the left, the 3rd Platoon found them. They set
up defensive positions behind the bank near the bridge with Company B, which was already
there. Lieutenant EARNEST W. RICKENBACKER, Captain EDWARD N. HATHAWAY and Pfc.
EDWARD G. HINSHAW went up onto the dike to observe the bridge. They wanted to fire the
mortars at the bridge, but the commander of Company B claimed his men were on the bridge,
and told them not to fire. Then machine gun fire opened up from the bridge, killing HINSHAW,
and slightly wounding RICKENBACKER. They then hit the bridge with mortars.
Apr 23
147
After an hour and a half here, the company was ordered by Colonel WORKS to follow Company
K, which had already taken Governolo, and Company I, and were going out to take the
three towns beyond. At dark they moved out, expecting to swing right from the battalion column
to take the first town, and there to set up a roadblock until relieved by Company B. In the
dark they moved along the canal. When they reached a side road they heard armored vehicles
and the sound of Germans shouting. While they were moving toward the town, two Germans
came down the road toward them. Sergeant FLYNN challenged them and told them to surrender.
With hands up they halted, but thought he was “kidding.” Since they didn’t obey, he fired.
They threw up their hands but dove for the ditch at the same time. One was wounded and Lieutenant
GUY B. BLOOD killed the other. The wounded man had fired back with his pistol.
Then a plane started following the road up and down. After the plane left, they entered the
town, which offered no resistance. There they were relieved by a unit of the 85th, and spent the
night.
COMPANY K
Company K started moving up for the Po crossing shortly after twelve noon, and after some
delay reached the assembly area to the left of the road. There they “sweated out” a heavy barrage,
and after a long wait crossed the main north-south road and prepared to embark across the
river a quarter of a mile below the ferry landing at about 1530. After the 2nd Platoon had started
across, the heavy flak barrage, which had held up the crossings earlier, broke out again. Although
most of it was cracking farther upstream, Sgt. PHILIP THURSTON was slightly wounded
on the bank. He stayed with the company. The men crossed as they happened into boats, pretty
much without organization and with little help from the engineers. On the north side Captain
EDDY met Colonel FOWLER. The colonel had been on the north side for more than two hours,
his only communication with the south bank was through battalion radio sets when he chanced
to meet a headquarters group. His own telephone wires had been swept away by the current,
and his radio had been destroyed on the south bank. Colonel FOWLER pointed to Governolo
and asked Captain EDDY if he thought the company could take it. Captain EDDY, without hesitation,
replied, “We will take the town.”
They organized quickly and moved out, 1st Platoon leading, 2nd following, and went north
to the Mincio canal. The 2nd Platoon crossed the deep canal on a few canal boats they scouted
up, their second river crossing of the day. They were fired on by a sniper, who only succeeded in
hitting an Italian civilian. The 1st Platoon followed the 2nd across the canal, as the 2nd went in
and took the town without resistance. They captured two prisoners, and a good many enemy
fled from the town. Quite a few Lugers and machine carbines were taken as souvenirs.
At about dusk, the company marched to the north and established a roadblock at C. San Martino.
The mortar section set up under Sgt. PORTER SULLIVAN and fired at an enemy demolition
squad trying to destroy a dike. Sgt. CLARENCE ADAMS’ machine gun section joined the
mortars.
COMPANY I
Company I, the last rifle company of the regiment to cross, moved down to the right of K.
They entered boats and crossed further downstream than any of the previous crossings. There
they encountered very little of the flak that had been hitting the river upstream, and landed on
the far shore without difficulty. Moving inland, echeloned to the right behind Company K, they
were ordered to seize the east side of Governolo, while Company K occupied the west wide. The
jubilant paisans, with the boats used to ferry Company K across, piloted Company I across the
canal. The only danger they encountered was when they overloaded the heavy weapons platoon
148
into a boat, which almost sank. From Governolo they were ordered to the next town to the
northeast, which they reached after dark. They could hear armored vehicles moving to their
front, but the vehicles didn’t enter the town. There they were relieved by one company of the
85th, and pulled back to Governolo, where they spent the night.
COMPANY M
When the reconnaissance party of Company M reached the banks of the river, the 1st Battalion
was already in the process of crossing. The enemy was raking the area with airbursts of flak,
and some heavy stuff started falling near the road and back to the regimental CP. The situation
looked bad. Despite the heavy shelling, however, the assault boats manned by the engineers and
the infantrymen were steadily making their way across, and reports from the other side stated
that resistance was light.
Company M moved up to an assembly area near the regimental CP, and prepared to cross.
The loading point had gradually shifted downstream, due to the drifting of the boats, and the
shelling here was not quite so heavy. Nevertheless, a couple of airbursts overhead made the men
speed up the paddling considerably. The company was fortunate, however, and reached the far
bank without casualty.
Once across, the men didn’t waste time in moving into and clearing the town of Governolo.
Scattered sniper fire was the only resistance, except for an unsuccessful attempt by the Germans
or Fascists to blow a bridge by exploding teller mines. The company spent the night in and
around Governolo. S/Sgt. ROGER W. KOHLENBERGER, radio chief of he 3rd Battalion, was
injured and had to be evacuated from south of the Po.
Medical Detachments
The medics deserve more mention than they ever get in this or any other account. Only the
front line infantryman fully appreciates the medics. For both litter bearers and company aid
men, the work is both backbreaking and heartbreaking. The medic is called most when things
are the worst. Under the heavy concentrations of fire south of the Po on 23 April, the medics lost
four men, but their skill and their rapid response to the frequent calls under fire surely saved
many lives.
In the 1st Battalion Section, T/5 THOMAS S. ROWE was found with a rifle bullet in his leg,
giving aid to another wounded man. After much persuasion, this outstanding medic and brave
soldier was evacuated.
Pfc. HAROLD J. GAGNON was slightly wounded by shrapnel near Camatta south of the Po.
In the 3rd Battalion Section, Pfc. GEORGE E. UHRON and Pfc. THOMAS W. YANTIS were
hit by shrapnel during the afternoon while evacuating wounded.
T/5 THEODORE H. SCHULT, a litter bearer from the 3rd Battalion, and Sgt. RALPH
MYERS, a litter bearer of the 10th Medical Battalion, were called up to evacuate a casualty from a
dugout under intense enemy artillery fire. The wounded soldier, once outside with the litter
men, realized the danger involved and leaped suddenly from the litter and ran back into the
dugout. SCHULT and MYERS then went to look for other wounded. Both were later hit by artillery
fire, but refused evacuation.
Apr 23
149
ELEVENTH AND TWELFTH DAYS—24-25 APRIL
North Bank of Po
COMPANY I—LEFT FLANK
The following morning, 24 April, Company I was given the mission of making a limited objective
attack on the regimental left flank. The man purpose was to look for and knock out antiaircraft
guns which had been firing on the crossing. The limit of their advance was the general
line: San Giacomo Po to the extreme left flank of the 2nd Battalion. They marched across the
regimental area in the late morning, and made contact with the left flank of the 2nd Battalion.
Then moving along to the right of the dike, through the fields and farmyards, they approached a
group of buildings east of il Gazzo. En route they had picked up two prisoners. Machine gun
fire opened up on them from the houses, and mortar rounds dropped in from over the dike to the
right. Sgt. EDWARD J. MYERS, T/5 BRUNO GUIDO, and Pfc. DANIEL T. WALSH were hit by
machine gun fire. Sgt. JOHN W. HAINES III, with the machine gun section, moved boldly forward
to an exposed position to try to locate the fire. He was killed by a mortar round.
Regiment was unable to contact Company I by radio, and desiring to fire an air mission to
support them, sent the Rover Pete jeep with Lieutenant GEORGE EARLE, liaison officer, up to
the firing line. From there by radio they ordered a strafing mission for the Air Corps. The mission
was refused by Air Corps headquarters unless Rover Pete could contact an officer on the
front lines who would verify the friendly troop clearance from the target. Rover Pete, at that
moment sitting in his jeep in the front line, in a trembling vice quavered back over the radio,
“But, sir, I am in the front lines.” The startled answer came back, “You are where?” “I am in the
front lines.”
The mission was hastily accepted and four fighter-bombers strafed the church steeple from
which the AA batteries had observation on the river and the gun positions near San Giacomo Po.
Then the Rover Pete jeep was driven up past the riflemen. The three wounded men were loaded
onto its hood, and the jeep turned around and bumped back across the fields.
On the appearance of the jeep, the firing ceased. Possibly the enemy mistook it for armor, or
at least assumed that with American vehicles already across the river it was time to retreat. The
jeep drove into the aid station carrying two prisoners, three wounded men, the two Air Corps
men, a regimental radio operator, and the liaison officer. Meanwhile a patrol had been sent over
the dike to the left to locate the mortar positions. No further artillery or air missions could be
fired until the patrol came back. Pfc. JOSEPH J. DE MULLING volunteered to climb the dike and
search for the patrol through the wooded fields on the far side. He spotted a tree OP wired for
operation. As he lay prone observing the dug-in positions along a nearby dike, 25 Germans came
into view about 75 yards away for night occupation of the position. Waiting until two Krauts
aligned themselves with him, he squeezed off one shot and felled them both. At once the confused
Germans opened fire wildly with all weapons, but DE MULLING succeeded in returning
unharmed to find the patrol safely back from its mission. Company I was withdrawn from this
area, and the mop-up mission taken over by the 10th Anti-tank Battalion. Pfc. LEROY F.
KNOWLES was injured during the action.
Situation on the Eleventh and Twelfth Days
The regiment, all except Company I, rested and improved positions during the 24th and 25th.
The companies fed up on eggs and vino, and ran the price of chickens up to three for $24.00, all in
a few hours. First Lieutenant GORDON ANDERSON, commanding Company G, was evacuated
for his former wounds complicated by shock and fatigue, and Lieutenant DUTTWEILER took
Apr 24
150
over the company again. A German WAC surrendered to one company; she had been the secretary
of an AA battery, and was the first female German soldier seen. Replacements caught up
and Captain JULIAN R. SHARPE took over Company F on the 25th.
During the night of 23-24 April, DUKWs shuttled with supplies across the river, landing near
Correggio. All day of the 24th, the prisoners (mainly captured near Bagnolo San Vito) unloaded
these DUKWs and formed bucket brigades to get the ammunition and rations over the embankment.
They loaded wagons, carts, and wheelbarrows, and manhandled the loads to the companies.
The prisoners did a lot of useful work, and the GIs enjoyed resting, and watching them.
Space was made available during the day for two jeeps per battalion to be brought across on the
DUKWs.
Material for two bridges came up during the night, and by noon of the 25th, the treadway
bridge was completed. The 85th Infantry had crossed in assault boats on the 23rd, following the
87th, and had expanded the bridgehead to the north. Now it was time for the 86th to go through
on trucks to continue the dash of the Division to Verona on the Adige River. The 87th was to be
assembled and alerted, ready to shuttle forward at the instant the trucks returned from Verona.
The battalions came into new assembly areas west of Governolo shortly after noon of the 25th,
and waited for news of the advance. A battalion of the 85th marched out toward Mantova and
then toward Verona, and news of its steady advance came in regularly.
During the night of 24-25 April, an enemy plane tried to bomb the pontoon bridge across the
Po. It was fired upon and hit. It flared up for an instant, but was able to fly away. Some rounds
of heavy artillery came near the bridge at Governolo over which tanks, armored artillery, trucks
of our own Division and the 85th Division were crossing. There was a possibility that the bridge
would become a bottleneck, with the 87th on the wrong side. Hour after hour passed with no
news of the progress of the 86th Infantry in trucks.
THIRTEENTH DAY—26 APRIL
At dawn of 26 April, no word having yet been received of the trucks to return from the 86th,
the regiment was alerted and marched across the Governolo bridge in the order: 2nd Battalion,
1st, and 3rd. The column marched off on an unimproved road at La Salmistre, and halted for a
quick breakfast of C-rations.
Almost at once, 1st Lieutenant WILLIAM C. MCGUCKIN, liaison officer with Division, came
to the regimental commander with word that the trucks would arrive shortly. In a few minutes
Captain CHARLES N. VAN HOUTEN, regimental motor officer, riding a captured German motorcycle,
led the convoy of empty trucks. A quick breakdown was made to battalions, routes prescribed
for each battalion, and in a few minutes the regiment was rolling to reassemble at Villafranca,
for the next mission from the division commander. In the columns were captured German
trucks of every type, and a tiny Fiat for the regimental surgeon, Major THOMAS P. CONNERS,
and the regimental dental surgeon, Major ALBERT H. MEYER. All the trucks were overloaded
to the fullest extent. The most important thing of all was to get the whole regiment north
as rapidly as possible—to cut off the Germans and prevent them from getting back into the Alps.
At Villafranca, the situation was rapidly stated and the general mission prescribed. The Division
was not to go into Verona after all, although some elements of the 86th had been inside the
city, but it was to go north to the Adige River near Bussolengo. Consequently, the 1st Battalion
was sent toward Bussolengo, and the 2nd Battalion turned off to the left and then north toward
Pastrengo. The 3rd Battalion was to be in reserve. This new movement began in late afternoon.
Apr 25
Apr 26
151
2nd Battalion—Sega
In the 2nd Battalion column, Company G was in the lead. The truck movement continued
from Villafranca, north through Sommacampagna, thence west and north to the town of Sega on
the Adige River. There they detrucked and were ordered to secure the bridge near Leporte.
Tanks had already been there earlier in the day. Lieutenant JOSEPH H. SHEPHERD’s 2nd Platoon
and one squad of machine guns led the company downhill toward the river. As they
marched, a series of explosions shook the town as the Germans blew up the warehouses. At the
same time, artillery opened up on the rear end of the company, the head being in Sega. Then,
after the platoon halted, self-propelled guns from across the river shot armor-piercing shells
through the buildings. There was also some sniper fire in the town. Lieutenant SHEPHERD,
moving forward to reconnoiter the bridge, was fired on from across the river. A Quartermaster
truck driver, alarmed by the shellfire, turned his 2 1/2 - ton truck around and drove off at a reckless
speed, striking and seriously injuring Major PAUL TOWNSEND, executive officer of the 2nd Battalion,
who had to be evacuated.
The town of Sega was apparently a German supply depot. The buildings were loaded with
foodstuffs and equipment. Behind the fleeing Germans, the Italian natives had broken into the
warehouses and were appearing from all sides. One group of six prisoners started marching up
the hill out of town, and by the time they had cleared the town there were seventy in the column.
Since the bridge was found to be blown, a withdrawal was ordered. S/Sgt. WARREN N. HART
and Pvt. WILLIAM R. LEONARD were wounded during this action. The company spent the
night in a town in this area. Captain SIDNEY C. PETERMAN of Company H was evacuated with
illness, and Lieutenant ROBERT C. RENNIE took over the company.
1st Battalion—Bussolengo
Meanwhile, the 1st Battalion had entered Bussolengo, and joining forces with the 1st Battalion,
86th Infantry, and some armor, formed into a Task Force under Colonel WILLIAM O.
DARBY, of Ranger fame, who had been assigned as assistant division commander on the 24th.
Lieutenant Colonel ROSS J. WILSON, with his company commanders, crossed the Adige over a
badly demolished bridge and made a reconnaissance, but by nightfall they were recalled to the
south bank and the entire battalion billeted in Bussolengo.
In the driving rain, the first bad weather of the entire drive, the remainder of the regiment
bivouacked or billeted: 2nd Battalion just south of Sega, 3rd Battalion in Sandra. Prisoners continued
to be collected, seven being rounded up by Lieutenant GEORGE EARLE from houses
around the regimental CP. At sundown a dud smashed into the CP and lay harmlessly on the
floor.
Situation at the End of the Thirteenth Day
During this day the mountain troops had their first glimpse of the Alps. After dark, the
regimental commander was called back to the Division CP at Villafranca for the mission of the
27th. General HAYS announced that, as a result of our actions of the afternoon, it was apparent
that the Adige Valley was organized in strength, and he didn’t propose to try to smash it head
on. The Division would march west and then north along the east shore road of Lake Garda. He
announced a novel plan to move the Division, on a single road, many miles in one day. The 87th
would lead for eight hours, pushing at good marching speed. Toward the end of that eight-hour
period, the 85th would be moved up by trucks, relieve the 87th, and lead by marching for the
next eight hours. Then the 86th would come up by trucks, relieve the 85th and march steadily for
eight hours. Theoretically, if the march were unopposed, the Division would advance an infantry
152
regiment sixty miles in twenty-four hours. Troops not marching were to get maximum rest. It
sounded too good to be true!
The regimental orders were issued by telephone and radio at about 0300 on the 27th. The
march was to begin at 0800. The 3rd Battalion was to march from Sandra; the 2nd Battalion and
the 1st were to march out from their respective areas in time to fall in behind the 3rd Battalion at
Lazise on the shore of Lake Garda.
FOURTEENTH DAY—27 APRIL
3rd Battalion—Lake Garda
COMPANY K—ROADBLOCK
Company K, leading the regiment, marched to Lake Garda and then moved north along the
eastern shore as far as Bardolino without incident. The entire population of Lazise was in the
street, with wine and flowers, adding their enthusiastic cheering to the ringing of many church
bells. Ahead of Bardolino, the shore swung out to the left where a ridge of hills pointed out into
the long lake. To the north beyond, the real mountains could be seen, and even at Bardolino the
hills were getting higher and crowding the road closer and closer to the lake. Ahead, the road
swung around the point of hills just at the water’s edge, hard up against rocky cliffs on one side,
and the cypress-lined beach on the other. The town of Garda lay at the foot of the cliffs just before
the road swung left to go around the point. A high butte-like bluff rose up from the town
overlooking it from the south, and the cliffs walled it in from the north. The I & R Platoon had
reported that German SS troops with self-propelled guns and artillery were waiting in Garda.
The 3rd Platoon, leading with attached machine guns, was fired on from a roadblock just
south of Garda. Second Lieutenant JACK R. SCHNEIDER was hit in both legs, and Pfc. HAROLD
A. VANDERWALL was wounded in the foot. The TDs, hearing of the roadblock, withdrew.
At this point, a heavy stone retaining wall ran along the left of the road and below it lay a
strip of land at the beach. The 1st Platoon dropped down here and moved along under cover of
the wall. The 2nd Platoon was ordered up the steep bank to the right at the base of the butte-like
hill. The 3rd Platoon stayed on the road in staggered column. The TDs from a distance began
firing at the cliffs beyond the town, which did no harm except brightening up the cliff in patches,
but did no good either. The enemy machine gun was silenced, and the company moved up under
artillery support.
The 1st Platoon soon ran out of shore, as the water pinched all the way to the road’s retaining
wall, so they climbed up onto the road right in front of the roadblock. Soon a mass of people,
including all kinds of higher divisional command and attached units, were in front of the vertically
sunk steel rails. Suddenly a high-velocity shell from an SP gun cracked in. Eleven other
rounds followed. A Corps engineer major was killed, and wounded men lay all over the road.
Lieutenant CHARLES E. COUGILL, JR., S-2 of the 3rd Battalion, was wounded. From the 1st Platoon
were Sgt. GEORGE M. FERRES, Pfc. WORLEY H. REAMS, Pfc. JAMES B. BRATTON, Pvt.
RICHARD J. MURPHY, and Pvt. FRANKLIN G. GIBSON, all wounded. T/5 HYMAN KALFIN
was killed by this 20-mm fire. The shells seemed to be armor-piercing, and much of the damage
they did was from flying rocks, smashed from the rock outcropping facing on the right of the
road, that dumped down into the ditch where many of the men sought cover. The TDs withdrew,
and only by more threats of courts-martial did Colonel WORKS get one up to fire a few
rounds. Then it pulled back.
Apr 27
153
Sgt. ROBERT W. MANCHESTER and thirteen men rushed forward under this fire and
reached the shelter of buildings ahead. The first building was locked, so they got into the second.
Then moving on from there, the first scout, Pvt. LOREN D. BLISS, picked off a German running
into a garage. Then they set up a momentary defense. Multi-antiaircraft guns started firing
point-blank at the roadblock, and the men decided to try to get close to the guns. They worked
their way into the Terminal Hotel in the center of Garda. Then they crossed the square, entered a
bar and on into another building. As they worked from building to building, they drew occasional
fire, but finally Sgt. MANCHESTER, a BAR team, and two riflemen approached a building
from which they knew they would have good observation on the AA gun. Here a German machine
gun opened up on them from a nearby house, and they returned fire with the BAR from
behind a stone wall. The two riflemen, Pfc. HUGH JOHNSTONE and Pvt. LOREN BLISS, under
the covering fire of the BAR, got forward into this building. Then the BAR was hit by the machine
gun, wounding the gunner, Pfc. JOHN A CLENIN, in the arm. While Sgt. MANCHESTER
and the assistant BAR man were dressing CLENIN’s wound, a rifle grenade struck the wall,
wounding CLENIN again and also Pfc. ELISIO H. MENDOZA. MANCHESTER was slightly
wounded but stayed in action to cover the scouts. Meanwhile the scouts had been shooting at the
German positions, and had drawn artillery fire from the surrounding buildings. Sgt. MANCHESTER
decided to withdraw them and return with their information to the company commander.
The 2nd Platoon during the action at the roadblock was climbing up the steep hill to the right
of the road. Some of the replacements had trouble climbing up the steep outcroppings and boulders.
First Lieutenant JOHN P. HUNTER, one of the veteran mountaineers who had just returned
to the 87th after a long tour of duty elsewhere, literally pushed up some of the inexperienced
climbers. As they climbed they could see the 20-mm stuff hitting the road below them
where the 1st Platoon men were trying to move forward. As they came over the skyline, a road
extending to the north away from the lake road could be seen. On the road were about 100 men,
two field pieces, two trucks, and either a self-propelled gun or a tank. They were all pulling out.
In place, however, by a white house was a 20-mm gun firing. All of this was 2,000 yards away,
out of range for all the weapons on the hill. Lieutenant HUNTER scrambled down to Colonel
WORKS, and led him back to an OP with Captain EDDY and a British artillery colonel. The British
fired some airbursts and one truck turned over trying to escape the fire, and two 88s were destroyed
by their crews. Sgt. PORTER SULLIVAN fired his mortars at maximum range, but they
couldn’t reach. Even the riflemen fired, and the 20-mm gun fired back at the hill as the men
watched the column escape over the crest.
Down on the lake road other German vehicles, including a tank, a half-track, and two German
88s, escaped around the point to the west, in plain sight and range of the TDs. After they
had gone, the TDs came up and fired on the now-empty road.
By this time, Company I had reached the top of the high butte-like hill overlooking the town
and threatened the German rear, so they pulled their remaining men out, and the 1st Platoon of
Company K moved into town without further resistance. T/4 ALFRED S. BALL of the 2nd Platoon
had been wounded by machine gun fire during the action.
At 1830 the company moved on through, headed for Torri del Benaco around the point.
Company I had moved across the point over a pass, and Company L was still getting down onto
the road from the hill it had climbed. Company K got around the point without opposition, and
had just reached P. Tenei, where the head of the column was fired on from Torri del Benaco—two
20-mm shells coming in. The company stopped, deployed, and the TDs were ordered forward.
The officer in charge of the TDs said, “We won’t go forward into town until we know what’s
there!” After much bickering, name-calling, and threatening, they went forward and hit a Ger154
man half-track, a 20-mm gun, an 88-mm gun, and set fire to an ammunition dump. They also
fired at two 75s behind town up on the hillside.
At 1930, as the company prepared to billet in Torri del Benaco while the 85th went through to
lead the Division march, Company M sent a billeting detail forward to look for suitable houses.
They ran head-on into an 88 which fired at them point-blank. Sgt. JAMES C. TOOMEY, Pfc.
EARNEST MULLINS, and Sgt. ROGER D. ROHRABAUGH, all of Company M, and their two
jeep-mounted machine guns, commanded by First Lieutenant FRANCIS C. ANDERSON, roared
up, and at 200 yards poured in such a stream of lead that the gun was abandoned. The TDs later
moved up and hazarded a couple of rounds at it, and claimed that they knocked it out.
COMPANY L—THE ESCARPMENT
When Company K, in the lead, was fired on from Garda and was held up at the roadblock,
Company L, according to a prearranged plan, swung up to the right. A very high, steep, buttelike
hill, dominating Garda, rose from the edge of the road, and Company L climbed it without
firing a shot, or being fired upon. Company K had driven the enemy out of Garda by this time,
and Company L came on down and back into the column. Company K was fired on again near
Torri del Benaco, and Company L was to go on through, but the 85th Infantry arrived at this time
and took over the lead.
COMPANY I—OVER THE PASS
On the 27th of April, marching along the east shore of Lake Garda, in battalion reserve,
Company I was held up south of Bardolino, as K fought its way into Garda, with L flanking. In
stead of following the lake shore road from Garda around the point to the west, Company I was
ordered to take the road to the north up over the ridge and rejoin the battalion where the lake
shore road swung back on the north side of the point. Moving up the long slope from the lake,
they were held up momentarily by a few shots of sniper fire. They sent out flanking scouts, but
the snipers evidently withdrew. They halted for a break at the little town of Costa, up on the pass
where the road turned to go back down to the lake.
The men were drawing water and eating rations when a truckload of Germans drove into
town from the road to the right. T/Sgt. RALPH W. MASSEY and a BAR man opened up on the
truck. MASSEY killed the driver, and ten Germans fled from the truck and then surrendered. On
the truck was a 20-mm AA gun, loaded and in position to fire. Behind the truck they towed another
one. Lieutenant ALFRED L WESTOL, a former antiaircraft man, fired three rounds to test
the guns, and they were manned by Company I for future use. Then a bunch of Italian Fascists
appeared, driving up the hill in a German ammunition truck. They were opened up on by the
TDs down by the lake. The Italians jumped clear of the truck just before it was hit. The ammunition
blew up, and Pfc. WILLARD M. NICHOLS, JR. was wounded again by flying shells, and this
time evacuated. As the company moved downhill and approached Torri del Benaco, they saw
enemy fleeing from the town. Company fire was brought on them and artillery called for. Very
few artillery rounds were effective, and most of the enemy escaped. In Torri del Benaco the
company got orders to stay in position. Here T/4 NICK M. FILIPPIS broke his wrist, and Pfc.
CLARENCE J. DIERBERGER was hurt while working with the litter bearers.
2nd and 1st Battalions—Inland From the Lake
Late in the morning when the 3rd Battalion was held up by a roadblock south of the town of
Garda, the 2nd Battalion, behind them in the column near Bardolino, was ordered to move up
onto the high ground on the right (east) flank, and clear the ridge that ran east inland from
Garda. The battalion advanced cross-country with Company F on the left and E on the right. As
Company E reached the top of the ridge and worked along to the right, they came under sniper
Apr 27
155
fire. S/Sgt. WALTER S. KASABUSKI, whose brother had been killed on Mt. Pigna on April 15th,
was instantly killed by this sniper fire. Company F worked to the left and Pvt. WILLIAM C.
TURNER was wounded. The scattered enemy fled up the valley to the northeast, and both companies
reorganized. Company E found one German dead, and four wounded on the ridge. Then
in column the entire battalion marched down into the valley to the northeast, and billeted in the
town of Pesina. This occupation protected the Division’s right flank. Pvt. WESLEY A. SMITH, of
Company G, was injured near Bardolino during the day.
When the leading 3rd Battalion was held up before Garda, the 1st Battalion followed right
behind the 2nd Battalion, billeting for the night at Costermano, east of Garda in the mountain
valley. During the day six Germans gave up, insisting that the war was over.
Situation at the End of the Fourteenth Day
The regiment, in accordance with the General HAYS’ instructions, quickly got into billets on
the evening of the 27th, to get maximum rest so as to be ready to lead again at 0800, relieving the
86th Infantry at the head of the column: 1st Battalion in Costermano; 2nd Battalion in Pesina; and
the 3rd Battalion in the beautiful resort town of Torri del Benaco. The regimental CP as set up in
the finest villa on the lakeshore at Garda.
During the night, the 85th led for a few hours covering several miles. The 86th at the proper
time took over the relief and continued marching into the night. Some time before daylight the
head of the 86th reached the first of six road tunnels about a mile north of Navene. Here the fears
of the pessimistic were confirmed: the Germans had set off demolitions that would require a lot
of engineer work to clear. Reconnaissance showed that two bridges just beyond had also been
demolished.
FIFTEENTH DAY—28 APRIL
At dawn Colonel FOWLER went by jeep to Navene to learn the situation and the probable
employment of the 87th Infantry. Small detachments of the 86th were already bypassing the demolished
tunnel and bridges in DUKWs and they were as vulnerable as “sitting ducks on a
pond” to the German SP guns on the west side of the lake, which narrows to about two miles in
width. German strength and capabilities at the town of Torbole and Riva at the north end of the
lake were unknown. Instructions for the 87th were to be ready about noon to move up toward
Navene. Division CP at this time was already being set up in the advanced location of Malcésine.
Word was carried back and transmitted to the battalions that allowed them to rest a few
hours more. In accordance with instructions, the 1st Battalion was in trucks and waiting in Garda
at noon, and the 2nd Battalion was alerted in Pesina to get on the waiting trucks just as soon as
the word should be given. There were not sufficient trucks to move the 3rd Battalion at the same
time. Colonel ROSS J. WILSON and Colonel EMMETT L. NATIONS were at the regimental CP
waiting for the instructions to move.
First Lieutenant WILLIAM C. MCGUCKIN, liaison officer, came from the Division CP (the
distance being too great for reliable radio communication) with notes of the division commander’s
order, with the same goals in mind: Trento, Bolzano, and the Brenner Pass. The 86th
was to send one battalion to cross over the high mountain ridge near Navene to outflank Torbole;
the 87th was to send one battalion still farther to the east toward Mori.
The obvious route for the battalion was from Pesina, where the 2nd Battalion was waiting, on
the valley road around the mountain mass through Spiazzi, thence along the high road with
many switchbacks to Mori. But nothing was known of German strength in the towns between
Apr 28
156
Pesina and Spiazzi. It might take one battalion considerable time to fight its way through this
area. And there were reports, yet unverified, that an important bridge near Spiazzi was demolished.
On the other hand, if a battalion were to march over the ridge from the west near Punta di
Naoli, leaving its transport behind at the end of the winding mountain road, it might be impossible
for the regiment to supply and support this battalion. (The Alpini mule Pack Company had
been left behind on the south edge of the Po Valley, when the mad dash across the flatlands began,
and had not yet rejoined the regiment.)
Consequently, a decision was quickly made to use two battalions. The 2nd Battalion to
march over the ridge and strike north for Mori, and the 1st Battalion to clear out enemy resistance
along the road through Spiazzi, so that Regiment could push supplies and supporting weapons
to the 2nd Battalion. At about this time a report came from Lieutenant DAVID S. ARNOLD, of
the I & R Platoon, who had been sent to make a reconnaissance by artillery plane, that the road to
Mori looked to be passable for 2 1/2 -ton trucks its entire length, except that a bridge was out
southwest of Spiazzi.
The 2nd Battalion entrucked at Pesina and was on the move by 1330, going rapidly through
San Zeno di Montagna, where the road became narrower, steeper, and more rocky. There were
many switchbacks, with turns so sharp that some trucks had to be maneuvered carefully back
and forth two or three times to complete the turn. Some of the German diesels that had been captured
had no front-wheel drive, and their progress was slow. The battalion did not close at the
dead end of this road until 1700. Colonel FOWLER had trailed this convoy with his own jeep and
a radio jeep from the Division’s 110th Signal Company. Just as he was seeing the troops detruck
to start the march over this ridge, the radio sergeant handed him a message, “Report to the Division
CP at once.” He took time to give last-minute instructions to Major BORIS T. VLADIMIROFF,
executive officer at the rear of the column, and then return down the long mountain road.
It was 1900 when he reached the regimental CP at Garda. Here he had a short conversation with
Lieutenant Colonel JEFFERSON J. IRVIN, Division G-3. Colonel IRVIN said, “The General wants
both battalions brought back.” Colonel FOWLER replied, “You just can’t move battalions around
like pieces on a checkerboard. I haven’t been able to get in touch with the 2nd Battalion by radio
since I left them. The vehicles have already returned. It will take at least three hours to get them
back up to the ridge. Furthermore, I can’t afford to bring the 1st Battalion back until I am sure
that the 2nd Battalion has gotten the word to come back.” Colonel IRVIN held the high card:
“The General wants them back.”
Colonel FOWLER then made the eighteen-mile trip to the Division CP to report the situation
to General HAYS. The General was insistent that the battalions be brought back as quickly a possible
and moved nearer the north end of the lake; and Colonel FOWLER was just as insistent that
the 1st Battalion would have to continue clearing out the resistance along the road through Spiazzi
until he could be sure that the 2nd Battalion was on its way back.
On his return to the regimental CP, Colonel FOWLER met Colonel WORKS at Torri del Benaco
just as the 3rd Battalion was entrucking to move north to the vicinity of Navene. This much
of the regiment, at least, could comply with the division commander’s desires. Then began a
long night with a double mission for the regiment: first, to get word, by come means, to the 2nd
Battalion to call off their march to the north; second, to push the attack of the 1st Battalion to clear
the way through Spiazzi, in case the efforts to reach the 2nd Battalion should prove unsuccessful.
Radio relay teams spent the night transmitting from various places, in the valley, and on the
mountain roads, but no reply came from the 2nd Battalion—nothing to indicate that they knew of
the change in mission. Patrols were sent out from the 1st Battalion to catch up to the 2nd Battalion,
but the night was black and rainy, and the mountain distances were too great. Lieutenant
157
Colonel JOHN F. SCHMELZER, regimental executive, went to the 1st Battalion CP to insure that
the second part of the mission would be carried out.
SIXTEENTH DAY—29 APRIL
1st Battalion—Spiazzi
On the 28th, the 1st Battalion, waiting in trucks at Garda, convoyed east to Caprino to begin
the mission of opening up the road through Spiazzi. Company A was to attack Spiazzi frontally,
after bypassing the blown bridge, while Company C was to move along the ridge to the west and
come in on the town from the rear.
COMPANY A
The company moved out of Caprino at 0130 of the 29th, after waiting vainly in hopes that the
2nd Battalion could be reached and withdrawn. They moved through the rain in column of twos:
3rd Platoon leading, 2nd Platoon, company machine guns, attached heavies, company headquarters,
mortars, and finally the 1st Platoon. They passed the blown bridge at 0330, and reached the
town shortly thereafter. Partisans had reported earlier in the afternoon that there were about 200
Germans in Spiazzi. At first it appeared as though the Partisan forces might have cleaned it out,
since the first few buildings of the town seemed deserted. Then Lieutenant WILFERD L. PHILLIPSEN
of the 3rd Platoon was challenged in German as he passed a building. He didn’t answer,
but held the column up.
In German, the guard yelled, “Attention to the fire!” and opened up with a new German
automatic weapon. It sounded very much like our own BAR, and our men feared that the 2nd
Battalion might be occupying the town, so they didn’t return fire. This misapprehension was further
heightened by an erroneous impression widely circulated among the troops from a British
radio message. The British artillery had radioed saying they would not fire support until assured
that none of the 2nd Battalion were in Spiazzi. This was thought by some to mean that the
2nd Battalion was in Spiazzi, although there was no other reason to expect them to be within several
miles of the town.
Consequently, S/Sgt. WILLIAM F. WHITEHEAD, who was with the company commander at
the time, raised his vice and shouted, “Are you Americans?”
One shot—sounding like an M-1 rifle, was the reply.
Again, “Are you Americans?”
One more shot—like an M-1.
For the third time, “Are you Americans?”
Then the characteristic German “Achtung!” and a burp gun opened up.
Someone in the company yelled, “That’s all, brother! Let’s go!” and the fight was on.
The 3rd Platoon finally passed around to the right of the buildings where they had been fired
on, and went into town. The 2nd Platoon built up a base of fire for them. Also the CP group
from a higher ridge to the left fired into the town. Bazookas were used against the buildings, and
the 3rd Platoon quickly cleaned out a half-dozen buildings. By 0700 the 3rd Platoon had taken
the first part of town, including a former schoolhouse and a German hospital building. The 2nd
Platoon had taken three or four prisoners and killed a good many more. With daylight, however,
the slightest exposure by the 3rd Platoon brought fire.
It was planned to move on through the town with the 2nd Platoon moving through the
houses and the 1st Platoon abreast of them on the street. As they advanced along the road to-
Apr 29
158
ward the center of town, machine gun fire opened up, cutting down several of the leading men.
Pfc. EDWIN W. STANKE, the acting squad leader, and Sgt. WILLIAM H. FORESTER, were
killed. First Sergeant GILBERT S. BATES, S/Sgt. LAWRENCE E. HOTALING, Pfc. WELDON E.
STOREY, Pvt. JOHN B. MORGAN, JR., and Pvt. EDWARD E. LEICHLEITER were all wounded.
A stream of bullets sprayed the men from all sides. STOREY was hit three times in the arm, and
Platoon Sergeant HOTALING was hit by seven bullets. The men who were able withdrew to
cover, and artillery fire was called for. The 604th Field Artillery laid in an effective barrage that
neutralized the machine gun fire.
At 1100, however, the Germans counterattacked furiously and in strength from the high
ground east of the town. The 2nd and 3rd Platoons and the company command group cut them
down from positions in the school and hospital, but the remnants kept driving on and got close
enough to hurl grenades. Large Panzerfausts were shot into the buildings, wounding two men
from Company D. The riflemen learned to stand back four or five feet from the windows to fire.
All of Company A had been committed, and while scores of dead Germans lay scattered
around, the situation did not look too promising. Suddenly Company C, attacking from the
north with tremendous surprise, entered the far end of town, captured forty to fifty prisoners,
and joined Company A.
COMPANY C
At 0100 of the 29th, Company C moved out in rain from Braga to support Company A, and
moved up a road to a point 2,000 yards west of and overlooking Spiazzi. From this high ground
they continued north to be behind the town when Company A should attack. Moving north and
northeastward cross-country by azimuth, the 3rd Platoon hit the road north of Spiazzi. It was
dark and stormy and no previous reconnaissance had been possible. There was some confusion
when they hit the road on either side of a hairpin turn. The point, on the lower switchback with
Lieutenant RICHARD C. POWERS, was challenged by four or five Germans. The point opened
up with a BAR, rifles were fired, and grenades thrown. This advance element could dimly see
and hear the balance of the company above them on the upper switchback, and at first feared
they were Germans. To add to the confusion, the new German machine carbine sounded like the
American BAR, making the men wonder if the 2nd Battalion wasn’t already in the town.
The company got oriented and tacked back to the south, so that at about 0800 they were just
outside of town in the German rear. At 0900 they jumped off, the 2nd and 3rd Platoons on either
side of the road, then the command group and weapons, and the 1st bringing up the rear. At this
time Company A was moving north in Spiazzi. First Lieutenant ROBERT F. BOYER, by his successful
maneuver, had the town sealed off. On the right, the 2nd Platoon spotted three Germans
facing south in dugouts west of town. They got up to 75 yards behind them when the lead scout
coughed, and the Germans swung around as the scout hit the ground. They then noticed for the
first time the tail of the company column still on the road to the rear, and they opened fire. Lieutenant
JOHN W. HAWK pitched his first grenade, scoring a bulls-eye and hitting the three Germans.
The platoon moved up to the crest and fired down on the dugouts, while Lieutenant
HAWK kept jumping to his feet and pitching grenades while covered by the fire. Pfc. HOMER G.
IRVIN, the platoon runner, was hit in the arm, but nine Germans were wounded, eight of them
by grenades. Lieutenant HAWK had been a great exponent of the hand grenade ever since the
March campaign.
Finally a big furst charge came sailing up toward the crest like a football, and the men withdrew
before it. Having located the enemy that were still firing, Lieutenant HAWK sent Sgt. RUSSELL
B. HELMER’s 3rd Squad up onto a small cliff to set up a base of fire. This was a difficult
spot to reach, but the sergeant did an excellent job placing his men to cover the 2nd Squad as they
159
moved into position. Pfc. ELMER T. PERKINS, a BAR man, got right up in full view and poured
fire into the dugouts. Then the 2nd Squad set up the base of fire on the right while the 3rd assaulted
from the left, firing as they ran. Sgt. THOMAS P. HOLLAND and two men jumped
down into the long dugout trench system and flushed out ten Germans. Pfc. KENNETH A.
SPERRY had just stepped across a dugout opening when a Kraut stuck his head out of the dugout
behind him. Sgt. WILBUR R. MORROW tossed a grenade, disposing of the German.
The platoon reorganized. The 3rd Platoon had been stopped up on a hill to the left during
the firing, so the 3rd now went down into the rear section of Spiazzi, which had five or six houses
around a square. Sgt. HOLLAND and the 2nd Squad flushed thirteen Germans from one building,
and there was no other resistance here. The platoon then moved to the main part of town,
and after subduing some upper-story machine gun fire, spread out in town and awaited the rest
of the company.
Meanwhile, the 3rd Platoon was firing into dugouts with a BAR and rifles, and taking prisoners
who were confused by the attack from the rear. Seven men of the platoon with Sgt.
CASIMIR POVELAITES were fired on by rifle fire from the left. They flushed out a Fascist and
threw him in with the prisoners, while he protested violently. Another German was knocked off
his bike by rifle fire, and he and two others in a ditch beside him ran into a building. A bazooka
shell in the doorway produced a white flag, and five Germans surrendered from the building.
This ended resistance in Spiazzi as the company closed in and met Company A.
The company had captured 38 Germans, and these were “fighting” Germans of the quality
encountered during the initial phase in the mountains. The company, coordinating with Company
A’s frontal attack, had circled completely around the town in a difficult maneuver executed
during a dark, stormy night. In the morning they had caught the Germans completely by surprise,
reaching hand-grenade range in his rear before discovery. Company C had but one man
slightly wounded. It was a brilliant action.
COMPANY D
Company D took part in the fight for the mountain town of Spiazzi. The mortars were unable
to reach the objective from the line of departure, so they took no part in the engagement.
Lieutenant ANTSELM BRADLEY’s platoon was attached, one section each to Company A and C.
Lieutenant WILLIAM SPINNEY’s platoon was kept in reserve. Lieutenant BRADLEY with
Company A set up a machine gun on a table inside a building, and was firing from a window. A
direct hit with a large Panzerfaust grenade struck the machine gun and smashed it against the
wall. Miraculously, no one was seriously hurt. Then they set up a gun in another room and fired
through a doorway. They were so exposed to direct fire that Lieutenant BRADLEY moved all
men but the gunner away from the gun. Then lining the men up in a place of safety, each man
took his turn firing. This gun killed twelve Germans one after another as they came around the
corner of a building. During this engagement in the town, Company D was able to set up crossing
bands of machine gun fire for the first time, when they placed two guns to fire down corridors
at right angles to each other in a large building. Wounded in this action were Pfc. JOHN G.
KAPUSTINEC, COLEMAN B. KELLY, and Pvt. CLYDE H. DALTON. Cpl. JOOS DEN HERDER
was injured.
MOUNTAIN COMMUNICATION
Early in the morning of the 29th, all attempts to reach the 2nd Battalion having been unsuccessful,
Colonel FOWLER and driver, Pfc. JOHN MRENKO, the radio jeep of the 110th Signal
Company, and two jeeps of the regimental I & R Platoon, one under T/Sgt. EDWARD WILLFORD
and the other under Sgt. BENNETT L. BOGGESS, set out to find a route to the 2nd Battal160
ion. Without difficulty they reached the cluster of sheepherders’ buildings called Pradonego, at
an elevation of about 3,000 feet. From there they had a most difficult, rocky path climbing another
1,000 feet to the top of a lateral ridge. In several places, all men except the driver had to
dismount to lift and push a jeep. It took two hours to go the last mile to the top. It was about
1300 when they finally reached the better road on the other side, and began rolling north to overtake
the 2nd Battalion. In a few minutes, the head of the battalion column was met wearily plodding
the way back. They had finally received one of the regiment’s urgent messages recalling
them.
2nd Battalion—March Toward Mori
The 2nd Battalion, on the afternoon of the 28th, rode in trucks up the mountain to the end of
the road west of Punta di Naoli. Here in the ruins of an old monastery, they ate their supper rations
as a fog closed in on the mountain. Each man was issued a blanket just before the march
began over the ridge in the dusk.
It was a strenuous climb over the ridge, with its elevation of 5,000 feet, and it took a long
hunt to locate the beginning of the trail on the east side of the ridge. It was dark and rain was
falling at this time. However, they were finally on the main road, and they marched north until
0330 with the blankets wrapped around them like shrouds as protection against the cold rain.
Higher on the ridge that night, considerable snow fell. Company G led the march and set up allaround
security at a cluster of buildings where the battalion halted. Behind them, they felt assured,
the 1st Battalion was moving up beyond Pesina, past the blown bridge, to clean out the
Germans in Spiazzi and reestablish a supply route to them.
At 0800 of the 29th, in broad daylight, a German officer and two enlisted men walked up and
through the door of the 1st Platoon CP. The whole platoon and machine gun squad were in the
building. In the building next to it was the mortar section. The vigilance had been relaxed with
the coming of daylight. However, from the mortar section building, Pfc. JULIUS HILL saw the
three Germans as they entered the building. The German officer demanded that the whole platoon
surrender as the surprised men reached for their weapons. One of the Germans fired two
shots, killing Pvt. EVERETT G. MANTHEI and wounding Second Lieutenant PAUL M.
GOLDEN, who had received his battlefield commission and reported for duty the day before.
Pfc. JULIUS HILL opened up on the Germans with a Tommy gun from the next building, as they
tried to escape. The two enlisted men were cut down, but the officer escaped. The two wounded
prisoners were interrogated. They revealed that 200 SS troops, in this area to attend an NCO
school, were waiting half a mile away.
The battalion started to march north again, but received the radio message from Regiment
about 1000 that the mission had been changed. The 2nd Battalion was to return at once. Colonel
NATIONS, puzzled by this unexplained change, began the march to the south, and had returned
about five miles on the road overlooking Spiazzi when he met the regimental commander.
MINUTES TOO LATE
As soon as Colonel FOWLER’s party had crossed to the north side of the lateral ridge, radio
communication to the 1st Battalion died out, although T/5 MATTHEW R. FABER called continuously.
Consequently, when Colonel FOWLER met Colonel NATIONS and was assured that the
2nd Battalion, complete, was returning, he was unable to call Colonel WILSON direct to withdraw
his troops from Spiazzi. However, by using the “300” set of Company E, he was able to talk
to Captain KLEMME of Company A. He asked, “Is Spiazzi clear of Germans?” The answer,
“Yes. We are in control of Spiazzi.” Then, “Get word to the battalion commander to withdraw.”
Apr 29
161
At that very instant, while Colonel FOWLER was observing Spiazzi through glasses, a large
building blew apart in a great cloud of smoke, dust and paper. Colonel FOWLER asked, “Did
you have men in that building?” The answer, “Just a minute, sir. Yes, we did have men in that
building.”
1st Battalion—Spiazzi Tragedy
The battle was over, but tragedy struck just as they received the order to withdraw. It is
thought that the safe was booby-trapped, for thousands of records were scattered far and wide.
In any case, the building occupied by Company A was mined by the Germans who must have
foreseen their defeat, and left their treachery behind them. The whole wing of the building fell.
S/Sgt. HAROLD M. CREGER was killed. He was the platoon sergeant of the 3rd Platoon, Company
A, and his work in the campaign had been superior. Wounded in the blast were Second
Lieutenant WILFERD L. PHILLIPSEN, of the 3rd Platoon, and Sgt. RAOUL J. CLOUTIER, Pfc.
ROBERT A. UTTER, Pfc. CLIFFORD G. ABNEY, JR., Pfc. LEO HACKNEY, JR., Pvt. DANIEL O.
FIKE, Pvt. LOWELL E. GIBSON, and Pvt. WILLIAM P. ANTHONY. Three men of Company D
were wounded: Pfc. GRANVILLE BROWN, Pfc. WILLIAM J. LALLY, and Pfc. ROBERT J.
STILLER.
The action at Spiazzi, apart from the tragedy of the explosion, was an outstanding example of
a night approach, and a surprise attack from two directions against a fanatical enemy. The garrison
at Spiazzi was in reality an NCO school, consisting of about 200 men. The surrounding area
was well organized with model emplacements. The defenders counterattacked repeatedly and
viciously to throw out the attacking Americans. An estimated seventy Germans were killed;
about forty were captured. The remainder are believed to have escaped down the steep bluffs to
the east toward the Adige River.
The prisoners and the two jeeps of the I & R Platoon were used to evacuate the wounded to
the site of the blown bridge, then carried across the streambed to an ambulance on the far side.
The four jeeps of the colonel’s party were able to negotiate the bypass, where Lieutenant DALLAS
BEAMAN’s Pioneer Platoon was working on the mission to open up a supply route. There
was no longer any need for this route. Both battalions were assembling near Pazzon for truck
movement to Torri del Benaco. The battalions arrived about dark, and found billets in the lakeshore
village.
END OF THE CAMPAIGN—30 APRIL - 2 MAY
Despite the frantic efforts that had been made to recall the 1st and 2nd Battalions, there was
really no point to pushing them further north than Torri del Benaco, because the engineers were
still having their troubles repairing demolitions of the tunnels and bridges. The 86th Infantry,
having bypassed the obstacles by DUKW or by tortuous mountain trail, was having some grim
sessions with the Germans at the north end of the lake. Although they suffered some bitter
losses, they fought with determination and skill, drove the Germans out of Torbole and then
Nago, then swung left and gained the much larger town of Riva, and finally pushed a company
northeast to Arco.
The Germans were still retreating. They put up a desperate show of resistance, took some
losses, and pulled back. Where did they intend to fight to the finish? Where could there be any
better place than in these rugged mountains? The 85th Infantry was making raids, usually of one
company strength, in DUKWs across the lake. The raid most publicized after it was over was the
one to Gargnano to search a villa of Mussolini.
Apr 30
Apr 29
162
There was little the 87th could do until there was more room to fight. Most men needed rest.
Now was the time for it. They needed to clean up. The lake was at the front door. We needed
winter equipment if we were going to fight the Germans in the high mountains. Major DON R.
HARRIS, Regimental S-4, had to get it, and get it quick. The Alpini Pack Company caught up
again, and made ready for the campaign in the mountains.
One little episode is typical of the inveterate mountaineer. Being in reserve with nothing official
to do, Second Lieutenant RICHARD A. ROCKER, 3rd Battalion Headquarters, and a few others
of the same category, viewed the majestic range of mountains towering at their back door,
and took up the challenge. A four-hour climb brought them to a pass, Bocca di Navene, elevation
4,410 feet, close to the winding mountain road leading northeast to Mori. Approaching from the
north was a small group of Germans, apparently a security force for a formation of about sixty
fully equipped Germans 300 yards farther back. Around a bend marched a similar large group.
As the point came close, ROCKER’s party called to them to surrender, but the point was in a
mood to fight. The Americans opened fire, and killed and wounded some of the lead men, but
the larger group of Germans came quickly to the rescue, and there was nothing to do but withdraw.
They were able to accomplish this without casualty.
The next day a large group climbed toward the pass again, but was fired on before reaching
the top. Obviously, the Germans had established observation posts overlooking the lake road.
On the return of this patrol, attempts were made to reach the pass with a concentration of 81-mm
mortar fire, but the range and elevation were too great.
The next day, 2 May, a party from the 3rd Battalion reconnoitered a trail along the ridge high
above the lake that would bring troops out to the east-west road between Torbole and Mori, near
Lago di Loppio. On the 3rd of May, one battalion with mules would take this mountain route;
the remainder of the regiment would go by motor and marching through the cleared tunnels and
over the repaired bridges; and the Division would begin the drive on Trento, Bolzano, and the
Brenner Pass.
VICTORY — 2 MAY
After several false rumors among the Italians, and after some very good indications, such as
the refusal of the Air Force to fly any more missions, and the withdrawal of certain artillery support,
the official news of the capitulation of all German forces in Italy broke over the radio at
about suppertime on the 2nd of May 1945.
The Presidential Message sent to General MARK W. CLARK, Commander of the 15th Army
Group, follows:
PRESIDENTIAL MESSAGE
ON THE OCCASION OF THE FINAL BRILLIANT VICTORY OF THE ALLIED ARMIES IN
ITALY IN IMPOSING UNCONDITIONAL SURRENDER UPON THE ENEMY, I WISH TO
CONVEY TO THE AMERICAN FORCES UNDER YOUR COMMAND AND TO YOU PERSONALLY
THE APPRECIATION AND GRATITUDE OF THE PRESIDENT AND OF THE
PEOPLE OF THE UNITED STATES. NO PRAISE IS ADEQUATE FOR THE HEROIC
ACHIEVEMENTS AND MAGNIFICENT COURAGE OF EVERY INDIVIDUAL UNDER YOUR
COMMAND DURING THIS LONG AND TRYING CAMPAIGN.
AMERICA IS PROUD OF THE ESSENTIAL CONTRIBUTION MADE BY YOUR AMERICAN
ARMIES TO THE FINAL ALLIED VICTORY IN ITALY. OUR THANKS FOR YOUR GALLANT
LEADERSHIP AND THE DEATHLESS VALOR OF YOUR MEN.
HARRY S. TRUMAN
May 2
May 1
163
The Italians were jubilant and noisy as only Latin peoples can be. They sang, yelled, and
crowded the streets firing their weapons. All the church bells clanged jubilantly. Some of the
tankers fired their .50-calibers at a dangerous angle.
But by and large, the infantryman was soberly relieved. The next phase of the attack over the
mountains had been scheduled to get under way the next morning. He was too weary in a cumulative
way, too stunned to believe the full import of this news. He knew he ought to feel more
elated than he did. Almost mechanically he realized that he’d made it, that now he would have a
chance to get home. Then he thought of those who didn’t make it, and wouldn’t go home. Three
hundred and eleven from the 87th had been killed since moving up to the front on the 2nd of
February, just exactly three months previously. During the same period, 1,281 had been
wounded. Only a small percentage had come back from the hospitals; more would return from
day to day. The regiment wasn’t the same. After a while things would renew themselves, but for
the night of the peace, the mountain infantryman was thoughtful.
Commendations
During the following weeks, several commendations recognizing the outstanding battle record
of the 10th Mountain Division were received. Two of them are here shown:
From Major General WILLIS D. CRITTENBERGER, Commander of IV Corps:
The splendid performance of the officers and men of the 10th Mountain Division
while a part of IV Corps attack in the Fifth Army offensive from 14 April to 28 April, inclusive,
was such as to evoke unqualified praise in all military circles, and it is my desire
hereby to commend you and your officers and men in the very highest terms..
In fifteen days of arduous fighting the 10th Mountain Division covered 105 miles in a
northerly direction, an average advance of seven miles per day. During that period you
broke through the enemy Apennine defenses in your front with such impetus as to split
three enemy divisions, inflicting heavy losses in men and material and throwing these
enemy units into a state of utter confusion.
On the seventh day of your attack, debauching into the Po Valley with admirable
speed, you cut Highway 9 and threatened Bologna by thrusting beyond it well to the
north. The infantry and armor under your command raced on to seize the southern bank
of the Po River in zone, and by the evening of 23 April, with scarcely a pause, you had established
a firm bridgehead across that important obstacle. Allowing the bewildered and
beaten enemy forces no respite, the 10th Mountain Division then thrust on northward to
seize the Villafranca airport and the city of Verona, which your elements had cleared by
early afternoon of 26 April.
Bearing northwestward in accordance with your new mission, you continued the
pursuit of the enemy with such relentless speed that by the evening of 28 April your leading
elements were a good three-fourths of the way up the eastern shore of Lago di Garda.
At this time the 10th Mountain Division was detached from IV Corps, but we continued
to watch with the greatest admiration your further northward progress, which demonstrated
conclusively the fine physical condition and offensive spirit which still obtained
even though your offensive had continued by this time without cessation for more than
two weeks.
The story of the fifteen days from 14 April to 28 April, inclusive, establishes for the
10th Mountain Division a record of which every officer and man can be justly proud.
These battlefield accomplishments are now known to the entire Army. Seldom has a Di164
vision contributed more effectively to an offensive which has so decisively thrown German
forces completely off balance.
The IV Corps was fortunate to have had the stalwart 10th Mountain Division available
to deliver its main attack in this final offensive and this Headquarters is fully aware
of the important contribution which that Division made to our success in overwhelmingly
defeating the enemy forces in northwest Italy, and bringing about the speedy cessation
of hostilities.
WILLIS D. CRITTENBERGER
Major General, U.S. Army
From General MARK W. CLARK, Commander of the 15th Army Group:
Our great offensive which ended in the unconditional surrender of the German
forces was spearheaded by the 10th Mountain Division under your brilliant leadership.
Will you please convey to all your officers and men the fact that I look upon the action of
the 10th Mountain as one of the most vital and brilliant in the campaign.
From the Apennines you drove ever northward with the Fifth Army until the Germans
laid down their arms.
You plunged ahead, exploiting the severing of Route 9, and to you came the welldeserved
honor of being first across the Po. Nothing, it seemed, could stop your drive,
and you went forward to Villafranca, to Verona, up and across Lake Garda, to Bolzano
and up the Resia Pass to meet the Seventh Army. This is the aggressive spirit of which
victory is made. It was a privilege to have you in this command. Good luck to you.
Sincerely,
MARK W. CLARK
General, U.S. Army
165
OCCUPATION DUTY AND RETURN TO THE STATES
(2 MAY — 14 AUG)
s Division planned the continued advance to the Brenner Pass, the war in Italy ended on 2
May. The night before, a 100-vehicle German convoy tried to escape from Milano along
Lake Garda, but was captured by the 2nd Battalion. The peace news was officially confirmed
from Fifth Army by way of 10th Mountain Division at 2315. Colonel FOWLER visited all of the
battalions in their areas around Lake Garda on the morning of the 3rd of May. General HAYS at
the same time officially addressed each battalion on the occasion of victory.
On 4 May, “Task Force Works” headed for Trento, Bolzano, Merano and Passo di Resia. This
force was made up of the 3rd Battalion, with attached artillery, TDs, engineers, and medics; all
motorized.
The rest of the regiment started a reconversion to peace program. On the 5th, training
schedules were requested with reveille, drill calls, and retreat. Military courtesy was required
once more.
On the 6th, duffle bags were sent for and ammunition was turned in. Blackout regulations
were lifted. Conditioning marches and exercises were held.
The remaining two battalions left lovely Lake Garda on May 8th, moving north through the
valley to Rovereto and then east up onto a beautiful mountainside. The battalions were bivouacked
in and around Folgaria. After the memory of the seared browns of the Apennines and the
recent dust of battle, the May colors in the foothills of the Alps seemed unbelievably fresh and
vivid. The towns were pastel-colored, and more picturesque in architecture than the Italy of further
south. Every view seemed like a children’s book illustration.
The troops listened on the 8th of May to Prime Minister Winston Churchill proclaim the
complete victory of the Allies. He declared that the victory would be celebrated the next day on
the 9th. The 9th was proclaimed a holiday for all Fifth Army troops.
Censorship was lifted on the 11th. A big regimental picnic was held for the natives and soldiers
in celebration of victory. Hundreds of Italians were driven in GI trucks from miles around
for the food, games, and music.
“Task Force Works” in the Alps
Meanwhile the 3rd Battalion had a fabulous tale to tell. Quoting from Colonel ROBERT C.
WORKS’ letter to Colonel FOWLER on May 6th:
Dear Colonel FOWLER:
I thought you would be interested in the “Lost Battalion” and I’ll give you a brief
picture of our situation.
As you know, our trip north was uneventful; it only caused my hair to turn
grey—no other casualties. From Trento to our present location, we ran the gauntlet
of thousands of armed Krauts who, in their oafish German way, insisted on maintaining
roadblocks; manning 88-mm scout cars, and mountain guns; and stopping
and checking our convoy. No harm was done, but they tested the temper of a man
who would have liked nothing better than to open up a broadside with all tanks, TDs
and artillery.
We arrived in the area at 4:30 AM, but had to immediately start the job of billeting
and military government. Last night I would have gladly taken over some easy
A
166
job, such as the attack of Madna di Rodiano. We now maintain roadblocks: Company
I at Tubre, Company L just north of Malles, Company K at Sluderno, Company
M is at Tarces, the tanks at Landes, the 1125th FA at Sluderno. The areas assigned
were more a result of billeting expedience, for initially they were put in to defend the
valley south of Malles and to block the three roads entering the area. But later we
had to move to our present positions to allow the Krauts to assemble in the valley
around Glorenza.
As usual, we have received no clear-out orders from Division. Yesterday, as late
as 2:00 PM, I could get no policy from the task force commander, except that “saluting
would be improved,” “the pile liner will not be used as an outer garment,” and
that “Krauts and civilians will not be evacuated from billets to let our men in out of
the rain.” On handling the Krauts, civil government, AMG duties, I could get no answer.
The civil population is 95 percent Austrian and hates the Italians. The Italians
are the former fascists who are now ardent partisans. The gendarmerie are mostly
Krauts. The Krauts consist of AAA, AP, MPs, Poles, Todt, SOS, etc., with fifteen or
twenty different units, including WACs in groups of two or three up to seventy-five.
The latter were living in the same houses as my men.
So at noon yesterday I called in the senior officer in the area, a Colonel, and ordered
him to organize a provisional Regiment and move his troops to Glorenza
where there are some old barracks. I laid down the law on drinking, curfew, fraternizing
with Americans, etc. He is an old Prussian, Iron Cross in World War I, monocle,
right out of Hollywood. When he saw I meant business, he saluted, clicked his
heels, bowed, and left. About three hours later, the queerest assortment of Krauts
started pouring out of the hills into the assembly area. Today most of them are gathered
together, doing close order drill, etc., preparing for the next war, I suppose.
The civilian problem hasn’t been so easy. I called together the local mayors, all
Tyroleans, and told them they were still in charge, and that I expected them to maintain
law and order. I called together all the partisan leaders and read them the riot
act. So far no trouble, except that the partisans stole the key to the mayor’s office and
he wants me to get it back.
My staff is as busy as bird dogs, but my troops have no entertainment or recreation,
except the local vino shop. The Germans assure me that the VD rate is very low
in this area. To kill time I have started training in the morning with a retreat formation
in the afternoon. We do quite a lot of guard duty, but still there is too much time
on the hands of the men. The training consists of mountain training: rock climbing,
skiing (not very good), marching, and a dozen other subjects. Will enclose training
schedule.
ROBERT C. WORKS
After the date of the colonel’s letter, Company K moved into a large ski resort at Solda. Here
with excellent skiing every day, they lived in every luxury, with maid service, excellent beds and
showers, and the army chow served up expertly. Strangest of all, they had champagne to drink
three times a day. German warehouses of it came to their disposal. Over the bar a sign read:
“Champagne Free! Beer 20 Cents. Only you wealthy guys drink beer!” They also had found a
warehouse of German radios, and just about any other merchandise to be thought of up to and
including pianos and Fiat cars.
I Company was at Merano in another hotel just as happy. They were nearer the warehouses
and besides it was a lovely city, untouched by bombs because of its many hospitals. All of the
167
fashionables and wealthy Nazis and near-Nazis left in Europe had fled to this former resort city.
To veterans of Italy the women were beautiful.
The battalion executive officer, Major JOHN C. MCKAY, acted as mayor of Merano. His
function among other things was to coordinate between German and Allied commands. In the
town were 15,000 German troops (mostly service) and scores of wanted Nazi “Bigwigs.” The loot
of Europe was stored here, too. Twelve kilometers away was a great cache of paintings and other
art treasures from Florence. There were bales of silk stockings, warehouses of liquor, 5,000 commercial
radios, 1,000 tons of food, and millions in Italian currency.
During a thirty-minute period, the following typical problems entered Major MCKAYS’s office:
1. The disposition of Baron Kemeny, former head of the Austrian Nazi party, was
determined.
2. Twenty priests told of being forced into the German army to do menial work
in hospitals and wanted to get out of the German army immediately.
3. A German officer came to see about getting protection for his Italian family
against Partisans.
4. A German brewery called for regulations on beer.
5. The German military complained of Americans driving off their cars.
6. A British colonel came in regarding some $12,000,000 lire in currency which
wouldn’t fit into his car for the trip to the Bank at Bolzano. He wanted a
trailer.
7. A woman pregnant by an unknown German soldier wanted to know what to
do.
8. A French movie actress desired to go to Switzerland.
9. Arrangements were ordered for the removal of the 25-man Jap embassy to
Montecatini while the 100-man German embassy remained in immunity.
It was al soon over. By the 14th the regiment was in their new area southwest of Lake Garda
on the flat plain near Montichiari (F145550) prepared to guard the thousands of surrendered
Germans assembling at the Ghedi Airport.
Trouble With Tito
On 16 May, Division was put on a 48-four alert and reverted to full censorship status.
Tito’s occupation of the Trieste and Klagenfurt areas drew the 10th Mountain Division over
east to the vicinity of Udine. The regiment moved administratively on 19 May, driving through
Verona, Vicenza, Treviso, Panzenone, and Udine, to a bivouac area near Tarcento. Tito’s men
were billeted all around the troops and the two armies drilled in front of each other. For the next
two months the Yugoslav troops were in close association with the Americans and both sides felt
the other both friend and enemy. Tito’s men tried to impress the people with a show of strength,
his soldiers and pictures were everywhere, and the Italian town names were changed to Slavic,
the Italian language dropped. The Allies were trying to impress Tito with a show of strength:
planes overhead, tanks on the road, trucks everywhere. Some towns were pro-Italian, some pro-
Yugoslavian. Geographically it made no sense. But there were other strong feelings in the area;
there were other bands besides Tito’s partisans. There were “Garibaldis” and hated “Chetnicks”
and “Ossopo Frinlie,” and several more. Whole villages nearby had been sacked and burned in
retribution for a killed enemy.
The 1st Battalion moved on the 20th to Plezzo in the historic Valley of the Isonzo north of
Caporetto where the regimental CP was established. The other two battalions settled in the long
green valley running west from Caporetto toward Udine, the valley where the Italian army was
168
cut off by German and Austrian mountain troops in World War I and 30,000 of them killed or
captured between the steep green walls.
Then commenced a series of international incidents with the Partisans that seem comic operalike
in retrospect but seemed as dangerous as a powder chain at the time. It was discovered after
moving into the CP building that its basement was the Yugoslav ammo dump. Guards from both
armies walked post for that night. Yugoslav troop movements were made of record but not
stopped.
Ammunition went up and down the road with the Yugoslavs. The Italian Partisans accused
Tito’s men of holding the people up for cattle and food. Tito’s men called the Partisans ex-fascists
and put up posters claiming this area “freed by Yugoslav blood and that blood alone.” Signals
by church bells, flares, small arms shots, and the appearance of Russian Cossacks cast alarms.
On the 27th of May a parade was held in the 3rd Battalion area. The troops were in excellent
physical shape. Athletic fields were being groomed in all areas. Many of the wounded were returning
to their outfits. The Army point system was being discussed avidly.
On the other hand, an American soldier in the Yugoslav area injured himself and started a
rumor that he was shot. A personnel man was shot at, but not hit, while bathing in a creek. A
drunken truckload of armed partisans went Italian-hunting one evening. Roadblocks appeared
on all sides manned by both sides. The local girls were afraid to talk to Americans after one girl’s
head was shaved in Caporetto. More cows were taken without payment by Tito’s men. Their
army had to eat.
At the end of the month things seemed to be reaching a climax when Tito ordered the 91st
Division to leave Gorizia or be interned. The 91st ignored the order and nothing but a wild demonstration
developed.
Memorial Day—Italy, 1945
The month ended with a memorial day ceremony attended by the men of the regiment. The
executive officer of the 87th Mountain Infantry, Lt. Col. JOHN SCHMELTZER, gave the following
remarks to the 2nd Battalion:
“On Memorial Day we do not honor the glorious deeds of the living or rejoice in the fruits of
victory. It is a day set aside to honor American dead, of all wars. We honor particularly our close
comrades, those that helped us in battle, those that gave their lives so that we might push on not
only to military objectives but also to a life of freedom of speech, freedom of religion, freedom
from want, freedom from fear. Never let us forget that our dead comrades made the supreme
sacrifice not only for us, but for those at home—not only for the living but for the children yet
unborn. Always remember the cause for which they fought and for which they died, so that you
may live a life worthy of their great sacrifice.”
Summary of Occupation
June-July 1945
During the entire month the regimental combat team continued to occupy the sector along
the Isonzo River from Plezzo to Tolmino. Conditions improved, points of friction with Yugoslavs
were smoothed over. On the evening of 9 June, Major JOHN C. MCKAY, S-3, represented the
regimental commander at a banquet given by Captain Sergei, commander of the Yugoslav force
in Tolmino.
The Yugoslavs persisted in their practice of regularly relieving the garrison at Oltrasonzo.
This involved a march on the main highway west of the Isonzo River from Tolmino to a point just
169
north of Saga. This was considered totally unnecessary from a military standpoint, and it was
assumed that the Yugoslavs were simply using this expedient to parade their troops west of the
Morgan Line. Our guards simply reported numbers of men and vehicles and principal types of
supplies, as the nondescript troops passed our checkpoints.
On 1 June, Lieutenant General Sir Richard McCreery, commander of the British Eighth Army,
visited the regimental sector and had lunch at the regimental officers’ mess. Two days later,
Sunday, 3 June, he drove through the area with Field Marshal Sir Harold Alexander, commander
of the Mediterranean Theater, making short visits inspecting representative formations of the
regiment. He spoke briefly to the officers at Pulfero and in the square at Caporetto, but to all of
the troops of the 3rd Battalion at Robic and the 1st Battalion at Plezzo, the Field Marshal spoke
informally in words of highest praise for the 10th Mountain Division.
On Sunday, 24 June, at a ceremony of American troops and members of the Difesa Popolare,
Yugoslav Police, the regimental commander made the following speech in English, which was
interpreted by Pvt. JAMES MAMARCHEV, 87th Mountain Infantry:
“Members of the Difesa Popolare, you have guarded your towns and defended your homes
against our common enemy. You have fought heroically for four long years. The British, Russian,
and American armies have also fought to destroy the common enemy. We have provided
you with some fighting equipment so you could fight better. You have fought side by side with
us. Fighting together we have destroyed the armed might of the Fascists of Italy and Germany.
We have been fighting to restore peace. Now we want an end of fighting. We want an end of
shooting.
“An Allied Military Government has been established in this area. The Allied Military Government
has only one police force. No other police force has any authority in this territory now.
Your authority therefore has come to an honorable end. Each one of you may now choose:
“1. To turn your rifle and ammunition over to my troops. If you choose to do this, you may
get a pass to go back to the town where you were on duty. We will take you back by truck. Or
you may volunteer for the Allied Military Government Police force to be trained and equipped in
Gorizia. Or:
“2. You may choose to take your weapon to Tolmino. If so, our troops will escort you there
in trucks. Then we must ask you not to come back across the Morgan Line.
“Now the time has come for you to choose. We thank you for what you have done in the
years of fighting. We will continue to be friends.”
The outcome was not as simple as hoped for, but eventually most of the Yugoslavs turned in
their rifles and the remainder were escorted to Tolmino.
In early June the officers and enlisted men of the unit having ASR scores in excess of eightyfour
points, who did not elect to remain with the unit, were transferred to the 85th Infantry Division
for return home. In this transfer, the regiment lost many of the officers and men longest
with the regiment, including the regimental executive officer, S-1, S-2, S-3, S-4, surgeon, dental
surgeon, one battalion commander and nine company commanders. These vacancies were filled
within the regiment.
Quotas from Division for officers and enlisted men to various rest centers were filled. Venice,
Florence, Rome, Allasio, Stresa, Cannes became familiar to many. A truck convoy was sent
each day to Venice so that practically every man of the regiment spent from 1000 until 2100 in the
famous city of canals.
170
Mountaineering instruction began during the month with two platoons per week at Lago di
Fusino on the north side of Mt. Mangart, and a reinforced company per week at Passo Pordoi
near the Marmolada.
The occupation duties of the regiment continued into July, with steadily improving conditions.
Under the tentative plan for return to the United States in November, much work was
done to put into effect the Army Educational Program. Officers and enlisted men signed up for
various courses, books were requisitioned and distributed, and school classes began. Much enthusiastic
work was done by all units toward improving recreational facilities: playing fields,
swimming pools on the river Natisone, an outdoor stage.
One final occasion remained for the regiment before its occupation phase was abruptly terminated.
An elaborate and enthusiastic old-fashioned Fourth of July picnic was staged in the 3rd
Battalion area at Robic, with sports competitions, games, music, food, and beer. It was a fitting
and thoroughly American celebration of Independence Day, an independence more than a century
and a half old for these Americans but an independence still being fought for. In the beautiful
mountain-surrounded valley where these men were gathered on July 4th, independence was
strange and new. Throughout the period of occupation it was only too obvious that it would take
these newly liberated peoples many years to learn how to use their hard-won independence and
freedom. The olive-drab soldiers in the foreign valley had done all that men can do to free these
people, but as a great American pointed out, freedom has not only to be won but continually renewed
and defended wherever it is to grow old.
In Conclusion
During July the War Department gave the 10th Mountain Division an assignment in the Pacific.
They were scheduled for immediate redeployment, with reorganization and training in the
United States followed by shipment to the Far East. General HAYS, the division commander,
arranged for assignment to Camp Carson, Colorado, the camp most preferred by the officers and
men of the Division.
The regiment left Caporetto, Italy, on the 17th of July. The men moved by truck to Udine and
entrained there on Italian four-wheeled boxcars. Two days later, on the 19th, they closed at the
Florence Redeployment Training Area. On the 28th of July they entrained again on the uncomfortable
boxcars, this time bound for Naples. The staging area at Naples was reached on the 30th
and on the morning of 2 August the troops filed up the gangplank of the Mount Vernon, the
peacetime Washington, a large (30,000 ton) comfortable liner. General MCNARNEY gave the
troops a farewell speech in which he commended them on their fine battle record in Italy and
promised them that the name “Mountain Infantry” would never be dropped from the unit. The
great ship sailed at 1500 and moved out into the peaceful Mediterranean. The rock of Gibraltar
was passed at 1600 of the 4th of August and in beautiful calm seas the Mount Vernon moved out
into the Atlantic. The weather remained fine throughout the crossing; the men sunned themselves
and enjoyed the three meals a day offered by the ship, one of the few transports serving all
three meals. In mid-Atlantic the first reports of the atomic bomb landing on Japan startled the
troops and set up wild hopes that the war might be nearly over. The next day Russia was reported
to have joined the fight against Japan. Peace seemed nearer. Rumors of peace came over
the ship’s radio the day before landing. On the 11th of August at 1330 the 87th Mountain Infantry
docked at Newport News, Virginia, as a welcoming band played on the pier. An hour later
the regiment was entrained for Camp Patrick Henry. Within twenty-four hours they were off
again by train for separation centers and thirty-day furloughs.
171
On August 14, three days after the regiment’s return to the United States, the wonderful, incredible
news was announced. Japan had unconditionally surrendered to the Allies! The war
was over.
___________________
BIENNIAL REPORT OF THE CHIEF OF STAFF OF THE UNITED STATES ARMY
TO THE SECRETARY OF WAR
EXTRACT PERTAINING TO THE FINAL OFFENSIVE IN ITALY
The entire campaign was slow and bitter. The Allied troops did not have the superiority they
enjoyed in western Europe, where geography had compelled us to make the great effort. Nonetheless,
the Italian campaign made a heavy contribution to the successes on the western front,
pinning down German forces which Hitler needed badly to reinforce his weakened armies, both
in the east and west. The troops participating in the Italian campaign should feel as great a satisfaction
in the defeat of the Axis enemy as those of the larger forces which drove into the heart of
Germany from the west and made contact with the Red armies.
___________________
ARMY GROUND FORCES
Washington, D. C.
20 October 1945
TO: Commanding General, 10th Mountain Division
Expert employment of special combat skills enabled the officers and men of the 10th Mountain
Division to destroy a stubborn enemy on Europe’s most difficult battleground and to make a
magnificent contribution to our glorious victory over the Nazi threat to America’s cherished way
of life.
The proud history of Army Ground Forces must always contain the colorful chapter written
by the 10th Mountain at Mount Belvedere, in spearheading the Fifth Army’s Apennines offensive,
in the sweeping drive across the Po Valley, and in helping to smash final enemy resistance
in Northern Italy.
It is fitting at this time, with the 10th Division scheduled for inactivation, to pay tribute to
soldiers whose valor, willing sacrifice and staunch devotion to duty won the undying esteem of a
grateful nation. I consider it a privilege to commend your organization for a job well done.
JACOB L. DEVERS
General, USA, Commanding
___________________
TO: Personnel of the 10th Mountain Division.
1. I share with you pleasure and gratification that the splendid achievements of this Division
during the latter phases of the Italian Campaign are recognized as an important part of the glorious
history of our ground forces during World War II.
2. We all regret that this splendid Division with its high morale and esprit de corps is not to
be maintained as part of the Post War Army. As each of you leave to join other Army units or
return to civil life, I hope you will retain a feeling of lasting satisfaction in your contribution to
the war effort. I trust that the future will extend to you a happy and prosperous life which you so
richly deserve. I extend to you my gratitude and best wishes.
GEORGE P. HAYS
Major General, U.S. Army
___________________
172
COMBAT ORGANIZATION
of the 87th MOUNTAIN INFANTRY REGIMENT
10th Mountain Division
Major General George P. Hays, Division Commander
Brigadier General Robinson E. Duff, Asst. Division Commander
Wounded in action April 22
Colonel William O. Darby, Asst. Division Commander
Killed on action April 30
Brigadier General David L. Ruffner, Division Artillery
87th Mountain Infantry Regiment
Colonel David M. Fowler, Commander
Wounded in action February 22
Returned to regiment March 28
Lieutenant Colonel John F. Schmelzer
February 22 to March 28
1st Battalion
Lieutenant Colonel Ross J. Wilson
2nd Battalion
Lieutenant Colonel Emmett L. Nations
3rd Battalion
Lieutenant Colonel John F. Schmelzer - to February 22
Lieutenant Colonel Robert C. Works – from February 22
The 10th Mountain Division was part of IV Corps, which was commanded by Major General
Willis D. Crittenberger. IV Corps was part of the Fifth Army, commanded by Lt. Gen. Lucian K.
Truscott.
173
CASUALTIES
of the 87th MOUNTAIN INFANTRY REGIMENT
he total number of men who fought in Italy in the 87th Mountain Infantry Regiment was
4,781. Of these, 1,727 (36%) were replacements who joined the regiment in Italy.
Total casualties in the 87th were 1,593: 311 killed or died of wounds incurred in action, 1281
wounded, and 1 taken prisoner of war.
The Italian campaign can be divided into nine phases. The table below identifies the phases
and the number of 87th Regiment casualties in each phase.
CAMPAIGN PHASE DATES KIA/DOW WIA POW TOTAL
1. Early Patrols Jan 6 - Feb 18 2 13 15
2. Riva Ridge Feb 18 - Feb 25 0
3. Mt. Belvedere Feb 19 - Mar 2 34 162 196
4. March Offensive Mar 3 - Mar 6 51 170 221
5. Consolidation Mar 7 - Apr 13 13 58 71
6. Spring Offensive Apr 14 - Apr 16 110 436 546
7. Breakout Apr 17 - Apr 20 48 198 246
8., Po Valley Apr 20 - Apr 26 46 177 1 224
9. Lake Garda Apr 26 - May 2 7 58 65
Unknown dates 9 9
TOTALS: 311 1281 1 1593
T
174
ROLL OF HONOR
87th MOUNTAIN INFANTRY REGIMENT
KIA/DOW DOW WIA
NAME RANK* C O DATE DATE PLACE
MANUEL G ABASTA JR PFC A 4/15/45 LE COSTE
CHARLES W ADKINS PVT K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
JAMES A ALDAHL PFC A 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 903
LESTER L ALLISON T/SGT H 4/17/45 MT SERRA
FRED J ANETSBERGER PFC H 4/17/45 MT SERRA
MAURICE E AUCOIN S/SGT K 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
HERMAN S AUSTIN S/SGT K 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
EUGENE H BAGNESKI PFC B 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
GLENN R BAILEY PFC C 3/5/45 MONFENARO
AREL BAJKAN PFC MED 4/14/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
FRANK P BAKER 2ND LT H 3/8/45 TAMBURINI
RAFAEL BALDOR JR PFC L 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
ROBERT S BARR 2ND LT K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
JUAN BARRIENTOS PFC C 2/27/45 VALPIANA
ANDREW R BATTILORO PFC K 4/19/45 IL POGGIO
FEDOR H BENJAMIN PFC E 3/7/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
SYDNEY W BENNETT PVT A 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
JOHN P BENSON JR 1ST LT F 2/20/45 C FLORIO
ROBERT A BERGENDORFF PFC E 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
ELMER A BERLIN SGT HQ 3RD 3/4/45 2/28/45 MALANDRONE
MELVIN BERNSTEIN PFC G 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
WILLIAM J BETTENBERG SGT B 4/15/45 MT PIGNA HILL 834
GEORGE J BLAKER S/SGT G 3/4/45 MADNA DI BRASA
JOHN B BLANCHARD SGT L 2/28/45 MALANDRONE
WILLIAM B BLOCKER JR 2ND LT D 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
ROY F BREITENBACH PFC A 4/15/45 LE COSTE
LOUIS O BROWN S/SGT C 3/7/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
HECTOR W BRUNEAU PFC E 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
PAUL J BUCHANAN PFC MED 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
ARTHUR H BURGESS JR SGT L 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
MANFRED BUTLER PFC C 4/17/45 C BACUCCHI
GEORGE E CABEZUT PFC I 4/21/45 MANZOLINO
JOHN CAMILLO PVT K 4/21/45 MADNA DELLA PROVVIDENZA
CLARENCE E CAMPBELL PFC F 2/20/45 C FLORIO
ROBERT E CAMPBELL PFC K 4/19/45 PALZO MUSICO
WILLIAM CAMPBELL JR PFC I 2/24/45 VALPIANA
MOSE CAREY PFC A 4/21/45 4/14/45 LE COSTE
JAMES R CAUDILL PFC A 3/6/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
LEE H CHEW PFC A 2/20/45 CORONA
GLENN L CHRYSLER PFC L 4/15/45 TREVISO
WAYNE C CLARK S/SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
WALTER R COCHRAN JR PVT SVC 4/23/45 PO RIVER
WILLIAM R CONNER T/5 MED 3/3/45 MERLANO (RIOLA)
NORMAND W CONNOLLY T/SGT G 2/21/45 POLLA
WILLIAM S CONTINO 1ST LT (CHPL) HQ 3/3/45 ABETAIA
WID R CORN SGT HQ 3RD 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
HARVEY F CORN JR SGT F 3/5/45 3/3/45 MALANDRONE
HAROLD M CREGER S/SGT A 4/29/45 SPIAZZI
* Rank shown is the highest rank attained while serving in the 10th Mountain Division.
175
KIA/DOW DOW WIA
NAME RANK C O DATE DATE PLACE
LEONARD C CRISP PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
ANDREW E DALTON JR CPL H 4/18/45 C BACUCCHI
PRENTIS F DAVIDSON PFC C 4/3/45 BARDALONE
GEORGE T DAVIS PFC HQ 3RD 4/19/45 BADIA DI SOPRA
GEORGE H DAY JR SGT M 2/21/45 CORONA
RAYMOND V DE SORCY PFC MED 4/16/45 MT PIGNA AID STATION
OKEY C DEAN PFC A 4/14/45 LE COSTE
DAVID T DEANE SGT HQ 2ND 4/17/45 4/16/45 SECCADELLA
LUCIEN T DEETER PFC B 3/4/45 BACUCCO
JOHN P DELGADO PFC B 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
DAVID H C DENNIS PFC K 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
CAMILLE J DESCHAINE PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
FREDDIE DICKENS PFC E 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
HERBERT W DILKES PVT C 2/20/45 QUERCIOLA
WALTER W DILLER PFC B 4/15/45 LE COSTE HILL 838
LUTHER E DOANE JR PFC I 4/16/45 MT MOSCA
WILLARD W DORA 1ST LT L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO HILL 765
LOUIS M DORSEY PFC D 4/23/45 S BENEDETTO PO
JOSEPH J DUNCAN CAPT L 4/17/45 C COSTA
DALE W DUNHAM PFC L 2/28/45 MALANDRONE
HARRY H DUNN PFC A 4/15/45 LE COSTE HILL 802
PIERRE B ERHARD PFC K 2/20/45 CORONA
GORDON D ERICKSON PFC E 4/20/45 MT AVEZZANO
LESTER S ERSLAND 1ST SGT C 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI
GENE FANNING PFC HQ 2ND 4/12/45 CORGNOLE
JOSEPH C FARRELL PFC A 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
GEORGE A FELCH MAJ HQ 3RD 2/21/45 VALPIANA
OWEN W FLIGG JR 2ND LT D 4/15/45 LE COSTE HILL 802
WALTER O FLOWE PFC D 3/7/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
FRED FLOYD PFC D 2/20/45 MT BELVEDERE
WILLIAM D FLOYD 1ST LT M 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
THOMAS A FOLEY SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
EARL A FOLSE SGT C 4/19/45 SULMONTE
WILLIAM H FORESTER SGT A 4/29/45 SPIAZZI
EAGAN L FOSTER PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
BETTA FOTAS S/SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
LOREN M FRANK SGT HQ 3/1/45 LA SERRA
WILLIAM H FRICKE SGT HQ 3RD 7/14/46 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
ELMER FRISTOE PFC C 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
THEODORE J FRITCHIE PVT G 2/22/45 PRADA
PAUL N FRYE JR SGT B 2/21/45 CORONA
SAM GALLEGOS PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
HAROLD E GARFINKEL 1ST LT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
ALFRED A GARNEAU PFC F 4/14/45 MT PIGNA
ROY G GAY PFC MED 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
JACK GOLDBERG PFC D 4/20/45 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
EDWIN R GORDON SGT A 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
LLOYD A GORMAN SGT A 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
HAROLD R GOULD PFC K 4/21/45 MADNA DELLA PROVVIDENZA
ROBERT W GRABOWSKY PFC B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
CHARLIE I GREEN PVT G 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
ALBERT F GROEGER PVT G 5/1/45 4/16/45 C BACUCCHI
ALEX GUSKO PFC HQ 3RD 4/21/45 CAVAZZONA
ROBERT W GUSTAFSON PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
RANDOLPH J HABURNE S/SGT F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
DONALD G HAIGHT S/SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
176
KIA/DOW DOW WIA
NAME RANK C O DATE DATE PLACE
JOHN W HAINES III SGT I 4/24/45 ZAMMARCA
MARVIN G HALE SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
LEE L HALL PFC A 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI
ERIK H HAMILTON PFC A 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI
WILLIAM L HAMILTON T/5 K 4/21/45 MADNA DELLA PROVVIDENZA
JOSEPH G HANCE PFC I 3/4/45 PIETRA COLORA
LEO T HANDWERK PFC E 4/19/45 CASTELLO
HAROLD S HARRIS T/5 MED 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
EDMON E HATHAWAY PFC E 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
JOHN L HEICHEL PVT C 4/19/45 SULMONTE
RUDOLPH W HEINS PFC MED 4/14/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
OSCAR W HEMMER PFC HQ 3RD 4/22/45 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
WILLIAM E HEMSTREET PVT C 4/17/45 C BACUCCHI
WAYNE E HERMON PFC B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
GEORGE H HEYDENREICH PFC HQ 3RD 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
MARVIN E HINER PFC C 2/20/45 QUERCIOLA
EDWARD G HINSHAW PFC L 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
WALTER W HODGE PFC L 4/16/45 MT CROCE
MARVIN H HOFFMAN PFC F 2/23/45 C FLORIO
JOHN HOLLINGSWORTH CPL H 2/20/45 POLLA
PALMER W HORTON PFC M 4/19/45 IL POGGIO
GILBERT G HOUSLEY 2ND LT B 4/15/45 LE COSTE HILL 838
DAVID C HOYT CPL A 4/15/45 LE COSTE
RALPH HUBBARD PVT E 4/17/45 MT SERRA
WALTER R HUCKABEE S/SGT M 4/14/45 TORA
WILLIAM D HUFF PFC C 4/3/45 BARDALONE
CARL P HUJANEN SGT K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
ALAN HUNTLEY CPL HQ 2ND 4/15/45 MO DOZZONE
SAMUEL L IRVIN PVT SVC 4/16/45 MT PIGNA AID STATION
STANLEY F JAZWINSKI 2ND LT G 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
CASIMIR F JILKA PFC K 4/19/45 IL POGGIO
RICHARD D JOHNSTON PFC A 4/14/45 LE COSTE
HOMER P JUMP JR PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
HYMAN KALFIN T/5 K 4/27/45 GARDA
JOHN A KASABUSKI PFC E 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
WALTER S KASABUSKI S/SGT E 4/27/45 S ZENO
MOSE KEARSE PFC M 4/16/45 LOCARI SCUOLA
WILLIAM M KENNEDY SGT L 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
JAMES C KENNETT CAPT F 4/23/45 BAGNOLO SAN VIT0
JAMES P KENNEY PFC E 3/4/45 CANEVACCIA
ARTHUR L KERSTING PFC A 3/19/45 PIETRA COLORA
HARRISON H KING 2ND LT M 4/20/45 4/17/45 CAVARINE
PAUL L KLEIN PFC A 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI
LARRY KOLKKA PFC C 5/4/45 4/23/45 S BENEDETTO PO
RUDOLPH W KONIECZNY T/SGT F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
EDWARD J KOSA PFC B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
FRANK S KOVAR PFC F 4/15/45 MT PIGNA HILL 840
MORRIS J KRIEGER PFC F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
ROBERT J LA BOMBARD PFC B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
LAWRENCE J LA BONTE S/SGT L 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
FRANCIS A LA FOUNTAIN PFC M 3/4/45 C DEL FABBRO
WESLEY E LAHTI PFC F 3/3/45 FLIZZONE
WARNER F LAKEWAY PFC K 2/27/45 BELLAVISTA
CECIL D LARGENT PFC F 4/14/45 MT PIGNA
ROBERT H LATHROP PFC E 4/17/45 MT SERRA
GEORGE J LAWRENCE PFC F 4/14/45 TABOLE HILL 868
177
KIA/DOW DOW WIA
NAME RANK C O DATE DATE PLACE
MARION F LAY S/SGT C 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
MARVIN D LEDBETTER PFC M 4/14/45 TORA
TOIVO H LEINONEN PFC F 4/15/45 MT PIGNA HILL 840
SYLVESTER J LEPPEK PFC C 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
CHARLES W LEVITT SGT I 2/21/45 VALPIANA
LUTHER P LEWIS PFC A 3/6/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
MERVIN H LEWIS T/5 L 4/15/45 TREVISO
HENRY LEYMAN PFC D 4/14/45 LE COSTE
SOLON R LINDSEY CPL I 4/21/45 BASTIGLIA
CLARENCE W LINN JR PFC H 4/14/45 MT DELLA SPE
JOHN LOWATTI PFC I 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
HOMER H LOWE PFC I 4/16/45 MT MOSCA
FRANCIS E LOWERY PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
FRANK J LUIF PFC L 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
FLOYD H LUNSFORD PFC F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
MARVIN C LUTZ PFC K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
BRAINERD E LYNCH PVT G 3/4/45 MADNA DI BRASA
WILLIAM C MAAS III PFC K 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
ROBERT L MACWILLIAMS PFC L 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
WARREN F MAIN PFC G 2/17/45 RONCORAVECCHIA
THOMAS I MALLOY PFC F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
ALBERT MANCHIO T/5 B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
EVERETT G MANTHEI PVT G 4/29/45 MT BALDO
HARRY F MARKSON PVT G 4/20/45 TOMBA
JOHN C MARRONE S/SGT K 4/15/45 VEDETOLA
JOSEPH M MARTINEZ PFC I 4/21/45 BASTIGLIA
NYERAY O MATHEWS PFC G 4/23/45 VILLA CORREGGIO
LAWRENCE E MCARDLE PVT G 4/23/45 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
ROY L MCBRIDE PFC I 4/21/45 BASTIGLIA
DONALD M MCCOY JR PFC F 4/15/45 MT PIGNA HILL 840
ORVAL R MCDANIEL SGT I 4/16/45 MT CROCE
ALFRED C MCDONALD PVT G 4/22/45 BASTIGLIA
HOWARD MCMILLIAN PFC MED 4/14/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
CHARLES R MEISER JR PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
WILLIAM C MERRILL S/SGT D 2/19/45 MT BELVEDERE
JOSEPH C MILLER T/5 HQ 1ST 3/4/45 MT ACIDOLA
LEO E MILLER S/SGT HQ 2ND 3/3/45 ABETAIA
WILLIAM G MILLER PFC MED 4/16/45 MT PIGNA AID STATION
WILLIAM H MILLMANN 1ST LT MED 2/21/45 CORONA
HARRY MONTGOMERY CAPT (CHPL) HQ 3/3/45 ABETAIA
ROBERT D MOOTZ PFC G 4/15/45 SASSOLETTO HILL 807
BARTON C MORRISON T/5 MED 4/16/45 SECCADELLA
FORREST N MUELLER PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
JOHN C MURPHY PFC A 3/9/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
WILLIAM F MURPHY SGT D 2/20/45 MT BELVEDERE
CLARENCE K MUSICK 2ND LT F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
MICHAEL G NENNIG T/5 L 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
JAMES F NEVERGALL PFC I 3/26/45 LE BORRE
MICHAEL NICOSIA PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
RICHARD B NOCITRA PFC L 4/18/45 C BIDGINI
HOWARD R NORLIN PFC C 4/19/45 SULMONTE
LEE ROY NORRIS PFC L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
EUGENE C NORTON PFC F 3/3/45 FLIZZONE
JACOB R NUNNEMACHER S/SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
EVERT L NYLUND JR SGT K 4/19/45 IL POGGIO
GERARD E O'HARA PVT I 3/3/45 PIETRA COLORA
178
KIA/DOW DOW WIA
NAME RANK C O DATE DATE PLACE
THOMAS O'NEIL S/SGT E 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
LOUIE A ORDAZ PFC I 2/24/45 VALPIANA
CARL H ORTWEIN PFC C 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
FRED M PALMER PFC K 3/5/45 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
PETER A PANTSARI PFC B 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
JACK PEHR PFC C 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
HAROLD J PERDUE PFC K 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
KENNETH D PERKINS PFC MED 3/4/45 PIETRA COLORA
MARLIN A PERKINS PFC B 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
CHARLES L PFEIFFER 2ND LT K 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
ROBERT B PFUSCH 1ST LT E 3/6/45 3/5/45 CASONE
WILLIAM PHILP 1ST LT K 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
FRANK J PIAZZA PFC MED 3/3/45 PODELECCHIA
BURTON E PIERCE PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
EUGENE J PIOTROWSKI PFC HQ 3RD 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
JOSEPH A POIRIER JR S/SGT K 2/21/45 CORONA
ROBERT M POST PFC B 2/21/45 CORONA
ALEXIS POUTIATINE PFC C 3/17/45 PIETRA COLORA
CARL C PRATER PFC I 4/21/45 BASTIGLIA
PAUL T PUSKARICH PFC L 4/24/45 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
KENNETH D RAFFETY SGT M 4/16/45 LOCARI SCUOLA
HORACE H RAINEY PFC C 3/5/45 BACUCCO
WILBUR D REDDING PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
ROBERT P REICHE PFC L 4/16/45 LOCARI SCUOLA
CHARLES H REYNOLDS JR PFC L 4/16/45 LOCARI SCUOLA
ALAN H RINFRET CPL L 3/25/45 SASSOMOLARE
EDWARD J RINGLEIN PFC H 4/23/45 VILLA CORREGGIO
JAMES H ROGERS JR PVT L 2/28/45 ABETAIA
HENRY F ROSE JR PFC G 3/4/45 MADNA DI BRASA
ZALE R RUBINS PFC B 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
JAMES P RYAN S/SGT F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
WILLIAM S RYBERG 2ND LT C 3/5/45 MONFENARO
JESUS M SALAZAR PFC A 4/14/45 LE COSTE
FRANCISCO L SANTIESTEBAN PFC B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
ABRAHAM J SANTONI S/SGT A 3/5/45 CASTEL D'AIANO
ALBERT L SAYER PFC E 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
HARRY Y SCHAEDLER PFC F 3/12/45 CAMPO DEL SOLE
PAUL F SCHILLER PFC B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
CLAUS S SCHROEDER S/SGT K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
ANTHONY S SCUTO PFC I 3/3/45 PIETRA COLORA
WARREN H SEEBADE S/SGT K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
MACK O SELF PVT SVC 5/2/45 GARDA
JAMES C SERAKOS PFC B 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI
HARRY M SHEVCHIK S/SGT B 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
ANDREW F SIMPSON PFC F 4/15/45 TABOLE HILL 868
ANTHONY L SKOMP PFC A 4/14/45 LE COSTE
GEORGE SMITH JR PVT SVC 4/16/45 MT PIGNA AID STATION
WALTER F SMITH JR PFC L 4/17/45 C COSTA
EDWARD SNYDER PFC K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
HERBERT C SPAULDING S/SGT L 3/3/45 MT DELLA VEDETTA
HERBERT W A SPAULDING T/5 K 4/21/45 MADNA DELLA PROVVIDENZA
JOHN G SPRENG PFC I 4/21/45 4/16/45 MT MOSCA
ROBERT L STANGER PFC B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
EDWIN W STANKE T/4 A 4/29/45 SPIAZZI
EARL H STEVENS PFC I 4/15/45 SECCADELLA
JAMES M STEVENS PFC K 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
179
KIA/DOW DOW WIA
NAME RANK C O DATE DATE PLACE
WILLIAM F STEYERT SGT C 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
CHARLES G STICE PFC E 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
SAMUEL H STONER PFC HQ 3RD 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
FREDERICK B STRAUSS PFC I 3/3/45 PIETRA COLORA
JOSEPH E STREUMEYER SGT C 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
ROBERT W STROMBERG CPL M 4/14/45 TORA
ALLEN C STROMER S/SGT L 4/16/45 LOCARI SCUOLA
WALTER R STRUBEL SGT F 2/20/45 C FLORIO
WALFRED F SUTHERBURG PFC D 4/30/45 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
BILLY J THAXTON PVT G 2/17/45 RONCORAVECCHIA
HARRY THOMAS SGT K 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
LEWIS M THOMAS PFC F 4/14/45 TABOLE HILL 868
STEVE TOBIS T/4 K 4/19/45 IL POGGIO
JOHN J TOMICH PFC B 4/15/45 TORRE IUSSI
LEWIS S TRAUTWEIN T/5 HQ 2ND 3/3/45 ABETAIA
SIDNEY B UTTER PFC F 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
EDWIN G VAN AUKEN PFC G 2/20/45 POLLA
JOHN F VAN DE PUTTE PFC HQ 3/1/45 LA SERRA
CHESTER W VEST PFC C 4/24/45 4/23/45 GOVERNOLO
MELO VUKOVICH 2ND LT F 4/17/45 MT SERRA
SYLVAN D WALDRIP SGT B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
THEODORE E WALL PFC L 3/2/45 MALANDRONE
WILLIAM H WEBB JR T/SGT A 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI
JOHN J WELCH S/SGT K 4/15/45 MT CROCE
WILLIAM E WELLS PFC B 4/15/45 LE COSTE HILL 838
THEODORE W WENDERS PFC I 3/2/45 BELLAVISTA
WILLIAM H WENTWORTH PFC K 4/21/45 MADNA DELLA PROVVIDENZA
JAMES C WHYTE S/SGT D 4/15/45 MT PIGNA
JOHN M WILBUR PFC B 4/21/45 4/14/45 TORRE IUSSI HILL 860
WAYNE WILLIAMS PFC HQ 3RD 4/21/45 BAGAZZANO
DAN M WILSON PFC K 3/9/45 3/3/45 CIMON DELLA PIELLA
PAUL T WILSON T/4 B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
WILLIAM J WOLFGRAM 2ND LT L 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
GROVER P WOODS PFC A 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
EDWARD O WOZENCRAFT CPL B 4/19/45 C SILVESTRI
HERBERT G YARNELL PFC B 2/23/45 CORONA
ORLON J YODER PFC K 4/16/45 MADNA DI RODIANO
CHARLES YUPA PVT C 2/20/45 QUERCIOLA
FRED E ZARLENGO PFC C 4/19/45 MONGIORGIO
180
MAP 1. RIVA RIDGE
February 18 - 25
181
MAP 2. MT. BELVEDERE RIDGE
February 19 – March 2
182
MAP 3. MARCH OFFENSIVE
March 3 – March 6
183
MAP 4. SPRING OFFENSIVE
April 14 – 16
184
MAP 5. BREAKOUT
April 17 - 20
185
MAP 6. PO VALLEY SOUTH
April 20 – 22
186
MAP 7. PO RIVER CROSSING
April 23 – 24
187
MAP 8. ADVANCE TO LAKE GARDA
April 25 – 29
188
MAP 9. LAKE GARDA: THE FINAL BATTLES
April 28 – May 2